record-btrace: optionally indent function call history
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
889
890 @smallexample
891 @value{GDBP} -silent
892 @end smallexample
893
894 @noindent
895 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
896 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
897
898 @noindent
899 Type
900
901 @smallexample
902 @value{GDBP} -help
903 @end smallexample
904
905 @noindent
906 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
907 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
908
909 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
910 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
911 @samp{-x} option is used.
912
913
914 @menu
915 * File Options:: Choosing files
916 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
917 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
918 @end menu
919
920 @node File Options
921 @subsection Choosing Files
922
923 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
924 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
925 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
926 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
927 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
928 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
929 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
930 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
931 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
932 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
933 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
934 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
935 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
936
937 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
938 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
939 argument and ignore it.
940
941 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
942 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
943 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
944 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
945 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
946
947 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
948 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
949 @c it.
950
951 @table @code
952 @item -symbols @var{file}
953 @itemx -s @var{file}
954 @cindex @code{--symbols}
955 @cindex @code{-s}
956 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
957
958 @item -exec @var{file}
959 @itemx -e @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--exec}
961 @cindex @code{-e}
962 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
963 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
964
965 @item -se @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--se}
967 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
968 file.
969
970 @item -core @var{file}
971 @itemx -c @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--core}
973 @cindex @code{-c}
974 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
975
976 @item -pid @var{number}
977 @itemx -p @var{number}
978 @cindex @code{--pid}
979 @cindex @code{-p}
980 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
981
982 @item -command @var{file}
983 @itemx -x @var{file}
984 @cindex @code{--command}
985 @cindex @code{-x}
986 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
987 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
988 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
989
990 @item -eval-command @var{command}
991 @itemx -ex @var{command}
992 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
993 @cindex @code{-ex}
994 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
995
996 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
997 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
998
999 @smallexample
1000 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1001 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1002 @end smallexample
1003
1004 @item -init-command @var{file}
1005 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1006 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1007 @cindex @code{-ix}
1008 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1009 after loading gdbinit files).
1010 @xref{Startup}.
1011
1012 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1013 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1014 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1015 @cindex @code{-iex}
1016 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1017 after loading gdbinit files).
1018 @xref{Startup}.
1019
1020 @item -directory @var{directory}
1021 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1022 @cindex @code{--directory}
1023 @cindex @code{-d}
1024 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1025
1026 @item -r
1027 @itemx -readnow
1028 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1029 @cindex @code{-r}
1030 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1031 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1032 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1033
1034 @end table
1035
1036 @node Mode Options
1037 @subsection Choosing Modes
1038
1039 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1040 batch mode or quiet mode.
1041
1042 @table @code
1043 @anchor{-nx}
1044 @item -nx
1045 @itemx -n
1046 @cindex @code{--nx}
1047 @cindex @code{-n}
1048 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1049 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1050
1051 @table @code
1052 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1053 This is the system-wide init file.
1054 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1055 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1056 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1057 have been processed.
1058 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1059 This is the init file in your home directory.
1060 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1061 command options have been processed.
1062 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1063 This is the init file in the current directory.
1064 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1065 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1067 @end table
1068
1069 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1070 For documentation on how to write command files,
1071 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1072
1073 @anchor{-nh}
1074 @item -nh
1075 @cindex @code{--nh}
1076 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1077 in your home directory.
1078 @xref{Startup}.
1079
1080 @item -quiet
1081 @itemx -silent
1082 @itemx -q
1083 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1084 @cindex @code{--silent}
1085 @cindex @code{-q}
1086 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1087 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1088
1089 @item -batch
1090 @cindex @code{--batch}
1091 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1092 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1093 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1094 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1095 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1096 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1097 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1098
1099 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1100 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1101 make this more useful, the message
1102
1103 @smallexample
1104 Program exited normally.
1105 @end smallexample
1106
1107 @noindent
1108 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1109 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1110 mode.
1111
1112 @item -batch-silent
1113 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1114 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1115 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1116 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1117 for an interactive session.
1118
1119 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1120 messages, for example.
1121
1122 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1123 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1124
1125 @item -return-child-result
1126 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1127 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1128 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1129
1130 @itemize @bullet
1131 @item
1132 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1133 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1134 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1135 @item
1136 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1137 @item
1138 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1139 the exit code will be -1.
1140 @end itemize
1141
1142 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1143 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1144 interface.
1145
1146 @item -nowindows
1147 @itemx -nw
1148 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1149 @cindex @code{-nw}
1150 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1151 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1152 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1153
1154 @item -windows
1155 @itemx -w
1156 @cindex @code{--windows}
1157 @cindex @code{-w}
1158 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1159 used if possible.
1160
1161 @item -cd @var{directory}
1162 @cindex @code{--cd}
1163 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1164 instead of the current directory.
1165
1166 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1167 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1168 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1169 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1170 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1171
1172 @item -fullname
1173 @itemx -f
1174 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1175 @cindex @code{-f}
1176 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1177 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1178 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1179 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1180 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1181 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1182 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1183 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1184 frame.
1185
1186 @item -annotate @var{level}
1187 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1188 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1189 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1190 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1191 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1192 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1193 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1194 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1195 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1196
1197 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1198 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1199
1200 @item --args
1201 @cindex @code{--args}
1202 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1203 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1204 This option stops option processing.
1205
1206 @item -baud @var{bps}
1207 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1208 @cindex @code{--baud}
1209 @cindex @code{-b}
1210 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1211 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1212
1213 @item -l @var{timeout}
1214 @cindex @code{-l}
1215 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1216 for remote debugging.
1217
1218 @item -tty @var{device}
1219 @itemx -t @var{device}
1220 @cindex @code{--tty}
1221 @cindex @code{-t}
1222 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1223 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1224
1225 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1226 @item -tui
1227 @cindex @code{--tui}
1228 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1229 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1230 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1231 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1232 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1233 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1234
1235 @c @item -xdb
1236 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1237 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1238 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1239 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1240 @c systems.
1241
1242 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1243 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1244 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1245 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1246 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1247 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1248
1249 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1250 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1251 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1252 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1253 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1254 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1255
1256 @item -write
1257 @cindex @code{--write}
1258 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1259 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1260 (@pxref{Patching}).
1261
1262 @item -statistics
1263 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1264 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1265 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1266
1267 @item -version
1268 @cindex @code{--version}
1269 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1270 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1271
1272 @item -configuration
1273 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1274 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1275 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1276 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1277
1278 @end table
1279
1280 @node Startup
1281 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1282 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1283
1284 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1285
1286 @enumerate
1287 @item
1288 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1289 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1290
1291 @item
1292 @cindex init file
1293 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1294 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1295 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1296 that file.
1297
1298 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1299 @item
1300 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1301 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1302 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1303 that file.
1304
1305 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1306 @item
1307 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1308 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1309 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1310 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1311 gets loaded.
1312
1313 @item
1314 Processes command line options and operands.
1315
1316 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1317 @item
1318 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1319 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1320 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1321 This is only done if the current directory is
1322 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1323 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1324 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1325 @value{GDBN}.
1326
1327 @item
1328 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1329 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1330 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1331 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1332
1333 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1334 you must do something like the following:
1335
1336 @smallexample
1337 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1338 @end smallexample
1339
1340 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1341 off too late.
1342
1343 @item
1344 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1345 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1346 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1347
1348 @item
1349 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1350 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1351 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1352 @end enumerate
1353
1354 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1355 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1356 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1357 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1358 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1359 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1360
1361 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1362 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1363
1364 @cindex init file name
1365 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1366 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1367 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1368 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1369 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1370 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1371 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1372 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1373
1374
1375 @node Quitting GDB
1376 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1377 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1378 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1379
1380 @table @code
1381 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1382 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1383 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1384 @itemx q
1385 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1386 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1387 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1388 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1389 error code.
1390 @end table
1391
1392 @cindex interrupt
1393 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1394 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1395 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1396 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1397 until a time when it is safe.
1398
1399 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1400 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1401 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1402
1403 @node Shell Commands
1404 @section Shell Commands
1405
1406 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1407 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1408 just use the @code{shell} command.
1409
1410 @table @code
1411 @kindex shell
1412 @kindex !
1413 @cindex shell escape
1414 @item shell @var{command-string}
1415 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1416 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1417 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1418 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1419 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1420 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1421 @end table
1422
1423 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1424 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1425 @value{GDBN}:
1426
1427 @table @code
1428 @kindex make
1429 @cindex calling make
1430 @item make @var{make-args}
1431 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1432 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1433 @end table
1434
1435 @node Logging Output
1436 @section Logging Output
1437 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1438 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1439
1440 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1441 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1442
1443 @table @code
1444 @kindex set logging
1445 @item set logging on
1446 Enable logging.
1447 @item set logging off
1448 Disable logging.
1449 @cindex logging file name
1450 @item set logging file @var{file}
1451 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1452 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1453 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1454 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1455 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1456 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1457 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1458 @kindex show logging
1459 @item show logging
1460 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1461 @end table
1462
1463 @node Commands
1464 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1465
1466 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1467 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1468 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1469 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1470 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1471
1472 @menu
1473 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1474 * Completion:: Command completion
1475 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1476 @end menu
1477
1478 @node Command Syntax
1479 @section Command Syntax
1480
1481 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1482 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1483 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1484 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1485 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1486 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1487
1488 @cindex abbreviation
1489 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1490 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1491 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1492 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1493 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1494 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1495 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1496
1497 @cindex repeating commands
1498 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1499 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1500 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1501 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1502 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1503 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1504 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1505
1506 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1507 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1508 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1509
1510 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1511 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1512 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1513 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1514 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1515
1516 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1517 @cindex comment
1518 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1519 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1520 Files,,Command Files}).
1521
1522 @cindex repeating command sequences
1523 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1524 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1525 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1526 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1527 for editing.
1528
1529 @node Completion
1530 @section Command Completion
1531
1532 @cindex completion
1533 @cindex word completion
1534 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1535 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1536 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1537 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1538
1539 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1540 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1541 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1542 enter it). For example, if you type
1543
1544 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1545 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1546 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1547 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1548 @smallexample
1549 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1550 @end smallexample
1551
1552 @noindent
1553 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1554 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1555
1556 @smallexample
1557 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1558 @end smallexample
1559
1560 @noindent
1561 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1562 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1563 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1564 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1565 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1566 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1567
1568 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1569 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1570 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1571 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1572 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1573 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1574 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1575 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1576 example:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1580 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1581 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1582 make_abs_section make_function_type
1583 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1584 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1585 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1586 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1587 @end smallexample
1588
1589 @noindent
1590 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1591 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1592 command.
1593
1594 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1595 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1596 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1597 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1598 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1599
1600 @cindex quotes in commands
1601 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1602 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1603 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1604 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1605 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1606 @value{GDBN} commands.
1607
1608 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1609 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1610 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1611 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1612 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1613 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1614 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1615 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1616 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1617 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1618 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1622 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1623 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1624 @end smallexample
1625
1626 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1627 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1628 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1629 place:
1630
1631 @smallexample
1632 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1633 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1634 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1635 @end smallexample
1636
1637 @noindent
1638 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1639 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1640 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1641
1642 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1643 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1644 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1645 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1646
1647 @cindex completion of structure field names
1648 @cindex structure field name completion
1649 @cindex completion of union field names
1650 @cindex union field name completion
1651 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1652 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1653 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1654 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1655 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1656 left-hand-side:
1657
1658 @smallexample
1659 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1660 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1661 to_data to_isatty to_write
1662 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1663 to_flush to_read
1664 @end smallexample
1665
1666 @noindent
1667 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1668 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1669 follows:
1670
1671 @smallexample
1672 struct ui_file
1673 @{
1674 int *magic;
1675 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1676 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1677 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1678 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1679 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1680 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1681 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1682 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1683 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1684 void *to_data;
1685 @}
1686 @end smallexample
1687
1688
1689 @node Help
1690 @section Getting Help
1691 @cindex online documentation
1692 @kindex help
1693
1694 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1695 using the command @code{help}.
1696
1697 @table @code
1698 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1699 @item help
1700 @itemx h
1701 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1702 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1703
1704 @smallexample
1705 (@value{GDBP}) help
1706 List of classes of commands:
1707
1708 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1709 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1710 data -- Examining data
1711 files -- Specifying and examining files
1712 internals -- Maintenance commands
1713 obscure -- Obscure features
1714 running -- Running the program
1715 stack -- Examining the stack
1716 status -- Status inquiries
1717 support -- Support facilities
1718 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1719 stopping the program
1720 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1721
1722 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1723 commands in that class.
1724 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1725 documentation.
1726 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1727 (@value{GDBP})
1728 @end smallexample
1729 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1730
1731 @item help @var{class}
1732 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1733 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1734 help display for the class @code{status}:
1735
1736 @smallexample
1737 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1738 Status inquiries.
1739
1740 List of commands:
1741
1742 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1743 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1744 info -- Generic command for showing things
1745 about the program being debugged
1746 show -- Generic command for showing things
1747 about the debugger
1748
1749 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1750 documentation.
1751 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1752 (@value{GDBP})
1753 @end smallexample
1754
1755 @item help @var{command}
1756 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1757 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1758
1759 @kindex apropos
1760 @item apropos @var{args}
1761 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1762 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1763 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1764
1765 @smallexample
1766 apropos alias
1767 @end smallexample
1768
1769 @noindent
1770 results in:
1771
1772 @smallexample
1773 @c @group
1774 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1775 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1776 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1777 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1778 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1779 @c @end group
1780 @end smallexample
1781
1782 @kindex complete
1783 @item complete @var{args}
1784 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1785 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1786 command you want completed. For example:
1787
1788 @smallexample
1789 complete i
1790 @end smallexample
1791
1792 @noindent results in:
1793
1794 @smallexample
1795 @group
1796 if
1797 ignore
1798 info
1799 inspect
1800 @end group
1801 @end smallexample
1802
1803 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1804 @end table
1805
1806 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1807 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1808 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1809 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1810 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1811 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1812 Index}.
1813
1814 @c @group
1815 @table @code
1816 @kindex info
1817 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1818 @item info
1819 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1820 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1821 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1822 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1823 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1824 @w{@code{help info}}.
1825
1826 @kindex set
1827 @item set
1828 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1829 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1830 @code{set prompt $}.
1831
1832 @kindex show
1833 @item show
1834 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1835 @value{GDBN} itself.
1836 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1837 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1838 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1839 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1840
1841 @kindex info set
1842 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1843 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1844 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1845 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1846 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1847 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1848 @end table
1849 @c @end group
1850
1851 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1852 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1853
1854 @table @code
1855 @kindex show version
1856 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1857 @item show version
1858 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1859 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1860 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1861 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1862 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1863 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1864 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1865 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1866 @value{GDBN}.
1867
1868 @kindex show copying
1869 @kindex info copying
1870 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1871 @item show copying
1872 @itemx info copying
1873 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1874
1875 @kindex show warranty
1876 @kindex info warranty
1877 @item show warranty
1878 @itemx info warranty
1879 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1880 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1881
1882 @kindex show configuration
1883 @item show configuration
1884 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1885 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1886 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1887 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1888 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1889 your report.
1890
1891 @end table
1892
1893 @node Running
1894 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1895
1896 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1897 debugging information when you compile it.
1898
1899 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1900 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1901 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1902 kill a child process.
1903
1904 @menu
1905 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1906 * Starting:: Starting your program
1907 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1908 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1909
1910 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1911 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1912 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1913 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1914
1915 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1916 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1917 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1918 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1919 @end menu
1920
1921 @node Compilation
1922 @section Compiling for Debugging
1923
1924 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1926 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1927 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1928 and addresses in the executable code.
1929
1930 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1931 the compiler.
1932
1933 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1934 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1935 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1936 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1937 executables containing debugging information.
1938
1939 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1940 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1941 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1942 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1943 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1944
1945 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1946 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1947 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1948
1949 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1950 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1951 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1952 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1953 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1954 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1955
1956 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1957 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1958 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1959
1960 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1961 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1962 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1963 format in @value{GDBN}.
1964
1965 @need 2000
1966 @node Starting
1967 @section Starting your Program
1968 @cindex starting
1969 @cindex running
1970
1971 @table @code
1972 @kindex run
1973 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1974 @item run
1975 @itemx r
1976 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1977 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1978 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1979 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1980 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1981
1982 @end table
1983
1984 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1985 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1986 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1987 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1988 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1989 message like this one:
1990
1991 @smallexample
1992 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1993 Try "help target" or "continue".
1994 @end smallexample
1995
1996 @noindent
1997 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1998 first (@pxref{load}).
1999
2000 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2001 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2002 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2003 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2004 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2005 divided into four categories:
2006
2007 @table @asis
2008 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2009 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2010 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2011 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2012 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2013 the arguments.
2014 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2015 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2016 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2017 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2018 below for details).
2019
2020 @item The @emph{environment.}
2021 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2022 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2023 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2024 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2025
2026 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2027 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2028 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2029 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2030
2031 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2032 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2033 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2034 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2035 set a different device for your program.
2036 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2037
2038 @cindex pipes
2039 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2040 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2041 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2042 wrong program.
2043 @end table
2044
2045 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2046 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2047 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2048 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2049 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2050
2051 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2052 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2053 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2054 your current breakpoints.
2055
2056 @table @code
2057 @kindex start
2058 @item start
2059 @cindex run to main procedure
2060 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2061 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2062 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2063 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2064 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2065 procedure, depending on the language used.
2066
2067 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2068 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2069 the @samp{run} command.
2070
2071 @cindex elaboration phase
2072 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2073 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2074 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2075 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2076 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2077 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2078 will remain to halt execution.
2079
2080 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2081 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2082 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2083 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2084 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2085
2086 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2087 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2088 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2089 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2090 elaboration code before running your program.
2091
2092 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2093 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2094 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2095 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2096 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2097 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2098 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2099 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2100 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2101 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2102 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2103 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2104
2105 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2106 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2107 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2108 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2109
2110 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2111 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2112 environment:
2113
2114 @smallexample
2115 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2116 (@value{GDBP}) run
2117 @end smallexample
2118
2119 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2120 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2121
2122 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2123 @item set startup-with-shell
2124 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2125 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2126 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2127 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2128 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2129 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2130 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2131 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2132 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2133 startup failures such as:
2134
2135 @smallexample
2136 (@value{GDBP}) run
2137 Starting program: ./a.out
2138 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2139 @end smallexample
2140
2141 @noindent
2142 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2143 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2144 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2145 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2146 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2147 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2148
2149 @kindex set disable-randomization
2150 @item set disable-randomization
2151 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2152 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2153 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2154 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2155 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2156
2157 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2158 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2159
2160 @smallexample
2161 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2162 @end smallexample
2163
2164 @item set disable-randomization off
2165 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2166 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2167 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2168 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2169 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2170 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2171
2172 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2173 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2174 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2175 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2176 a code at its expected addresses.
2177
2178 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2179 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2180 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2181 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2182 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2183 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2184 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2185 a randomly chosen address.
2186
2187 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2188 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2189 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2190 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2191 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2192
2193 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2194 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2195
2196 @item show disable-randomization
2197 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2198 the virtual address space of the started program.
2199
2200 @end table
2201
2202 @node Arguments
2203 @section Your Program's Arguments
2204
2205 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2206 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2207 @code{run} command.
2208 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2209 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2210 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2211 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2212 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2213
2214 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2215 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2216 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2217 the program, not by the shell.
2218
2219 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2220 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2221
2222 @table @code
2223 @kindex set args
2224 @item set args
2225 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2226 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2227 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2228 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2229 it again without arguments.
2230
2231 @kindex show args
2232 @item show args
2233 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2234 @end table
2235
2236 @node Environment
2237 @section Your Program's Environment
2238
2239 @cindex environment (of your program)
2240 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2241 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2242 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2243 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2244 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2245 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2246 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2247
2248 @table @code
2249 @kindex path
2250 @item path @var{directory}
2251 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2252 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2253 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2254 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2255 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2256 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2257 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2258
2259 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2260 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2261 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2262 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2263 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2264 @var{directory} to the search path.
2265 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2266 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2267
2268 @kindex show paths
2269 @item show paths
2270 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2271 environment variable).
2272
2273 @kindex show environment
2274 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2275 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2276 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2277 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2278 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2279
2280 @kindex set environment
2281 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2282 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2283 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2284 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may be any string; the
2285 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2286 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2287 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2288 null value.
2289 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2290 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2291
2292 For example, this command:
2293
2294 @smallexample
2295 set env USER = foo
2296 @end smallexample
2297
2298 @noindent
2299 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2300 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2301 are not actually required.)
2302
2303 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2304 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2305 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2306 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2307 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2308
2309 @kindex unset environment
2310 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2311 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2312 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2313 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2314 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2315 @end table
2316
2317 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2318 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2319 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2320 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2321 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2322 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2323 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2324 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2325 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2326 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2327
2328 @node Working Directory
2329 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2330
2331 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2332 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2333 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2334 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2335 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2336 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2337
2338 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2339 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2340 Specify Files}.
2341
2342 @table @code
2343 @kindex cd
2344 @cindex change working directory
2345 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2346 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2347 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2348
2349 @kindex pwd
2350 @item pwd
2351 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2352 @end table
2353
2354 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2355 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2356 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2357 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2358 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2359 current working directory of the debuggee.
2360
2361 @node Input/Output
2362 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2363
2364 @cindex redirection
2365 @cindex i/o
2366 @cindex terminal
2367 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2368 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2369 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2370 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2371 running your program.
2372
2373 @table @code
2374 @kindex info terminal
2375 @item info terminal
2376 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2377 program is using.
2378 @end table
2379
2380 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2381 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2382
2383 @smallexample
2384 run > outfile
2385 @end smallexample
2386
2387 @noindent
2388 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2389
2390 @kindex tty
2391 @cindex controlling terminal
2392 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2393 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2394 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2395 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2396 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2397
2398 @smallexample
2399 tty /dev/ttyb
2400 @end smallexample
2401
2402 @noindent
2403 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2404 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2405 that as their controlling terminal.
2406
2407 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2408 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2409 terminal.
2410
2411 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2412 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2413 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2414 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2415
2416 @cindex inferior tty
2417 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2418 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2419 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2420 program.
2421
2422 @table @code
2423 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2424 @kindex set inferior-tty
2425 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2426
2427 @item show inferior-tty
2428 @kindex show inferior-tty
2429 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2430 @end table
2431
2432 @node Attach
2433 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2434 @kindex attach
2435 @cindex attach
2436
2437 @table @code
2438 @item attach @var{process-id}
2439 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2440 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2441 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2442 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2443 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2444
2445 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2446 executing the command.
2447 @end table
2448
2449 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2450 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2451 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2452 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2453
2454 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2455 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2456 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2457 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2458 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2459 Specify Files}.
2460
2461 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2462 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2463 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2464 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2465 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2466 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2467 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2468
2469 @table @code
2470 @kindex detach
2471 @item detach
2472 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2473 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2474 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2475 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2476 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2477 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2478 executing the command.
2479 @end table
2480
2481 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2482 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2483 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2484 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2485 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2486 Messages}).
2487
2488 @node Kill Process
2489 @section Killing the Child Process
2490
2491 @table @code
2492 @kindex kill
2493 @item kill
2494 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2495 @end table
2496
2497 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2498 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2499 is running.
2500
2501 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2502 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2503 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2504 outside the debugger.
2505
2506 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2507 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2508 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2509 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2510 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2511 breakpoint settings).
2512
2513 @node Inferiors and Programs
2514 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2515
2516 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2517 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2518 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2519 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2520 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2521 from multiple executables.
2522
2523 @cindex inferior
2524 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2525 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2526 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2527 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2528 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2529 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2530 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2531 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2532 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2533 threads running in it.
2534
2535 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2536 inferiors}}:
2537
2538 @table @code
2539 @kindex info inferiors
2540 @item info inferiors
2541 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2542
2543 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2544
2545 @enumerate
2546 @item
2547 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2548
2549 @item
2550 the target system's inferior identifier
2551
2552 @item
2553 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2554
2555 @end enumerate
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2559 indicates the current inferior.
2560
2561 For example,
2562 @end table
2563 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2564
2565 @smallexample
2566 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2567 Num Description Executable
2568 2 process 2307 hello
2569 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2570 @end smallexample
2571
2572 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2573
2574 @table @code
2575 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2576 @item inferior @var{infno}
2577 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2578 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2579 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2580 @end table
2581
2582
2583 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2584 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2585 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2586 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2587 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2588 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2589
2590 @table @code
2591 @kindex add-inferior
2592 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2593 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2594 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2595 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2596 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2597 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2598
2599 @kindex clone-inferior
2600 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2601 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2602 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2603 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2604 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2605
2606 @smallexample
2607 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2608 Num Description Executable
2609 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2610 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2611 Added inferior 2.
2612 1 inferiors added.
2613 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2614 Num Description Executable
2615 2 <null> helloworld
2616 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2617 @end smallexample
2618
2619 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2620
2621 @kindex remove-inferiors
2622 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2623 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2624 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2625 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2626
2627 @end table
2628
2629 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2630 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2631 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2632 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2633
2634 @table @code
2635 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2636 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2637 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2638 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2639 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2640 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2641
2642 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2643 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2644 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2645 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2646 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2647 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2648 @end table
2649
2650 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2651 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2652 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2653 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2654
2655
2656 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2657 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2658
2659 @table @code
2660 @kindex set print inferior-events
2661 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2662 @item set print inferior-events
2663 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2664 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2665 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2666 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2667 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2668 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2669
2670 @kindex show print inferior-events
2671 @item show print inferior-events
2672 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2673 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2674 @end table
2675
2676 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2677 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2678 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2679
2680
2681 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2682 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2683 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2684 info program-spaces}} command.
2685
2686 @table @code
2687 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2688 @item maint info program-spaces
2689 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2690 @value{GDBN}.
2691
2692 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2693
2694 @enumerate
2695 @item
2696 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2697
2698 @item
2699 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2700 the @code{file} command.
2701
2702 @end enumerate
2703
2704 @noindent
2705 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2706 indicates the current program space.
2707
2708 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2709 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2710 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2711
2712 @smallexample
2713 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2714 Id Executable
2715 2 goodbye
2716 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2717 * 1 hello
2718 @end smallexample
2719
2720 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2721 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2722 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2723 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2724 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2725
2726 @smallexample
2727 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2728 Id Executable
2729 * 1 vfork-test
2730 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2731 @end smallexample
2732
2733 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2734 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2735 @end table
2736
2737 @node Threads
2738 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2739
2740 @cindex threads of execution
2741 @cindex multiple threads
2742 @cindex switching threads
2743 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2744 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2745 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2746 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2747 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2748 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2749 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2750
2751 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2752 programs:
2753
2754 @itemize @bullet
2755 @item automatic notification of new threads
2756 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2757 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2758 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2759 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2760 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2761 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2762 messages on thread start and exit.
2763 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2764 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2765 isn't compatible with the program.
2766 @end itemize
2767
2768 @quotation
2769 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2770 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2771 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2772 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2773 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2774 like this:
2775
2776 @smallexample
2777 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2778 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2779 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2780 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2781 @end smallexample
2782 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2783 @c doesn't support threads"?
2784 @end quotation
2785
2786 @cindex focus of debugging
2787 @cindex current thread
2788 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2789 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2790 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2791 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2792 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2793
2794 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2795 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2796 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2797 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2798 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2799 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2800 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2801 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2802 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2803 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2807 @end smallexample
2808
2809 @noindent
2810 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2811 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2812 further qualifier.
2813
2814 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2815 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2816 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2817 @c program?
2818 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2819 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2820 @c threads ab initio?
2821
2822 @cindex thread number
2823 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2824 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2825 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2826
2827 @table @code
2828 @kindex info threads
2829 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2830 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2831 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2832 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2833 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2834
2835 @enumerate
2836 @item
2837 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2838
2839 @item
2840 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2841
2842 @item
2843 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2844 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2845 program itself.
2846
2847 @item
2848 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2849 @end enumerate
2850
2851 @noindent
2852 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2853 indicates the current thread.
2854
2855 For example,
2856 @end table
2857 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2858
2859 @smallexample
2860 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2861 Id Target Id Frame
2862 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2863 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2864 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2865 at threadtest.c:68
2866 @end smallexample
2867
2868 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2869 Solaris-specific command:
2870
2871 @table @code
2872 @item maint info sol-threads
2873 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2874 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2875 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2876 @end table
2877
2878 @table @code
2879 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2880 @item thread @var{threadno}
2881 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2882 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2883 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2884 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2885 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2886
2887 @smallexample
2888 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2889 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2890 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2891 8 printf ("hello\n");
2892 @end smallexample
2893
2894 @noindent
2895 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2896 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2897 threads.
2898
2899 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2900 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2901 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2902 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2903 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2904 information on convenience variables.
2905
2906 @kindex thread apply
2907 @cindex apply command to several threads
2908 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2909 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2910 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2911 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2912 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2913 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2914 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2915 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2916
2917 @kindex thread name
2918 @cindex name a thread
2919 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2920 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2921 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2922 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2923
2924 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2925 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2926 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2927 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2928 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2929
2930 @kindex thread find
2931 @cindex search for a thread
2932 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2933 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2934 matches the supplied regular expression.
2935
2936 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2937 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2938 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2939 is the LWP id.
2940
2941 @smallexample
2942 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2943 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2944 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2945 Id Target Id Frame
2946 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
2947 @end smallexample
2948
2949 @kindex set print thread-events
2950 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2951 @item set print thread-events
2952 @itemx set print thread-events on
2953 @itemx set print thread-events off
2954 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2955 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2956 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2957 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2958 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2959
2960 @kindex show print thread-events
2961 @item show print thread-events
2962 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2963 have started and exited.
2964 @end table
2965
2966 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2967 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2968 programs with multiple threads.
2969
2970 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2971 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2972
2973 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
2974 @table @code
2975 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2976 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2977 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2978 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2979 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2980 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2981 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
2982 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
2983 macro.
2984
2985 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2986 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2987 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2988 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
2989 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
2990 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2991
2992 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2993 refers to the default system directories that are
2994 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
2995 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
2996 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
2997
2998 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2999 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3000 was loaded in the inferior process.
3001
3002 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3003 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3004 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3005 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3006 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3007 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3008 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3009
3010 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3011 only on some platforms.
3012
3013 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3014 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3015 Display current libthread_db search path.
3016
3017 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3018 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3019 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3020 @item set debug libthread-db
3021 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3022 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3023 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3024 @end table
3025
3026 @node Forks
3027 @section Debugging Forks
3028
3029 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3030 @cindex multiple processes
3031 @cindex processes, multiple
3032 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3033 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3034 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3035 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3036 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3037 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3038 will cause it to terminate.
3039
3040 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3041 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3042 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3043 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3044 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3045 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3046 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3047 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3048 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3049 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3050
3051 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3052 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3053 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3054 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3055
3056 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3057 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3058
3059 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3060 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3061
3062 @table @code
3063 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3064 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3065 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3066 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3067 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3068
3069 @table @code
3070 @item parent
3071 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3072 unimpeded. This is the default.
3073
3074 @item child
3075 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3076 unimpeded.
3077
3078 @end table
3079
3080 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3081 @item show follow-fork-mode
3082 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3083 @end table
3084
3085 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3086 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3087 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3088
3089 @table @code
3090 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3091 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3092 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3093 retain debugger control over them both.
3094
3095 @table @code
3096 @item on
3097 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3098 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3099 independently. This is the default.
3100
3101 @item off
3102 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3103 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3104 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3105 is held suspended.
3106
3107 @end table
3108
3109 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3110 @item show detach-on-fork
3111 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3112 @end table
3113
3114 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3115 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3116 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3117 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3118 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3119 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3120
3121 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3122 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3123 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3124 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3125 and Programs}.
3126
3127 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3128 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3129 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3130 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3131 the child process's @code{main}.
3132
3133 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3134 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3135
3136 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3137 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3138 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3139 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3140 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3141 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3142 command.
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3146 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3147
3148 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3149 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3150
3151 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3152
3153 @table @code
3154 @item new
3155 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3156 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3157 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3158 original inferior.
3159
3160 For example:
3161
3162 @smallexample
3163 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3164 (gdb) info inferior
3165 Id Description Executable
3166 * 1 <null> prog1
3167 (@value{GDBP}) run
3168 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3169 Program exited normally.
3170 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3171 Id Description Executable
3172 * 2 <null> prog2
3173 1 <null> prog1
3174 @end smallexample
3175
3176 @item same
3177 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3178 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3179 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3180 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3181 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3182
3183 For example:
3184
3185 @smallexample
3186 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3187 Id Description Executable
3188 * 1 <null> prog1
3189 (@value{GDBP}) run
3190 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3191 Program exited normally.
3192 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3193 Id Description Executable
3194 * 1 <null> prog2
3195 @end smallexample
3196
3197 @end table
3198 @end table
3199
3200 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3201 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3202 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3203
3204 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3205 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3206
3207 @cindex checkpoint
3208 @cindex restart
3209 @cindex bookmark
3210 @cindex snapshot of a process
3211 @cindex rewind program state
3212
3213 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3214 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3215 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3216 later.
3217
3218 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3219 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3220 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3221 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3222 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3223
3224 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3225 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3226 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3227 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3228 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3229 start again from there.
3230
3231 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3232 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3233
3234 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3235
3236 @table @code
3237 @kindex checkpoint
3238 @item checkpoint
3239 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3240 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3241 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3242
3243 @kindex info checkpoints
3244 @item info checkpoints
3245 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3246 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3247 listed:
3248
3249 @table @code
3250 @item Checkpoint ID
3251 @item Process ID
3252 @item Code Address
3253 @item Source line, or label
3254 @end table
3255
3256 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3257 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3258 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3259 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3260 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3261 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3262 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3263
3264 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3265 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3266 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3267 the debugger.
3268
3269 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3270 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3271 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3272
3273 @end table
3274
3275 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3276 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3277 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3278 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3279 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3280 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3281 previously read data can be read again.
3282
3283 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3284 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3285 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3286 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3287 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3288 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3289
3290 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3291 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3292 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3293 different execution path this time.
3294
3295 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3296 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3297 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3298 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3299 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3300 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3301 potentially pose a problem.
3302
3303 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3304
3305 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3306 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3307 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3308 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3309 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3310 next.
3311
3312 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3313 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3314 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3315 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3316 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3317
3318 @node Stopping
3319 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3320
3321 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3322 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3323 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3324
3325 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3326 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3327 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3328 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3329 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3330 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3331 explicitly request this information at any time.
3332
3333 @table @code
3334 @kindex info program
3335 @item info program
3336 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3337 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3338 @end table
3339
3340 @menu
3341 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3342 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3343 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3344 Skipping over functions and files
3345 * Signals:: Signals
3346 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3347 @end menu
3348
3349 @node Breakpoints
3350 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3351
3352 @cindex breakpoints
3353 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3354 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3355 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3356 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3357 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3358 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3359 program.
3360
3361 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3362 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3363 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3364 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3365 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3366 call).
3367
3368 @cindex watchpoints
3369 @cindex data breakpoints
3370 @cindex memory tracing
3371 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3372 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3373 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3374 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3375 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3376 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3377 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3378 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3379 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3380 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3381 same commands.
3382
3383 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3384 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3385 Automatic Display}.
3386
3387 @cindex catchpoints
3388 @cindex breakpoint on events
3389 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3390 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3391 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3392 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3393 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3394 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3395 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3396
3397 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3398 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3399 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3400 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3401 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3402 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3403 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3404 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3405 enable it again.
3406
3407 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3408 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3409 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3410 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3411 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3412 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3413 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3414
3415 @menu
3416 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3417 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3418 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3419 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3420 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3421 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3422 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3423 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3424 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3425 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3426 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3427 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3428 @end menu
3429
3430 @node Set Breaks
3431 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3432
3433 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3434 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3435 @c
3436 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3437
3438 @kindex break
3439 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3440 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3441 @cindex latest breakpoint
3442 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3443 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3444 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3445 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3446 convenience variables.
3447
3448 @table @code
3449 @item break @var{location}
3450 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3451 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3452 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3453 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3454 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3455
3456 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3457 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3458 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3459 that situation.
3460
3461 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3462 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3463 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3464
3465 @item break
3466 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3467 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3468 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3469 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3470 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3471 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3472 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3473 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3474 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3475 inside loops.
3476
3477 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3478 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3479 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3480 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3481 existed when your program stopped.
3482
3483 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3484 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3485 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3486 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3487 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3488 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3489 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3490
3491 @kindex tbreak
3492 @item tbreak @var{args}
3493 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3494 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3495 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3496 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3497
3498 @kindex hbreak
3499 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3500 @item hbreak @var{args}
3501 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3502 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3503 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3504 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3505 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3506 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3507 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3508 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3509 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3510 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3511 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3512 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3513 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3514 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3515 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3516 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3517 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3518 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3519
3520 @kindex thbreak
3521 @item thbreak @var{args}
3522 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3523 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3524 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3525 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3526 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3527 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3528 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3529 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3530
3531 @kindex rbreak
3532 @cindex regular expression
3533 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3534 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3535 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3536 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3537 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3538 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3539 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3540 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3541 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3542
3543 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3544 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3545 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3546 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3547 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3548 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3549
3550 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3551 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3552 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3553 classes.
3554
3555 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3556 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3557 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3558
3559 @smallexample
3560 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3561 @end smallexample
3562
3563 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3564 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3565 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3566 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3567 every function in a given file:
3568
3569 @smallexample
3570 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3571 @end smallexample
3572
3573 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3574 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3575
3576 @kindex info breakpoints
3577 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3578 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3579 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3580 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3581 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3582 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3583 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3584
3585 @table @emph
3586 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3587 @item Type
3588 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3589 @item Disposition
3590 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3591 @item Enabled or Disabled
3592 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3593 that are not enabled.
3594 @item Address
3595 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3596 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3597 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3598 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3599 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3600 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3601 @item What
3602 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3603 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3604 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3605 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3606 @end table
3607
3608 @noindent
3609 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3610 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3611 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3612 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3613 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3614 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3615
3616 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3617 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3618 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3619 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3620
3621 @noindent
3622 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3623 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3624 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3625 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3626 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3627
3628 @noindent
3629 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3630 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3631 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3632 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3633 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3634 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3635
3636 @noindent
3637 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3638 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3639
3640 @end table
3641
3642 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3643 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3644 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3645 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3646
3647 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3648 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3649 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3650 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3651
3652 @itemize @bullet
3653 @item
3654 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3655
3656 @item
3657 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3658 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3659
3660 @item
3661 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3662 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3663
3664 @item
3665 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3666 several places where that function is inlined.
3667 @end itemize
3668
3669 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3670 the relevant locations.
3671
3672 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3673 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3674 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3675 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3676 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3677 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3678 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3679
3680 For example:
3681
3682 @smallexample
3683 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3684 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3685 stop only if i==1
3686 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3687 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3688 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3689 @end smallexample
3690
3691 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3692 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3693 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3694 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3695 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3696 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3697 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3698 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3699 that belong to that breakpoint.
3700
3701 @cindex pending breakpoints
3702 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3703 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3704 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3705 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3706 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3707 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3708 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3709 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3710 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3711 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3712 is not yet resolved.
3713
3714 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3715 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3716 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3717 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3718 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3719 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3720
3721 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3722 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3723 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3724 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3725
3726 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3727 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3728 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3729
3730 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3731 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3732 address specification to an address:
3733
3734 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3735 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3736 @table @code
3737 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3738 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3739 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3740
3741 @item set breakpoint pending on
3742 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3743 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3744
3745 @item set breakpoint pending off
3746 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3747 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3748 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3749
3750 @item show breakpoint pending
3751 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3752 @end table
3753
3754 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3755 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3756 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3757
3758 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3759 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3760 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3761 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3762 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3763 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3764 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3765 breakpoints.
3766
3767 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3768
3769 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3770 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3771 @table @code
3772 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3773 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3774 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3775 breakpoint must be used.
3776
3777 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3778 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3779 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3780 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3781 @end table
3782
3783 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3784 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3785 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3786 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3787 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3788 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3789 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3790 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3791 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3792
3793 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3794 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3795 @table @code
3796 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3797 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3798 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3799 removed from the target when it stops.
3800
3801 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3802 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3803 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3804 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3805 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3806
3807 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3808 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3809 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3810 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3811 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3812 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3813 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3814 @end table
3815
3816 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3817 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3818 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3819
3820 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3821 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3822
3823 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3824
3825 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3826 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3827 @table @code
3828 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3829 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3830 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3831 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3832 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3833
3834 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3835 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3836 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3837 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3838 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3839 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3840 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3841 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3842 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3843 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3844 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3845 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3846 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3847
3848 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3849 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3850 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3851 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3852 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3853 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3854 @end table
3855
3856
3857 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3858 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3859 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3860 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3861 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3862 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3863 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3864 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3865
3866
3867 @node Set Watchpoints
3868 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3869
3870 @cindex setting watchpoints
3871 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3872 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3873 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3874 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3875 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3876
3877 @itemize @bullet
3878 @item
3879 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3880
3881 @item
3882 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3883 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3884 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3885
3886 @item
3887 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3888 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3889 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3890 @end itemize
3891
3892 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3893 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3894 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3895 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3896 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3897 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3898 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3899 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3900 the expression changes.
3901
3902 @cindex software watchpoints
3903 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3904 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3905 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3906 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3907 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3908 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3909 culprit.)
3910
3911 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3912 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3913 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3914
3915 @table @code
3916 @kindex watch
3917 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3918 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3919 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3920 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3921 to watch the value of a single variable:
3922
3923 @smallexample
3924 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3925 @end smallexample
3926
3927 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3928 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3929 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3930 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3931 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3932 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3933
3934 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3935 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3936 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3937 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3938 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3939 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3940 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3941 error.
3942
3943 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3944 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3945 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
3946 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
3947 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
3948 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
3949 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
3950 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
3951 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
3952 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
3953 Examples:
3954
3955 @smallexample
3956 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
3957 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
3958 @end smallexample
3959
3960 @kindex rwatch
3961 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3962 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3963 by the program.
3964
3965 @kindex awatch
3966 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3967 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3968 or written into by the program.
3969
3970 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3971 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3972 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3973 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3974 @end table
3975
3976 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3977 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3978 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3979 a never-changing value:
3980
3981 @smallexample
3982 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3983 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3984 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3985 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3986 @end smallexample
3987
3988 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3989 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3990 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3991 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3992 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3993 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3994
3995 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3996 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3997 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3998 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3999 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4000 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4001 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4002 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4003
4004 @table @code
4005 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4006 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4007 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4008
4009 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4010 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4011 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4012 @end table
4013
4014 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4015 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4016 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4017
4018 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4019
4020 @smallexample
4021 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4022 @end smallexample
4023
4024 @noindent
4025 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4026
4027 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4028 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4029 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4030 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4031 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4032 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4033 will print a message like this:
4034
4035 @smallexample
4036 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4037 @end smallexample
4038
4039 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4040 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4041 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4042 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4043 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4044 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4045 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4046 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4047
4048 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4049 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4050 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4051 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4052 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4053 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4054
4055 @smallexample
4056 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4057 @end smallexample
4058
4059 @noindent
4060 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4061
4062 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4063 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4064 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4065 expression with separately allocated resources.
4066
4067 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4068 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4069 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4070
4071 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4072 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4073 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4074 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4075 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4076 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4077 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4078 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4079 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4080
4081 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4082 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4083 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4084 watched expression from every thread.
4085
4086 @quotation
4087 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4088 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4089 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4090 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4091 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4092 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4093 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4094 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4095 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4096 @end quotation
4097
4098 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4099
4100 @node Set Catchpoints
4101 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4102 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4103 @cindex exception handlers
4104 @cindex event handling
4105
4106 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4107 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4108 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4109
4110 @table @code
4111 @kindex catch
4112 @item catch @var{event}
4113 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
4114
4115 @table @code
4116 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4117 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4118 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4119 @kindex catch throw
4120 @kindex catch rethrow
4121 @kindex catch catch
4122 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4123 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4124
4125 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4126 regular expression will be caught.
4127
4128 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4129 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4130 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4131 exception being thrown.
4132
4133 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4134 @value{GDBN}:
4135
4136 @itemize @bullet
4137 @item
4138 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4139 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4140 supported.
4141
4142 @item
4143 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4144 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4145 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4146 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4147 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4148 built.
4149
4150 @item
4151 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4152 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4153
4154 @item
4155 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4156 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4157 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4158 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4159
4160 @item
4161 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4162 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4163 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4164 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4165 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4166 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4167 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4168 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4169 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4170
4171 @item
4172 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4173
4174 @item
4175 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4176 @end itemize
4177
4178 @item exception
4179 @kindex catch exception
4180 @cindex Ada exception catching
4181 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4182 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4183 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4184 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4185 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4186
4187 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4188 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4189 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4190 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4191 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4192 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4193 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4194 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4195
4196 @item exception unhandled
4197 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4198 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4199
4200 @item assert
4201 @kindex catch assert
4202 A failed Ada assertion.
4203
4204 @item exec
4205 @kindex catch exec
4206 @cindex break on fork/exec
4207 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4208 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4209
4210 @item syscall
4211 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4212 @kindex catch syscall
4213 @cindex break on a system call.
4214 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4215 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4216 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4217 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4218 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4219 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4220 will be caught.
4221
4222 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4223 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4224 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4225 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4226
4227 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4228 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4229 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4230 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4231
4232 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4233 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4234 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4235 available choices.
4236
4237 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4238 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4239 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4240 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4241 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4242 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4243 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4244 behind the OS upgrades).
4245
4246 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4247 arguments to it:
4248
4249 @smallexample
4250 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4251 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4252 (@value{GDBP}) r
4253 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4254
4255 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4256 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4257 (@value{GDBP}) c
4258 Continuing.
4259
4260 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4261 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4262 (@value{GDBP})
4263 @end smallexample
4264
4265 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4266
4267 @smallexample
4268 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4269 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4270 (@value{GDBP}) r
4271 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4272
4273 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4274 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4275 (@value{GDBP}) c
4276 Continuing.
4277
4278 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4279 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4280 (@value{GDBP})
4281 @end smallexample
4282
4283 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4284 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4285 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4286
4287 @smallexample
4288 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4289 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4290 (@value{GDBP}) r
4291 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4292
4293 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4294 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4295 (@value{GDBP}) c
4296 Continuing.
4297
4298 Program exited normally.
4299 (@value{GDBP})
4300 @end smallexample
4301
4302 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4303 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4304 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4305 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4306
4307 @smallexample
4308 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4309 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4310 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4311 (@value{GDBP})
4312 @end smallexample
4313
4314 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4315 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4316 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4317 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4318 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4319 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4320
4321 @smallexample
4322 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4323 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4324 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4325 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4326 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4327 (@value{GDBP})
4328 @end smallexample
4329
4330 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4331
4332 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4333 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4334
4335 @smallexample
4336 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4337 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4338 @end smallexample
4339
4340 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4341
4342 @item fork
4343 @kindex catch fork
4344 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4345 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4346
4347 @item vfork
4348 @kindex catch vfork
4349 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4350 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4351
4352 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4353 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4354 @kindex catch load
4355 @kindex catch unload
4356 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4357 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4358 matches one of the affected libraries.
4359
4360 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4361 @kindex catch signal
4362 The delivery of a signal.
4363
4364 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4365 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4366 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4367
4368 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4369 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4370 signal names.
4371
4372 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4373 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4374 will be caught.
4375
4376 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4377 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4378 catchpoint.
4379
4380 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4381 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4382 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4383 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4384 commands.
4385
4386 @end table
4387
4388 @item tcatch @var{event}
4389 @kindex tcatch
4390 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4391 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4392
4393 @end table
4394
4395 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4396
4397
4398 @node Delete Breaks
4399 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4400
4401 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4402 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4403 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4404 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4405 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4406 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4407
4408 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4409 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4410 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4411 their breakpoint numbers.
4412
4413 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4414 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4415 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4416
4417 @table @code
4418 @kindex clear
4419 @item clear
4420 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4421 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4422 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4423 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4424
4425 @item clear @var{location}
4426 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4427 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4428 most useful ones are listed below:
4429
4430 @table @code
4431 @item clear @var{function}
4432 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4433 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4434
4435 @item clear @var{linenum}
4436 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4437 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4438 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4439 @end table
4440
4441 @cindex delete breakpoints
4442 @kindex delete
4443 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4444 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4445 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4446 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4447 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4448 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4449 @end table
4450
4451 @node Disabling
4452 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4453
4454 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4455 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4456 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4457 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4458 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4459
4460 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4461 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4462 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4463 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4464 do not know which numbers to use.
4465
4466 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4467 affects all of its locations.
4468
4469 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4470 different states of enablement:
4471
4472 @itemize @bullet
4473 @item
4474 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4475 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4476 @item
4477 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4478 @item
4479 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4480 disabled.
4481 @item
4482 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4483 N times, then becomes disabled.
4484 @item
4485 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4486 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4487 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4488 @end itemize
4489
4490 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4491 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4492
4493 @table @code
4494 @kindex disable
4495 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4496 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4497 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4498 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4499 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4500 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4501 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4502
4503 @kindex enable
4504 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4505 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4506 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4507
4508 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4509 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4510 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4511
4512 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4513 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4514 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4515 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4516 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4517 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4518 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4519
4520 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4521 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4522 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4523 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4524 @end table
4525
4526 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4527 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4528 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4529 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4530 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4531 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4532 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4533 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4534 Stepping}.)
4535
4536 @node Conditions
4537 @subsection Break Conditions
4538 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4539 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4540
4541 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4542 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4543 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4544 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4545 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4546 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4547 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4548 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4549
4550 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4551 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4552 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4553 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4554 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4555
4556 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4557 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4558 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4559 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4560 one.
4561
4562 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4563 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4564 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4565 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4566 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4567 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4568 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4569 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4570 conditions for the
4571 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4572 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4573
4574 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4575 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4576 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4577 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4578 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4579 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4580
4581 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4582 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4583 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4584 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4585 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4586
4587 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4588 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4589 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4590 with the @code{condition} command.
4591
4592 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4593 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4594 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4595 catchpoint.
4596
4597 @table @code
4598 @kindex condition
4599 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4600 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4601 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4602 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4603 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4604 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4605 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4606 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4607 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4608 prints an error message:
4609
4610 @smallexample
4611 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4612 @end smallexample
4613
4614 @noindent
4615 @value{GDBN} does
4616 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4617 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4618 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4619
4620 @item condition @var{bnum}
4621 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4622 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4623 @end table
4624
4625 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4626 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4627 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4628 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4629 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4630 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4631 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4632 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4633 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4634 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4635 your program reaches it.
4636
4637 @table @code
4638 @kindex ignore
4639 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4640 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4641 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4642 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4643 takes no action.
4644
4645 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4646 a count of zero.
4647
4648 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4649 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4650 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4651 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4652
4653 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4654 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4655 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4656
4657 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4658 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4659 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4660 Variables}.
4661 @end table
4662
4663 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4664
4665
4666 @node Break Commands
4667 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4668
4669 @cindex breakpoint commands
4670 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4671 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4672 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4673 enable other breakpoints.
4674
4675 @table @code
4676 @kindex commands
4677 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4678 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4679 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4680 @itemx end
4681 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4682 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4683 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4684
4685 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4686 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4687
4688 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4689 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4690 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4691 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4692 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4693 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4694 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4695 Expressions}).
4696 @end table
4697
4698 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4699 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4700
4701 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4702 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4703 that resumes execution.
4704
4705 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4706 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4707 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4708 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4709 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4710
4711 @kindex silent
4712 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4713 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4714 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4715 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4716 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4717 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4718
4719 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4720 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4721 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4722
4723 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4724 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4725
4726 @smallexample
4727 break foo if x>0
4728 commands
4729 silent
4730 printf "x is %d\n",x
4731 cont
4732 end
4733 @end smallexample
4734
4735 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4736 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4737 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4738 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4739 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4740 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4741 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4742
4743 @smallexample
4744 break 403
4745 commands
4746 silent
4747 set x = y + 4
4748 cont
4749 end
4750 @end smallexample
4751
4752 @node Dynamic Printf
4753 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4754
4755 @cindex dynamic printf
4756 @cindex dprintf
4757 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4758 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4759 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4760 having to recompile it.
4761
4762 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4763 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4764 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4765 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4766 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4767 redirects to files and so forth.
4768
4769 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4770 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4771 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4772 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4773 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4774 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4775 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4776
4777 @table @code
4778 @kindex dprintf
4779 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4780 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4781 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4782 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4783
4784 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4785 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4786 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4787 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4788 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4789 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4790
4791 @item gdb
4792 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4793 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4794
4795 @item call
4796 @kindex dprintf-style call
4797 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4798 @code{printf}).
4799
4800 @item agent
4801 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4802 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4803 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4804 support running commands on the target.
4805
4806 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4807 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4808 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4809 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4810 command.
4811
4812 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4813 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4814 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4815 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4816 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4817 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4818
4819 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4820 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4821 you could do the following:
4822
4823 @example
4824 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4825 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4826 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4827 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4828 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4829 (gdb) info break
4830 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4831 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4832 continue
4833 (gdb)
4834 @end example
4835
4836 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4837 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4838 the variable settings.
4839
4840 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4841 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4842 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4843 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4844 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4845 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4846
4847 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4848 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4849 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4850
4851 @end table
4852
4853 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4854 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4855 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4856 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4857 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4858 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4859
4860 @node Save Breakpoints
4861 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4862
4863 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4864 breakpoints}} command.
4865
4866 @table @code
4867 @kindex save breakpoints
4868 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4869 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4870 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4871 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4872 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4873 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4874 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4875 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4876 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4877 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4878 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4879 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4880 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4881 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4882 that can no longer be recreated.
4883 @end table
4884
4885 @node Static Probe Points
4886 @subsection Static Probe Points
4887
4888 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4889 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4890 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4891 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4892 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4893 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4894 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4895
4896 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4897 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4898 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4899 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4900 in your applications.
4901
4902 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4903 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4904 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4905 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4906 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4907 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4908 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4909 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4910
4911 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4912 probes}, with optional arguments:
4913
4914 @table @code
4915 @kindex info probes
4916 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4917 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4918 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4919 probes from all providers are listed.
4920
4921 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4922 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4923 considered when deciding whether to display them.
4924
4925 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
4926 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
4927 given, all object files are considered.
4928
4929 @item info probes all
4930 List the available static probes, from all types.
4931 @end table
4932
4933 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
4934 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
4935 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
4936 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
4937 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
4938 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
4939 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
4940 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
4941 at the current probe point.
4942
4943 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
4944 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
4945 an error message.
4946
4947
4948 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4949 @node Error in Breakpoints
4950 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4951
4952 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4953 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4954
4955 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4956 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4957 @smallexample
4958 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4959 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4960 @end smallexample
4961
4962 @noindent
4963 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4964 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4965 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4966
4967 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4968 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4969
4970 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4971 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4972 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4973
4974 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4975 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4976 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4977 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4978
4979 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4980 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4981 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4982 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4983 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4984 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4985 first in the bundle.
4986
4987 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4988 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4989 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4990 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4991 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4992 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4993 is hit.
4994
4995 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4996 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4997
4998 @smallexample
4999 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5000 @end smallexample
5001
5002 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5003 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5004 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5005 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5006 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5007 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5008 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5009 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5010
5011 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5012 adjusted breakpoints:
5013
5014 @smallexample
5015 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5016 to 0x00010410.
5017 @end smallexample
5018
5019 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5020 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5021 frequently than expected.
5022
5023 @node Continuing and Stepping
5024 @section Continuing and Stepping
5025
5026 @cindex stepping
5027 @cindex continuing
5028 @cindex resuming execution
5029 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5030 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5031 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5032 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5033 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5034 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5035 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5036 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
5037
5038 @table @code
5039 @kindex continue
5040 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5041 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5042 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5043 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5044 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5045 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5046 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5047 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5048 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5049 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5050
5051 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5052 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5053 @code{continue} is ignored.
5054
5055 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5056 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5057 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5058 @code{continue}.
5059 @end table
5060
5061 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5062 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5063 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5064 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5065
5066 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5067 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5068 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5069 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5070 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5071 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5072
5073 @table @code
5074 @kindex step
5075 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5076 @item step
5077 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5078 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5079 abbreviated @code{s}.
5080
5081 @quotation
5082 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5083 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5084 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5085 @c distinction here.
5086 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5087 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5088 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5089 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5090 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5091 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5092 below.
5093 @end quotation
5094
5095 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5096 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5097 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5098 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5099 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5100 called within the line.
5101
5102 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5103 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5104 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5105 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5106 was any debugging information about the routine.
5107
5108 @item step @var{count}
5109 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5110 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5111 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5112
5113 @kindex next
5114 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5115 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5116 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5117 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5118 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5119 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5120 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5121 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5122
5123 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5124
5125
5126 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5127 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5128 @c
5129 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5130 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5131 @c function are executed without stopping.
5132
5133 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5134 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5135 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5136
5137 @kindex set step-mode
5138 @item set step-mode
5139 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5140 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5141 @itemx set step-mode on
5142 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5143 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5144 information rather than stepping over it.
5145
5146 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5147 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5148 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5149
5150 @item set step-mode off
5151 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5152 debug information. This is the default.
5153
5154 @item show step-mode
5155 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5156 source line debug information.
5157
5158 @kindex finish
5159 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5160 @item finish
5161 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5162 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5163 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5164
5165 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5166 ,Returning from a Function}).
5167
5168 @kindex until
5169 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5170 @cindex run until specified location
5171 @item until
5172 @itemx u
5173 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5174 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5175 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5176 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5177 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5178 than the address of the jump.
5179
5180 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5181 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5182 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5183 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5184 through the next iteration.
5185
5186 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5187 stack frame.
5188
5189 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5190 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5191 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5192 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5193 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5194
5195 @smallexample
5196 (@value{GDBP}) f
5197 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5198 206 expand_input();
5199 (@value{GDBP}) until
5200 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5201 @end smallexample
5202
5203 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5204 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5205 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5206 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5207 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5208 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5209 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5210
5211 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5212 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5213 argument.
5214
5215 @item until @var{location}
5216 @itemx u @var{location}
5217 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
5218 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
5219 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5220 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5221 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5222 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5223 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5224 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5225 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5226 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5227 invocations have returned.
5228
5229 @smallexample
5230 94 int factorial (int value)
5231 95 @{
5232 96 if (value > 1) @{
5233 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5234 98 @}
5235 99 return (value);
5236 100 @}
5237 @end smallexample
5238
5239
5240 @kindex advance @var{location}
5241 @item advance @var{location}
5242 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5243 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5244 @ref{Specify Location}.
5245 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5246 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5247 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5248 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5249
5250
5251 @kindex stepi
5252 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5253 @item stepi
5254 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5255 @itemx si
5256 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5257
5258 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5259 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5260 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5261 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5262
5263 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5264
5265 @need 750
5266 @kindex nexti
5267 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5268 @item nexti
5269 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5270 @itemx ni
5271 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5272 proceed until the function returns.
5273
5274 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5275
5276 @end table
5277
5278 @anchor{range stepping}
5279 @cindex range stepping
5280 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5281 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5282 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5283 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5284 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5285 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5286 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5287 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5288 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5289 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5290 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5291 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5292 if necessary:
5293
5294 @table @code
5295 @kindex set range-stepping
5296 @kindex show range-stepping
5297 @item set range-stepping
5298 @itemx show range-stepping
5299 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5300
5301 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5302 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5303 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5304 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5305 default is @code{on}.
5306
5307 @end table
5308
5309 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5310 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5311 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5312
5313 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5314 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5315 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5316
5317 For example, consider the following C function:
5318
5319 @smallexample
5320 101 int func()
5321 102 @{
5322 103 foo(boring());
5323 104 bar(boring());
5324 105 @}
5325 @end smallexample
5326
5327 @noindent
5328 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5329 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5330 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5331 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5332
5333 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5334 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5335 is called from many places.
5336
5337 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5338 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5339 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5340 @code{foo}.
5341
5342 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5343 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5344
5345 @table @code
5346 @kindex skip function
5347 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5348 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5349 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5350 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5351 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5352
5353 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5354 will be skipped.
5355
5356 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5357 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5358
5359 @kindex skip file
5360 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5361 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5362 will be skipped over when stepping.
5363
5364 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5365 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5366 @end table
5367
5368 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5369 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5370
5371 @table @code
5372 @kindex info skip
5373 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5374 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5375 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5376 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5377
5378 @table @emph
5379 @item Identifier
5380 A number identifying this skip.
5381 @item Type
5382 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5383 @item Enabled or Disabled
5384 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5385 @item Address
5386 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5387 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5388 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5389 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5390 address here.
5391 @item What
5392 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5393 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5394 where it is defined.
5395 @end table
5396
5397 @kindex skip delete
5398 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5399 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5400 skips.
5401
5402 @kindex skip enable
5403 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5404 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5405 skips.
5406
5407 @kindex skip disable
5408 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5409 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5410 skips.
5411
5412 @end table
5413
5414 @node Signals
5415 @section Signals
5416 @cindex signals
5417
5418 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5419 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5420 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5421 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5422 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5423 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5424 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5425 requested an alarm).
5426
5427 @cindex fatal signals
5428 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5429 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5430 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5431 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5432 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5433 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5434
5435 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5436 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5437 signal.
5438
5439 @cindex handling signals
5440 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5441 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5442 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5443 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5444 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5445
5446 @table @code
5447 @kindex info signals
5448 @kindex info handle
5449 @item info signals
5450 @itemx info handle
5451 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5452 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5453 the defined types of signals.
5454
5455 @item info signals @var{sig}
5456 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5457
5458 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5459
5460 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5461 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5462 for details about this command.
5463
5464 @kindex handle
5465 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5466 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
5467 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5468 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5469 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5470 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5471 say what change to make.
5472 @end table
5473
5474 @c @group
5475 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5476 Their full names are:
5477
5478 @table @code
5479 @item nostop
5480 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5481 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5482
5483 @item stop
5484 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5485 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5486
5487 @item print
5488 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5489
5490 @item noprint
5491 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5492 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5493
5494 @item pass
5495 @itemx noignore
5496 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5497 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5498 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5499
5500 @item nopass
5501 @itemx ignore
5502 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5503 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5504 @end table
5505 @c @end group
5506
5507 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5508 program until you
5509 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5510 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5511 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5512 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5513 program sees that signal when you continue.
5514
5515 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5516 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5517 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5518 erroneous signals.
5519
5520 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5521 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5522 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5523 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5524 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5525 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5526 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5527 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5528 Program a Signal}.
5529
5530 @cindex extra signal information
5531 @anchor{extra signal information}
5532
5533 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5534 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5535 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5536 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5537 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5538 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5539 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5540 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5541 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5542 system header.
5543
5544 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5545 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5546
5547 @smallexample
5548 @group
5549 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5550 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5551 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5552 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5553 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5554 type = struct @{
5555 int si_signo;
5556 int si_errno;
5557 int si_code;
5558 union @{
5559 int _pad[28];
5560 struct @{...@} _kill;
5561 struct @{...@} _timer;
5562 struct @{...@} _rt;
5563 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5564 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5565 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5566 @} _sifields;
5567 @}
5568 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5569 type = struct @{
5570 void *si_addr;
5571 @}
5572 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5573 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5574 @end group
5575 @end smallexample
5576
5577 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5578
5579 @node Thread Stops
5580 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5581
5582 @cindex stopped threads
5583 @cindex threads, stopped
5584
5585 @cindex continuing threads
5586 @cindex threads, continuing
5587
5588 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5589 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5590 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5591 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5592 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5593 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5594 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5595 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5596 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5597
5598 @menu
5599 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5600 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5601 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5602 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5603 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5604 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5605 @end menu
5606
5607 @node All-Stop Mode
5608 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5609
5610 @cindex all-stop mode
5611
5612 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5613 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5614 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5615 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5616 underfoot.
5617
5618 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5619 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5620 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5621
5622 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5623 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5624 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5625 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5626 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5627 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5628 stops.
5629
5630 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5631 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5632 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5633 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5634
5635 @cindex automatic thread selection
5636 @cindex switching threads automatically
5637 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5638 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5639 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5640 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5641 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5642 thread.
5643
5644 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5645 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5646
5647 @table @code
5648 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5649 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5650 @cindex lock scheduler
5651 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5652 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5653 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5654 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5655 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5656 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5657 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5658 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5659 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5660 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5661 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5662 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5663
5664 @item show scheduler-locking
5665 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5666 @end table
5667
5668 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5669 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5670 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5671 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5672 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5673 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5674 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5675 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5676 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5677 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5678 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5679 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5680 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5681 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5682
5683 @table @code
5684 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5685 @item set schedule-multiple
5686 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5687 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5688 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5689 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5690 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5691 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5692
5693 @item show schedule-multiple
5694 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5695 multiple processes.
5696 @end table
5697
5698 @node Non-Stop Mode
5699 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5700
5701 @cindex non-stop mode
5702
5703 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5704 @c with more details.
5705
5706 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5707 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5708 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5709 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5710 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5711 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5712
5713 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5714 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5715 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5716 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5717 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5718 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5719 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5720 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5721 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5722 independently and simultaneously.
5723
5724 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5725 or attach to your program:
5726
5727 @smallexample
5728 # Enable the async interface.
5729 set target-async 1
5730
5731 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5732 set pagination off
5733
5734 # Finally, turn it on!
5735 set non-stop on
5736 @end smallexample
5737
5738 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5739
5740 @table @code
5741 @kindex set non-stop
5742 @item set non-stop on
5743 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5744 @item set non-stop off
5745 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5746 @kindex show non-stop
5747 @item show non-stop
5748 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5749 @end table
5750
5751 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5752 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5753 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5754 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5755 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5756 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5757 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5758 default.
5759
5760 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5761 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5762 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5763
5764 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5765 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5766 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5767 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5768 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5769
5770 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5771 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5772 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5773 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5774 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5775
5776 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5777
5778 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5779 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5780 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5781 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5782 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5783 previously current thread.
5784
5785 @node Background Execution
5786 @subsection Background Execution
5787
5788 @cindex foreground execution
5789 @cindex background execution
5790 @cindex asynchronous execution
5791 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5792
5793 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5794 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5795 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5796 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5797 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5798 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5799
5800 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5801 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5802 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5803
5804 @table @code
5805 @kindex set target-async
5806 @item set target-async on
5807 Enable asynchronous mode.
5808 @item set target-async off
5809 Disable asynchronous mode.
5810 @kindex show target-async
5811 @item show target-async
5812 Show the current target-async setting.
5813 @end table
5814
5815 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5816 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5817
5818 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5819 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5820 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5821 are:
5822
5823 @table @code
5824 @kindex run&
5825 @item run
5826 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5827
5828 @item attach
5829 @kindex attach&
5830 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5831
5832 @item step
5833 @kindex step&
5834 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5835
5836 @item stepi
5837 @kindex stepi&
5838 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5839
5840 @item next
5841 @kindex next&
5842 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5843
5844 @item nexti
5845 @kindex nexti&
5846 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5847
5848 @item continue
5849 @kindex continue&
5850 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5851
5852 @item finish
5853 @kindex finish&
5854 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5855
5856 @item until
5857 @kindex until&
5858 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5859
5860 @end table
5861
5862 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5863 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5864 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5865 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5866 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5867 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5868
5869 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5870 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5871
5872 @table @code
5873 @kindex interrupt
5874 @item interrupt
5875 @itemx interrupt -a
5876
5877 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5878 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5879 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5880 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5881 @end table
5882
5883 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5884 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5885
5886 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5887 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5888 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5889
5890 @table @code
5891 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5892 @cindex thread breakpoints
5893 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5894 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5895 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5896 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5897 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5898 specify some source line.
5899
5900 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5901 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5902 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5903 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5904 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5905
5906 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5907 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5908 program.
5909
5910 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5911 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5912 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5913
5914 @smallexample
5915 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5916 @end smallexample
5917
5918 @end table
5919
5920 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
5921 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
5922 thread list. For example:
5923
5924 @smallexample
5925 (@value{GDBP}) c
5926 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
5927 @end smallexample
5928
5929 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
5930 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
5931 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
5932 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
5933 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
5934 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
5935 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
5936 command.
5937
5938 @node Interrupted System Calls
5939 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5940
5941 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5942 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5943 @cindex premature return from system calls
5944 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5945 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5946 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5947 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5948 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5949 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5950 stop execution.
5951
5952 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5953 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5954 style anyways.
5955
5956 For example, do not write code like this:
5957
5958 @smallexample
5959 sleep (10);
5960 @end smallexample
5961
5962 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5963 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5964
5965 Instead, write this:
5966
5967 @smallexample
5968 int unslept = 10;
5969 while (unslept > 0)
5970 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5971 @end smallexample
5972
5973 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5974 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5975 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5976 @value{GDBN}.
5977
5978 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5979 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5980 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5981 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5982
5983 @node Observer Mode
5984 @subsection Observer Mode
5985
5986 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5987 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5988 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5989 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5990 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5991
5992 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5993 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5994 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5995 mode.
5996
5997 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5998 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5999 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6000 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6001 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6002
6003 @table @code
6004
6005 @kindex observer
6006 @item set observer on
6007 @itemx set observer off
6008 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6009 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6010 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6011 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6012
6013 @item show observer
6014 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6015
6016 @kindex may-write-registers
6017 @item set may-write-registers on
6018 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6019 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6020 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6021 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6022
6023 @item show may-write-registers
6024 Show the current permission to write registers.
6025
6026 @kindex may-write-memory
6027 @item set may-write-memory on
6028 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6029 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6030 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6031 defaults to @code{on}.
6032
6033 @item show may-write-memory
6034 Show the current permission to write memory.
6035
6036 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6037 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6038 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6039 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6040 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6041 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6042
6043 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6044 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6045
6046 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6047 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6048 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6049 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6050 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6051 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6052 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6053
6054 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6055 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6056
6057 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6058 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6059 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6060 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6061 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6062 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6063 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6064
6065 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6066 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6067
6068 @kindex may-interrupt
6069 @item set may-interrupt on
6070 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6071 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6072 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6073 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6074 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6075
6076 @item show may-interrupt
6077 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6078
6079 @end table
6080
6081 @node Reverse Execution
6082 @chapter Running programs backward
6083 @cindex reverse execution
6084 @cindex running programs backward
6085
6086 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6087 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6088 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6089 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6090
6091 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6092 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6093 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6094 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6095 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6096 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6097
6098 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6099 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6100 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6101 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6102 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6103 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6104 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6105 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6106 prior values@footnote{
6107 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6108 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6109 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6110
6111 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6112 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6113 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6114 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6115 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6116 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6117 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6118 }.
6119
6120 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6121 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6122
6123 @table @code
6124 @kindex reverse-continue
6125 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6126 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6127 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6128 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6129 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6130 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6131 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6132
6133 @kindex reverse-step
6134 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6135 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6136 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6137 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6138
6139 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6140 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6141 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6142 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6143 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6144 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6145
6146 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6147 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6148
6149 @kindex reverse-stepi
6150 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6151 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6152 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6153 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6154 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6155 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6156 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6157
6158 @kindex reverse-next
6159 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6160 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6161 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6162 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6163 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6164 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6165 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6166 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6167 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6168 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6169
6170 @kindex reverse-nexti
6171 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6172 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6173 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6174 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6175 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6176 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6177 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6178 frame) is reached.
6179
6180 @kindex reverse-finish
6181 @item reverse-finish
6182 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6183 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6184 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6185 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6186
6187 @kindex set exec-direction
6188 @item set exec-direction
6189 Set the direction of target execution.
6190 @item set exec-direction reverse
6191 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6192 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6193 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6194 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6195 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6196 @item set exec-direction forward
6197 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6198 This is the default.
6199 @end table
6200
6201
6202 @node Process Record and Replay
6203 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6204 @cindex process record and replay
6205 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6206
6207 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6208 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6209 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6210
6211 @cindex replay mode
6212 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6213 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6214 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6215 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6216 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6217 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6218 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6219 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6220 execution log.
6221
6222 @cindex record mode
6223 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6224 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6225 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6226 for future replay.
6227
6228 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6229 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6230 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6231 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6232 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6233 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6234
6235 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6236 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6237 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6238 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6239
6240 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6241 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6242
6243 @table @code
6244 @kindex target record
6245 @kindex target record-full
6246 @kindex target record-btrace
6247 @kindex record
6248 @kindex record full
6249 @kindex record btrace
6250 @kindex rec
6251 @kindex rec full
6252 @kindex rec btrace
6253 @item record @var{method}
6254 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6255 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6256 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6257 recording methods are available:
6258
6259 @table @code
6260 @item full
6261 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6262 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6263 execution.
6264
6265 @item btrace
6266 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not allow
6267 replaying and reverse execution.
6268
6269 This recording method may not be available on all processors.
6270 @end table
6271
6272 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6273 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6274 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6275 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6276
6277 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6278 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6279
6280 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6281 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6282 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6283 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6284 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6285
6286 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6287 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6288 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6289 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6290 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6291 does not support these two modes.
6292
6293 @kindex record stop
6294 @kindex rec s
6295 @item record stop
6296 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6297 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6298 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6299
6300 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6301 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6302 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6303 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6304 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6305
6306 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6307 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6308 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6309 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6310 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6311
6312 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6313 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6314
6315 @kindex record goto
6316 @item record goto
6317 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6318 ways to specify the location to go to:
6319
6320 @table @code
6321 @item record goto begin
6322 @itemx record goto start
6323 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6324
6325 @item record goto end
6326 Go to the end of the execution log.
6327
6328 @item record goto @var{n}
6329 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6330 @end table
6331
6332 @kindex record save
6333 @item record save @var{filename}
6334 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6335 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6336 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6337
6338 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6339
6340 @kindex record restore
6341 @item record restore @var{filename}
6342 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6343 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6344
6345 @kindex set record full
6346 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6347 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6348 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6349 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6350
6351 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6352 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6353 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6354 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6355 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6356 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6357 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6358 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6359
6360 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6361 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6362 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6363
6364 @kindex show record full
6365 @item show record full insn-number-max
6366 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6367 recording method.
6368
6369 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6370 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6371 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6372 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6373 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6374 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6375 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6376 oldest one to be deleted.
6377
6378 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6379 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6380
6381 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6382 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6383
6384 @item set record full memory-query
6385 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6386 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6387 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6388 case.
6389
6390 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6391 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6392 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6393 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6394 results.
6395
6396 @item show record full memory-query
6397 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6398
6399 @kindex info record
6400 @item info record
6401 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6402 method:
6403
6404 @table @code
6405 @item full
6406 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6407 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6408
6409 @itemize @bullet
6410 @item
6411 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6412 @item
6413 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6414 @item
6415 Highest recorded instruction number.
6416 @item
6417 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6418 @item
6419 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6420 @item
6421 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6422 @end itemize
6423
6424 @item btrace
6425 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows the number of
6426 instructions that have been recorded and the number of blocks of
6427 sequential control-flow that is formed by the recorded instructions.
6428 @end table
6429
6430 @kindex record delete
6431 @kindex rec del
6432 @item record delete
6433 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6434 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6435 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6436 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6437
6438 @kindex record instruction-history
6439 @kindex rec instruction-history
6440 @item record instruction-history
6441 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6442 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6443 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6444 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6445 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6446
6447 @table @code
6448 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6449 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6450 @var{insn}.
6451
6452 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6453 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6454 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6455 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6456 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6457 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6458
6459 @item record instruction-history
6460 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6461
6462 @item record instruction-history -
6463 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6464
6465 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6466 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6467 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6468 number @var{end} is not included.
6469 @end table
6470
6471 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6472
6473 @kindex set record
6474 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6475 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6476 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6477 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6478 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6479
6480 @kindex show record
6481 @item show record instruction-history-size
6482 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6483 instruction-history} command.
6484
6485 @kindex record function-call-history
6486 @kindex rec function-call-history
6487 @item record function-call-history
6488 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6489 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6490 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6491 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6492 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6493 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6494 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6495 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6496 given together.
6497
6498 @smallexample
6499 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6500 1 void foo (void)
6501 2 @{
6502 3 @}
6503 4
6504 5 void bar (void)
6505 6 @{
6506 7 ...
6507 8 foo ();
6508 9 ...
6509 10 @}
6510 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6511 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6512 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6513 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6514 @end smallexample
6515
6516 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6517 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6518 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6519 to print:
6520
6521 @table @code
6522 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6523 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6524
6525 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6526 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6527 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6528 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6529 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6530
6531 @item record function-call-history
6532 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6533
6534 @item record function-call-history -
6535 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6536
6537 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6538 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6539 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is not
6540 included.
6541 @end table
6542
6543 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6544
6545 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6546 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6547 Define how many lines to print in the
6548 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6549 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6550
6551 @item show record function-call-history-size
6552 Show how many lines to print in the
6553 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6554 @end table
6555
6556
6557 @node Stack
6558 @chapter Examining the Stack
6559
6560 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6561 stopped and how it got there.
6562
6563 @cindex call stack
6564 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6565 is generated.
6566 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6567 the arguments of the call,
6568 and the local variables of the function being called.
6569 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6570 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6571 stack}.
6572
6573 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6574 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6575
6576 @cindex selected frame
6577 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6578 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6579 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6580 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6581 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6582 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6583
6584 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6585 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6586 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6587
6588 @menu
6589 * Frames:: Stack frames
6590 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6591 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6592 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6593 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6594
6595 @end menu
6596
6597 @node Frames
6598 @section Stack Frames
6599
6600 @cindex frame, definition
6601 @cindex stack frame
6602 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6603 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6604 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6605 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6606 which the function is executing.
6607
6608 @cindex initial frame
6609 @cindex outermost frame
6610 @cindex innermost frame
6611 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6612 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6613 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6614 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6615 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6616 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6617 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6618 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6619
6620 @cindex frame pointer
6621 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6622 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6623 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6624 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6625 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6626 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6627
6628 @cindex frame number
6629 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6630 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6631 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6632 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6633 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6634
6635 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6636 @c underflow problems.
6637 @cindex frameless execution
6638 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6639 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6640 @smallexample
6641 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6642 @end smallexample
6643 generates functions without a frame.)
6644 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6645 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6646 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6647 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6648 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6649 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6650 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6651
6652 @table @code
6653 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6654 @cindex current stack frame
6655 @item frame @var{args}
6656 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6657 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
6658 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6659 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6660
6661 @kindex select-frame
6662 @cindex selecting frame silently
6663 @item select-frame
6664 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6665 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6666 @code{frame}.
6667 @end table
6668
6669 @node Backtrace
6670 @section Backtraces
6671
6672 @cindex traceback
6673 @cindex call stack traces
6674 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6675 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6676 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6677 stack.
6678
6679 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6680 @table @code
6681 @kindex backtrace
6682 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6683 @item backtrace
6684 @itemx bt
6685 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6686 frames in the stack.
6687
6688 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6689 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6690
6691 @item backtrace @var{n}
6692 @itemx bt @var{n}
6693 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6694
6695 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6696 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6697 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6698
6699 @item backtrace full
6700 @itemx bt full
6701 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6702 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6703 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
6704 number of frames to print, as described above.
6705
6706 @item backtrace no-filters
6707 @itemx bt no-filters
6708 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6709 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6710 @itemx bt no-filters full
6711 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6712 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6713 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6714 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6715 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6716 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6717 support.
6718 @end table
6719
6720 @kindex where
6721 @kindex info stack
6722 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6723 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6724
6725 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6726 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6727 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6728 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6729 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6730 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6731 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6732 multi-threaded program.
6733
6734 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6735 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6736 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6737 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6738 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6739 line number.
6740
6741 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6742 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6743
6744 @smallexample
6745 @group
6746 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6747 at builtin.c:993
6748 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6749 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6750 at macro.c:71
6751 (More stack frames follow...)
6752 @end group
6753 @end smallexample
6754
6755 @noindent
6756 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6757 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6758 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6759
6760 @noindent
6761 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6762 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6763 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6764 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6765 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6766
6767 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6768 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6769 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6770 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6771 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6772 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6773 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6774 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6775 such a backtrace might look like:
6776
6777 @smallexample
6778 @group
6779 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6780 at builtin.c:993
6781 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6782 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6783 at macro.c:71
6784 (More stack frames follow...)
6785 @end group
6786 @end smallexample
6787
6788 @noindent
6789 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6790 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6791
6792 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6793 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6794 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6795
6796 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6797 @cindex program entry point
6798 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6799 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6800 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6801 @code{main}@footnote{
6802 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6803 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6804 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6805 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6806 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6807 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6808
6809 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6810 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6811
6812 @table @code
6813 @item set backtrace past-main
6814 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6815 @kindex set backtrace
6816 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6817
6818 @item set backtrace past-main off
6819 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6820 default.
6821
6822 @item show backtrace past-main
6823 @kindex show backtrace
6824 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6825
6826 @item set backtrace past-entry
6827 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6828 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6829 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6830 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6831
6832 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6833 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6834 application. This is the default.
6835
6836 @item show backtrace past-entry
6837 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6838
6839 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6840 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6841 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
6842 @cindex backtrace limit
6843 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
6844 or zero means unlimited levels.
6845
6846 @item show backtrace limit
6847 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6848 @end table
6849
6850 You can control how file names are displayed.
6851
6852 @table @code
6853 @item set filename-display
6854 @itemx set filename-display relative
6855 @cindex filename-display
6856 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
6857
6858 @item set filename-display basename
6859 Display only basename of a filename.
6860
6861 @item set filename-display absolute
6862 Display an absolute filename.
6863
6864 @item show filename-display
6865 Show the current way to display filenames.
6866 @end table
6867
6868 @node Frame Filter Management
6869 @section Management of Frame Filters.
6870 @cindex managing frame filters
6871
6872 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
6873 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
6874
6875 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
6876 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
6877
6878 @table @code
6879 @kindex info frame-filter
6880 @item info frame-filter
6881 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
6882 their name, priority and enabled status.
6883
6884 @kindex disable frame-filter
6885 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
6886 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6887 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6888 @var{filter-dictionary}, or @code{all}, and @var{filter-name}.
6889 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6890 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6891 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
6892 across all dictionaries are disabled. @var{filter-name} is the name
6893 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6894 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
6895 may be enabled again later.
6896
6897 @kindex enable frame-filter
6898 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6899 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6900 @var{filter-dictionary}, or @code{all}, and @var{filter-name}.
6901 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6902 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6903 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
6904 all dictionaries are enabled. @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
6905 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6906 @var{filter-dictionary}.
6907
6908 Example:
6909
6910 @smallexample
6911 (gdb) info frame-filter
6912
6913 global frame-filters:
6914 Priority Enabled Name
6915 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6916 100 Yes Reverse
6917
6918 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6919 Priority Enabled Name
6920 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6921
6922 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6923 Priority Enabled Name
6924 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
6925
6926 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
6927 (gdb) info frame-filter
6928
6929 global frame-filters:
6930 Priority Enabled Name
6931 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6932 100 Yes Reverse
6933
6934 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6935 Priority Enabled Name
6936 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6937
6938 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6939 Priority Enabled Name
6940 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6941
6942 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
6943 (gdb) info frame-filter
6944
6945 global frame-filters:
6946 Priority Enabled Name
6947 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6948 100 Yes Reverse
6949
6950 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6951 Priority Enabled Name
6952 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6953
6954 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6955 Priority Enabled Name
6956 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6957 @end smallexample
6958
6959 @kindex set frame-filter priority
6960 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
6961 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6962 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
6963 @var{filter-name}. @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
6964 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6965 dictionary resides. @var{priority} is an integer.
6966
6967 @kindex show frame-filter priority
6968 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6969 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6970 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
6971 @var{filter-name}. @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
6972 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6973 dictionary resides.
6974
6975 Example:
6976
6977 @smallexample
6978 (gdb) info frame-filter
6979
6980 global frame-filters:
6981 Priority Enabled Name
6982 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6983 100 Yes Reverse
6984
6985 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6986 Priority Enabled Name
6987 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6988
6989 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6990 Priority Enabled Name
6991 999 No BuildProgramFilter
6992
6993 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
6994 (gdb) info frame-filter
6995
6996 global frame-filters:
6997 Priority Enabled Name
6998 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
6999 50 Yes Reverse
7000
7001 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7002 Priority Enabled Name
7003 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7004
7005 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7006 Priority Enabled Name
7007 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7008 @end smallexample
7009 @end table
7010
7011 @node Selection
7012 @section Selecting a Frame
7013
7014 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7015 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7016 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7017 of the stack frame just selected.
7018
7019 @table @code
7020 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7021 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7022 @item frame @var{n}
7023 @itemx f @var{n}
7024 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7025 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7026 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7027 @code{main}.
7028
7029 @item frame @var{addr}
7030 @itemx f @var{addr}
7031 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7032 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7033 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7034 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7035 switches between them.
7036
7037 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7038 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7039
7040 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7041 pointer and a program counter.
7042
7043 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7044 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7045
7046 @kindex up
7047 @item up @var{n}
7048 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
7049 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
7050 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
7051
7052 @kindex down
7053 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7054 @item down @var{n}
7055 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
7056 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
7057 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
7058 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7059 @end table
7060
7061 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7062 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7063 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7064 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7065
7066 @need 1000
7067 For example:
7068
7069 @smallexample
7070 @group
7071 (@value{GDBP}) up
7072 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7073 at env.c:10
7074 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7075 @end group
7076 @end smallexample
7077
7078 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7079 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7080 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7081 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7082 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7083 for details.
7084
7085 @table @code
7086 @kindex down-silently
7087 @kindex up-silently
7088 @item up-silently @var{n}
7089 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7090 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7091 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7092 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7093 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7094 distracting.
7095 @end table
7096
7097 @node Frame Info
7098 @section Information About a Frame
7099
7100 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7101 stack frame.
7102
7103 @table @code
7104 @item frame
7105 @itemx f
7106 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7107 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7108 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7109 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7110 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7111
7112 @kindex info frame
7113 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7114 @item info frame
7115 @itemx info f
7116 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7117 including:
7118
7119 @itemize @bullet
7120 @item
7121 the address of the frame
7122 @item
7123 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7124 @item
7125 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7126 @item
7127 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7128 @item
7129 the address of the frame's arguments
7130 @item
7131 the address of the frame's local variables
7132 @item
7133 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7134 @item
7135 which registers were saved in the frame
7136 @end itemize
7137
7138 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7139 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7140 the usual conventions.
7141
7142 @item info frame @var{addr}
7143 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7144 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7145 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7146 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7147 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7148 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7149
7150 @kindex info args
7151 @item info args
7152 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7153
7154 @item info locals
7155 @kindex info locals
7156 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7157 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7158 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7159
7160 @end table
7161
7162
7163 @node Source
7164 @chapter Examining Source Files
7165
7166 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7167 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7168 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7169 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7170 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7171 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7172 source files by explicit command.
7173
7174 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7175 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7176 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7177
7178 @menu
7179 * List:: Printing source lines
7180 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7181 * Edit:: Editing source files
7182 * Search:: Searching source files
7183 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7184 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7185 @end menu
7186
7187 @node List
7188 @section Printing Source Lines
7189
7190 @kindex list
7191 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7192 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7193 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7194 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7195 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7196
7197 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7198
7199 @table @code
7200 @item list @var{linenum}
7201 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7202 current source file.
7203
7204 @item list @var{function}
7205 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7206 @var{function}.
7207
7208 @item list
7209 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7210 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7211 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7212 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7213 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7214
7215 @item list -
7216 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7217 @end table
7218
7219 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7220 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7221 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7222
7223 @table @code
7224 @kindex set listsize
7225 @item set listsize @var{count}
7226 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7227 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7228 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7229 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7230
7231 @kindex show listsize
7232 @item show listsize
7233 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7234 @end table
7235
7236 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7237 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7238 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7239 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7240 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7241
7242 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7243 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7244 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7245 to specify some source line.
7246
7247 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7248
7249 @table @code
7250 @item list @var{linespec}
7251 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7252
7253 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7254 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7255 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7256 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7257 the same source file as the first linespec.
7258
7259 @item list ,@var{last}
7260 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7261
7262 @item list @var{first},
7263 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7264
7265 @item list +
7266 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7267
7268 @item list -
7269 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7270
7271 @item list
7272 As described in the preceding table.
7273 @end table
7274
7275 @node Specify Location
7276 @section Specifying a Location
7277 @cindex specifying location
7278 @cindex linespec
7279
7280 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7281 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7282 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7283 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7284
7285 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7286 @value{GDBN} understands:
7287
7288 @table @code
7289 @item @var{linenum}
7290 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7291
7292 @item -@var{offset}
7293 @itemx +@var{offset}
7294 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7295 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7296 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7297 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7298 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7299 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7300 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7301 linespec.
7302
7303 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7304 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7305 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7306 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7307 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7308 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7309 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7310
7311 @item @var{function}
7312 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7313 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7314
7315 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7316 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7317
7318 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7319 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7320 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7321 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7322 functions in different source files.
7323
7324 @item @var{label}
7325 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7326 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7327 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7328 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7329 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7330
7331 @item *@var{address}
7332 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7333 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7334 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7335 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7336 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7337 source files.
7338
7339 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7340 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7341 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7342 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7343 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7344 of @var{address}:
7345
7346 @table @code
7347 @item @var{expression}
7348 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7349
7350 @item @var{funcaddr}
7351 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7352 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7353 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7354 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7355 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7356 (although the Pascal form also works).
7357
7358 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7359 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7360
7361 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7362 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7363 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7364 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7365 functions with identical names in different source files.
7366 @end table
7367
7368 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7369 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7370 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7371 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7372 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7373 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7374
7375 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7376 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7377 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7378 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7379 each one of those probes.
7380
7381 @end table
7382
7383
7384 @node Edit
7385 @section Editing Source Files
7386 @cindex editing source files
7387
7388 @kindex edit
7389 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7390 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7391 The editing program of your choice
7392 is invoked with the current line set to
7393 the active line in the program.
7394 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7395 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7396
7397 @table @code
7398 @item edit @var{location}
7399 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7400 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7401 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7402 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7403 command most commonly used:
7404
7405 @table @code
7406 @item edit @var{number}
7407 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7408
7409 @item edit @var{function}
7410 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7411 @end table
7412
7413 @end table
7414
7415 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7416 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7417 @footnote{
7418 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7419 following command-line syntax:
7420 @smallexample
7421 ex +@var{number} file
7422 @end smallexample
7423 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7424 the file where to start editing.}.
7425 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7426 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7427 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7428 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7429 @smallexample
7430 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7431 export EDITOR
7432 gdb @dots{}
7433 @end smallexample
7434 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7435 @smallexample
7436 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7437 gdb @dots{}
7438 @end smallexample
7439
7440 @node Search
7441 @section Searching Source Files
7442 @cindex searching source files
7443
7444 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7445 regular expression.
7446
7447 @table @code
7448 @kindex search
7449 @kindex forward-search
7450 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7451 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7452 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7453 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7454 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7455 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7456 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7457 @code{fo}.
7458
7459 @kindex reverse-search
7460 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7461 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7462 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7463 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7464 this command as @code{rev}.
7465 @end table
7466
7467 @node Source Path
7468 @section Specifying Source Directories
7469
7470 @cindex source path
7471 @cindex directories for source files
7472 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7473 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7474 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7475 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7476 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7477 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7478 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7479
7480 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7481 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7482 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7483 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7484 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7485 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7486 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7487 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7488 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7489 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7490 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7491
7492 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7493 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7494 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7495 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7496 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7497 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7498
7499 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7500 source files.
7501
7502 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7503 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7504 each line is in the file.
7505
7506 @kindex directory
7507 @kindex dir
7508 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7509 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7510 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7511
7512 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7513 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7514
7515 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7516 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7517 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7518 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7519 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7520 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7521 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7522 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7523 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7524 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7525 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7526 name to look up the sources.
7527
7528 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7529 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7530 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7531 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7532 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7533 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7534 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7535 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7536
7537 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7538 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7539 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7540 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7541 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7542 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7543 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7544
7545 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7546 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7547 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7548 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7549 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7550 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7551 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7552 command.
7553
7554 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7555 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7556 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7557 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7558 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7559 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7560 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7561
7562 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7563 @cindex default source path substitution
7564 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7565 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7566 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7567 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7568 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7569 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7570 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7571 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7572 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7573 together.
7574
7575 @table @code
7576 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7577 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7578 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7579 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7580 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7581 part of absolute file names) or
7582 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7583 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7584
7585 @kindex cdir
7586 @kindex cwd
7587 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7588 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7589 @cindex compilation directory
7590 @cindex current directory
7591 @cindex working directory
7592 @cindex directory, current
7593 @cindex directory, compilation
7594 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7595 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7596 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7597 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7598 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7599 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7600
7601 @item directory
7602 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7603
7604 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7605 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7606
7607 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7608 @kindex set directories
7609 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7610 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7611
7612 @item show directories
7613 @kindex show directories
7614 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7615
7616 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7617 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7618 @kindex set substitute-path
7619 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7620 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7621 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7622
7623 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7624 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7625
7626 @smallexample
7627 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7628 @end smallexample
7629
7630 @noindent
7631 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7632 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7633 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7634
7635 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7636 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7637 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7638 the substitution.
7639
7640 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7641
7642 @smallexample
7643 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7644 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7645 @end smallexample
7646
7647 @noindent
7648 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7649 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7650 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7651 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7652
7653
7654 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7655 @kindex unset substitute-path
7656 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7657 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7658 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7659
7660 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7661
7662 @item show substitute-path [path]
7663 @kindex show substitute-path
7664 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7665 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7666
7667 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7668 rules.
7669
7670 @end table
7671
7672 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7673 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7674 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7675
7676 @enumerate
7677 @item
7678 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7679
7680 @item
7681 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7682 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7683 directories in one command.
7684 @end enumerate
7685
7686 @node Machine Code
7687 @section Source and Machine Code
7688 @cindex source line and its code address
7689
7690 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7691 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7692 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7693 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7694 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7695 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7696 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7697 well as hex.
7698
7699 @table @code
7700 @kindex info line
7701 @item info line @var{linespec}
7702 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7703 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7704 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7705 @end table
7706
7707 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7708 the object code for the first line of function
7709 @code{m4_changequote}:
7710
7711 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7712 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7713 @smallexample
7714 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7715 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7716 @end smallexample
7717
7718 @noindent
7719 @cindex code address and its source line
7720 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7721 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7722 @smallexample
7723 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7724 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7725 @end smallexample
7726
7727 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7728 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7729 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7730 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7731 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7732 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7733 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7734 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7735 Variables}).
7736
7737 @table @code
7738 @kindex disassemble
7739 @cindex assembly instructions
7740 @cindex instructions, assembly
7741 @cindex machine instructions
7742 @cindex listing machine instructions
7743 @item disassemble
7744 @itemx disassemble /m
7745 @itemx disassemble /r
7746 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7747 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7748 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7749 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7750 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7751 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7752 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7753 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7754 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7755 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7756
7757 @table @code
7758 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7759 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7760 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7761 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7762 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7763 @end table
7764
7765 @noindent
7766 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7767 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7768
7769 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7770 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7771
7772 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7773 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7774 @end table
7775
7776 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7777 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7778
7779 @smallexample
7780 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7781 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7782 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7783 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7784 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7785 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7786 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7787 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7788 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7789 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7790 End of assembler dump.
7791 @end smallexample
7792
7793 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7794 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7795
7796 @smallexample
7797 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
7798 Dump of assembler code for function main:
7799 5 @{
7800 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
7801 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
7802 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
7803 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
7804 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
7805
7806 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
7807 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
7808 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
7809
7810 7 return 0;
7811 8 @}
7812 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
7813 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
7814 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
7815
7816 End of assembler dump.
7817 @end smallexample
7818
7819 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
7820
7821 @smallexample
7822 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
7823 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
7824 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
7825 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7826 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7827 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7828 End of assembler dump.
7829 @end smallexample
7830
7831 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
7832 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
7833 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
7834 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
7835
7836 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7837 mnemonics or other syntax.
7838
7839 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7840 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7841 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7842 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7843 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7844
7845 @table @code
7846 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7847 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7848 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7849 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7850 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7851 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7852
7853 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7854 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7855 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7856 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7857
7858 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7859 @item show disassembly-flavor
7860 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7861 @end table
7862
7863 @table @code
7864 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7865 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7866 @item set disassemble-next-line
7867 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7868 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7869 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7870 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7871 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7872 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7873 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7874 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7875 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7876 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7877 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7878 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7879 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7880 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7881 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7882 instruction.
7883 @end table
7884
7885
7886 @node Data
7887 @chapter Examining Data
7888
7889 @cindex printing data
7890 @cindex examining data
7891 @kindex print
7892 @kindex inspect
7893 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7894 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7895 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7896 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7897 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7898 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7899
7900 @table @code
7901 @item print @var{expr}
7902 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7903 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7904 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7905 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7906 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7907 Formats}.
7908
7909 @item print
7910 @itemx print /@var{f}
7911 @cindex reprint the last value
7912 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7913 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7914 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7915 @end table
7916
7917 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7918 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7919 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7920
7921 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7922 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7923 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7924 Table}.
7925
7926 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
7927 @kindex explore
7928 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
7929 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
7930 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
7931 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
7932 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
7933 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
7934 embedded in the higher level data types.
7935
7936 @table @code
7937 @item explore @var{arg}
7938 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
7939 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
7940 @end table
7941
7942 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
7943 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
7944 C program as
7945
7946 @smallexample
7947 struct SimpleStruct
7948 @{
7949 int i;
7950 double d;
7951 @};
7952
7953 struct ComplexStruct
7954 @{
7955 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
7956 int arr[10];
7957 @};
7958 @end smallexample
7959
7960 @noindent
7961 followed by variable declarations as
7962
7963 @smallexample
7964 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
7965 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
7966 @end smallexample
7967
7968 @noindent
7969 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
7970 @code{explore} command as follows.
7971
7972 @smallexample
7973 (gdb) explore cs
7974 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
7975 the following fields:
7976
7977 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
7978 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
7979
7980 Enter the field number of choice:
7981 @end smallexample
7982
7983 @noindent
7984 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
7985 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
7986 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
7987 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
7988 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
7989 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
7990 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
7991 field will be explored as if it were an array.
7992
7993 @smallexample
7994 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
7995 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
7996 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
7997 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
7998
7999 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8000 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8001
8002 Press enter to return to parent value:
8003 @end smallexample
8004
8005 @noindent
8006 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8007 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8008 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8009 to explore.
8010
8011 @smallexample
8012 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8013 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8014
8015 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8016
8017 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8018
8019 Press enter to return to parent value:
8020 @end smallexample
8021
8022 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8023 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8024 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8025 level data structure).
8026
8027 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8028 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8029 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8030 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8031 same example as above, your can explore the type
8032 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8033 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8034
8035 @smallexample
8036 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8037 @end smallexample
8038
8039 @noindent
8040 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8041 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8042 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8043 example.
8044
8045 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8046 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8047 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8048 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8049 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8050
8051 @table @code
8052 @item explore value @var{expr}
8053 @cindex explore value
8054 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8055 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8056 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8057 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8058 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8059
8060 @item explore type @var{arg}
8061 @cindex explore type
8062 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8063 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8064 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8065 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8066 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8067 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8068 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8069 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8070 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8071 @end table
8072
8073 @menu
8074 * Expressions:: Expressions
8075 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8076 * Variables:: Program variables
8077 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8078 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8079 * Memory:: Examining memory
8080 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8081 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8082 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8083 * Value History:: Value history
8084 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8085 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8086 * Registers:: Registers
8087 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8088 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8089 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8090 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8091 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8092 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8093 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8094 character set than GDB does
8095 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8096 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8097 @end menu
8098
8099 @node Expressions
8100 @section Expressions
8101
8102 @cindex expressions
8103 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8104 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8105 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8106 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8107 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8108 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8109 @ref{Compilation}.
8110
8111 @cindex arrays in expressions
8112 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8113 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8114 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8115 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8116 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8117 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8118
8119 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8120 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8121 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8122 languages.
8123
8124 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8125 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8126
8127 @cindex casts, in expressions
8128 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8129 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8130 at that address in memory.
8131 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8132
8133 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8134 to programming languages:
8135
8136 @table @code
8137 @item @@
8138 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8139 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8140
8141 @item ::
8142 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8143 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8144
8145 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8146 @cindex type casting memory
8147 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8148 @cindex casts, to view memory
8149 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8150 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8151 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
8152 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
8153 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
8154 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8155 @end table
8156
8157 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8158 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8159 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8160
8161 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8162 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8163 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8164 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8165 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8166 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8167 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8168
8169 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8170 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8171 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8172 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8173 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8174 as well.
8175
8176 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8177 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8178 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8179 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8180 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8181 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8182 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8183 choices.
8184
8185 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8186 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8187 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8188
8189 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8190 @smallexample
8191 @group
8192 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8193 [0] cancel
8194 [1] all
8195 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8196 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8197 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8198 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8199 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8200 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8201 > 2 4 6
8202 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8203 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8204 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8205 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8206 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8207 breakpoints.
8208 (@value{GDBP})
8209 @end group
8210 @end smallexample
8211
8212 @table @code
8213 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8214 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8215 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8216
8217 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8218 is ambiguous.
8219
8220 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8221 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8222 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8223 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8224 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8225 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8226 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8227 in the use of the menu.
8228
8229 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8230 when an ambiguity is detected.
8231
8232 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8233 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8234
8235 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8236 @item show multiple-symbols
8237 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8238 @end table
8239
8240 @node Variables
8241 @section Program Variables
8242
8243 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8244 in your program.
8245
8246 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8247 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8248
8249 @itemize @bullet
8250 @item
8251 global (or file-static)
8252 @end itemize
8253
8254 @noindent or
8255
8256 @itemize @bullet
8257 @item
8258 visible according to the scope rules of the
8259 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8260 @end itemize
8261
8262 @noindent This means that in the function
8263
8264 @smallexample
8265 foo (a)
8266 int a;
8267 @{
8268 bar (a);
8269 @{
8270 int b = test ();
8271 bar (b);
8272 @}
8273 @}
8274 @end smallexample
8275
8276 @noindent
8277 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8278 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8279 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8280 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8281
8282 @cindex variable name conflict
8283 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8284 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8285 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8286 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8287 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8288 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8289 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8290
8291 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8292 @ifnotinfo
8293 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8294 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8295 @end ifnotinfo
8296 @smallexample
8297 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8298 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8299 @end smallexample
8300
8301 @noindent
8302 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8303 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8304 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8305 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8306
8307 @smallexample
8308 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8309 @end smallexample
8310
8311 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8312 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8313 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8314 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8315 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8316
8317 @smallexample
8318 void
8319 foo (int a)
8320 @{
8321 if (a < 10)
8322 bar (a);
8323 else
8324 process (a); /* Stop here */
8325 @}
8326
8327 int
8328 bar (int a)
8329 @{
8330 foo (a + 5);
8331 @}
8332 @end smallexample
8333
8334 @noindent
8335 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8336 here is what you might see
8337 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8338
8339 @smallexample
8340 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8341 $1 = 10
8342 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8343 $2 = 5
8344 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8345 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8346 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8347 $3 = 5
8348 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8349 $4 = 0
8350 @end smallexample
8351
8352 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8353 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8354 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8355 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8356 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8357
8358 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8359 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8360 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8361 @code{some_global}.
8362
8363 @smallexample
8364 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8365 $1 = 23
8366 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8367 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8368 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8369 $2 = 27
8370 @end smallexample
8371
8372 @cindex wrong values
8373 @cindex variable values, wrong
8374 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8375 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8376 @quotation
8377 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8378 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8379 scope, and just before exit.
8380 @end quotation
8381 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8382 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8383 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8384 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8385 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8386 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8387 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8388 variable definitions may be gone.
8389
8390 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8391 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8392 when compiling.
8393
8394 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8395 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8396 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8397 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8398 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8399 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8400 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8401
8402 @smallexample
8403 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8404 @end smallexample
8405
8406 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8407 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8408 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8409 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8410 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8411
8412 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8413 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8414 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8415 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8416
8417 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8418 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8419 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8420 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8421 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8422
8423 @smallexample
8424 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8425 29 i++;
8426 (gdb) next
8427 30 e (i);
8428 (gdb) print i
8429 $1 = 31
8430 (gdb) print i@@entry
8431 $2 = 30
8432 @end smallexample
8433
8434 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8435 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8436 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8437 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8438 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8439 For program code
8440
8441 @smallexample
8442 char var0[] = "A";
8443 signed char var1[] = "A";
8444 @end smallexample
8445
8446 You get during debugging
8447 @smallexample
8448 (gdb) print var0
8449 $1 = "A"
8450 (gdb) print var1
8451 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8452 @end smallexample
8453
8454 @node Arrays
8455 @section Artificial Arrays
8456
8457 @cindex artificial array
8458 @cindex arrays
8459 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8460 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8461 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8462 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8463 program.
8464
8465 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8466 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8467 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8468 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8469 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8470 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8471 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8472 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8473 example. If a program says
8474
8475 @smallexample
8476 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8477 @end smallexample
8478
8479 @noindent
8480 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8481
8482 @smallexample
8483 p *array@@len
8484 @end smallexample
8485
8486 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8487 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8488 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8489 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8490 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8491
8492 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8493 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8494 The value need not be in memory:
8495 @smallexample
8496 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8497 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8498 @end smallexample
8499
8500 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8501 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8502 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8503 @smallexample
8504 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8505 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8506 @end smallexample
8507
8508 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8509 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8510 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8511 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8512 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8513 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8514 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8515 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8516 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8517 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8518
8519 @smallexample
8520 set $i = 0
8521 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8522 @key{RET}
8523 @key{RET}
8524 @dots{}
8525 @end smallexample
8526
8527 @node Output Formats
8528 @section Output Formats
8529
8530 @cindex formatted output
8531 @cindex output formats
8532 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8533 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8534 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8535 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8536 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8537
8538 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8539 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8540 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8541 letters supported are:
8542
8543 @table @code
8544 @item x
8545 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8546 hexadecimal.
8547
8548 @item d
8549 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8550
8551 @item u
8552 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8553
8554 @item o
8555 Print as integer in octal.
8556
8557 @item t
8558 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8559 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8560 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8561 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8562
8563 @item a
8564 @cindex unknown address, locating
8565 @cindex locate address
8566 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8567 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8568 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8569
8570 @smallexample
8571 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8572 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8573 @end smallexample
8574
8575 @noindent
8576 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8577 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8578
8579 @item c
8580 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8581 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8582 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8583 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8584
8585 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8586 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8587 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8588 data.
8589
8590 @item f
8591 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8592 using typical floating point syntax.
8593
8594 @item s
8595 @cindex printing strings
8596 @cindex printing byte arrays
8597 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8598 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8599 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8600 natural types.
8601
8602 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8603 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8604 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8605 array.
8606
8607 @item z
8608 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8609 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8610 to the size of the integer type.
8611
8612 @item r
8613 @cindex raw printing
8614 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8615 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8616 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8617 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8618 pretty-printer which might exist.
8619 @end table
8620
8621 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8622
8623 @smallexample
8624 p/x $pc
8625 @end smallexample
8626
8627 @noindent
8628 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8629 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8630
8631 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8632 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8633 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8634
8635 @node Memory
8636 @section Examining Memory
8637
8638 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8639 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8640
8641 @cindex examining memory
8642 @table @code
8643 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8644 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8645 @itemx x @var{addr}
8646 @itemx x
8647 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8648 @end table
8649
8650 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8651 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8652 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8653 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8654 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8655
8656 @table @r
8657 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8658 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8659 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8660 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8661 @c 4.1.2.
8662
8663 @item @var{f}, the display format
8664 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8665 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8666 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8667 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8668 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8669
8670 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8671 The unit size is any of
8672
8673 @table @code
8674 @item b
8675 Bytes.
8676 @item h
8677 Halfwords (two bytes).
8678 @item w
8679 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8680 @item g
8681 Giant words (eight bytes).
8682 @end table
8683
8684 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8685 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8686 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8687 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8688 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8689 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8690 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8691 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8692 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8693 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8694 be altered.
8695
8696 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8697 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8698 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8699 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8700 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8701 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8702 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8703 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8704 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8705 a value from memory).
8706 @end table
8707
8708 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8709 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8710 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8711 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8712 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8713
8714 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8715 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8716 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8717 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8718 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8719
8720 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8721 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8722 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8723 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8724 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8725 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8726 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8727 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8728 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8729
8730 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8731 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8732 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8733 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8734 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8735 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8736 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8737
8738 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8739 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8740
8741 @smallexample
8742 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8743 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8744 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8745 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8746 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8747 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8748 @end smallexample
8749
8750 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8751 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8752 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8753 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8754 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8755 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8756 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8757 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8758 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8759
8760 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8761 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8762 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8763
8764 @cindex remote memory comparison
8765 @cindex verify remote memory image
8766 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8767 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
8768 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
8769 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
8770 situations.
8771
8772 @table @code
8773 @kindex compare-sections
8774 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
8775 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8776 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8777 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8778 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
8779 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
8780 remote request.
8781 @end table
8782
8783 @node Auto Display
8784 @section Automatic Display
8785 @cindex automatic display
8786 @cindex display of expressions
8787
8788 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8789 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
8790 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
8791 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
8792 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
8793 The automatic display looks like this:
8794
8795 @smallexample
8796 2: foo = 38
8797 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
8798 @end smallexample
8799
8800 @noindent
8801 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
8802 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
8803 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
8804 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
8805 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
8806 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
8807
8808 @table @code
8809 @kindex display
8810 @item display @var{expr}
8811 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
8812 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8813
8814 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8815
8816 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
8817 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
8818 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
8819 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
8820 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
8821
8822 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
8823 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
8824 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
8825 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
8826 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8827 @end table
8828
8829 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
8830 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
8831 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8832
8833 @table @code
8834 @kindex delete display
8835 @kindex undisplay
8836 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
8837 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8838 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
8839 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
8840 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
8841 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
8842 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8843
8844 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8845 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
8846
8847 @kindex disable display
8848 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8849 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
8850 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
8851 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
8852 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
8853 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
8854 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
8855 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8856
8857 @kindex enable display
8858 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8859 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
8860 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
8861 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
8862 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
8863 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
8864 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8865
8866 @item display
8867 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
8868 done when your program stops.
8869
8870 @kindex info display
8871 @item info display
8872 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
8873 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
8874 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
8875 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
8876 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
8877 @end table
8878
8879 @cindex display disabled out of scope
8880 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
8881 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
8882 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
8883 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
8884 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
8885 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
8886 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
8887 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
8888 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
8889 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
8890
8891 @node Print Settings
8892 @section Print Settings
8893
8894 @cindex format options
8895 @cindex print settings
8896 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
8897 and symbols are printed.
8898
8899 @noindent
8900 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
8901
8902 @table @code
8903 @kindex set print
8904 @item set print address
8905 @itemx set print address on
8906 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
8907 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
8908 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
8909 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
8910 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
8911 @code{set print address on}:
8912
8913 @smallexample
8914 @group
8915 (@value{GDBP}) f
8916 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
8917 at input.c:530
8918 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8919 @end group
8920 @end smallexample
8921
8922 @item set print address off
8923 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
8924 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
8925
8926 @smallexample
8927 @group
8928 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
8929 (@value{GDBP}) f
8930 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
8931 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8932 @end group
8933 @end smallexample
8934
8935 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
8936 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
8937 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
8938 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
8939
8940 @kindex show print
8941 @item show print address
8942 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
8943 @end table
8944
8945 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
8946 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
8947 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
8948 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
8949 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
8950 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
8951 it prints a symbolic address:
8952
8953 @table @code
8954 @item set print symbol-filename on
8955 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
8956 @cindex symbol, source file and line
8957 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
8958 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8959
8960 @item set print symbol-filename off
8961 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
8962 default.
8963
8964 @item show print symbol-filename
8965 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
8966 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
8967 @end table
8968
8969 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
8970 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
8971 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
8972
8973 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
8974 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
8975
8976 @table @code
8977 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
8978 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
8979 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
8980 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
8981 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
8982 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
8983 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
8984 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
8985
8986 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
8987 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
8988 symbolic address.
8989 @end table
8990
8991 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
8992 @cindex pointer, finding referent
8993 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
8994 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
8995 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
8996 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
8997 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
8998 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
8999
9000 @smallexample
9001 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9002 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9003 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9004 @end smallexample
9005
9006 @quotation
9007 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9008 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9009 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9010 @end quotation
9011
9012 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9013 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9014
9015 @table @code
9016 @item set print symbol on
9017 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9018 one exists.
9019
9020 @item set print symbol off
9021 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9022 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9023 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9024
9025 @item show print symbol
9026 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9027 address.
9028 @end table
9029
9030 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9031
9032 @table @code
9033 @item set print array
9034 @itemx set print array on
9035 @cindex pretty print arrays
9036 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9037 but uses more space. The default is off.
9038
9039 @item set print array off
9040 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9041
9042 @item show print array
9043 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9044 arrays.
9045
9046 @cindex print array indexes
9047 @item set print array-indexes
9048 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9049 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9050 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9051 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9052
9053 @item set print array-indexes off
9054 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9055
9056 @item show print array-indexes
9057 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9058 arrays.
9059
9060 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9061 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9062 @cindex number of array elements to print
9063 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9064 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9065 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9066 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9067 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9068 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9069 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9070 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9071
9072 @item show print elements
9073 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9074 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9075
9076 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9077 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9078 @cindex printing frame argument values
9079 @cindex print all frame argument values
9080 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9081 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9082 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9083 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9084 values are:
9085
9086 @table @code
9087 @item all
9088 The values of all arguments are printed.
9089
9090 @item scalars
9091 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9092 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9093 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9094 only scalar arguments are shown:
9095
9096 @smallexample
9097 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9098 at frame-args.c:23
9099 @end smallexample
9100
9101 @item none
9102 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9103 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9104
9105 @smallexample
9106 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9107 at frame-args.c:23
9108 @end smallexample
9109 @end table
9110
9111 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9112 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9113 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9114 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9115 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9116 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9117 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9118 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9119 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9120 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9121
9122 @item show print frame-arguments
9123 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9124
9125 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9126 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9127
9128 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9129 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9130 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9131 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9132 This is the default.
9133
9134 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9135 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9136
9137 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9138 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9139 @kindex set print entry-values
9140 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9141 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9142 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9143 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9144 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9145
9146 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9147 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9148 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9149 @code{no} setting.
9150
9151 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9152 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9153 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9154 this information.
9155
9156 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9157
9158 @table @code
9159 @item no
9160 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9161 point.
9162 @smallexample
9163 #0 equal (val=5)
9164 #0 different (val=6)
9165 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9166 #0 born (val=10)
9167 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9168 @end smallexample
9169
9170 @item only
9171 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9172 values are never printed.
9173 @smallexample
9174 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9175 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9176 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9177 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9178 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9179 @end smallexample
9180
9181 @item preferred
9182 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9183 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9184 value for such parameter.
9185 @smallexample
9186 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9187 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9188 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9189 #0 born (val=10)
9190 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9191 @end smallexample
9192
9193 @item if-needed
9194 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9195 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9196 parameter.
9197 @smallexample
9198 #0 equal (val=5)
9199 #0 different (val=6)
9200 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9201 #0 born (val=10)
9202 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9203 @end smallexample
9204
9205 @item both
9206 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9207 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9208 optimizations.
9209 @smallexample
9210 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9211 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9212 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9213 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9214 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9215 @end smallexample
9216
9217 @item compact
9218 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9219 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9220 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9221 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9222 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9223 @smallexample
9224 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9225 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9226 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9227 #0 born (val=10)
9228 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9229 @end smallexample
9230
9231 @item default
9232 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9233 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9234 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9235 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9236 @smallexample
9237 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9238 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9239 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9240 #0 born (val=10)
9241 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9242 @end smallexample
9243 @end table
9244
9245 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9246 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9247
9248 @item show print entry-values
9249 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9250 entry.
9251
9252 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9253 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9254 @cindex repeated array elements
9255 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9256 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9257 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9258 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9259 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9260 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9261 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9262 is 10.
9263
9264 @item show print repeats
9265 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9266 elements.
9267
9268 @item set print null-stop
9269 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9270 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9271 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9272 contain only short strings.
9273 The default is off.
9274
9275 @item show print null-stop
9276 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9277 @sc{null} character.
9278
9279 @item set print pretty on
9280 @cindex print structures in indented form
9281 @cindex indentation in structure display
9282 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9283 per line, like this:
9284
9285 @smallexample
9286 @group
9287 $1 = @{
9288 next = 0x0,
9289 flags = @{
9290 sweet = 1,
9291 sour = 1
9292 @},
9293 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9294 @}
9295 @end group
9296 @end smallexample
9297
9298 @item set print pretty off
9299 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9300
9301 @smallexample
9302 @group
9303 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9304 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9305 @end group
9306 @end smallexample
9307
9308 @noindent
9309 This is the default format.
9310
9311 @item show print pretty
9312 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9313
9314 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9315 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9316 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9317 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9318 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9319 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9320 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9321 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9322
9323 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9324 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9325 international character sets, and is the default.
9326
9327 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9328 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9329
9330 @item set print union on
9331 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9332 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9333 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9334
9335 @item set print union off
9336 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9337 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9338 instead.
9339
9340 @item show print union
9341 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9342 structures and other unions.
9343
9344 For example, given the declarations
9345
9346 @smallexample
9347 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9348 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9349 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9350 Bug_forms;
9351
9352 struct thing @{
9353 Species it;
9354 union @{
9355 Tree_forms tree;
9356 Bug_forms bug;
9357 @} form;
9358 @};
9359
9360 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9361 @end smallexample
9362
9363 @noindent
9364 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9365
9366 @smallexample
9367 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9368 @end smallexample
9369
9370 @noindent
9371 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9372
9373 @smallexample
9374 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9375 @end smallexample
9376
9377 @noindent
9378 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9379 and in Pascal.
9380 @end table
9381
9382 @need 1000
9383 @noindent
9384 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9385
9386 @table @code
9387 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9388 @item set print demangle
9389 @itemx set print demangle on
9390 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9391 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9392 linkage. The default is on.
9393
9394 @item show print demangle
9395 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9396
9397 @item set print asm-demangle
9398 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9399 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9400 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9401 The default is off.
9402
9403 @item show print asm-demangle
9404 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9405 or demangled form.
9406
9407 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9408 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9409 @kindex set demangle-style
9410 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9411 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9412 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9413
9414 @table @code
9415 @item auto
9416 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9417 This is the default.
9418
9419 @item gnu
9420 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9421
9422 @item hp
9423 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9424
9425 @item lucid
9426 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9427
9428 @item arm
9429 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9430 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9431 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9432 require further enhancement to permit that.
9433
9434 @end table
9435 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9436
9437 @item show demangle-style
9438 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9439
9440 @item set print object
9441 @itemx set print object on
9442 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9443 @cindex display derived types
9444 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9445 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9446 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9447 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9448 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9449 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9450 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9451
9452 @item set print object off
9453 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9454 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9455
9456 @item show print object
9457 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9458
9459 @item set print static-members
9460 @itemx set print static-members on
9461 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9462 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9463
9464 @item set print static-members off
9465 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9466
9467 @item show print static-members
9468 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9469
9470 @item set print pascal_static-members
9471 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9472 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9473 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9474 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9475
9476 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9477 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9478
9479 @item show print pascal_static-members
9480 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9481
9482 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9483 @item set print vtbl
9484 @itemx set print vtbl on
9485 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9486 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9487 @cindex VTBL display
9488 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9489 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9490 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9491
9492 @item set print vtbl off
9493 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9494
9495 @item show print vtbl
9496 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9497 @end table
9498
9499 @node Pretty Printing
9500 @section Pretty Printing
9501
9502 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9503 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9504 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9505
9506 @menu
9507 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9508 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9509 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9510 @end menu
9511
9512 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9513 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9514
9515 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9516 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9517 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9518
9519 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9520 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9521 pretty-printers with their names.
9522 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9523 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9524 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9525 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9526
9527 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9528 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9529 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9530 do anything special.
9531
9532 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9533
9534 @itemize @bullet
9535 @item
9536 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9537 all inferiors.
9538
9539 @item
9540 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9541 when debugging that program.
9542 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9543
9544 @item
9545 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9546 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9547 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9548 @end itemize
9549
9550 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9551 pretty-printers are selected,
9552
9553 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9554 for new types.
9555
9556 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9557 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9558
9559 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9560
9561 @smallexample
9562 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9563 $1 = @{
9564 static npos = 4294967295,
9565 _M_dataplus = @{
9566 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9567 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9568 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9569 @},
9570 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9571 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9572 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9573 @}
9574 @}
9575 @end smallexample
9576
9577 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9578
9579 @smallexample
9580 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9581 $2 = "abcd"
9582 @end smallexample
9583
9584 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9585 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9586 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9587
9588 @table @code
9589 @kindex info pretty-printer
9590 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9591 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9592 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9593
9594 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9595 whose pretty-printers to list.
9596 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9597 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9598 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9599 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9600 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9601
9602 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9603 to list.
9604
9605 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9606 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9607 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9608 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9609
9610 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9611 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9612 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9613 @end table
9614
9615 Example:
9616
9617 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9618 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9619 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9620 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9621
9622 @smallexample
9623 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9624 library1.so:
9625 foo
9626 library2.so:
9627 bar
9628 bar1
9629 bar2
9630 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9631 library2.so:
9632 bar
9633 bar1
9634 bar2
9635 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9636 1 printer disabled
9637 2 of 3 printers enabled
9638 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9639 library1.so:
9640 foo [disabled]
9641 library2.so:
9642 bar
9643 bar1
9644 bar2
9645 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9646 1 printer disabled
9647 1 of 3 printers enabled
9648 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9649 library1.so:
9650 foo [disabled]
9651 library2.so:
9652 bar
9653 bar1 [disabled]
9654 bar2
9655 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9656 1 printer disabled
9657 0 of 3 printers enabled
9658 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9659 library1.so:
9660 foo [disabled]
9661 library2.so:
9662 bar [disabled]
9663 bar1 [disabled]
9664 bar2
9665 @end smallexample
9666
9667 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9668 as can each individual subprinter.
9669
9670 @node Value History
9671 @section Value History
9672
9673 @cindex value history
9674 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9675 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9676 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9677 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9678 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9679 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9680 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9681 symbol table.
9682
9683 @cindex @code{$}
9684 @cindex @code{$$}
9685 @cindex history number
9686 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9687 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9688 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9689 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9690 history number.
9691
9692 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9693 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9694 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9695 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9696 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9697 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9698 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9699
9700 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9701 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9702
9703 @smallexample
9704 p *$
9705 @end smallexample
9706
9707 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9708 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9709
9710 @smallexample
9711 p *$.next
9712 @end smallexample
9713
9714 @noindent
9715 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9716 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9717
9718 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9719 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9720
9721 @smallexample
9722 print x
9723 set x=5
9724 @end smallexample
9725
9726 @noindent
9727 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9728 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9729
9730 @table @code
9731 @kindex show values
9732 @item show values
9733 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9734 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9735 values} does not change the history.
9736
9737 @item show values @var{n}
9738 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9739
9740 @item show values +
9741 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9742 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9743 @end table
9744
9745 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9746 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9747
9748 @node Convenience Vars
9749 @section Convenience Variables
9750
9751 @cindex convenience variables
9752 @cindex user-defined variables
9753 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9754 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9755 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9756 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9757 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9758
9759 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9760 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9761 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9762 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9763 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9764
9765 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9766 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9767 For example:
9768
9769 @smallexample
9770 set $foo = *object_ptr
9771 @end smallexample
9772
9773 @noindent
9774 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9775 @code{object_ptr}.
9776
9777 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9778 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9779 value with another assignment at any time.
9780
9781 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9782 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9783 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9784 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9785
9786 @table @code
9787 @kindex show convenience
9788 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9789 @item show convenience
9790 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
9791 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
9792 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
9793
9794 @kindex init-if-undefined
9795 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
9796 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
9797 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
9798 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
9799 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
9800 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
9801 override default values used in a command script.
9802
9803 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
9804 any side-effects do not occur.
9805 @end table
9806
9807 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
9808 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
9809 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
9810
9811 @smallexample
9812 set $i = 0
9813 print bar[$i++]->contents
9814 @end smallexample
9815
9816 @noindent
9817 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
9818
9819 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
9820 values likely to be useful.
9821
9822 @table @code
9823 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
9824 @item $_
9825 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
9826 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
9827 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
9828 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
9829 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
9830 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
9831 to the type of @code{$__}.
9832
9833 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
9834 @item $__
9835 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
9836 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
9837 to match the format in which the data was printed.
9838
9839 @item $_exitcode
9840 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
9841 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
9842 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
9843 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
9844
9845 @item $_exitsignal
9846 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
9847 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
9848 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
9849 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
9850
9851 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
9852 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
9853 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
9854 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
9855 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
9856
9857 @smallexample
9858 #include <signal.h>
9859
9860 int
9861 main (int argc, char *argv[])
9862 @{
9863 raise (SIGALRM);
9864 return 0;
9865 @}
9866 @end smallexample
9867
9868 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
9869 or signalled would be:
9870
9871 @smallexample
9872 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
9873 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
9874 End with a line saying just ``end''.
9875 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
9876 >echo The program has exited\n
9877 >else
9878 >echo The program has signalled\n
9879 >end
9880 >end
9881 (@value{GDBP}) run
9882 Starting program:
9883
9884 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
9885 The program no longer exists.
9886 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9887 The program has signalled
9888 @end smallexample
9889
9890 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
9891 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
9892 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
9893 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
9894
9895 @smallexample
9896 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9897 The program has exited
9898 @end smallexample
9899
9900 @item $_exception
9901 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
9902 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
9903
9904 @item $_probe_argc
9905 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
9906 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
9907
9908 @item $_sdata
9909 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
9910 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
9911 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
9912 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
9913 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
9914
9915 @item $_siginfo
9916 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
9917 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
9918 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
9919 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
9920 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
9921
9922 @item $_tlb
9923 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
9924 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
9925 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
9926 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
9927 @xref{General Query Packets}.
9928 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
9929
9930 @end table
9931
9932 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9933 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9934 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9935
9936 @node Convenience Funs
9937 @section Convenience Functions
9938
9939 @cindex convenience functions
9940 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
9941 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
9942 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
9943 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
9944 @value{GDBN}.
9945
9946 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
9947 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
9948
9949 @table @code
9950
9951 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
9952 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
9953 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
9954 returns zero.
9955
9956 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
9957 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
9958 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
9959 it is @code{void}:
9960
9961 @smallexample
9962 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
9963 $1 = void
9964 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
9965 $2 = 1
9966 (@value{GDBP}) run
9967 Starting program: ./a.out
9968 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
9969 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
9970 $3 = 0
9971 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
9972 $4 = 0
9973 @end smallexample
9974
9975 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
9976 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
9977 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
9978 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
9979 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
9980 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
9981 anymore.
9982
9983 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
9984 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
9985
9986 @smallexample
9987 void
9988 foo (void)
9989 @{
9990 @}
9991 @end smallexample
9992
9993 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
9994
9995 @smallexample
9996 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
9997 $1 = void
9998 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
9999 $2 = 1
10000 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10001 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10002 $3 = void
10003 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10004 $4 = 1
10005 @end smallexample
10006
10007 @end table
10008
10009 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10010 @code{Python} support.
10011
10012 @table @code
10013
10014 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10015 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10016 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10017 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10018 Otherwise it returns zero.
10019
10020 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10021 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10022 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10023 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10024 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10025 regular expression support.
10026
10027 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10028 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10029 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10030 Otherwise it returns zero.
10031
10032 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10033 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10034 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10035
10036 @end table
10037
10038 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10039 convenience functions.
10040
10041 @table @code
10042 @item help function
10043 @kindex help function
10044 @cindex show all convenience functions
10045 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10046 @end table
10047
10048 @node Registers
10049 @section Registers
10050
10051 @cindex registers
10052 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10053 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10054 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10055 your machine.
10056
10057 @table @code
10058 @kindex info registers
10059 @item info registers
10060 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10061 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10062
10063 @kindex info all-registers
10064 @cindex floating point registers
10065 @item info all-registers
10066 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10067 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10068
10069 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10070 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10071 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10072 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10073 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10074 @end table
10075
10076 @cindex stack pointer register
10077 @cindex program counter register
10078 @cindex process status register
10079 @cindex frame pointer register
10080 @cindex standard registers
10081 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10082 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10083 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10084 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10085 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10086 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10087 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10088 you could print the program counter in hex with
10089
10090 @smallexample
10091 p/x $pc
10092 @end smallexample
10093
10094 @noindent
10095 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10096
10097 @smallexample
10098 x/i $pc
10099 @end smallexample
10100
10101 @noindent
10102 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10103 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10104 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10105 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10106 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10107 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10108 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10109
10110 @smallexample
10111 set $sp += 4
10112 @end smallexample
10113
10114 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10115 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10116 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10117 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10118 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10119 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10120 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10121
10122 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10123 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10124 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10125 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10126 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10127 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10128 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10129
10130 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10131 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10132 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10133 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10134 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10135 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10136 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10137 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10138 prints the data in both formats.
10139
10140 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10141 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10142 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10143 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10144 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10145 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10146 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10147
10148 @smallexample
10149 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10150 $1 = @{
10151 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10152 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10153 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10154 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10155 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10156 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10157 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10158 @}
10159 @end smallexample
10160
10161 @noindent
10162 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10163 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10164 value to a @code{struct} member:
10165
10166 @smallexample
10167 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10168 @end smallexample
10169
10170 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10171 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10172 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10173 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10174 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10175 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10176
10177 @cindex caller-saved registers
10178 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10179 @cindex volatile registers
10180 @cindex <not saved> values
10181 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10182 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10183 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10184 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10185 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10186 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10187 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10188 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10189 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10190 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10191 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10192 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10193 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10194 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10195 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10196 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10197 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10198 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10199 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10200 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10201 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10202 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10203 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10204
10205 @node Floating Point Hardware
10206 @section Floating Point Hardware
10207 @cindex floating point
10208
10209 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10210 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10211
10212 @table @code
10213 @kindex info float
10214 @item info float
10215 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10216 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10217 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10218 the ARM and x86 machines.
10219 @end table
10220
10221 @node Vector Unit
10222 @section Vector Unit
10223 @cindex vector unit
10224
10225 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10226 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10227
10228 @table @code
10229 @kindex info vector
10230 @item info vector
10231 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10232 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10233 @end table
10234
10235 @node OS Information
10236 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10237 @cindex OS information
10238
10239 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10240 you debug your program.
10241
10242 @cindex auxiliary vector
10243 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10244 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10245 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10246 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10247 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10248 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10249 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10250 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10251 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10252 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10253 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10254 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10255
10256 @table @code
10257 @kindex info auxv
10258 @item info auxv
10259 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10260 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10261 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10262 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10263 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10264 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10265 an unrecognized tag.
10266 @end table
10267
10268 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10269 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10270 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10271 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10272 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10273 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10274 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10275
10276 @table @code
10277 @kindex info os
10278 @item info os @var{infotype}
10279
10280 Display OS information of the requested type.
10281
10282 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10283
10284 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10285 @table @code
10286 @kindex info os processes
10287 @item processes
10288 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10289 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10290 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10291 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10292 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10293 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10294
10295 @kindex info os procgroups
10296 @item procgroups
10297 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10298 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10299 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10300 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10301 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10302 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10303 and the process group leader is listed first.
10304
10305 @kindex info os threads
10306 @item threads
10307 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10308 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10309 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10310 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10311 process is not listed.
10312
10313 @kindex info os files
10314 @item files
10315 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10316 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10317 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10318 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10319
10320 @kindex info os sockets
10321 @item sockets
10322 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10323 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10324 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10325 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10326 connection.
10327
10328 @kindex info os shm
10329 @item shm
10330 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10331 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10332 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10333 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10334 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10335 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10336 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10337
10338 @kindex info os semaphores
10339 @item semaphores
10340 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10341 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10342 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10343 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10344 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10345
10346 @kindex info os msg
10347 @item msg
10348 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10349 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10350 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10351 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10352 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10353 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10354 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10355 the message queue was last changed.
10356
10357 @kindex info os modules
10358 @item modules
10359 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10360 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10361 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10362 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10363 in memory.
10364 @end table
10365
10366 @item info os
10367 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10368 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10369 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10370 types, this command will report an error.
10371 @end table
10372
10373 @node Memory Region Attributes
10374 @section Memory Region Attributes
10375 @cindex memory region attributes
10376
10377 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10378 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10379 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10380 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10381 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10382 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10383 user can override the fetched regions.
10384
10385 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10386 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10387 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10388 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10389 all memory.
10390
10391 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10392 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10393
10394 @table @code
10395 @kindex mem
10396 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10397 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10398 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10399 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10400 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10401 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10402
10403 @item mem auto
10404 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10405 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10406
10407 @kindex delete mem
10408 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10409 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10410 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10411
10412 @kindex disable mem
10413 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10414 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10415 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10416 It may be enabled again later.
10417
10418 @kindex enable mem
10419 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10420 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10421
10422 @kindex info mem
10423 @item info mem
10424 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10425 for each region:
10426
10427 @table @emph
10428 @item Memory Region Number
10429 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10430 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10431 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10432
10433 @item Lo Address
10434 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10435
10436 @item Hi Address
10437 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10438
10439 @item Attributes
10440 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10441 @end table
10442 @end table
10443
10444
10445 @subsection Attributes
10446
10447 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10448 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10449 write accesses to a memory region.
10450
10451 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10452 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10453 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10454
10455 @table @code
10456 @item ro
10457 Memory is read only.
10458 @item wo
10459 Memory is write only.
10460 @item rw
10461 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10462 @end table
10463
10464 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10465 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10466 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10467 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10468 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10469
10470 @table @code
10471 @item 8
10472 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10473 @item 16
10474 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10475 @item 32
10476 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10477 @item 64
10478 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10479 @end table
10480
10481 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10482 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10483 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10484 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10485 @c
10486 @c @table @code
10487 @c @item hwbreak
10488 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10489 @c @item swbreak (default)
10490 @c @end table
10491
10492 @subsubsection Data Cache
10493 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10494 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10495 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10496 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10497 registers.
10498
10499 @table @code
10500 @item cache
10501 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10502 @item nocache
10503 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10504 @end table
10505
10506 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10507 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10508 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10509 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10510 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10511
10512 @table @code
10513 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10514 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10515 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10516 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10517 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10518 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10519 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10520 The default value is @code{on}.
10521 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10522 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10523 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10524 @end table
10525
10526
10527 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10528 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10529 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10530 @c
10531 @c @table @code
10532 @c @item verify
10533 @c @item noverify (default)
10534 @c @end table
10535
10536 @node Dump/Restore Files
10537 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10538 @cindex dump/restore files
10539 @cindex append data to a file
10540 @cindex dump data to a file
10541 @cindex restore data from a file
10542
10543 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10544 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10545 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10546 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10547 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10548 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10549 files.
10550
10551 @table @code
10552
10553 @kindex dump
10554 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10555 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10556 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10557 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10558
10559 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10560 @table @code
10561 @item binary
10562 Raw binary form.
10563 @item ihex
10564 Intel hex format.
10565 @item srec
10566 Motorola S-record format.
10567 @item tekhex
10568 Tektronix Hex format.
10569 @end table
10570
10571 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10572 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10573 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10574 form.
10575
10576 @kindex append
10577 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10578 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10579 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10580 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10581 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10582
10583 @kindex restore
10584 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10585 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10586 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10587 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10588 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10589
10590 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10591 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10592 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10593 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10594 from that location.
10595
10596 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10597 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10598 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10599 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10600
10601 @end table
10602
10603 @node Core File Generation
10604 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10605 @cindex dump core from inferior
10606
10607 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10608 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10609 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10610 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10611 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10612 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10613 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10614
10615 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10616 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10617 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10618
10619 @table @code
10620 @kindex gcore
10621 @kindex generate-core-file
10622 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10623 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10624 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10625 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10626 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10627 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10628
10629 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10630 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10631 @end table
10632
10633 @node Character Sets
10634 @section Character Sets
10635 @cindex character sets
10636 @cindex charset
10637 @cindex translating between character sets
10638 @cindex host character set
10639 @cindex target character set
10640
10641 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10642 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10643 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10644 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10645 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10646 @dfn{target character set}.
10647
10648 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10649 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10650 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10651 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10652 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10653 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10654 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10655 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10656 character and string literals in expressions.
10657
10658 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10659 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10660 target-charset} command, described below.
10661
10662 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10663 support:
10664
10665 @table @code
10666 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10667 @kindex set target-charset
10668 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10669 list of supported target character sets, type
10670 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10671
10672 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10673 @kindex set host-charset
10674 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10675
10676 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10677 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10678 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10679 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10680 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10681
10682 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10683 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10684 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10685
10686 @item set charset @var{charset}
10687 @kindex set charset
10688 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10689 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10690 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10691 for both host and target.
10692
10693 @item show charset
10694 @kindex show charset
10695 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10696
10697 @item show host-charset
10698 @kindex show host-charset
10699 Show the name of the current host character set.
10700
10701 @item show target-charset
10702 @kindex show target-charset
10703 Show the name of the current target character set.
10704
10705 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10706 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10707 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10708 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10709 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10710 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10711
10712 @item show target-wide-charset
10713 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10714 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10715 @end table
10716
10717 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10718 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10719 @file{charset-test.c}:
10720
10721 @smallexample
10722 #include <stdio.h>
10723
10724 char ascii_hello[]
10725 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
10726 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
10727 char ibm1047_hello[]
10728 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
10729 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
10730
10731 main ()
10732 @{
10733 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10734 @}
10735 @end smallexample
10736
10737 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
10738 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
10739 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
10740
10741 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
10742
10743 @smallexample
10744 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
10745 $ gdb -nw charset-test
10746 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
10747 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10748 @dots{}
10749 (@value{GDBP})
10750 @end smallexample
10751
10752 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
10753 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
10754 strings:
10755
10756 @smallexample
10757 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10758 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
10759 (@value{GDBP})
10760 @end smallexample
10761
10762 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
10763 initial character set:
10764 @smallexample
10765 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
10766 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10767 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
10768 (@value{GDBP})
10769 @end smallexample
10770
10771 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
10772 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
10773 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
10774 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
10775 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
10776
10777 @smallexample
10778 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10779 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
10780 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10781 $2 = 72 'H'
10782 (@value{GDBP})
10783 @end smallexample
10784
10785 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
10786 literals you use in expressions:
10787
10788 @smallexample
10789 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10790 $3 = 43 '+'
10791 (@value{GDBP})
10792 @end smallexample
10793
10794 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
10795 character.
10796
10797 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
10798 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
10799 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
10800
10801 @smallexample
10802 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10803 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
10804 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10805 $5 = 200 '\310'
10806 (@value{GDBP})
10807 @end smallexample
10808
10809 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
10810 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
10811
10812 @smallexample
10813 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10814 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
10815 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10816 @end smallexample
10817
10818 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
10819 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
10820 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
10821 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
10822 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
10823
10824 @smallexample
10825 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
10826 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10827 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
10828 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
10829 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10830 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
10831 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10832 $7 = 72 '\110'
10833 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10834 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
10835 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10836 $9 = 200 'H'
10837 (@value{GDBP})
10838 @end smallexample
10839
10840 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
10841 string literals you use in expressions:
10842
10843 @smallexample
10844 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10845 $10 = 78 '+'
10846 (@value{GDBP})
10847 @end smallexample
10848
10849 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
10850 character.
10851
10852 @node Caching Target Data
10853 @section Caching Data of Targets
10854 @cindex caching data of targets
10855
10856 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
10857 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
10858 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
10859 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
10860 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
10861 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
10862 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
10863 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
10864 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
10865 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
10866 is executing.
10867 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
10868 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
10869 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
10870 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
10871 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
10872 in the code segment.
10873 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
10874 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
10875
10876 @table @code
10877 @kindex set remotecache
10878 @item set remotecache on
10879 @itemx set remotecache off
10880 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
10881 with old scripts.
10882
10883 @kindex show remotecache
10884 @item show remotecache
10885 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
10886
10887 @kindex set stack-cache
10888 @item set stack-cache on
10889 @itemx set stack-cache off
10890 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
10891 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
10892
10893 @kindex show stack-cache
10894 @item show stack-cache
10895 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
10896
10897 @kindex set code-cache
10898 @item set code-cache on
10899 @itemx set code-cache off
10900 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
10901 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
10902 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
10903
10904 @kindex show code-cache
10905 @item show code-cache
10906 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
10907 accesses.
10908
10909 @kindex info dcache
10910 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
10911 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
10912 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
10913 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
10914 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
10915 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
10916
10917 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
10918 printed in hex.
10919
10920 @item set dcache size @var{size}
10921 @cindex dcache size
10922 @kindex set dcache size
10923 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
10924
10925 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
10926 @cindex dcache line-size
10927 @kindex set dcache line-size
10928 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
10929 Must be a power of 2.
10930
10931 @item show dcache size
10932 @kindex show dcache size
10933 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
10934
10935 @item show dcache line-size
10936 @kindex show dcache line-size
10937 Show default size of dcache lines.
10938
10939 @end table
10940
10941 @node Searching Memory
10942 @section Search Memory
10943 @cindex searching memory
10944
10945 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
10946 @code{find} command.
10947
10948 @table @code
10949 @kindex find
10950 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10951 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
10952 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
10953 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
10954 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
10955 @end table
10956
10957 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
10958 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
10959
10960 @table @r
10961 @item @var{s}, search query size
10962 The size of each search query value.
10963
10964 @table @code
10965 @item b
10966 bytes
10967 @item h
10968 halfwords (two bytes)
10969 @item w
10970 words (four bytes)
10971 @item g
10972 giant words (eight bytes)
10973 @end table
10974
10975 All values are interpreted in the current language.
10976 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
10977 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
10978
10979 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
10980 value's type in the current language.
10981 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
10982 pattern as a mixture of types.
10983 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
10984 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
10985 which is typically four bytes.
10986
10987 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
10988 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
10989 @end table
10990
10991 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
10992 (@code{"}).
10993 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
10994 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
10995
10996 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
10997 number of matches found.
10998
10999 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11000 @samp{$_}.
11001 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11002
11003 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11004
11005 @smallexample
11006 void
11007 hello ()
11008 @{
11009 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11010 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11011 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11012 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11013 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11014 @}
11015 @end smallexample
11016
11017 @noindent
11018 you get during debugging:
11019
11020 @smallexample
11021 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11022 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11023 1 pattern found
11024 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11025 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11026 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11027 2 patterns found
11028 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11029 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11030 1 pattern found
11031 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11032 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11033 1 pattern found
11034 (gdb) print $numfound
11035 $1 = 1
11036 (gdb) print $_
11037 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11038 @end smallexample
11039
11040 @node Optimized Code
11041 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11042 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11043 @cindex debugging optimized code
11044
11045 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11046 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11047 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11048 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11049 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11050 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11051 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11052
11053 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11054 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11055 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11056 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11057
11058 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11059 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11060 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11061 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11062 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11063 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11064
11065 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11066 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11067 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11068 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11069 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11070
11071 @menu
11072 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11073 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11074 @end menu
11075
11076 @node Inline Functions
11077 @section Inline Functions
11078 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11079
11080 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11081 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11082 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11083 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11084 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11085 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11086 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11087 @code{info frame} command.
11088
11089 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11090 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11091 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11092 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11093 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11094 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11095 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11096 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11097 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11098 local variables in the caller.
11099
11100 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11101 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11102 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11103 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11104 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11105 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11106 instructions are executed.
11107
11108 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11109 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11110 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11111 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11112
11113 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11114 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11115
11116 @itemize @bullet
11117 @item
11118 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11119 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11120 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11121 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11122 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11123 or inside the inlined function instead.
11124
11125 @item
11126 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11127 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11128 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11129 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11130
11131 @end itemize
11132
11133 @node Tail Call Frames
11134 @section Tail Call Frames
11135 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11136
11137 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11138 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11139 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11140 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11141 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11142
11143 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11144 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11145 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11146 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11147 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11148 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11149 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11150
11151 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11152 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11153 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11154 this information.
11155
11156 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11157 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11158
11159 @smallexample
11160 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11161 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11162 (gdb) info frame
11163 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11164 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11165 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11166 source language c++.
11167 Arglist at unknown address.
11168 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11169 @end smallexample
11170
11171 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11172 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11173 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11174 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11175 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11176 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11177
11178 @table @code
11179 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11180 @item set debug entry-values
11181 @kindex set debug entry-values
11182 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11183 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11184 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11185 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11186 result.
11187
11188 @item show debug entry-values
11189 @kindex show debug entry-values
11190 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11191 values at function entry and tail calls.
11192 @end table
11193
11194 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11195 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11196 reference by variable @code{x}):
11197
11198 @smallexample
11199 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11200 void (*x) (void) = c;
11201 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11202 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11203 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11204
11205 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11206 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11207 a () at t.c:3
11208 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11209 (gdb) bt
11210 #0 a () at t.c:3
11211 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11212 @end smallexample
11213
11214 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11215
11216 @smallexample
11217 int i;
11218 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11219 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11220 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11221 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11222 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11223 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11224 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11225 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11226
11227 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11228 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11229 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11230 (gdb) bt
11231 #0 f () at t.c:2
11232 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11233 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11234 @end smallexample
11235
11236 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11237 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11238
11239 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11240 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11241 @set ARROW @click{}
11242 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11243 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11244 @end ifset
11245 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11246 @set ARROW ->
11247 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11248 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11249 @end ifclear
11250
11251 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11252 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11253 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11254
11255 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11256 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11257 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11258 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11259 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11260 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11261
11262 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11263 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11264 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11265 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11266 omitted.
11267
11268 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11269 entry may fail:
11270
11271 @smallexample
11272 int v;
11273 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11274 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11275 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11276 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11277 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11278 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11279
11280 (gdb) bt
11281 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11282 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11283 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11284 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11285 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11286 @end smallexample
11287
11288 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11289 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11290 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11291 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11292 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11293
11294 @node Macros
11295 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11296
11297 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11298 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11299 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11300 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11301 where it was defined.
11302
11303 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11304 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11305 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11306 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11307
11308 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11309 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11310 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11311 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11312 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11313 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11314 see @ref{List}.
11315
11316 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11317 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11318 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11319
11320 @table @code
11321
11322 @kindex macro expand
11323 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11324 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11325 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11326 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11327 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11328 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11329 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11330 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11331 it can be any string of tokens.
11332
11333 @kindex macro exp1
11334 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11335 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11336 @cindex expand macro once
11337 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11338 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11339 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11340 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11341 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11342 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11343 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11344 can be any string of tokens.
11345
11346 @kindex info macro
11347 @cindex macro definition, showing
11348 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11349 @cindex macros, from debug info
11350 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11351 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11352 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11353 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11354 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11355 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11356
11357 @kindex info macros
11358 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11359 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11360 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11361 command-line where those definitions were established.
11362
11363 @kindex macro define
11364 @cindex user-defined macros
11365 @cindex defining macros interactively
11366 @cindex macros, user-defined
11367 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11368 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11369 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11370 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11371 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11372 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11373 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11374 @var{arglist}.
11375
11376 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11377 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11378 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11379 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11380 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11381
11382 @kindex macro undef
11383 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11384 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11385 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11386 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11387 in the program being debugged.
11388
11389 @kindex macro list
11390 @item macro list
11391 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11392 @end table
11393
11394 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11395 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11396 show our source files:
11397
11398 @smallexample
11399 $ cat sample.c
11400 #include <stdio.h>
11401 #include "sample.h"
11402
11403 #define M 42
11404 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11405
11406 main ()
11407 @{
11408 #define N 28
11409 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11410 #undef N
11411 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11412 #define N 1729
11413 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11414 @}
11415 $ cat sample.h
11416 #define Q <
11417 $
11418 @end smallexample
11419
11420 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11421 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11422 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11423 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11424 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11425 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11426 information.
11427
11428 @smallexample
11429 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11430 $
11431 @end smallexample
11432
11433 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11434
11435 @smallexample
11436 $ gdb -nw sample
11437 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11438 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11439 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11440 (@value{GDBP})
11441 @end smallexample
11442
11443 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11444 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11445 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11446
11447 @smallexample
11448 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11449 3
11450 4 #define M 42
11451 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11452 6
11453 7 main ()
11454 8 @{
11455 9 #define N 28
11456 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11457 11 #undef N
11458 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11459 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11460 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11461 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11462 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11463 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11464 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11465 #define Q <
11466 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11467 expands to: (42 + 1)
11468 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11469 expands to: once (M + 1)
11470 (@value{GDBP})
11471 @end smallexample
11472
11473 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11474 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11475 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11476 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11477
11478 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11479 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11480
11481 @smallexample
11482 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11483 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11484 (@value{GDBP}) run
11485 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11486
11487 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11488 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11489 (@value{GDBP})
11490 @end smallexample
11491
11492 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11493
11494 @smallexample
11495 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11496 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11497 #define N 28
11498 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11499 expands to: 28 < 42
11500 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11501 $1 = 1
11502 (@value{GDBP})
11503 @end smallexample
11504
11505 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11506 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11507 thereof) in force at each point:
11508
11509 @smallexample
11510 (@value{GDBP}) next
11511 Hello, world!
11512 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11513 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11514 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11515 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11516 (@value{GDBP}) next
11517 We're so creative.
11518 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11519 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11520 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11521 #define N 1729
11522 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11523 expands to: 1729 < 42
11524 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11525 $2 = 0
11526 (@value{GDBP})
11527 @end smallexample
11528
11529 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11530 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11531 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11532 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11533
11534 @smallexample
11535 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11536 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11537 -D__STDC__=1
11538 (@value{GDBP})
11539 @end smallexample
11540
11541
11542 @node Tracepoints
11543 @chapter Tracepoints
11544 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11545 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11546
11547 @cindex tracepoints
11548 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11549 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11550 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11551 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11552 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11553 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11554 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11555
11556 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11557 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11558 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11559 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11560 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11561 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11562 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11563 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11564 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11565 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11566 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11567
11568 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11569 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11570 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11571 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11572 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11573 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11574 Packets}.
11575
11576 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11577 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11578 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11579
11580 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11581
11582 @menu
11583 * Set Tracepoints::
11584 * Analyze Collected Data::
11585 * Tracepoint Variables::
11586 * Trace Files::
11587 @end menu
11588
11589 @node Set Tracepoints
11590 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11591
11592 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11593 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11594 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11595 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11596 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11597 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11598 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11599
11600 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11601 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11602 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11603 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11604 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11605 tracepoint was hit.
11606
11607 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11608 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11609 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11610 either.
11611
11612 @cindex fast tracepoints
11613 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11614 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11615 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11616
11617 @cindex static tracepoints
11618 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11619 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11620 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11621 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11622 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11623 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11624 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11625 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11626 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11627 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11628 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11629 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11630 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11631 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11632 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11633 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11634 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11635 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11636 static tracepoint marker.
11637
11638 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11639 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11640
11641 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11642 conditions and actions.
11643
11644 @menu
11645 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11646 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11647 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11648 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11649 * Trace State Variables::
11650 * Tracepoint Actions::
11651 * Listing Tracepoints::
11652 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11653 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11654 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11655 @end menu
11656
11657 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11658 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11659
11660 @table @code
11661 @cindex set tracepoint
11662 @kindex trace
11663 @item trace @var{location}
11664 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11665 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11666 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11667 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11668 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11669 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11670 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11671 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11672 in tracing}).
11673 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11674 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11675 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11676 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11677 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11678 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11679 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11680 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11681 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11682 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11683 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11684 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11685
11686 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11687
11688 @smallexample
11689 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11690
11691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11692
11693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11694
11695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11696
11697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11698 @end smallexample
11699
11700 @noindent
11701 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11702
11703 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11704 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11705 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11706 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11707 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11708 information on tracepoint conditions.
11709
11710 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11711 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11712 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11713 @kindex ftrace
11714 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11715 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11716 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11717 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11718 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11719 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11720 message.
11721
11722 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11723 @code{trace}.
11724
11725 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
11726 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
11727 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
11728 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
11729 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
11730 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
11731 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
11732 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
11733
11734 @example
11735 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
11736 @end example
11737
11738 @noindent
11739 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
11740 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
11741
11742 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11743 @cindex set static tracepoint
11744 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
11745 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
11746 @kindex strace
11747 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
11748 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
11749 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
11750 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
11751 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
11752
11753 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
11754 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
11755 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
11756 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
11757 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
11758 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
11759 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
11760 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
11761 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
11762 tracing engine:
11763
11764 @smallexample
11765 main ()
11766 @{
11767 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
11768 @}
11769 @end smallexample
11770
11771 @noindent
11772 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
11773 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
11774
11775 @smallexample
11776 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11777 Cnt Enb ID Address What
11778 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
11779 Data: "str %s"
11780 [etc...]
11781 @end smallexample
11782
11783 @noindent
11784 so you may probe the marker above with:
11785
11786 @smallexample
11787 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
11788 @end smallexample
11789
11790 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
11791 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
11792 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
11793 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
11794 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
11795 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
11796 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
11797 the @samp{Data:} field.
11798
11799 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
11800 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
11801 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
11802
11803 @vindex $tpnum
11804 @cindex last tracepoint number
11805 @cindex recent tracepoint number
11806 @cindex tracepoint number
11807 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
11808 of the most recently set tracepoint.
11809
11810 @kindex delete tracepoint
11811 @cindex tracepoint deletion
11812 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11813 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
11814 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
11815 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
11816
11817 Examples:
11818
11819 @smallexample
11820 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
11821
11822 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
11823 @end smallexample
11824
11825 @noindent
11826 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
11827 @end table
11828
11829 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11830 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11831
11832 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
11833
11834 @table @code
11835 @kindex disable tracepoint
11836 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11837 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
11838 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
11839 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
11840 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
11841 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
11842 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
11843 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
11844 next trace experiment.
11845
11846 @kindex enable tracepoint
11847 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11848 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
11849 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
11850 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
11851 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
11852 next time a trace experiment is run.
11853 @end table
11854
11855 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
11856 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
11857
11858 @table @code
11859 @kindex passcount
11860 @cindex tracepoint pass count
11861 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
11862 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
11863 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
11864 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
11865 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
11866 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
11867 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
11868 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
11869 user.
11870
11871 Examples:
11872
11873 @smallexample
11874 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
11875 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
11876
11877 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
11878 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
11879 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
11880 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
11881 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
11882 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
11883 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
11884 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
11885 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
11886 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
11887 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
11888 @end smallexample
11889 @end table
11890
11891 @node Tracepoint Conditions
11892 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
11893 @cindex conditional tracepoints
11894 @cindex tracepoint conditions
11895
11896 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
11897 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
11898 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
11899 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
11900 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
11901 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
11902 is true.
11903
11904 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
11905 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
11906 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
11907 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
11908 just as with breakpoints.
11909
11910 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
11911 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
11912 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
11913 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
11914 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
11915 accesses, and so forth.
11916
11917 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
11918 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
11919 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
11920 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
11921 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
11922 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
11923 search through.
11924
11925 @smallexample
11926 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
11927 @end smallexample
11928
11929 @node Trace State Variables
11930 @subsection Trace State Variables
11931 @cindex trace state variables
11932
11933 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
11934 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
11935 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
11936 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
11937 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
11938 integers.
11939
11940 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
11941 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
11942 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
11943 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
11944
11945 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
11946 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
11947 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
11948 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
11949 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
11950 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
11951 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
11952 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
11953 variable with the same name.
11954
11955 @table @code
11956
11957 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
11958 @kindex tvariable
11959 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
11960 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
11961 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
11962 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
11963 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
11964 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
11965 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
11966 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
11967 value. The default initial value is 0.
11968
11969 @item info tvariables
11970 @kindex info tvariables
11971 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
11972 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
11973 currently running.
11974
11975 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
11976 @kindex delete tvariable
11977 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
11978 are specified.
11979
11980 @end table
11981
11982 @node Tracepoint Actions
11983 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
11984
11985 @table @code
11986 @kindex actions
11987 @cindex tracepoint actions
11988 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11989 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
11990 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
11991 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
11992 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
11993 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
11994 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
11995 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
11996 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
11997 @code{while-stepping}.
11998
11999 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12000 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12001 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12002
12003 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12004 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12005 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12006
12007 @smallexample
12008 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12009
12010 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12011
12012 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12013 @end smallexample
12014
12015 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12016 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12017 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12018 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12019 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12020 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12021 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12022 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12023
12024 @smallexample
12025 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12026 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12027 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12028 > collect bar,baz
12029 > collect $regs
12030 > while-stepping 12
12031 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12032 > end
12033 end
12034 @end smallexample
12035
12036 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12037 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12038 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12039 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12040 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12041 special arguments are supported:
12042
12043 @table @code
12044 @item $regs
12045 Collect all registers.
12046
12047 @item $args
12048 Collect all function arguments.
12049
12050 @item $locals
12051 Collect all local variables.
12052
12053 @item $_ret
12054 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12055 of a backtrace.
12056
12057 @item $_probe_argc
12058 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12059 tracepoint is located.
12060 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12061
12062 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12063 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12064 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12065 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12066
12067 @item $_sdata
12068 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12069 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12070 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12071 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12072 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12073 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12074 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12075 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12076 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12077
12078 @smallexample
12079 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12080 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12081 @end smallexample
12082
12083 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12084 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12085 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12086 @value{GDBN}.
12087 @end table
12088
12089 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12090 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12091 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12092
12093 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12094 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12095 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12096 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12097 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12098 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12099 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12100 @samp{mystr}.
12101
12102 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12103 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12104
12105 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12106 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12107 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12108 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12109 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12110 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12111 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12112 action were used.
12113
12114 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12115 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12116 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12117 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12118 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12119 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12120
12121 @smallexample
12122 > while-stepping 12
12123 > collect $regs, myglobal
12124 > end
12125 >
12126 @end smallexample
12127
12128 @noindent
12129 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12130 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12131 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12132 @code{stepping}.
12133
12134 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12135 @kindex set default-collect
12136 @cindex default collection action
12137 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12138 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12139 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12140 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12141 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12142 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12143
12144 @item show default-collect
12145 @kindex show default-collect
12146 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12147 tracepoint hit.
12148
12149 @end table
12150
12151 @node Listing Tracepoints
12152 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12153
12154 @table @code
12155 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12156 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12157 @cindex information about tracepoints
12158 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12159 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12160 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12161 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12162 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12163 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12164
12165 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12166 tracing:
12167
12168 @itemize @bullet
12169 @item
12170 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12171
12172 @item
12173 the state about installed on target of each location
12174 @end itemize
12175
12176 @smallexample
12177 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12178 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12179 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12180 while-stepping 20
12181 collect globfoo, $regs
12182 end
12183 collect globfoo2
12184 end
12185 pass count 1200
12186 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12187 collect $eip
12188 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12189 installed on target
12190 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12191 installed on target
12192 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12193 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12194 not installed on target
12195 (@value{GDBP})
12196 @end smallexample
12197
12198 @noindent
12199 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12200 @end table
12201
12202 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12203 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12204
12205 @table @code
12206 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12207 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12208 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12209 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12210 program.
12211
12212 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12213
12214 @table @emph
12215 @item Count
12216 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12217 stable identifier.
12218 @item ID
12219 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12220 @item Enabled or Disabled
12221 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12222 that are not enabled.
12223 @item Address
12224 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12225 @item What
12226 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12227 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12228 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12229 will be left blank.
12230 @end table
12231
12232 @noindent
12233 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12234
12235 @table @emph
12236 @item Data
12237 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12238 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12239 marker call.
12240 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12241 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12242 @end table
12243
12244 @smallexample
12245 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12246 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12247 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12248 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12249 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12250 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12251 Data: str %s
12252 (@value{GDBP})
12253 @end smallexample
12254 @end table
12255
12256 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12257 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12258
12259 @table @code
12260 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12261 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12262 @cindex collected data discarded
12263 @item tstart
12264 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12265 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12266 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12267 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12268 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12269 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12270 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12271 information, and so forth.
12272
12273 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12274 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12275 @item tstop
12276 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12277 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12278 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12279 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12280 needs to be stopped quickly.
12281
12282 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12283 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12284 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12285
12286 @kindex tstatus
12287 @cindex status of trace data collection
12288 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12289 @item tstatus
12290 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12291 collection.
12292 @end table
12293
12294 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12295
12296 @smallexample
12297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12298 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12299 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12300 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12301 > while-stepping 11
12302 > collect $regs
12303 > end
12304 > end
12305 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12306 [time passes @dots{}]
12307 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12308 @end smallexample
12309
12310 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12311 @cindex disconnected tracing
12312 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12313 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12314 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12315 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12316 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12317 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12318 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12319 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12320
12321 @table @code
12322 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12323 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12324 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12325 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12326 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12327 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12328 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12329 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12330
12331 @item show disconnected-tracing
12332 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12333 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12334
12335 @end table
12336
12337 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12338 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12339 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12340 it will continue after reconnection.
12341
12342 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12343 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12344 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12345 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12346 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12347 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12348 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12349 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12350 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12351 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12352
12353 @cindex circular trace buffer
12354 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12355 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12356 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12357 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12358 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12359 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12360 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12361 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12362 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12363 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12364 the next run.
12365
12366 @table @code
12367 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12368 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12369 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12370 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12371 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12372 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12373 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12374
12375 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12376 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12377 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12378 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12379 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12380 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12381
12382 @end table
12383
12384 @table @code
12385 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12386 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12387 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12388 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12389 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12390 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12391 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12392 likes. This is also the default.
12393
12394 @item show trace-buffer-size
12395 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12396 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12397 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12398 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12399 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12400 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12401 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12402 @end table
12403
12404 @table @code
12405 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12406 @kindex set trace-user
12407
12408 @item show trace-user
12409 @kindex show trace-user
12410
12411 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12412 @kindex set trace-notes
12413 Set the trace run's notes.
12414
12415 @item show trace-notes
12416 @kindex show trace-notes
12417 Show the trace run's notes.
12418
12419 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12420 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12421 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12422 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12423 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12424
12425 @item show trace-stop-notes
12426 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12427 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12428
12429 @end table
12430
12431 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12432 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12433
12434 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12435 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12436 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12437 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12438 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12439 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12440 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12441 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12442 mentioned here.
12443
12444 @itemize @bullet
12445
12446 @item
12447 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12448 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12449 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12450 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12451 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12452 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12453 cannot be collected either.
12454
12455 @item
12456 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12457 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12458 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12459 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12460 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12461 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12462 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12463 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12464 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12465 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12466
12467 @item
12468 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12469 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12470 in a misleading way.
12471
12472 @item
12473 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12474 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12475 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12476 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12477 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12478 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12479 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12480 by @code{ptr}.
12481
12482 @item
12483 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12484 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12485 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12486 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12487 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12488 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12489 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12490 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12491 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12492 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12493 invalid address.
12494
12495 @item
12496 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12497 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12498 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12499 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12500 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12501 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12502 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12503 it to zero.
12504
12505 @end itemize
12506
12507 @node Analyze Collected Data
12508 @section Using the Collected Data
12509
12510 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12511 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12512 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12513 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12514 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12515 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12516 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12517 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12518 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12519 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12520 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12521 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12522 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12523 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12524 the buffer will fail.
12525
12526 @menu
12527 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12528 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12529 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12530 @end menu
12531
12532 @node tfind
12533 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12534
12535 @kindex tfind
12536 @cindex select trace snapshot
12537 @cindex find trace snapshot
12538 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12539 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12540 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12541 snapshot is selected.
12542
12543 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12544
12545 @table @code
12546 @item tfind start
12547 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12548 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12549
12550 @item tfind none
12551 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12552
12553 @item tfind end
12554 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12555
12556 @item tfind
12557 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12558
12559 @item tfind -
12560 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12561 retracing earlier steps.
12562
12563 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12564 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12565 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12566 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12567 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12568
12569 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12570 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12571 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12572 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12573 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12574
12575 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12576 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12577 addresses (exclusive).
12578
12579 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12580 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12581 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12582
12583 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12584 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12585 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12586 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12587 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12588 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12589 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12590 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12591 @end table
12592
12593 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12594 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12595 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12596 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12597 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12598 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12599 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12600 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12601 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12602 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12603 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12604 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12605 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12606 tracepoint as the current one.
12607
12608 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12609 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12610 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12611 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12612 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12613
12614 @smallexample
12615 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12616 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12617 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12618 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12619 > tfind
12620 > end
12621
12622 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12623 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12624 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12625 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12626 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12627 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12628 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12629 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12630 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12631 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12632 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12633 @end smallexample
12634
12635 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12636 the buffer:
12637
12638 @smallexample
12639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12640 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12641 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12642 > tfind line
12643 > end
12644
12645 Frame 0, X = 1
12646 Frame 7, X = 2
12647 Frame 13, X = 255
12648 @end smallexample
12649
12650 @node tdump
12651 @subsection @code{tdump}
12652 @kindex tdump
12653 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12654 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12655
12656 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12657 the current trace snapshot.
12658
12659 @smallexample
12660 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12661 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12662 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12663 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12664 > end
12665
12666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12667
12668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12669 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12670 at gdb_test.c:444
12671 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12672
12673 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12674 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12675 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12676 d1 0x18 24
12677 d2 0x80 128
12678 d3 0x33 51
12679 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12680 d5 0x22 34
12681 d6 0xe0 224
12682 d7 0x380035 3670069
12683 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12684 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12685 a2 0x100 256
12686 a3 0x322000 3284992
12687 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12688 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12689 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12690 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12691 ps 0x0 0
12692 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12693 fpcontrol 0x0 0
12694 fpstatus 0x0 0
12695 fpiaddr 0x0 0
12696 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
12697 p1 = (void *) 0x11
12698 p2 = (void *) 0x22
12699 p3 = (void *) 0x33
12700 p4 = (void *) 0x44
12701 p5 = (void *) 0x55
12702 p6 = (void *) 0x66
12703 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
12704
12705 (@value{GDBP})
12706 @end smallexample
12707
12708 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
12709 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
12710 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
12711 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
12712
12713 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
12714 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
12715 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
12716 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
12717 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
12718 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
12719 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
12720 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
12721 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
12722 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
12723
12724 @node save tracepoints
12725 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
12726 @kindex save tracepoints
12727 @kindex save-tracepoints
12728 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
12729
12730 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
12731 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
12732 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
12733 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
12734 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
12735 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
12736
12737 @node Tracepoint Variables
12738 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
12739 @cindex tracepoint variables
12740 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
12741
12742 @table @code
12743 @vindex $trace_frame
12744 @item (int) $trace_frame
12745 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
12746 snapshot is selected.
12747
12748 @vindex $tracepoint
12749 @item (int) $tracepoint
12750 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
12751
12752 @vindex $trace_line
12753 @item (int) $trace_line
12754 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
12755
12756 @vindex $trace_file
12757 @item (char []) $trace_file
12758 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
12759
12760 @vindex $trace_func
12761 @item (char []) $trace_func
12762 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
12763 @end table
12764
12765 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
12766 use @code{output} instead.
12767
12768 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
12769 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
12770 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
12771 which are managed by the target.
12772
12773 @smallexample
12774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12775
12776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
12777 > output $trace_file
12778 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
12779 > tfind
12780 > end
12781 @end smallexample
12782
12783 @node Trace Files
12784 @section Using Trace Files
12785 @cindex trace files
12786
12787 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
12788 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
12789 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
12790 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
12791 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
12792
12793 @table @code
12794
12795 @kindex tsave
12796 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
12797 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
12798 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
12799 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
12800 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
12801 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
12802 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
12803 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
12804 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
12805 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
12806 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
12807 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
12808 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
12809 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
12810 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
12811
12812 @kindex target tfile
12813 @kindex tfile
12814 @kindex target ctf
12815 @kindex ctf
12816 @item target tfile @var{filename}
12817 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
12818 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
12819 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
12820 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
12821 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
12822 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
12823 @var{filename} or @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
12824 the host.
12825
12826 @smallexample
12827 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
12828 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
12829 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
12830 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
12831 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
12832 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
12833 i = 0
12834 a = 0
12835 b = 1 '\001'
12836 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
12837 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
12838 (@value{GDBP}) p b
12839 $1 = 1
12840 @end smallexample
12841
12842 @end table
12843
12844 @node Overlays
12845 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
12846 @cindex overlays
12847
12848 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
12849 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
12850 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
12851 use overlays.
12852
12853 @menu
12854 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
12855 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
12856 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
12857 mapped by asking the inferior.
12858 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
12859 @end menu
12860
12861 @node How Overlays Work
12862 @section How Overlays Work
12863 @cindex mapped overlays
12864 @cindex unmapped overlays
12865 @cindex load address, overlay's
12866 @cindex mapped address
12867 @cindex overlay area
12868
12869 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
12870 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
12871 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
12872 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
12873 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
12874
12875 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
12876 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
12877 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
12878 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
12879 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
12880 largest overlay as well.
12881
12882 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
12883 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
12884 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
12885 there.
12886
12887 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
12888 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
12889 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
12890
12891 @smallexample
12892 @group
12893 Data Instruction Larger
12894 Address Space Address Space Address Space
12895 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
12896 | | | | | |
12897 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
12898 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
12899 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
12900 | and heap | | | | | |
12901 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
12902 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
12903 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
12904 | | | | | |
12905 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
12906 address | | | | | |
12907 | overlay | <-' | | |
12908 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
12909 | | <---. | | load address
12910 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
12911 | | | |
12912 +-----------+ | |
12913 +-----------+
12914 | |
12915 +-----------+
12916
12917 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
12918 @end group
12919 @end smallexample
12920
12921 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
12922 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
12923 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
12924 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
12925 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
12926 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
12927 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
12928 program and the overlay area.
12929
12930 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
12931 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
12932 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
12933 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
12934 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
12935 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
12936 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
12937
12938 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
12939 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
12940 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
12941
12942 @itemize @bullet
12943
12944 @item
12945 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
12946 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
12947 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
12948 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
12949
12950 @item
12951 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
12952 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
12953 your program's performance.
12954
12955 @item
12956 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
12957 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
12958 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
12959 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
12960 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
12961 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
12962 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
12963
12964 @item
12965 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
12966 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
12967 instruction and data spaces.
12968
12969 @end itemize
12970
12971 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
12972 improved in many ways:
12973
12974 @itemize @bullet
12975
12976 @item
12977 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
12978 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
12979 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
12980 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
12981 area in the usual way.
12982
12983 @item
12984 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
12985 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
12986
12987 @item
12988 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
12989 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
12990 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
12991 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
12992 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
12993 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
12994 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
12995
12996 @end itemize
12997
12998
12999 @node Overlay Commands
13000 @section Overlay Commands
13001
13002 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13003 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13004 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13005 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13006 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13007 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13008
13009 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13010 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13011
13012 @table @code
13013 @item overlay off
13014 @kindex overlay
13015 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13016 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13017 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13018 overlay support is disabled.
13019
13020 @item overlay manual
13021 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13022 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13023 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13024 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13025 commands described below.
13026
13027 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13028 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13029 @cindex map an overlay
13030 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13031 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13032 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13033 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13034 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13035 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13036
13037 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13038 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13039 @cindex unmap an overlay
13040 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13041 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13042 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13043 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13044
13045 @item overlay auto
13046 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13047 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13048 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13049 Overlay Debugging}.
13050
13051 @item overlay load-target
13052 @itemx overlay load
13053 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13054 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13055 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13056 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13057 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13058 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13059
13060 @item overlay list-overlays
13061 @itemx overlay list
13062 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13063 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13064 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13065
13066 @end table
13067
13068 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13069 of the function the address falls in:
13070
13071 @smallexample
13072 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13073 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13074 @end smallexample
13075 @noindent
13076 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13077 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13078 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13079 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13080
13081 @smallexample
13082 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13083 No sections are mapped.
13084 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13085 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13086 @end smallexample
13087 @noindent
13088 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13089 name normally:
13090
13091 @smallexample
13092 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13093 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13094 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13095 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13096 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13097 @end smallexample
13098
13099 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13100 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13101 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13102 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13103 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13104
13105 @itemize @bullet
13106 @item
13107 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13108 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13109 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13110 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13111 @item
13112 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13113 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13114 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13115 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13116 breakpoints properly.
13117 @end itemize
13118
13119
13120 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13121 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13122 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13123
13124 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13125 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13126 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13127 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13128 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13129 current state of the overlays.
13130
13131 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13132 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13133
13134 @table @asis
13135
13136 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13137 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13138
13139 @smallexample
13140 struct
13141 @{
13142 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13143 unsigned long vma;
13144
13145 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13146 unsigned long size;
13147
13148 /* The overlay's load address. */
13149 unsigned long lma;
13150
13151 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13152 zero otherwise. */
13153 unsigned long mapped;
13154 @}
13155 @end smallexample
13156
13157 @item @code{_novlys}:
13158 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13159 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13160
13161 @end table
13162
13163 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13164 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13165 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13166 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13167 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13168 currently mapped.
13169
13170 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13171 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13172 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13173 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13174 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13175 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13176 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13177 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13178 are not being executed.
13179
13180 @node Overlay Sample Program
13181 @section Overlay Sample Program
13182 @cindex overlay example program
13183
13184 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13185 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13186 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13187 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13188 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13189 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13190 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13191
13192 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13193 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13194 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13195 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13196
13197 @table @file
13198 @item overlays.c
13199 The main program file.
13200 @item ovlymgr.c
13201 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13202 @item foo.c
13203 @itemx bar.c
13204 @itemx baz.c
13205 @itemx grbx.c
13206 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13207 @item d10v.ld
13208 @itemx m32r.ld
13209 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13210 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13211 @end table
13212
13213 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13214 cross-compiler like this:
13215
13216 @smallexample
13217 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13218 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13219 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13220 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13221 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13222 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13223 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13224 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13225 @end smallexample
13226
13227 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13228 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13229 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13230
13231
13232 @node Languages
13233 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13234 @cindex languages
13235
13236 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13237 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13238 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13239 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13240 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13241 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13242
13243 @cindex working language
13244 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13245 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13246 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13247 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13248 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13249 language}.
13250
13251 @menu
13252 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13253 * Show:: Displaying the language
13254 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13255 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13256 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13257 @end menu
13258
13259 @node Setting
13260 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13261
13262 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13263 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13264 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13265 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13266 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13267 are printed, etc.
13268
13269 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13270 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13271 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13272 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13273 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13274 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13275 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13276 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13277 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13278 Displaying the Language}.
13279
13280 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13281 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13282 another language. In that case, make the
13283 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13284 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13285 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13286
13287 @menu
13288 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13289 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13290 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13291 @end menu
13292
13293 @node Filenames
13294 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13295
13296 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13297 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13298
13299 @table @file
13300 @item .ada
13301 @itemx .ads
13302 @itemx .adb
13303 @itemx .a
13304 Ada source file.
13305
13306 @item .c
13307 C source file
13308
13309 @item .C
13310 @itemx .cc
13311 @itemx .cp
13312 @itemx .cpp
13313 @itemx .cxx
13314 @itemx .c++
13315 C@t{++} source file
13316
13317 @item .d
13318 D source file
13319
13320 @item .m
13321 Objective-C source file
13322
13323 @item .f
13324 @itemx .F
13325 Fortran source file
13326
13327 @item .mod
13328 Modula-2 source file
13329
13330 @item .s
13331 @itemx .S
13332 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13333 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13334 @end table
13335
13336 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13337 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13338
13339 @node Manually
13340 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13341
13342 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13343 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13344 your program.
13345
13346 @kindex set language
13347 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13348 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13349 a language, such as
13350 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13351 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13352
13353 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13354 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13355 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13356 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13357 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13358 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13359 command such as:
13360
13361 @smallexample
13362 print a = b + c
13363 @end smallexample
13364
13365 @noindent
13366 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13367 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13368 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13369 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13370
13371 @node Automatically
13372 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13373
13374 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13375 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13376 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13377 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13378 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13379 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13380 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13381 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13382 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13383
13384 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13385 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13386 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13387 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13388 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13389
13390 @node Show
13391 @section Displaying the Language
13392
13393 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13394 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13395
13396 @table @code
13397 @item show language
13398 @anchor{show language}
13399 @kindex show language
13400 Display the current working language. This is the
13401 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13402 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13403
13404 @item info frame
13405 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13406 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13407 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13408 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13409 information listed here.
13410
13411 @item info source
13412 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13413 Display the source language of this source file.
13414 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13415 information listed here.
13416 @end table
13417
13418 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13419 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13420 with a language explicitly:
13421
13422 @table @code
13423 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13424 @kindex set extension-language
13425 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13426 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13427
13428 @item info extensions
13429 @kindex info extensions
13430 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13431 @end table
13432
13433 @node Checks
13434 @section Type and Range Checking
13435
13436 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13437 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13438 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13439 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13440 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13441 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13442 errors when your program is running.
13443
13444 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13445 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13446 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13447 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13448
13449 @menu
13450 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13451 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13452 @end menu
13453
13454 @cindex type checking
13455 @cindex checks, type
13456 @node Type Checking
13457 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13458
13459 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13460 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13461 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13462 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13463
13464 @smallexample
13465 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13466
13467 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13468 $1 = 2
13469 @exdent but
13470 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13471 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13472 @end smallexample
13473
13474 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13475 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13476
13477 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13478 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13479 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13480 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13481 expressions like the second example above.
13482
13483 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13484 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13485 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13486 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13487 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13488 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13489
13490 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13491
13492 @kindex set check type
13493 @kindex show check type
13494 @table @code
13495 @item set check type on
13496 @itemx set check type off
13497 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13498 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13499 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13500
13501 @item show check type
13502 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13503 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13504 @end table
13505
13506 @cindex range checking
13507 @cindex checks, range
13508 @node Range Checking
13509 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13510
13511 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13512 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13513 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13514 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13515 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13516
13517 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13518 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13519 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13520 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13521
13522 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13523 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13524 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13525 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13526 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13527 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13528
13529 @smallexample
13530 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13531 @end smallexample
13532
13533 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13534 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13535 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13536
13537 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13538
13539 @kindex set check range
13540 @kindex show check range
13541 @table @code
13542 @item set check range auto
13543 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13544 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13545 each language.
13546
13547 @item set check range on
13548 @itemx set check range off
13549 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13550 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13551 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13552 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13553
13554 @item set check range warn
13555 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13556 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13557 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13558 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13559 systems).
13560
13561 @item show range
13562 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13563 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13564 @end table
13565
13566 @node Supported Languages
13567 @section Supported Languages
13568
13569 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13570 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13571 @c This is false ...
13572 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13573 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13574 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13575 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13576 language.
13577
13578 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13579 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13580 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13581 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13582 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13583 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13584 language reference or tutorial.
13585
13586 @menu
13587 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13588 * D:: D
13589 * Go:: Go
13590 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13591 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13592 * Fortran:: Fortran
13593 * Pascal:: Pascal
13594 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13595 * Ada:: Ada
13596 @end menu
13597
13598 @node C
13599 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13600
13601 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13602 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13603
13604 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13605 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13606 together.
13607
13608 @cindex C@t{++}
13609 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13610 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13611 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13612 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13613 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13614 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13615 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13616
13617 @menu
13618 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13619 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13620 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13621 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13622 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13623 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13624 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13625 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13626 @end menu
13627
13628 @node C Operators
13629 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13630
13631 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13632
13633 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13634 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13635 often defined on groups of types.
13636
13637 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13638
13639 @itemize @bullet
13640
13641 @item
13642 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13643 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13644
13645 @item
13646 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13647 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13648
13649 @item
13650 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13651
13652 @item
13653 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13654
13655 @end itemize
13656
13657 @noindent
13658 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13659 in order of increasing precedence:
13660
13661 @table @code
13662 @item ,
13663 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13664 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13665 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13666
13667 @item =
13668 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13669 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13670
13671 @item @var{op}=
13672 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13673 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13674 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
13675 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13676 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13677
13678 @item ?:
13679 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13680 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
13681 integral type.
13682
13683 @item ||
13684 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13685
13686 @item &&
13687 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13688
13689 @item |
13690 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13691
13692 @item ^
13693 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13694
13695 @item &
13696 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13697
13698 @item ==@r{, }!=
13699 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
13700 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
13701
13702 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
13703 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
13704 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
13705 and non-zero for true.
13706
13707 @item <<@r{, }>>
13708 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
13709
13710 @item @@
13711 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13712
13713 @item +@r{, }-
13714 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
13715 pointer types.
13716
13717 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
13718 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
13719 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
13720 integral types.
13721
13722 @item ++@r{, }--
13723 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
13724 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
13725 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
13726 operation takes place.
13727
13728 @item *
13729 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
13730 @code{++}.
13731
13732 @item &
13733 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
13734
13735 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
13736 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
13737 to examine the address
13738 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
13739 stored.
13740
13741 @item -
13742 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
13743 precedence as @code{++}.
13744
13745 @item !
13746 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13747 @code{++}.
13748
13749 @item ~
13750 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13751 @code{++}.
13752
13753
13754 @item .@r{, }->
13755 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
13756 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
13757 pointer based on the stored type information.
13758 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
13759
13760 @item .*@r{, }->*
13761 Dereferences of pointers to members.
13762
13763 @item []
13764 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
13765 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13766
13767 @item ()
13768 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13769
13770 @item ::
13771 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
13772 and @code{class} types.
13773
13774 @item ::
13775 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
13776 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
13777 above.
13778 @end table
13779
13780 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
13781 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
13782 predefined meaning.
13783
13784 @node C Constants
13785 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
13786
13787 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
13788
13789 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
13790 following ways:
13791
13792 @itemize @bullet
13793 @item
13794 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
13795 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
13796 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
13797 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
13798 @code{long} value.
13799
13800 @item
13801 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
13802 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
13803 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
13804 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
13805 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
13806 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
13807 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
13808 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
13809 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
13810 constant.
13811
13812 @item
13813 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
13814 integral equivalents.
13815
13816 @item
13817 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
13818 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
13819 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
13820 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
13821 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
13822 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
13823 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
13824 @samp{\n} for newline.
13825
13826 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
13827 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
13828 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
13829 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13830
13831 @item
13832 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
13833 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
13834 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
13835 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
13836 characters.
13837
13838 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
13839 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
13840 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13841
13842 @item
13843 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
13844 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
13845
13846 @item
13847 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
13848 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
13849 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
13850 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
13851 @end itemize
13852
13853 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
13854 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
13855
13856 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
13857 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
13858
13859 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
13860 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
13861 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
13862 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
13863 @quotation
13864 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
13865 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
13866 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
13867 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
13868 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
13869 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
13870 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
13871 code. @xref{Compilation}.
13872 @end quotation
13873
13874 @enumerate
13875
13876 @cindex member functions
13877 @item
13878 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
13879
13880 @smallexample
13881 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
13882 @end smallexample
13883
13884 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
13885 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
13886 @item
13887 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
13888 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
13889 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
13890 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
13891 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
13892
13893 @cindex call overloaded functions
13894 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
13895 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
13896 @item
13897 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
13898 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
13899 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
13900 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
13901 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
13902 default arguments.
13903
13904 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
13905 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
13906 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
13907 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
13908 number of function arguments.
13909
13910 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
13911 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
13912 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
13913
13914 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
13915 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
13916 @smallexample
13917 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
13918 @end smallexample
13919
13920 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
13921 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
13922
13923 @cindex reference declarations
13924 @item
13925 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
13926 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
13927 dereferenced.
13928
13929 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
13930 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
13931 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
13932 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
13933 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
13934
13935 @item
13936 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
13937 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
13938 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
13939 necessary, for example in an expression like
13940 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
13941 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
13942 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
13943
13944 @item
13945 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
13946 specification.
13947 @end enumerate
13948
13949 @node C Defaults
13950 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
13951
13952 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
13953
13954 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
13955 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
13956 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
13957 selects the working language.
13958
13959 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
13960 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
13961 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
13962 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
13963 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
13964 for further details.
13965
13966 @node C Checks
13967 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
13968
13969 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
13970
13971 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
13972 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
13973 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
13974 constants to pointers.
13975
13976 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
13977 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
13978 that is not itself an array.
13979
13980 @node Debugging C
13981 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
13982
13983 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
13984 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
13985 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
13986 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
13987
13988 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
13989 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
13990 ,Expressions}.
13991
13992 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
13993 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
13994
13995 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
13996
13997 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
13998 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
13999
14000 @table @code
14001 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14002 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14003 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14004 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14005 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14006 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14007
14008 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14009 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14010 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14011 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14012 classes.
14013 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14014
14015 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14016 @item catch throw
14017 @itemx catch rethrow
14018 @itemx catch catch
14019 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14020 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14021
14022 @cindex inheritance
14023 @item ptype @var{typename}
14024 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14025 @var{typename}.
14026 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14027
14028 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14029 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14030 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14031 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14032 multiple inheritance is in use.
14033
14034 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14035 @item set print demangle
14036 @itemx show print demangle
14037 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14038 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14039 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14040 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14041 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14042
14043 @item set print object
14044 @itemx show print object
14045 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14046 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14047
14048 @item set print vtbl
14049 @itemx show print vtbl
14050 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14051 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14052 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14053 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14054
14055 @kindex set overload-resolution
14056 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14057 @item set overload-resolution on
14058 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14059 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14060 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14061 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14062 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14063 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14064
14065 @item set overload-resolution off
14066 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14067 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14068 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14069 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14070 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14071 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14072 argument types.
14073
14074 @kindex show overload-resolution
14075 @item show overload-resolution
14076 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14077
14078 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14079 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14080 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14081 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14082 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14083 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14084 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14085 @end table
14086
14087 @node Decimal Floating Point
14088 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14089 @cindex decimal floating point format
14090
14091 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14092 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14093 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14094 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14095
14096 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14097 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14098 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14099 configured target.
14100
14101 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14102 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14103 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14104
14105 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14106 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14107 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14108
14109 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14110 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14111 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14112
14113 @node D
14114 @subsection D
14115
14116 @cindex D
14117 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14118 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14119 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14120
14121 @node Go
14122 @subsection Go
14123
14124 @cindex Go (programming language)
14125 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14126 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14127
14128 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14129
14130 @table @code
14131 @cindex current Go package
14132 @item The current Go package
14133 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14134 specifying global variables and functions.
14135
14136 For example, given the program:
14137
14138 @example
14139 package main
14140 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14141 func main () @{
14142 // ...
14143 @}
14144 @end example
14145
14146 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14147
14148 @example
14149 (gdb) p myglob
14150 (gdb) p main.myglob
14151 @end example
14152
14153 @cindex builtin Go types
14154 @item Builtin Go types
14155 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14156 as a string.
14157
14158 @cindex builtin Go functions
14159 @item Builtin Go functions
14160 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14161 function and handles it internally.
14162
14163 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14164 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14165 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14166 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14167 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14168 @end table
14169
14170 @node Objective-C
14171 @subsection Objective-C
14172
14173 @cindex Objective-C
14174 This section provides information about some commands and command
14175 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14176 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14177 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14178
14179 @menu
14180 * Method Names in Commands::
14181 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14182 @end menu
14183
14184 @node Method Names in Commands
14185 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14186
14187 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14188 names as line specifications:
14189
14190 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14191 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14192 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14193 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14194 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14195 @itemize
14196 @item @code{clear}
14197 @item @code{break}
14198 @item @code{info line}
14199 @item @code{jump}
14200 @item @code{list}
14201 @end itemize
14202
14203 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14204
14205 @smallexample
14206 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14207 @end smallexample
14208
14209 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14210 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14211 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14212 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14213 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14214 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14215 debugged, enter:
14216
14217 @smallexample
14218 break -[Fruit create]
14219 @end smallexample
14220
14221 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14222 enter:
14223
14224 @smallexample
14225 list +[NSText initialize]
14226 @end smallexample
14227
14228 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14229 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14230 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14231 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14232
14233 @smallexample
14234 break create
14235 @end smallexample
14236
14237 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14238 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14239 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14240 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14241 none apply.
14242
14243 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14244 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14245
14246 @smallexample
14247 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14248 @end smallexample
14249
14250 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14251 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14252 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14253 @kindex print-object
14254 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14255
14256 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14257
14258 @smallexample
14259 print -[@var{object} hash]
14260 @end smallexample
14261
14262 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14263 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14264 @noindent
14265 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14266 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14267 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14268 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14269 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14270 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14271
14272 @node OpenCL C
14273 @subsection OpenCL C
14274
14275 @cindex OpenCL C
14276 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14277
14278 @menu
14279 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14280 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14281 * OpenCL C Operators::
14282 @end menu
14283
14284 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14285 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14286
14287 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14288 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14289 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14290 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14291 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14292
14293 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14294 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14295
14296 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14297 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14298 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14299 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14300
14301 @node OpenCL C Operators
14302 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14303
14304 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14305 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14306 vector data types.
14307
14308 @node Fortran
14309 @subsection Fortran
14310 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14311
14312 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14313 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14314
14315 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14316 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14317 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14318 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14319 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14320 underscore.
14321
14322 @menu
14323 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14324 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14325 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14326 @end menu
14327
14328 @node Fortran Operators
14329 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14330
14331 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14332
14333 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14334 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14335 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14336
14337 @table @code
14338 @item **
14339 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14340 of the second one.
14341
14342 @item :
14343 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14344 represent a section of array.
14345
14346 @item %
14347 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14348 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14349 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14350 union type.
14351 @end table
14352
14353 @node Fortran Defaults
14354 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14355
14356 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14357
14358 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14359 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14360 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14361 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14362
14363 @node Special Fortran Commands
14364 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14365
14366 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14367
14368 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14369 such as displaying common blocks.
14370
14371 @table @code
14372 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14373 @kindex info common
14374 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14375 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14376 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14377 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14378 printed.
14379 @end table
14380
14381 @node Pascal
14382 @subsection Pascal
14383
14384 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14385 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14386 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14387 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14388 syntax.
14389
14390 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14391 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14392 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14393
14394 @node Modula-2
14395 @subsection Modula-2
14396
14397 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14398
14399 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14400 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14401 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14402 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14403 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14404 table.
14405
14406 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14407 @menu
14408 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14409 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14410 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14411 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14412 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14413 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14414 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14415 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14416 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14417 @end menu
14418
14419 @node M2 Operators
14420 @subsubsection Operators
14421 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14422
14423 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14424 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14425 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14426 following definitions hold:
14427
14428 @itemize @bullet
14429
14430 @item
14431 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14432 their subranges.
14433
14434 @item
14435 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14436
14437 @item
14438 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14439
14440 @item
14441 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14442 @var{type}}.
14443
14444 @item
14445 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14446
14447 @item
14448 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14449
14450 @item
14451 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14452 @end itemize
14453
14454 @noindent
14455 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14456 increasing precedence:
14457
14458 @table @code
14459 @item ,
14460 Function argument or array index separator.
14461
14462 @item :=
14463 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14464 @var{value}.
14465
14466 @item <@r{, }>
14467 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14468 types.
14469
14470 @item <=@r{, }>=
14471 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14472 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14473 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14474
14475 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14476 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14477 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14478 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14479 comment character.
14480
14481 @item IN
14482 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14483 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14484
14485 @item OR
14486 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14487
14488 @item AND@r{, }&
14489 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14490
14491 @item @@
14492 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14493
14494 @item +@r{, }-
14495 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14496 and difference on set types.
14497
14498 @item *
14499 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14500 on set types.
14501
14502 @item /
14503 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14504 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14505
14506 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14507 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14508 precedence as @code{*}.
14509
14510 @item -
14511 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14512
14513 @item ^
14514 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14515
14516 @item NOT
14517 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14518 @code{^}.
14519
14520 @item .
14521 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14522 precedence as @code{^}.
14523
14524 @item []
14525 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14526
14527 @item ()
14528 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14529 as @code{^}.
14530
14531 @item ::@r{, }.
14532 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14533 @end table
14534
14535 @quotation
14536 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14537 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14538 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14539 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14540 @end quotation
14541
14542
14543 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14544 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14545 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14546
14547 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14548 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14549
14550 @table @var
14551
14552 @item a
14553 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14554
14555 @item c
14556 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14557
14558 @item i
14559 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14560
14561 @item m
14562 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14563 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14564 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14565
14566 @item n
14567 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14568
14569 @item r
14570 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14571
14572 @item t
14573 represents a type.
14574
14575 @item v
14576 represents a variable.
14577
14578 @item x
14579 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14580 explanation of the function for details.
14581 @end table
14582
14583 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14584
14585 @table @code
14586 @item ABS(@var{n})
14587 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14588
14589 @item CAP(@var{c})
14590 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14591 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14592
14593 @item CHR(@var{i})
14594 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14595
14596 @item DEC(@var{v})
14597 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14598
14599 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14600 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14601 new value.
14602
14603 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14604 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14605 set.
14606
14607 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14608 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14609
14610 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14611 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14612
14613 @item INC(@var{v})
14614 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14615
14616 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14617 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14618 new value.
14619
14620 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14621 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14622 there. Returns the new set.
14623
14624 @item MAX(@var{t})
14625 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14626
14627 @item MIN(@var{t})
14628 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14629
14630 @item ODD(@var{i})
14631 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14632
14633 @item ORD(@var{x})
14634 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14635 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
14636 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
14637 integral, character and enumerated types.
14638
14639 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14640 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
14641
14642 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14643 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14644
14645 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14646 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
14647
14648 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14649 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14650 @end table
14651
14652 @quotation
14653 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14654 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14655 an error.
14656 @end quotation
14657
14658 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14659 @node M2 Constants
14660 @subsubsection Constants
14661
14662 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14663 ways:
14664
14665 @itemize @bullet
14666
14667 @item
14668 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14669 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14670 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14671 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14672
14673 @item
14674 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14675 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14676 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14677 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14678 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14679 digits.
14680
14681 @item
14682 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14683 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14684 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14685 followed by a @samp{C}.
14686
14687 @item
14688 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
14689 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
14690 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
14691 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
14692 sequences.
14693
14694 @item
14695 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
14696
14697 @item
14698 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
14699 @code{FALSE}.
14700
14701 @item
14702 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
14703
14704 @item
14705 Set constants are not yet supported.
14706 @end itemize
14707
14708 @node M2 Types
14709 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
14710 @cindex Modula-2 types
14711
14712 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
14713 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
14714 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
14715 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
14716 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
14717 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
14718
14719 The first example contains the following section of code:
14720
14721 @smallexample
14722 VAR
14723 s: SET OF CHAR ;
14724 r: [20..40] ;
14725 @end smallexample
14726
14727 @noindent
14728 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
14729 @code{r} and @code{s}.
14730
14731 @smallexample
14732 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14733 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
14734 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14735 SET OF CHAR
14736 (@value{GDBP}) print r
14737 21
14738 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
14739 [20..40]
14740 @end smallexample
14741
14742 @noindent
14743 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
14744
14745 @smallexample
14746 VAR
14747 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
14748 @end smallexample
14749
14750 @noindent
14751 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
14752
14753 @smallexample
14754 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14755 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
14756 @end smallexample
14757
14758 @noindent
14759 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
14760 expressions using the debugger.
14761
14762 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
14763 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
14764
14765 @smallexample
14766 VAR
14767 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
14768 @end smallexample
14769
14770 @smallexample
14771 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14772 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
14773 @end smallexample
14774
14775 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
14776 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
14777 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
14778 above.
14779
14780 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
14781
14782 @smallexample
14783 TYPE
14784 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
14785 t = [blue..yellow] ;
14786 VAR
14787 s: t ;
14788 BEGIN
14789 s := blue ;
14790 @end smallexample
14791
14792 @noindent
14793 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
14794 and value of a variable.
14795
14796 @smallexample
14797 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14798 $1 = blue
14799 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
14800 type = [blue..yellow]
14801 @end smallexample
14802
14803 @noindent
14804 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
14805 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
14806 their @code{C} counterparts.
14807
14808 @smallexample
14809 VAR
14810 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14811 BEGIN
14812 s[1] := 1 ;
14813 @end smallexample
14814
14815 @smallexample
14816 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14817 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
14818 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14819 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14820 @end smallexample
14821
14822 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
14823 pointer types as shown in this example:
14824
14825 @smallexample
14826 VAR
14827 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14828 BEGIN
14829 NEW(s) ;
14830 s^[1] := 1 ;
14831 @end smallexample
14832
14833 @noindent
14834 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
14835
14836 @smallexample
14837 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14838 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14839 @end smallexample
14840
14841 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
14842 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
14843 types:
14844
14845 @smallexample
14846 TYPE
14847 foo = RECORD
14848 f1: CARDINAL ;
14849 f2: CHAR ;
14850 f3: myarray ;
14851 END ;
14852
14853 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
14854 myrange = [-2..2] ;
14855 VAR
14856 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
14857 @end smallexample
14858
14859 @noindent
14860 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
14861 below.
14862
14863 @smallexample
14864 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14865 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
14866 f1 : CARDINAL;
14867 f2 : CHAR;
14868 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
14869 END
14870 @end smallexample
14871
14872 @node M2 Defaults
14873 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
14874 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
14875
14876 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
14877 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
14878 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14879 selected the working language.
14880
14881 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
14882 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
14883 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
14884 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
14885
14886 @node Deviations
14887 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
14888 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
14889
14890 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
14891 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
14892
14893 @itemize @bullet
14894 @item
14895 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
14896 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
14897 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
14898 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
14899 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
14900 returned a pointer.)
14901
14902 @item
14903 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
14904 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
14905 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
14906 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
14907
14908 @item
14909 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
14910 argument.
14911
14912 @item
14913 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
14914 @end itemize
14915
14916 @node M2 Checks
14917 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
14918 @cindex Modula-2 checks
14919
14920 @quotation
14921 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
14922 range checking.
14923 @end quotation
14924 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
14925
14926 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
14927
14928 @itemize @bullet
14929 @item
14930 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
14931 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
14932
14933 @item
14934 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
14935 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
14936 @end itemize
14937
14938 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
14939 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
14940
14941 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
14942 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
14943
14944 @node M2 Scope
14945 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14946 @cindex scope
14947 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
14948 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
14949 @ifinfo
14950 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
14951 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
14952 @end ifinfo
14953 @ifnotinfo
14954 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
14955 @end ifnotinfo
14956
14957 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
14958 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
14959 similar syntax:
14960
14961 @smallexample
14962
14963 @var{module} . @var{id}
14964 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
14965 @end smallexample
14966
14967 @noindent
14968 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
14969 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
14970 identifier within your program, except another module.
14971
14972 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
14973 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
14974 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
14975 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
14976
14977 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
14978 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
14979 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
14980 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
14981 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
14982 @var{module}.
14983
14984 @node GDB/M2
14985 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14986
14987 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
14988 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
14989 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
14990 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
14991 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
14992 analogue in Modula-2.
14993
14994 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
14995 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
14996 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
14997 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
14998 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
14999 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15000
15001 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15002 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15003 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15004
15005 @node Ada
15006 @subsection Ada
15007 @cindex Ada
15008
15009 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15010 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15011 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15012 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15013 to be difficult.
15014
15015
15016 @cindex expressions in Ada
15017 @menu
15018 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15019 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15020 in @value{GDBN}.
15021 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15022 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15023 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15024 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15025 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15026 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15027 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15028 Profile
15029 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15030 @end menu
15031
15032 @node Ada Mode Intro
15033 @subsubsection Introduction
15034 @cindex Ada mode, general
15035
15036 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15037 syntax, with some extensions.
15038 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15039
15040 @itemize @bullet
15041 @item
15042 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15043 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15044 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15045 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15046
15047 @item
15048 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15049 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15050
15051 @item
15052 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15053 @end itemize
15054
15055 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15056 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15057 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15058 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15059 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15060
15061 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15062 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15063 was translated from an Ada source file.
15064
15065 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15066 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15067 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15068 middle (to allow based literals).
15069
15070 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15071 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15072 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15073 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15074 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15075 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15076
15077 @node Omissions from Ada
15078 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15079 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15080
15081 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15082
15083 @itemize @bullet
15084 @item
15085 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15086
15087 @itemize @minus
15088 @item
15089 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15090 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15091
15092 @item
15093 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15094
15095 @item
15096 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15097
15098 @item
15099 @t{'Tag}.
15100
15101 @item
15102 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15103 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15104
15105 @item
15106 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15107 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15108
15109 @item
15110 @t{'Address}.
15111 @end itemize
15112
15113 @item
15114 The names in
15115 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15116 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15117 not currently available.
15118
15119 @item
15120 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15121 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15122 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15123 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15124 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15125 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15126 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15127 indeterminate values.
15128
15129 @item
15130 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15131 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15132 are not implemented.
15133
15134 @item
15135 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15136 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15137 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15138 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15139 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15140
15141 @smallexample
15142 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15143 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15144 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15145 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15146 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15147 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15148 @end smallexample
15149
15150 Changing a
15151 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15152 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15153 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15154 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15155 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15156 declared to have a type such as:
15157
15158 @smallexample
15159 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15160 Id : Integer;
15161 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15162 end record;
15163 @end smallexample
15164
15165 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15166 assignments:
15167
15168 @smallexample
15169 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15170 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15171 @end smallexample
15172
15173 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15174 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15175 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15176 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15177 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15178 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15179 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15180 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15181
15182 @item
15183 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15184
15185 @item
15186 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15187 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15188 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15189 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15190 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15191 the proper resolution.
15192
15193 @item
15194 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15195
15196 @item
15197 Entry calls are not implemented.
15198
15199 @item
15200 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15201 formats are not supported.
15202
15203 @item
15204 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15205
15206 @item
15207 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15208 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15209 context.
15210 Should your program
15211 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15212 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15213 @end itemize
15214
15215 @node Additions to Ada
15216 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15217 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15218
15219 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15220 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15221
15222 @itemize @bullet
15223 @item
15224 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15225 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15226 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15227 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15228 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15229 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15230 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15231 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15232
15233 @item
15234 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15235 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15236 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15237
15238 @item
15239 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15240 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15241
15242 @item
15243 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15244 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15245 @end itemize
15246
15247 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15248 additions specific to Ada:
15249
15250 @itemize @bullet
15251 @item
15252 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15253 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15254
15255 @smallexample
15256 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15257 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15258 @end smallexample
15259
15260 @item
15261 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15262 the value of its right-hand operand.
15263 This allows, for example,
15264 complex conditional breaks:
15265
15266 @smallexample
15267 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15268 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15269 @end smallexample
15270
15271 @item
15272 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15273 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15274 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15275 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15276 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15277 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15278 in strings. For example,
15279 @smallexample
15280 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15281 @end smallexample
15282 @noindent
15283 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15284 after each period.
15285
15286 @item
15287 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15288 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15289 to write
15290
15291 @smallexample
15292 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15293 @end smallexample
15294
15295 @item
15296 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15297 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15298 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15299 of 3 might print as
15300
15301 @smallexample
15302 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15303 @end smallexample
15304
15305 @noindent
15306 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15307 clause.
15308
15309 @item
15310 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15311 multi-character subsequence of
15312 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15313 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15314 in place of @t{a'length}.
15315
15316 @item
15317 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15318 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15319 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15320 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15321 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15322 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15323 For example,
15324 @smallexample
15325 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15326 @end smallexample
15327
15328 @item
15329 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15330 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15331 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15332 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15333 object.
15334
15335 @end itemize
15336
15337 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15338 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15339
15340 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15341 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15342 before reaching the main procedure.
15343 As defined in the Ada Reference
15344 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15345 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15346 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15347 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15348
15349 @node Ada Exceptions
15350 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15351
15352 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15353
15354 @table @code
15355 @kindex info exceptions
15356 @item info exceptions
15357 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15358 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15359 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15360 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15361 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15362 @end table
15363
15364 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15365 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15366 argument.
15367
15368 @smallexample
15369 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15370 All defined Ada exceptions:
15371 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15372 program_error: 0x613d20
15373 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15374 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15375 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15376 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15377 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15378 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15379 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15380 @end smallexample
15381
15382 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15383 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15384
15385 @node Ada Tasks
15386 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15387 @cindex Ada, tasking
15388
15389 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15390 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15391
15392 @table @code
15393 @kindex info tasks
15394 @item info tasks
15395 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15396
15397
15398 @smallexample
15399 @iftex
15400 @leftskip=0.5cm
15401 @end iftex
15402 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15403 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15404 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15405 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15406 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15407 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15408
15409 @end smallexample
15410
15411 @noindent
15412 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15413 task currently being inspected.
15414
15415 @table @asis
15416 @item ID
15417 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15418
15419 @item TID
15420 The Ada task ID.
15421
15422 @item P-ID
15423 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15424
15425 @item Pri
15426 The base priority of the task.
15427
15428 @item State
15429 Current state of the task.
15430
15431 @table @code
15432 @item Unactivated
15433 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15434 executing.
15435
15436 @item Runnable
15437 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15438 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15439
15440 @item Terminated
15441 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15442 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15443 terminated themselves.
15444
15445 @item Child Activation Wait
15446 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15447
15448 @item Accept Statement
15449 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15450
15451 @item Waiting on entry call
15452 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15453
15454 @item Async Select Wait
15455 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15456 select statement.
15457
15458 @item Delay Sleep
15459 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15460 alternative open.
15461
15462 @item Child Termination Wait
15463 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15464 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15465 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15466
15467 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15468 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15469 finish terminating.
15470
15471 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15472 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15473 @end table
15474
15475 @item Name
15476 Name of the task in the program.
15477
15478 @end table
15479
15480 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15481 @item info task @var{taskno}
15482 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15483 the following example:
15484 @smallexample
15485 @iftex
15486 @leftskip=0.5cm
15487 @end iftex
15488 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15489 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15490 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15491 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15492 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15493 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15494 Name: task_1
15495 Thread: 0x807f378
15496 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15497 Base Priority: 15
15498 State: Runnable
15499 @end smallexample
15500
15501 @item task
15502 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15503 @cindex current Ada task ID
15504 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15505
15506 @smallexample
15507 @iftex
15508 @leftskip=0.5cm
15509 @end iftex
15510 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15511 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15512 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15513 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15514 (@value{GDBP}) task
15515 [Current task is 2]
15516 @end smallexample
15517
15518 @item task @var{taskno}
15519 @cindex Ada task switching
15520 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15521 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15522 from the current task to the given task.
15523
15524 @smallexample
15525 @iftex
15526 @leftskip=0.5cm
15527 @end iftex
15528 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15529 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15530 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15531 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15532 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15533 [Switching to task 1]
15534 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15535 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15536 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15537 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15538 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15539 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15540 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15541 @end smallexample
15542
15543 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15544 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15545 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15546 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15547 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15548 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15549 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
15550 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
15551 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15552
15553 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15554 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15555 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
15556 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15557 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15558
15559 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15560 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15561 program.
15562
15563 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15564 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15565 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15566
15567 For example,
15568
15569 @smallexample
15570 @iftex
15571 @leftskip=0.5cm
15572 @end iftex
15573 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15574 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15575 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15576 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15577 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15578 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15579 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15580 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15581 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15582 Continuing.
15583 task # 1 running
15584 task # 2 running
15585
15586 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15587 15 flush;
15588 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15589 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15590 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15591 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15592 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15593 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15594 @end smallexample
15595 @end table
15596
15597 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15598 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15599 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15600
15601 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15602 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15603 the platform being used.
15604 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15605 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
15606 as usual.
15607
15608 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
15609 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15610 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15611 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15612 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15613 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15614
15615 @node Ravenscar Profile
15616 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15617 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15618
15619 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15620 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15621 requirements.
15622
15623 @table @code
15624 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15625 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15626 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15627 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15628 Profile. This is the default.
15629
15630 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15631 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15632 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15633 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15634 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15635 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15636 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15637
15638 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15639 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15640 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15641 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15642
15643 @end table
15644
15645 @node Ada Glitches
15646 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15647 @cindex Ada, problems
15648
15649 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15650 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15651 @value{GDBN},
15652 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15653 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15654
15655 @itemize @bullet
15656 @item
15657 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15658 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15659
15660 @item
15661 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15662 argument lists are treated as positional).
15663
15664 @item
15665 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15666
15667 @item
15668 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15669 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15670 the host machine.
15671
15672 @item
15673 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15674 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15675 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15676 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15677 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15678 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15679 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15680 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15681 you can usually resolve the confusion
15682 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15683 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15684 @end itemize
15685
15686 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15687 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15688 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15689 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
15690 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
15691 enabled.
15692
15693 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15694 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15695 @table @code
15696
15697 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
15698 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
15699 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
15700 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
15701 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
15702 This is the default.
15703
15704 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
15705 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
15706 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
15707 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
15708 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
15709 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
15710 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
15711
15712 @end table
15713
15714 @node Unsupported Languages
15715 @section Unsupported Languages
15716
15717 @cindex unsupported languages
15718 @cindex minimal language
15719 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
15720 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
15721 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
15722 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
15723 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
15724 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
15725
15726 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
15727 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
15728 language.
15729
15730 @node Symbols
15731 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
15732
15733 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
15734 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
15735 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
15736 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
15737 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
15738 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
15739 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15740
15741 @cindex symbol names
15742 @cindex names of symbols
15743 @cindex quoting names
15744 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
15745 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
15746 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
15747 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
15748 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
15749 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
15750 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
15751 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
15752
15753 @smallexample
15754 p 'foo.c'::x
15755 @end smallexample
15756
15757 @noindent
15758 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
15759
15760 @table @code
15761 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
15762 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
15763 @kindex set case-sensitive
15764 @item set case-sensitive on
15765 @itemx set case-sensitive off
15766 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
15767 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
15768 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
15769 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
15770 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
15771 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
15772 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
15773 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
15774 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
15775 case-insensitive matches.
15776
15777 @kindex show case-sensitive
15778 @item show case-sensitive
15779 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
15780 lookups.
15781
15782 @kindex set print type methods
15783 @item set print type methods
15784 @itemx set print type methods on
15785 @itemx set print type methods off
15786 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
15787 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15788 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15789 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15790 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
15791 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
15792
15793 @kindex show print type methods
15794 @item show print type methods
15795 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
15796 classes.
15797
15798 @kindex set print type typedefs
15799 @item set print type typedefs
15800 @itemx set print type typedefs on
15801 @itemx set print type typedefs off
15802
15803 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
15804 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15805 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15806 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15807 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
15808 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
15809 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
15810 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
15811 types.
15812
15813 @kindex show print type typedefs
15814 @item show print type typedefs
15815 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
15816 printing classes.
15817
15818 @kindex info address
15819 @cindex address of a symbol
15820 @item info address @var{symbol}
15821 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
15822 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
15823 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
15824 is always stored.
15825
15826 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
15827 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
15828 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
15829
15830 @kindex info symbol
15831 @cindex symbol from address
15832 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
15833 @item info symbol @var{addr}
15834 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
15835 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
15836 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
15837
15838 @smallexample
15839 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
15840 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
15841 @end smallexample
15842
15843 @noindent
15844 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
15845 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
15846
15847 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
15848 library containing the symbol is also printed:
15849
15850 @smallexample
15851 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
15852 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
15853 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
15854 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
15855 @end smallexample
15856
15857 @kindex whatis
15858 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15859 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
15860 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
15861 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
15862
15863 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
15864 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
15865 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
15866
15867 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
15868 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
15869 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
15870 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
15871 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
15872 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
15873 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
15874 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
15875 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
15876
15877 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
15878 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
15879 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
15880 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
15881 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
15882 unroll it.
15883
15884 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
15885 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
15886 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
15887
15888 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
15889 Available flags are:
15890
15891 @table @code
15892 @item r
15893 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
15894 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
15895 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
15896
15897 @item m
15898 Do not print methods defined in the class.
15899
15900 @item M
15901 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15902 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
15903
15904 @item t
15905 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
15906 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
15907 names are substituted when printing other types.
15908
15909 @item T
15910 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
15911 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
15912 @end table
15913
15914 @kindex ptype
15915 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15916 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
15917 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
15918 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
15919
15920 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
15921 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
15922 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
15923 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
15924 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
15925 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
15926 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
15927 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
15928
15929 For example, for this variable declaration:
15930
15931 @smallexample
15932 typedef double real_t;
15933 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
15934 typedef struct complex complex_t;
15935 complex_t var;
15936 real_t *real_pointer_var;
15937 @end smallexample
15938
15939 @noindent
15940 the two commands give this output:
15941
15942 @smallexample
15943 @group
15944 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
15945 type = complex_t
15946 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
15947 type = struct complex @{
15948 real_t real;
15949 double imag;
15950 @}
15951 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
15952 type = struct complex
15953 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
15954 type = struct complex
15955 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
15956 type = struct complex @{
15957 real_t real;
15958 double imag;
15959 @}
15960 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
15961 type = real_t *
15962 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
15963 type = double *
15964 @end group
15965 @end smallexample
15966
15967 @noindent
15968 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
15969 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
15970
15971 @cindex incomplete type
15972 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
15973 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
15974 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
15975 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
15976 given these declarations:
15977
15978 @smallexample
15979 struct foo;
15980 struct foo *fooptr;
15981 @end smallexample
15982
15983 @noindent
15984 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
15985
15986 @smallexample
15987 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
15988 $1 = <incomplete type>
15989 @end smallexample
15990
15991 @noindent
15992 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
15993 completely specified.
15994
15995 @kindex info types
15996 @item info types @var{regexp}
15997 @itemx info types
15998 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
15999 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16000 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16001 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16002 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16003 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16004 name is @code{value}.
16005
16006 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16007 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16008 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16009
16010 @kindex info type-printers
16011 @item info type-printers
16012 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16013 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16014 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16015 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16016 type printers.
16017
16018 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16019
16020 @kindex enable type-printer
16021 @kindex disable type-printer
16022 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16023 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16024 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16025
16026 @kindex info scope
16027 @cindex local variables
16028 @item info scope @var{location}
16029 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16030 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16031 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16032 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16033 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16034
16035 @smallexample
16036 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16037 Scope for command_line_handler:
16038 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16039 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16040 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16041 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16042 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16043 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16044 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16045 @end smallexample
16046
16047 @noindent
16048 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16049 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16050 collect}.
16051
16052 @kindex info source
16053 @item info source
16054 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16055 the function containing the current point of execution:
16056 @itemize @bullet
16057 @item
16058 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16059 @item
16060 the directory it was compiled in,
16061 @item
16062 its length, in lines,
16063 @item
16064 which programming language it is written in,
16065 @item
16066 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16067 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16068 @item
16069 whether the debugging information includes information about
16070 preprocessor macros.
16071 @end itemize
16072
16073
16074 @kindex info sources
16075 @item info sources
16076 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16077 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16078 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16079
16080 @kindex info functions
16081 @item info functions
16082 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16083
16084 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16085 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16086 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16087 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16088 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16089 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16090 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16091 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16092
16093 @kindex info variables
16094 @item info variables
16095 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16096 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16097
16098 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16099 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16100 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16101 @var{regexp}.
16102
16103 @kindex info classes
16104 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16105 @item info classes
16106 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16107 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16108 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16109 expression.
16110
16111 @kindex info selectors
16112 @item info selectors
16113 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16114 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16115 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16116 expression.
16117
16118 @ignore
16119 This was never implemented.
16120 @kindex info methods
16121 @item info methods
16122 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16123 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16124 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16125 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16126 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16127 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16128 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16129 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16130 @end ignore
16131
16132 @cindex opaque data types
16133 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16134 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16135 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16136 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16137 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16138 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16139 another source file. The default is on.
16140
16141 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16142 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16143
16144 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16145 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16146 is printed as follows:
16147 @smallexample
16148 @{<no data fields>@}
16149 @end smallexample
16150
16151 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16152 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16153 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16154
16155 @kindex maint print symbols
16156 @cindex symbol dump
16157 @kindex maint print psymbols
16158 @cindex partial symbol dump
16159 @kindex maint print msymbols
16160 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16161 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16162 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16163 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16164 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16165 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16166 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16167 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16168 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16169 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16170 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16171 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16172 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16173 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16174 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16175 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16176 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16177 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16178
16179 @kindex maint info symtabs
16180 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16181 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16182 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16183 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16184 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16185 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16186 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16187
16188 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16189 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16190 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16191 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16192 structure in more detail. For example:
16193
16194 @smallexample
16195 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16196 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16197 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16198 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16199 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16200 readin no
16201 fullname (null)
16202 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16203 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16204 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16205 dependencies (none)
16206 @}
16207 @}
16208 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16209 (@value{GDBP})
16210 @end smallexample
16211 @noindent
16212 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16213 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16214 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16215 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16216 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16217
16218 @smallexample
16219 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16220 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16221 line 1574.
16222 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16223 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16224 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16225 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16226 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16227 dirname (null)
16228 fullname (null)
16229 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16230 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16231 debugformat DWARF 2
16232 @}
16233 @}
16234 (@value{GDBP})
16235 @end smallexample
16236 @end table
16237
16238
16239 @node Altering
16240 @chapter Altering Execution
16241
16242 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16243 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16244 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16245 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16246 program.
16247
16248 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16249 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16250 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16251
16252 @menu
16253 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16254 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16255 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16256 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16257 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16258 * Patching:: Patching your program
16259 @end menu
16260
16261 @node Assignment
16262 @section Assignment to Variables
16263
16264 @cindex assignment
16265 @cindex setting variables
16266 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16267 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16268
16269 @smallexample
16270 print x=4
16271 @end smallexample
16272
16273 @noindent
16274 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16275 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16276 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16277 information on operators in supported languages.
16278
16279 @kindex set variable
16280 @cindex variables, setting
16281 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16282 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16283 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16284 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16285 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16286
16287 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16288 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16289 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16290 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16291 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16292 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16293 command @code{set width}:
16294
16295 @smallexample
16296 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16297 type = double
16298 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16299 $4 = 13
16300 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16301 Invalid syntax in expression.
16302 @end smallexample
16303
16304 @noindent
16305 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16306 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16307
16308 @smallexample
16309 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16310 @end smallexample
16311
16312 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16313 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16314 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16315 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16316 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16317 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16318
16319 @smallexample
16320 @group
16321 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16322 type = double
16323 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16324 $1 = 1
16325 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16326 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16327 $2 = 1
16328 (@value{GDBP}) r
16329 The program being debugged has been started already.
16330 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16331 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16332 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16333 Invalid bfd target.
16334 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16335 The current BFD target is "=4".
16336 @end group
16337 @end smallexample
16338
16339 @noindent
16340 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16341 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16342 @code{g}, use
16343
16344 @smallexample
16345 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16346 @end smallexample
16347
16348 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16349 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16350 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16351 same length or shorter.
16352 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16353 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16354
16355 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16356 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16357 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16358 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16359 and representation in memory), and
16360
16361 @smallexample
16362 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16363 @end smallexample
16364
16365 @noindent
16366 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16367
16368 @node Jumping
16369 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16370
16371 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16372 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16373 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16374
16375 @table @code
16376 @kindex jump
16377 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16378 @item jump @var{linespec}
16379 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16380 @itemx jump @var{location}
16381 @itemx j @var{location}
16382 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16383 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16384 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16385 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16386 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16387 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16388
16389 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16390 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16391 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16392 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16393 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16394 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16395 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16396 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16397 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16398 @end table
16399
16400 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16401 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16402 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16403 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16404 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16405 example,
16406
16407 @smallexample
16408 set $pc = 0x485
16409 @end smallexample
16410
16411 @noindent
16412 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16413 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16414 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16415
16416 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16417 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16418 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16419 detail.
16420
16421 @c @group
16422 @node Signaling
16423 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16424 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16425
16426 @table @code
16427 @kindex signal
16428 @item signal @var{signal}
16429 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
16430 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16431 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16432 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16433
16434 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16435 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16436 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16437 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16438 signal.
16439
16440 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16441 after executing the command.
16442 @end table
16443 @c @end group
16444
16445 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16446 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16447 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16448 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16449 passes the signal directly to your program.
16450
16451
16452 @node Returning
16453 @section Returning from a Function
16454
16455 @table @code
16456 @cindex returning from a function
16457 @kindex return
16458 @item return
16459 @itemx return @var{expression}
16460 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16461 command. If you give an
16462 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16463 value.
16464 @end table
16465
16466 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16467 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16468 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16469 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16470
16471 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16472 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16473 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16474 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16475 of functions.
16476
16477 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16478 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16479 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16480 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16481 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16482
16483 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16484 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16485 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16486 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16487 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16488 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16489 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16490 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16491 assignment into the right register(s).
16492
16493 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16494 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16495 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16496 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16497 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16498 into a @code{long long int}:
16499
16500 @smallexample
16501 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16502 29 return 31;
16503 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16504 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16505 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16506 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16507 (@value{GDBP})
16508 @end smallexample
16509
16510 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16511 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16512 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16513 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16514 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16515 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16516 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16517 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16518
16519 @smallexample
16520 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16521 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16522 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16523 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16524 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16525 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16526 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16527 (@value{GDBP})
16528 @end smallexample
16529
16530 @node Calling
16531 @section Calling Program Functions
16532
16533 @table @code
16534 @cindex calling functions
16535 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16536 @item print @var{expr}
16537 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16538 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
16539 debugged.
16540
16541 @kindex call
16542 @item call @var{expr}
16543 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16544 returned values.
16545
16546 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16547 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16548 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16549 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16550 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16551 value history.
16552 @end table
16553
16554 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16555 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
16556 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
16557 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
16558
16559 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
16560 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
16561 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
16562 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
16563 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
16564 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
16565 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
16566 in that case is controlled by the
16567 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
16568
16569 @table @code
16570 @item set unwindonsignal
16571 @kindex set unwindonsignal
16572 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
16573 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
16574 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
16575 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
16576 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
16577 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
16578 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
16579 received.
16580
16581 @item show unwindonsignal
16582 @kindex show unwindonsignal
16583 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16584 @value{GDBN}.
16585
16586 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16587 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16588 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
16589 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
16590 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
16591 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
16592 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
16593 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
16594 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
16595 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
16596
16597 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16598 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16599 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16600 @value{GDBN}.
16601
16602 @end table
16603
16604 @cindex weak alias functions
16605 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
16606 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
16607 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
16608 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
16609 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
16610 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
16611 function instead.
16612
16613 @node Patching
16614 @section Patching Programs
16615
16616 @cindex patching binaries
16617 @cindex writing into executables
16618 @cindex writing into corefiles
16619
16620 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
16621 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
16622 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
16623 patching your program's binary.
16624
16625 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
16626 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
16627 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
16628 repairs.
16629
16630 @table @code
16631 @kindex set write
16632 @item set write on
16633 @itemx set write off
16634 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
16635 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
16636 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
16637
16638 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
16639 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
16640 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
16641
16642 @item show write
16643 @kindex show write
16644 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
16645 as well as reading.
16646 @end table
16647
16648 @node GDB Files
16649 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
16650
16651 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
16652 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
16653 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
16654 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
16655
16656 @menu
16657 * Files:: Commands to specify files
16658 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
16659 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
16660 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
16661 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
16662 * Data Files:: GDB data files
16663 @end menu
16664
16665 @node Files
16666 @section Commands to Specify Files
16667
16668 @cindex symbol table
16669 @cindex core dump file
16670
16671 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
16672 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
16673 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
16674 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
16675
16676 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
16677 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
16678 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
16679 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
16680 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
16681 new files are useful.
16682
16683 @table @code
16684 @cindex executable file
16685 @kindex file
16686 @item file @var{filename}
16687 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
16688 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
16689 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
16690 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
16691 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
16692 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
16693 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
16694 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
16695
16696 @cindex unlinked object files
16697 @cindex patching object files
16698 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
16699 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
16700 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
16701 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
16702 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
16703 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
16704 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
16705 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
16706
16707 @item file
16708 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
16709 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
16710
16711 @kindex exec-file
16712 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16713 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
16714 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
16715 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
16716 discard information on the executable file.
16717
16718 @kindex symbol-file
16719 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16720 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
16721 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
16722 table and program to run from the same file.
16723
16724 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
16725 program's symbol table.
16726
16727 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
16728 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
16729 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
16730 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
16731 @value{GDBN}.
16732
16733 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
16734 executing it once.
16735
16736 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
16737 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
16738 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
16739 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
16740 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
16741 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
16742 optimized code.
16743
16744 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
16745 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
16746 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
16747 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
16748 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
16749
16750 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
16751 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
16752 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
16753 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
16754 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
16755 Warnings and Messages}.)
16756
16757 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
16758 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
16759 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
16760 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
16761 in stabs format.
16762
16763 @kindex readnow
16764 @cindex reading symbols immediately
16765 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
16766 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16767 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16768 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
16769 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
16770 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
16771 entire symbol table available.
16772
16773 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
16774 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
16775 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
16776 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
16777 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
16778 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
16779 @c files.
16780
16781 @kindex core-file
16782 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
16783 @itemx core
16784 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
16785 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
16786 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
16787 executable file itself for other parts.
16788
16789 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
16790 to be used.
16791
16792 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
16793 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
16794 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
16795 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
16796 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
16797
16798 @kindex add-symbol-file
16799 @cindex dynamic linking
16800 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
16801 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
16802 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
16803 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
16804 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
16805 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
16806 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
16807 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
16808 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
16809 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
16810 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
16811 @var{address} as an expression.
16812
16813 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
16814 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
16815 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
16816 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
16817
16818 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
16819
16820 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
16821 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
16822 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
16823 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
16824 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
16825 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
16826 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
16827 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
16828 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
16829
16830 @itemize @bullet
16831 @item
16832 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
16833 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
16834 @item
16835 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
16836 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
16837 @item
16838 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
16839 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
16840 @end itemize
16841
16842 @noindent
16843 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
16844 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
16845 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
16846 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
16847 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
16848 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
16849 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
16850 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
16851 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
16852 way.
16853
16854 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16855
16856 @kindex remove-symbol-file
16857 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
16858 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
16859 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
16860 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
16861 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
16862
16863 @smallexample
16864 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
16865 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
16866 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
16867 (y or n) y
16868 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
16869 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
16870 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
16871 (gdb)
16872 @end smallexample
16873
16874
16875 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16876
16877 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
16878 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
16879 @cindex load symbols from memory
16880 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
16881 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
16882 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
16883 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
16884 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
16885 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
16886 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
16887 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
16888 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
16889
16890 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
16891 @kindex assf
16892 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
16893 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
16894 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
16895 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
16896 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
16897 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
16898 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
16899 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
16900 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
16901 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
16902
16903 @kindex section
16904 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
16905 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
16906 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
16907 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
16908 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
16909 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
16910 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
16911 their addresses.
16912
16913 @kindex info files
16914 @kindex info target
16915 @item info files
16916 @itemx info target
16917 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
16918 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
16919 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
16920 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
16921 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
16922 current ones.
16923
16924 @kindex maint info sections
16925 @item maint info sections
16926 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
16927 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
16928 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
16929 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
16930 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
16931 may be arbitrarily combined):
16932
16933 @table @code
16934 @item ALLOBJ
16935 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
16936 @item @var{sections}
16937 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
16938 @item @var{section-flags}
16939 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
16940 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
16941 @table @code
16942 @item ALLOC
16943 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
16944 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
16945 @item LOAD
16946 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
16947 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
16948 @item RELOC
16949 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
16950 @item READONLY
16951 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
16952 @item CODE
16953 Section contains executable code only.
16954 @item DATA
16955 Section contains data only (no executable code).
16956 @item ROM
16957 Section will reside in ROM.
16958 @item CONSTRUCTOR
16959 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
16960 @item HAS_CONTENTS
16961 Section is not empty.
16962 @item NEVER_LOAD
16963 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
16964 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
16965 A notification to the linker that the section contains
16966 COFF shared library information.
16967 @item IS_COMMON
16968 Section contains common symbols.
16969 @end table
16970 @end table
16971 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
16972 @cindex read-only sections
16973 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
16974 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
16975 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
16976 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
16977 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
16978 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
16979 enhancement to debugging performance.
16980
16981 The default is off.
16982
16983 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
16984 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
16985 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
16986 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
16987
16988 @item show trust-readonly-sections
16989 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
16990 @end table
16991
16992 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
16993 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
16994 name and remembers it that way.
16995
16996 @cindex shared libraries
16997 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
16998 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
16999 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17000
17001 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17002 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17003
17004 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17005 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17006 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17007 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17008 debugging a core file).
17009
17010 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17011 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17012
17013 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17014 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17015 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17016
17017 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17018 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17019 particularly large or there are many of them.
17020
17021 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17022 commands:
17023
17024 @table @code
17025 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17026 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17027 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17028 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17029 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17030 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17031 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17032 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17033
17034 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17035 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17036 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17037 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17038 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17039 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17040 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17041 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17042 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17043
17044 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17045 @item show auto-solib-add
17046 Display the current autoloading mode.
17047 @end table
17048
17049 @cindex load shared library
17050 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17051 command:
17052
17053 @table @code
17054 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17055 @kindex info share
17056 @item info share @var{regex}
17057 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17058 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17059 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17060 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17061
17062 @kindex sharedlibrary
17063 @kindex share
17064 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17065 @itemx share @var{regex}
17066 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17067 Unix regular expression.
17068 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17069 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17070 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17071 loaded.
17072
17073 @item nosharedlibrary
17074 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17075 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17076 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17077 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17078 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17079 discarded.
17080 @end table
17081
17082 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17083 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17084 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17085 Catchpoints}).
17086
17087 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17088 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17089 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17090 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17091
17092 @table @code
17093 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17094 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17095 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17096 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17097 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17098 shared library.
17099
17100 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17101 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17102 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17103 library events happen.
17104 @end table
17105
17106 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17107 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17108 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17109 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17110 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17111 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17112 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17113 not.
17114
17115 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17116 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17117 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17118 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17119 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17120
17121 @table @code
17122 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17123 @cindex system root, alternate
17124 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17125 @kindex set sysroot
17126 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17127 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17128 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17129 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17130 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17131 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17132 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17133 under @var{path}.
17134
17135 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
17136 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
17137 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
17138 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
17139 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
17140 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
17141 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
17142 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
17143 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
17144
17145 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17146 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17147 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17148 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17149 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17150
17151 @smallexample
17152 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17153 @end smallexample
17154
17155 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17156 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17157 system:
17158
17159 @smallexample
17160 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17161 @end smallexample
17162
17163 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17164 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17165 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17166 colons:
17167
17168 @smallexample
17169 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17170 @end smallexample
17171
17172 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17173 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17174 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17175 @samp{z}):
17176
17177 @smallexample
17178 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17179 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17180 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17181 @end smallexample
17182
17183 @noindent
17184 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17185 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17186 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17187
17188 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17189 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17190
17191 @smallexample
17192 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17193 @end smallexample
17194
17195 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17196 if you don't want or need to.
17197
17198 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17199 sysroot}.
17200
17201 @cindex default system root
17202 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
17203 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
17204 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
17205 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17206 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
17207 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17208 location.
17209
17210 @kindex show sysroot
17211 @item show sysroot
17212 Display the current shared library prefix.
17213
17214 @kindex set solib-search-path
17215 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
17216 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17217 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
17218 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
17219 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
17220 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
17221 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17222 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
17223 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
17224 of shared library symbols.
17225
17226 @kindex show solib-search-path
17227 @item show solib-search-path
17228 Display the current shared library search path.
17229
17230 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
17231 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
17232 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
17233 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
17234 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
17235
17236 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
17237 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
17238 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
17239 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
17240 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
17241 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
17242 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
17243 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
17244 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
17245 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
17246 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
17247 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
17248 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
17249 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
17250 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
17251 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
17252 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
17253 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
17254 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
17255 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
17256 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
17257 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
17258
17259 @table @code
17260 @item unix
17261 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
17262 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
17263 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
17264 the forward slash.
17265
17266 @item dos-based
17267 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
17268 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
17269 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
17270 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
17271 considered directory separators.
17272
17273 @item auto
17274 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
17275 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
17276 This is the default.
17277 @end table
17278 @end table
17279
17280 @cindex file name canonicalization
17281 @cindex base name differences
17282 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
17283 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
17284 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
17285 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
17286 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
17287 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
17288 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
17289 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
17290 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
17291 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
17292 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
17293 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
17294 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
17295 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
17296 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
17297
17298 @table @code
17299 @item set basenames-may-differ
17300 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
17301 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17302
17303 @item show basenames-may-differ
17304 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
17305 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17306 @end table
17307
17308 @node Separate Debug Files
17309 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
17310 @cindex separate debugging information files
17311 @cindex debugging information in separate files
17312 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
17313 @cindex debugging information directory, global
17314 @cindex global debugging information directories
17315 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
17316 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
17317
17318 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
17319 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
17320 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
17321 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
17322 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
17323 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17324 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17325
17326 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17327 file:
17328
17329 @itemize @bullet
17330 @item
17331 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17332 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17333 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17334 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17335 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17336 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17337 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
17338 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
17339
17340 @item
17341 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
17342 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
17343 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
17344 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
17345 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
17346 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
17347 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
17348 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
17349 below.
17350 @end itemize
17351
17352 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
17353 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
17354
17355 @itemize @bullet
17356 @item
17357 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
17358 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
17359 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
17360 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
17361 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
17362
17363 @item
17364 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
17365 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
17366 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
17367 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
17368 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
17369 hex characters, not 10.)
17370 @end itemize
17371
17372 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
17373 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
17374 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
17375 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
17376 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
17377 debug information files, in the indicated order:
17378
17379 @itemize @minus
17380 @item
17381 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
17382 @item
17383 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
17384 @item
17385 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
17386 @item
17387 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
17388 @end itemize
17389
17390 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
17391 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
17392 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
17393 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
17394 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
17395
17396 @table @code
17397
17398 @kindex set debug-file-directory
17399 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
17400 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17401 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
17402 concatenating them by a path separator.
17403
17404 @kindex show debug-file-directory
17405 @item show debug-file-directory
17406 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17407 information files.
17408
17409 @end table
17410
17411 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
17412 @cindex debug link sections
17413 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
17414 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
17415
17416 @itemize
17417 @item
17418 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
17419 a zero byte,
17420 @item
17421 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
17422 boundary within the section, and
17423 @item
17424 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
17425 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
17426 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
17427 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
17428 @end itemize
17429
17430 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
17431 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
17432 described above.
17433
17434 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
17435 @cindex build ID sections
17436 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
17437 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
17438 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
17439 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
17440 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
17441 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
17442 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
17443 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
17444 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
17445
17446 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
17447 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
17448 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
17449 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
17450 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
17451 in an ordinary executable.
17452
17453 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
17454 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
17455 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
17456 following commands:
17457
17458 @smallexample
17459 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
17460 @kbd{strip -g foo}
17461 @end smallexample
17462
17463 @noindent
17464 These commands remove the debugging
17465 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
17466 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
17467 two files:
17468
17469 @itemize @bullet
17470 @item
17471 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
17472 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
17473
17474 @smallexample
17475 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
17476 @end smallexample
17477
17478 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
17479 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
17480 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
17481 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
17482
17483 @item
17484 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
17485 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
17486 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
17487 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
17488 @end itemize
17489
17490 @noindent
17491
17492 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
17493 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
17494 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
17495
17496 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
17497 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
17498 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
17499 @c different ways!
17500 @ifhtml
17501 @display
17502 @html
17503 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
17504 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
17505 @end html
17506 @end display
17507 @end ifhtml
17508 @ifnothtml
17509 @display
17510 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
17511 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
17512 @end display
17513 @end ifnothtml
17514
17515 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
17516 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
17517 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
17518 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
17519 CRC.
17520
17521 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
17522 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
17523 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
17524 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
17525 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
17526 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
17527
17528 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
17529 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
17530 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
17531 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
17532 @code{0xffffffff}.
17533
17534 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
17535 @smallexample
17536 unsigned long
17537 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
17538 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
17539 @{
17540 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
17541 @{
17542 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
17543 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
17544 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
17545 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
17546 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
17547 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
17548 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
17549 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
17550 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
17551 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
17552 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
17553 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
17554 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
17555 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
17556 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
17557 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
17558 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
17559 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
17560 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
17561 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
17562 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
17563 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
17564 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
17565 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
17566 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
17567 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
17568 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
17569 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
17570 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
17571 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
17572 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
17573 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
17574 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
17575 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
17576 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
17577 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
17578 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
17579 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
17580 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
17581 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
17582 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
17583 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
17584 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
17585 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
17586 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
17587 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
17588 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
17589 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
17590 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
17591 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
17592 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
17593 0x2d02ef8d
17594 @};
17595 unsigned char *end;
17596
17597 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17598 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
17599 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
17600 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17601 @}
17602 @end smallexample
17603
17604 @noindent
17605 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
17606
17607 @node MiniDebugInfo
17608 @section Debugging information in a special section
17609 @cindex separate debug sections
17610 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
17611
17612 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
17613 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
17614 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
17615 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
17616
17617 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
17618 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
17619 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
17620 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
17621 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
17622 debugging information might be included in the section.
17623
17624 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
17625 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
17626 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
17627
17628 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
17629 standard utilities:
17630
17631 @smallexample
17632 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
17633 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
17634 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17635 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
17636
17637 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
17638 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
17639 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
17640 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17641 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
17642 | sort > funcsyms
17643
17644 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
17645 # table.
17646 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
17647
17648 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
17649 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
17650
17651 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
17652 # removing some unnecessary sections.
17653 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
17654 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
17655
17656 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
17657 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
17658
17659 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
17660 # original binary.
17661 xz mini_debuginfo
17662 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
17663 @end smallexample
17664
17665 @node Index Files
17666 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
17667 @cindex index files
17668 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
17669
17670 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
17671 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
17672 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
17673 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
17674 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
17675 startup.
17676
17677 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
17678 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
17679 using @command{objcopy}.
17680
17681 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
17682
17683 @table @code
17684 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
17685 @kindex save gdb-index
17686 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
17687 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
17688 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
17689 @var{directory}.
17690 @end table
17691
17692 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
17693 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
17694
17695 @smallexample
17696 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
17697 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
17698 @end smallexample
17699
17700 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
17701 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
17702 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
17703 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
17704 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
17705 The default is @code{off}.
17706 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
17707 @xref{Index Section Format}.
17708
17709 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
17710 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
17711
17712 @smallexample
17713 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17714 @end smallexample
17715
17716 Instead you must do, for example,
17717
17718 @smallexample
17719 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17720 @end smallexample
17721
17722 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
17723 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
17724 currently work for programs using Ada.
17725
17726 @node Symbol Errors
17727 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
17728
17729 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
17730 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
17731 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
17732 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
17733 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
17734 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
17735 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
17736 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
17737 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
17738 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17739 Messages}).
17740
17741 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
17742
17743 @table @code
17744 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
17745
17746 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
17747 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
17748 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
17749 in its outer scope blocks.
17750
17751 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
17752 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
17753 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
17754 function.
17755
17756 @item block at @var{address} out of order
17757
17758 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
17759 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
17760 do so.
17761
17762 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
17763 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
17764 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
17765 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17766 Messages}.)
17767
17768 @item bad block start address patched
17769
17770 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
17771 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
17772 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
17773
17774 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
17775 starting on the previous source line.
17776
17777 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
17778
17779 @cindex foo
17780 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
17781 larger than the size of the string table.
17782
17783 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
17784 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
17785 with this name.
17786
17787 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
17788
17789 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
17790 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
17791 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
17792
17793 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
17794 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
17795 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
17796 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
17797 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
17798 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
17799
17800 @item stub type has NULL name
17801
17802 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
17803
17804 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
17805 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
17806 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
17807 it.
17808
17809 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
17810
17811 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
17812
17813 @end table
17814
17815 @node Data Files
17816 @section GDB Data Files
17817
17818 @cindex prefix for data files
17819 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
17820 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
17821
17822 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
17823 is currently using.
17824
17825 @table @code
17826 @kindex set data-directory
17827 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
17828 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
17829 to @var{directory}.
17830
17831 @kindex show data-directory
17832 @item show data-directory
17833 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
17834 @end table
17835
17836 @cindex default data directory
17837 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
17838 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
17839 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
17840 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17841 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
17842 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17843 location.
17844
17845 The data directory may also be specified with the
17846 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
17847 @xref{Mode Options}.
17848
17849 @node Targets
17850 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
17851
17852 @cindex debugging target
17853 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
17854
17855 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
17856 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
17857 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
17858 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
17859 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
17860 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
17861 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
17862 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
17863
17864 @cindex target architecture
17865 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
17866 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
17867 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
17868 command.
17869
17870 @table @code
17871 @kindex set architecture
17872 @kindex show architecture
17873 @item set architecture @var{arch}
17874 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
17875 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
17876 supported architectures.
17877
17878 @item show architecture
17879 Show the current target architecture.
17880
17881 @item set processor
17882 @itemx processor
17883 @kindex set processor
17884 @kindex show processor
17885 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
17886 and @code{show architecture}.
17887 @end table
17888
17889 @menu
17890 * Active Targets:: Active targets
17891 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
17892 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
17893 @end menu
17894
17895 @node Active Targets
17896 @section Active Targets
17897
17898 @cindex stacking targets
17899 @cindex active targets
17900 @cindex multiple targets
17901
17902 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
17903 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
17904 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
17905 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
17906 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
17907 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
17908 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
17909 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
17910 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
17911
17912 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
17913 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
17914 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
17915 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
17916
17917 @node Target Commands
17918 @section Commands for Managing Targets
17919
17920 @table @code
17921 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
17922 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
17923 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
17924 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
17925 protocol of the target machine.
17926
17927 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
17928 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
17929 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
17930
17931 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
17932 after executing the command.
17933
17934 @kindex help target
17935 @item help target
17936 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
17937 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
17938 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17939
17940 @item help target @var{name}
17941 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
17942 select it.
17943
17944 @kindex set gnutarget
17945 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
17946 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
17947 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
17948 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
17949 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
17950 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
17951
17952 @quotation
17953 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
17954 you must know the actual BFD name.
17955 @end quotation
17956
17957 @noindent
17958 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
17959
17960 @kindex show gnutarget
17961 @item show gnutarget
17962 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
17963 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
17964 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
17965 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
17966 @end table
17967
17968 @cindex common targets
17969 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
17970 configuration):
17971
17972 @table @code
17973 @kindex target
17974 @item target exec @var{program}
17975 @cindex executable file target
17976 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
17977 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
17978
17979 @item target core @var{filename}
17980 @cindex core dump file target
17981 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
17982 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
17983
17984 @item target remote @var{medium}
17985 @cindex remote target
17986 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
17987 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
17988 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
17989
17990 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
17991 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
17992
17993 @smallexample
17994 target remote /dev/ttya
17995 @end smallexample
17996
17997 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
17998 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
17999 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18000 clobbered by the download.
18001
18002 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18003 @cindex built-in simulator target
18004 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18005 In general,
18006 @smallexample
18007 target sim
18008 load
18009 run
18010 @end smallexample
18011 @noindent
18012 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18013 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18014 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18015 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18016 Processors}.
18017
18018 @end table
18019
18020 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18021 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18022
18023 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18024 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18025 various aspects of this process.
18026
18027 @table @code
18028
18029 @item set hash
18030 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18031 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18032 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18033 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18034 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18035 monitor.
18036
18037 @item show hash
18038 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18039 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18040
18041 @item set debug monitor
18042 @kindex set debug monitor
18043 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18044 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18045 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18046
18047 @item show debug monitor
18048 @kindex show debug monitor
18049 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18050 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18051 @end table
18052
18053 @table @code
18054
18055 @kindex load @var{filename}
18056 @item load @var{filename}
18057 @anchor{load}
18058 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18059 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18060 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18061 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18062 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18063 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18064
18065 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18066 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18067 target is @dots{}}''
18068
18069 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18070 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18071 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18072 specifies a fixed address.
18073 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18074
18075 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18076 load programs into flash memory.
18077
18078 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18079 @end table
18080
18081 @node Byte Order
18082 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18083
18084 @cindex choosing target byte order
18085 @cindex target byte order
18086
18087 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18088 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18089 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18090 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18091 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18092 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18093
18094 @table @code
18095 @kindex set endian
18096 @item set endian big
18097 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18098
18099 @item set endian little
18100 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18101
18102 @item set endian auto
18103 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18104 executable.
18105
18106 @item show endian
18107 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18108
18109 @end table
18110
18111 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18112 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18113 target system.
18114
18115
18116 @node Remote Debugging
18117 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18118 @cindex remote debugging
18119
18120 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18121 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18122 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18123 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18124 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18125
18126 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18127 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18128 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18129 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18130 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18131 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18132
18133 Other remote targets may be available in your
18134 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18135
18136 @menu
18137 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18138 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18139 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18140 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18141 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18142 @end menu
18143
18144 @node Connecting
18145 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18146
18147 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18148 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18149 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18150 program as the first argument.
18151
18152 @cindex @code{target remote}
18153 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18154 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18155 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18156 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18157 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18158 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18159
18160 @table @code
18161
18162 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18163 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18164 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18165 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18166
18167 @smallexample
18168 target remote /dev/ttyb
18169 @end smallexample
18170
18171 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18172 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18173 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18174 @code{target} command.
18175
18176 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18177 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18178 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18179 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18180 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18181 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18182 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18183 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18184 target.
18185
18186 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18187 @code{manyfarms}:
18188
18189 @smallexample
18190 target remote manyfarms:2828
18191 @end smallexample
18192
18193 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18194 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18195 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
18196 port 1234 on your local machine:
18197
18198 @smallexample
18199 target remote :1234
18200 @end smallexample
18201 @noindent
18202
18203 Note that the colon is still required here.
18204
18205 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18206 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
18207 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
18208 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
18209
18210 @smallexample
18211 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
18212 @end smallexample
18213
18214 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
18215 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
18216 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
18217 cause havoc with your debugging session.
18218
18219 @item target remote | @var{command}
18220 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
18221 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
18222 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
18223 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
18224 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
18225 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
18226 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
18227 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
18228
18229 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
18230 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
18231 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
18232
18233 @end table
18234
18235 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
18236 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
18237 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
18238 need to use @kbd{run}.
18239
18240 @cindex interrupting remote programs
18241 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
18242 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
18243 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
18244 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
18245 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
18246 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
18247
18248 @smallexample
18249 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
18250 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
18251 @end smallexample
18252
18253 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
18254 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
18255 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
18256 goes back to waiting.
18257
18258 @table @code
18259 @kindex detach (remote)
18260 @item detach
18261 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
18262 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
18263 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
18264 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
18265 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
18266
18267 @kindex disconnect
18268 @item disconnect
18269 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
18270 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
18271 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
18272 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
18273 another target.
18274
18275 @cindex send command to remote monitor
18276 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
18277 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
18278 @kindex monitor
18279 @item monitor @var{cmd}
18280 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
18281 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
18282 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
18283 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
18284 and implement.
18285 @end table
18286
18287 @node File Transfer
18288 @section Sending files to a remote system
18289 @cindex remote target, file transfer
18290 @cindex file transfer
18291 @cindex sending files to remote systems
18292
18293 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
18294 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
18295 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
18296 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
18297 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
18298 the only way to upload or download files.
18299
18300 Not all remote targets support these commands.
18301
18302 @table @code
18303 @kindex remote put
18304 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
18305 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
18306 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
18307
18308 @kindex remote get
18309 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
18310 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
18311 on the host system.
18312
18313 @kindex remote delete
18314 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
18315 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
18316
18317 @end table
18318
18319 @node Server
18320 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18321
18322 @kindex gdbserver
18323 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18324 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18325 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18326 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18327
18328 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18329 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18330 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18331 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
18332 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
18333 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
18334 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
18335 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
18336 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
18337 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
18338 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
18339 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
18340 choice for debugging.
18341
18342 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
18343 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
18344 protocol.
18345
18346 @quotation
18347 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
18348 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
18349 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
18350 target system with the same privileges as the user running
18351 @code{gdbserver}.
18352 @end quotation
18353
18354 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
18355 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
18356 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
18357
18358 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
18359 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
18360 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
18361 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
18362 system does all the symbol handling.
18363
18364 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
18365 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
18366 syntax is:
18367
18368 @smallexample
18369 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
18370 @end smallexample
18371
18372 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
18373 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
18374 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
18375 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
18376 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
18377 @file{/dev/com1}:
18378
18379 @smallexample
18380 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
18381 @end smallexample
18382
18383 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
18384 with it.
18385
18386 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
18387
18388 @smallexample
18389 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
18390 @end smallexample
18391
18392 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
18393 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
18394 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
18395 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
18396 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
18397 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
18398 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
18399 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
18400 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
18401 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
18402 @code{target remote} command.
18403
18404 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
18405 with ssh:
18406
18407 @smallexample
18408 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
18409 @end smallexample
18410
18411 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
18412 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
18413 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
18414 You could elide it if you want to.
18415
18416 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
18417 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
18418 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
18419 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
18420
18421 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
18422 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
18423 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
18424
18425 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
18426 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
18427
18428 @smallexample
18429 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
18430 @end smallexample
18431
18432 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
18433 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
18434
18435 @pindex pidof
18436 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
18437 @code{pidof} utility:
18438
18439 @smallexample
18440 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
18441 @end smallexample
18442
18443 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
18444 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
18445 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
18446
18447 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
18448 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
18449 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
18450
18451 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
18452 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
18453 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
18454 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
18455
18456 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
18457 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
18458 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
18459 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
18460 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
18461 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
18462 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
18463 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
18464 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
18465
18466 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
18467 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
18468 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
18469 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
18470 the program you want to debug.
18471
18472 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
18473 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
18474 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
18475 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
18476 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
18477 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
18478
18479 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
18480
18481 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
18482
18483 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
18484 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
18485 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
18486 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
18487 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
18488 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
18489 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
18490 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
18491
18492 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
18493 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
18494 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
18495
18496 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
18497 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
18498 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
18499 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
18500 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
18501 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
18502 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
18503 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
18504 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
18505 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
18506 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
18507 instance closes its port after the first connection.
18508
18509 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
18510
18511 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18512 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
18513 status information about the debugging process.
18514 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18515 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
18516 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
18517 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
18518
18519 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
18520 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
18521 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
18522 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
18523 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
18524
18525 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
18526 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
18527 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
18528 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
18529
18530 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
18531 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
18532 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
18533 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
18534
18535 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
18536 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
18537 environment:
18538
18539 @smallexample
18540 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
18541 @end smallexample
18542
18543 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
18544
18545 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
18546
18547 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
18548 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
18549 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
18550 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
18551
18552 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
18553 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
18554 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
18555 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
18556 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
18557 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
18558 programs.
18559
18560 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
18561 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
18562 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
18563 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
18564 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
18565 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
18566 already on the target.
18567
18568 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
18569 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
18570 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
18571
18572 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
18573 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
18574 Here are the available commands.
18575
18576 @table @code
18577 @item monitor help
18578 List the available monitor commands.
18579
18580 @item monitor set debug 0
18581 @itemx monitor set debug 1
18582 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
18583
18584 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
18585 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
18586 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
18587 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
18588
18589 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
18590 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
18591 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18592 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
18593 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
18594 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
18595
18596 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
18597 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
18598
18599 @item monitor exit
18600 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
18601 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
18602 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
18603 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
18604 of a multi-process mode debug session.
18605
18606 @end table
18607
18608 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18609 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18610
18611 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
18612 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
18613
18614 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
18615 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
18616 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
18617 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
18618 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
18619 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
18620 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
18621 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
18622 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
18623 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
18624 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
18625 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
18626
18627 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
18628
18629 @table @code
18630 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
18631
18632 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
18633 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
18634 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
18635
18636 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
18637
18638 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
18639 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
18640 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
18641 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
18642 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
18643 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
18644
18645 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
18646
18647 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
18648 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
18649 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
18650 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
18651 command for that. For example:
18652
18653 @smallexample
18654 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
18655 @end smallexample
18656
18657 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
18658 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
18659 @end table
18660
18661 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
18662 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
18663 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
18664 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
18665 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
18666 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
18667 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
18668 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
18669 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
18670 @code{gdbserver} like so:
18671
18672 @smallexample
18673 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
18674 @end smallexample
18675
18676 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
18677
18678 @smallexample
18679 $ gdb myprogram
18680 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
18681 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
18682 (@value{GDBP}) b main
18683 (@value{GDBP}) continue
18684 @end smallexample
18685
18686 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
18687 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
18688 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
18689 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
18690 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
18691 tracing.
18692
18693 @node Remote Configuration
18694 @section Remote Configuration
18695
18696 @kindex set remote
18697 @kindex show remote
18698 This section documents the configuration options available when
18699 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
18700 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
18701 system-call-allowed}.
18702
18703 @table @code
18704 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
18705 @cindex address size for remote targets
18706 @cindex bits in remote address
18707 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
18708 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
18709 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
18710 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
18711
18712 @item show remoteaddresssize
18713 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
18714
18715 @item set serial baud @var{n}
18716 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
18717 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
18718 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
18719 remote targets.
18720
18721 @item show serial baud
18722 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
18723
18724 @item set remotebreak
18725 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18726 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
18727 @anchor{set remotebreak}
18728 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
18729 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
18730 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
18731 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
18732 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
18733
18734 @item show remotebreak
18735 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
18736 interrupt the remote program.
18737
18738 @item set remoteflow on
18739 @itemx set remoteflow off
18740 @kindex set remoteflow
18741 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
18742 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
18743
18744 @item show remoteflow
18745 @kindex show remoteflow
18746 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
18747
18748 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
18749 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
18750 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
18751 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
18752 @code{ascii}.
18753
18754 @item show remotelogbase
18755 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
18756 protocol.
18757
18758 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
18759 @cindex record serial communications on file
18760 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
18761 default is not to record at all.
18762
18763 @item show remotelogfile.
18764 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
18765 serial communications.
18766
18767 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
18768 @cindex timeout for serial communications
18769 @cindex remote timeout
18770 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
18771 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
18772
18773 @item show remotetimeout
18774 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
18775 responses.
18776
18777 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
18778 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
18779 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
18780 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
18781 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
18782 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
18783 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
18784 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
18785
18786 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
18787 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
18788 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
18789 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
18790 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
18791 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
18792 as unlimited.
18793
18794 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
18795 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
18796 a remote hardware watchpoint.
18797
18798 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
18799 @itemx show remote exec-file
18800 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
18801 @cindex executable file, for remote target
18802 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
18803 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
18804 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
18805 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
18806
18807 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
18808 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18809 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
18810 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
18811 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
18812 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
18813 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
18814 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
18815 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
18816 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
18817
18818 @item show interrupt-sequence
18819 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
18820 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
18821 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
18822 also known as Magic SysRq g.
18823
18824 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
18825 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
18826 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
18827 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
18828 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
18829 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
18830
18831 @item show interrupt-on-connect
18832 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
18833 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
18834
18835 @kindex set tcp
18836 @kindex show tcp
18837 @item set tcp auto-retry on
18838 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
18839 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
18840 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
18841 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
18842 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
18843 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
18844 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
18845 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
18846
18847 @item set tcp auto-retry off
18848 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
18849
18850 @item show tcp auto-retry
18851 Show the current auto-retry setting.
18852
18853 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
18854 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
18855 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
18856 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
18857 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
18858 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
18859 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
18860 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
18861 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
18862 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
18863 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
18864
18865 @item show tcp connect-timeout
18866 Show the current connection timeout setting.
18867 @end table
18868
18869 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
18870 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
18871 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
18872 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
18873 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
18874 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
18875 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
18876 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
18877 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
18878
18879 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
18880 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
18881 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
18882 @value{GDBN} developers.
18883
18884 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
18885 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
18886 are:
18887
18888 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
18889 @item Command Name
18890 @tab Remote Packet
18891 @tab Related Features
18892
18893 @item @code{fetch-register}
18894 @tab @code{p}
18895 @tab @code{info registers}
18896
18897 @item @code{set-register}
18898 @tab @code{P}
18899 @tab @code{set}
18900
18901 @item @code{binary-download}
18902 @tab @code{X}
18903 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
18904
18905 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
18906 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
18907 @tab @code{info auxv}
18908
18909 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
18910 @tab @code{qSymbol}
18911 @tab Detecting multiple threads
18912
18913 @item @code{attach}
18914 @tab @code{vAttach}
18915 @tab @code{attach}
18916
18917 @item @code{verbose-resume}
18918 @tab @code{vCont}
18919 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
18920
18921 @item @code{run}
18922 @tab @code{vRun}
18923 @tab @code{run}
18924
18925 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
18926 @tab @code{Z0}
18927 @tab @code{break}
18928
18929 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
18930 @tab @code{Z1}
18931 @tab @code{hbreak}
18932
18933 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
18934 @tab @code{Z2}
18935 @tab @code{watch}
18936
18937 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
18938 @tab @code{Z3}
18939 @tab @code{rwatch}
18940
18941 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
18942 @tab @code{Z4}
18943 @tab @code{awatch}
18944
18945 @item @code{target-features}
18946 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
18947 @tab @code{set architecture}
18948
18949 @item @code{library-info}
18950 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
18951 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
18952
18953 @item @code{memory-map}
18954 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
18955 @tab @code{info mem}
18956
18957 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
18958 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
18959 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
18960
18961 @item @code{read-spu-object}
18962 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
18963 @tab @code{info spu}
18964
18965 @item @code{write-spu-object}
18966 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
18967 @tab @code{info spu}
18968
18969 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
18970 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
18971 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
18972
18973 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
18974 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
18975 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
18976
18977 @item @code{threads}
18978 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
18979 @tab @code{info threads}
18980
18981 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
18982 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
18983 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
18984
18985 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
18986 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
18987 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
18988
18989 @item @code{search-memory}
18990 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
18991 @tab @code{find}
18992
18993 @item @code{supported-packets}
18994 @tab @code{qSupported}
18995 @tab Remote communications parameters
18996
18997 @item @code{pass-signals}
18998 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
18999 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19000
19001 @item @code{program-signals}
19002 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19003 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19004
19005 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19006 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19007 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19008
19009 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19010 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19011 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19012
19013 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19014 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19015 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19016
19017 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19018 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19019 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19020
19021 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19022 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19023 @tab @code{remote delete}
19024
19025 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19026 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19027 @tab Host I/O
19028
19029 @item @code{noack-packet}
19030 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19031 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19032
19033 @item @code{osdata}
19034 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19035 @tab @code{info os}
19036
19037 @item @code{query-attached}
19038 @tab @code{qAttached}
19039 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19040
19041 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19042 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19043 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19044
19045 @item @code{trace-status}
19046 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19047 @tab @code{tstatus}
19048
19049 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19050 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19051 @tab Traceframe info
19052
19053 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19054 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19055 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19056
19057 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19058 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19059 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19060
19061 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19062 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19063 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19064 @end multitable
19065
19066 @node Remote Stub
19067 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19068
19069 @cindex debugging stub, example
19070 @cindex remote stub, example
19071 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19072 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19073 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19074 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19075 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19076 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19077 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19078 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19079
19080 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19081 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19082 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19083 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19084 program, you need:
19085
19086 @enumerate
19087 @item
19088 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19089 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19090 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19091
19092 @item
19093 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19094 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19095
19096 @item
19097 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19098 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19099 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19100 documentation.
19101 @end enumerate
19102
19103 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19104 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19105 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19106
19107 @table @emph
19108 @item On the host,
19109 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19110 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19111 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19112
19113 @item On the target,
19114 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19115 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19116 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19117
19118 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19119 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19120 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19121 @end table
19122
19123 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19124 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19125 @sc{sparc} boards.
19126
19127 @cindex remote serial stub list
19128 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19129
19130 @table @code
19131
19132 @item i386-stub.c
19133 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19134 @cindex Intel
19135 @cindex i386
19136 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19137
19138 @item m68k-stub.c
19139 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19140 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19141 @cindex m680x0
19142 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
19143
19144 @item sh-stub.c
19145 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
19146 @cindex Renesas
19147 @cindex SH
19148 For Renesas SH architectures.
19149
19150 @item sparc-stub.c
19151 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
19152 @cindex Sparc
19153 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
19154
19155 @item sparcl-stub.c
19156 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
19157 @cindex Fujitsu
19158 @cindex SparcLite
19159 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
19160
19161 @end table
19162
19163 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
19164 recently added stubs.
19165
19166 @menu
19167 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
19168 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
19169 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
19170 @end menu
19171
19172 @node Stub Contents
19173 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
19174
19175 @cindex remote serial stub
19176 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
19177 subroutines:
19178
19179 @table @code
19180 @item set_debug_traps
19181 @findex set_debug_traps
19182 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
19183 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
19184 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
19185 program's startup code.
19186
19187 @item handle_exception
19188 @findex handle_exception
19189 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
19190 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
19191 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
19192 run when a trap is triggered.
19193
19194 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
19195 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
19196 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
19197 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
19198 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
19199 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
19200 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
19201 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
19202 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
19203 machine.
19204
19205 @item breakpoint
19206 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
19207 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
19208 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
19209 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
19210 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
19211 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
19212 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
19213 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
19214 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
19215 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
19216 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
19217
19218 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
19219 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
19220 start of your debugging session.
19221 @end table
19222
19223 @node Bootstrapping
19224 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
19225
19226 @cindex remote stub, support routines
19227 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
19228 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
19229 debugging target machine.
19230
19231 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
19232 serial port.
19233
19234 @table @code
19235 @item int getDebugChar()
19236 @findex getDebugChar
19237 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
19238 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
19239 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19240
19241 @item void putDebugChar(int)
19242 @findex putDebugChar
19243 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
19244 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
19245 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19246 @end table
19247
19248 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
19249 @cindex interrupting remote targets
19250 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
19251 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
19252 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
19253 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
19254 remote system to stop.
19255
19256 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
19257 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
19258 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
19259 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
19260
19261 Other routines you need to supply are:
19262
19263 @table @code
19264 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
19265 @findex exceptionHandler
19266 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
19267 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
19268 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
19269 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
19270 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
19271 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
19272 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
19273 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
19274 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
19275 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
19276 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
19277 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
19278 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
19279
19280 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
19281 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
19282 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
19283 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
19284 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
19285
19286 @item void flush_i_cache()
19287 @findex flush_i_cache
19288 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
19289 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
19290 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
19291
19292 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
19293 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
19294 @end table
19295
19296 @noindent
19297 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
19298
19299 @table @code
19300 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
19301 @findex memset
19302 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
19303 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
19304 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
19305 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
19306 @end table
19307
19308 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
19309 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
19310 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
19311 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
19312
19313
19314 @node Debug Session
19315 @subsection Putting it All Together
19316
19317 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
19318 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
19319 steps.
19320
19321 @enumerate
19322 @item
19323 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
19324 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
19325 @display
19326 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
19327 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
19328 @end display
19329
19330 @item
19331 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
19332 procedure is called:
19333
19334 @smallexample
19335 set_debug_traps();
19336 breakpoint();
19337 @end smallexample
19338
19339 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
19340 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
19341 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
19342 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
19343 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
19344 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
19345 progress.
19346
19347 @item
19348 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
19349 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
19350
19351 @smallexample
19352 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
19353 @end smallexample
19354
19355 @noindent
19356 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
19357 function in your program, that function is called when
19358 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
19359 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
19360 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
19361
19362 @item
19363 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
19364 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
19365
19366 @item
19367 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
19368 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
19369
19370 @item
19371 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
19372 @c document that. FIXME.
19373 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
19374 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
19375
19376 @item
19377 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
19378 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19379
19380 @end enumerate
19381
19382 @node Configurations
19383 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
19384
19385 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
19386 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
19387 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
19388
19389 There are three major categories of configurations: native
19390 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
19391 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
19392 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
19393 are quite different from each other.
19394
19395 @menu
19396 * Native::
19397 * Embedded OS::
19398 * Embedded Processors::
19399 * Architectures::
19400 @end menu
19401
19402 @node Native
19403 @section Native
19404
19405 This section describes details specific to particular native
19406 configurations.
19407
19408 @menu
19409 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
19410 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
19411 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
19412 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
19413 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
19414 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
19415 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
19416 @end menu
19417
19418 @node HP-UX
19419 @subsection HP-UX
19420
19421 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
19422 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
19423 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
19424
19425
19426 @node BSD libkvm Interface
19427 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
19428
19429 @cindex libkvm
19430 @cindex kernel memory image
19431 @cindex kernel crash dump
19432
19433 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
19434 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
19435 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
19436 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
19437 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
19438 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
19439 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
19440 @code{kvm} target:
19441
19442 @smallexample
19443 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
19444 @end smallexample
19445
19446 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
19447 argument:
19448
19449 @smallexample
19450 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
19451 @end smallexample
19452
19453 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
19454 available:
19455
19456 @table @code
19457 @kindex kvm
19458 @item kvm pcb
19459 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
19460
19461 @item kvm proc
19462 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
19463 modern FreeBSD systems.
19464 @end table
19465
19466 @node SVR4 Process Information
19467 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
19468 @cindex /proc
19469 @cindex examine process image
19470 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
19471
19472 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
19473 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
19474 process using file-system subroutines.
19475
19476 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
19477 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
19478 information about the process running your program, or about any
19479 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
19480 @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, and Irix, but
19481 not HP-UX, for example.
19482
19483 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
19484 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
19485
19486 @table @code
19487 @kindex info proc
19488 @cindex process ID
19489 @item info proc
19490 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
19491 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
19492 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
19493 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
19494 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
19495 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
19496 executable file's absolute file name.
19497
19498 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
19499 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
19500 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
19501 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
19502 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
19503 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
19504
19505 @item info proc cmdline
19506 @cindex info proc cmdline
19507 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
19508 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19509
19510 @item info proc cwd
19511 @cindex info proc cwd
19512 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
19513 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19514
19515 @item info proc exe
19516 @cindex info proc exe
19517 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
19518 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19519
19520 @item info proc mappings
19521 @cindex memory address space mappings
19522 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
19523 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
19524 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
19525 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
19526 memory access rights to that range.
19527
19528 @item info proc stat
19529 @itemx info proc status
19530 @cindex process detailed status information
19531 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
19532 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
19533 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
19534 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
19535 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
19536 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
19537 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
19538
19539 @item info proc all
19540 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
19541 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
19542
19543 @ignore
19544 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
19545 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
19546 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
19547 @kindex info proc times
19548 @item info proc times
19549 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
19550 its children.
19551
19552 @kindex info proc id
19553 @item info proc id
19554 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
19555 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
19556 @end ignore
19557
19558 @item set procfs-trace
19559 @kindex set procfs-trace
19560 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
19561 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
19562
19563 @item show procfs-trace
19564 @kindex show procfs-trace
19565 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
19566
19567 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
19568 @kindex set procfs-file
19569 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
19570 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
19571 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
19572 standard output.
19573
19574 @item show procfs-file
19575 @kindex show procfs-file
19576 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
19577
19578 @item proc-trace-entry
19579 @itemx proc-trace-exit
19580 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
19581 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
19582 @kindex proc-trace-entry
19583 @kindex proc-trace-exit
19584 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
19585 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
19586 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
19587 from the @code{syscall} interface.
19588
19589 @item info pidlist
19590 @kindex info pidlist
19591 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
19592 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
19593 processes and all the threads within each process.
19594
19595 @item info meminfo
19596 @kindex info meminfo
19597 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
19598 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
19599 @end table
19600
19601 @node DJGPP Native
19602 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
19603 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
19604 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
19605 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
19606
19607 @cindex DPMI
19608 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
19609 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
19610 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
19611 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
19612
19613 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
19614 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
19615 subsection describes those commands.
19616
19617 @table @code
19618 @kindex info dos
19619 @item info dos
19620 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
19621 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19622
19623 @kindex sysinfo
19624 @cindex MS-DOS system info
19625 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
19626 @item info dos sysinfo
19627 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
19628 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
19629 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
19630
19631 @cindex GDT
19632 @cindex LDT
19633 @cindex IDT
19634 @cindex segment descriptor tables
19635 @cindex descriptor tables display
19636 @item info dos gdt
19637 @itemx info dos ldt
19638 @itemx info dos idt
19639 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
19640 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
19641 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
19642 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
19643 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
19644 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
19645 rights.
19646
19647 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
19648 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
19649 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
19650 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
19651 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
19652
19653 @cindex garbled pointers
19654 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
19655 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
19656 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
19657 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
19658 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
19659 debugged program's data segment:
19660
19661 @smallexample
19662 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
19663 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
19664 @end smallexample
19665
19666 @noindent
19667 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
19668 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
19669
19670 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
19671 @item info dos pde
19672 @itemx info dos pte
19673 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
19674 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
19675 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
19676 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
19677 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
19678 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
19679 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
19680 that is currently in use.
19681
19682 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
19683 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
19684 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
19685 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
19686 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
19687 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
19688 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
19689
19690 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
19691 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
19692 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
19693 controller.
19694
19695 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
19696
19697 @cindex physical address from linear address
19698 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
19699 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
19700 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
19701 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
19702 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
19703 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
19704 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
19705
19706 @smallexample
19707 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
19708 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
19709 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
19710 @end smallexample
19711
19712 @noindent
19713 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
19714 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
19715 attributes of that page.
19716
19717 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
19718 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
19719 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
19720 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
19721 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
19722 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
19723
19724 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
19725 transfer buffer:
19726
19727 @smallexample
19728 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
19729 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
19730 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
19731 @end smallexample
19732
19733 @noindent
19734 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
19735 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
19736 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
19737 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
19738 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
19739
19740 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
19741 @end table
19742
19743 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
19744 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
19745 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
19746 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
19747
19748 @table @code
19749 @kindex set com1base
19750 @kindex set com1irq
19751 @kindex set com2base
19752 @kindex set com2irq
19753 @kindex set com3base
19754 @kindex set com3irq
19755 @kindex set com4base
19756 @kindex set com4irq
19757 @item set com1base @var{addr}
19758 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
19759 port.
19760
19761 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
19762 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
19763 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
19764
19765 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
19766 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
19767 other 3 COM ports.
19768
19769 @kindex show com1base
19770 @kindex show com1irq
19771 @kindex show com2base
19772 @kindex show com2irq
19773 @kindex show com3base
19774 @kindex show com3irq
19775 @kindex show com4base
19776 @kindex show com4irq
19777 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
19778 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
19779 lines used by the COM ports.
19780
19781 @item info serial
19782 @kindex info serial
19783 @cindex DOS serial port status
19784 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
19785 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
19786 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
19787 counts of various errors encountered so far.
19788 @end table
19789
19790
19791 @node Cygwin Native
19792 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
19793 @cindex MS Windows debugging
19794 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
19795 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
19796
19797 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
19798 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
19799
19800 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
19801 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
19802 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
19803 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
19804 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
19805 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
19806 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
19807 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
19808
19809 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
19810 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
19811 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
19812
19813 @table @code
19814 @kindex info w32
19815 @item info w32
19816 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
19817 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19818
19819 @item info w32 selector
19820 This command displays information returned by
19821 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
19822 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
19823 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
19824 Without argument, this command displays information
19825 about the six segment registers.
19826
19827 @item info w32 thread-information-block
19828 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
19829 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
19830 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
19831
19832 @kindex info dll
19833 @item info dll
19834 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
19835
19836 @kindex dll-symbols
19837 @item dll-symbols
19838 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
19839 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
19840
19841 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
19842 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
19843 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
19844 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
19845 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
19846 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
19847 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
19848 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
19849 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
19850 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
19851 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
19852
19853 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
19854 @item show cygwin-exceptions
19855 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
19856 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
19857
19858 @kindex set new-console
19859 @item set new-console @var{mode}
19860 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
19861 be started in a new console on next start.
19862 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
19863 be started in the same console as the debugger.
19864
19865 @kindex show new-console
19866 @item show new-console
19867 Displays whether a new console is used
19868 when the debuggee is started.
19869
19870 @kindex set new-group
19871 @item set new-group @var{mode}
19872 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
19873 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
19874 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
19875 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
19876
19877 @kindex show new-group
19878 @item show new-group
19879 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
19880
19881 @kindex set debugevents
19882 @item set debugevents
19883 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
19884 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
19885 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
19886 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
19887 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
19888
19889 @kindex set debugexec
19890 @item set debugexec
19891 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
19892 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
19893
19894 @kindex set debugexceptions
19895 @item set debugexceptions
19896 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
19897 debuggee seen by the debugger.
19898
19899 @kindex set debugmemory
19900 @item set debugmemory
19901 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
19902 and writes by the debugger.
19903
19904 @kindex set shell
19905 @item set shell
19906 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
19907 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
19908
19909 @kindex show shell
19910 @item show shell
19911 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
19912
19913 @end table
19914
19915 @menu
19916 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
19917 @end menu
19918
19919 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
19920 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
19921 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
19922 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
19923
19924 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
19925 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
19926 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
19927 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
19928 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
19929 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
19930 ``minimal symbols''.
19931
19932 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
19933 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
19934 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
19935 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
19936 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
19937 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
19938 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
19939 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
19940 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
19941 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
19942
19943 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
19944
19945 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
19946 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
19947 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
19948 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
19949 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
19950 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
19951 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
19952 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
19953 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
19954
19955 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
19956 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
19957 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
19958 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
19959 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
19960 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
19961
19962 @smallexample
19963 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
19964 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
19965
19966 Non-debugging symbols:
19967 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
19968 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
19969 @end smallexample
19970
19971 @smallexample
19972 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
19973 All functions matching regular expression "!":
19974
19975 Non-debugging symbols:
19976 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
19977 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
19978 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
19979 [etc...]
19980 @end smallexample
19981
19982 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
19983
19984 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
19985 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
19986 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
19987 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
19988 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
19989 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
19990 a function within a DLL without a running program.
19991
19992 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
19993 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
19994 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
19995 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
19996 problem:
19997
19998 @smallexample
19999 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20000 $1 = 268572168
20001 @end smallexample
20002
20003 @smallexample
20004 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20005 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20006 @end smallexample
20007
20008 And two possible solutions:
20009
20010 @smallexample
20011 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20012 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20013 @end smallexample
20014
20015 @smallexample
20016 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20017 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20018 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20019 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20020 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20021 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20022 @end smallexample
20023
20024 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20025 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20026 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20027 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20028 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20029
20030 @smallexample
20031 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20032 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20033 @end smallexample
20034
20035 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20036 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20037 safe.
20038
20039 @node Hurd Native
20040 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20041 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20042
20043 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20044 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20045
20046 @table @code
20047 @item set signals
20048 @itemx set sigs
20049 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20050 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20051 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20052 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20053 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20054 @code{signals}.
20055
20056 @item show signals
20057 @itemx show sigs
20058 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20059 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20060 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20061
20062 @item set signal-thread
20063 @itemx set sigthread
20064 @kindex set signal-thread
20065 @kindex set sigthread
20066 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20067 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20068 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20069 signal-thread}.
20070
20071 @item show signal-thread
20072 @itemx show sigthread
20073 @kindex show signal-thread
20074 @kindex show sigthread
20075 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20076 delivered a signal.
20077
20078 @item set stopped
20079 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20080 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20081 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20082 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20083
20084 @item show stopped
20085 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20086 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20087 stopped.
20088
20089 @item set exceptions
20090 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20091 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20092 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20093 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20094 trapping on.
20095
20096 @item show exceptions
20097 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20098 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20099
20100 @item set task pause
20101 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20102 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20103 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20104 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20105 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20106 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20107 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20108 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20109 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20110
20111 @item show task pause
20112 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20113 Show the current state of task suspension.
20114
20115 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20116 @cindex task suspend count
20117 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20118 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20119 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20120
20121 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20122 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20123
20124 @item set task exception-port
20125 @itemx set task excp
20126 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20127 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20128 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20129 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20130
20131 @item set noninvasive
20132 @cindex noninvasive task options
20133 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20134 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20135 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20136 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20137
20138 @item info send-rights
20139 @itemx info receive-rights
20140 @itemx info port-rights
20141 @itemx info port-sets
20142 @itemx info dead-names
20143 @itemx info ports
20144 @itemx info psets
20145 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20146 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20147 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20148 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20149 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20150 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20151 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20152 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20153 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
20154
20155 @item set thread pause
20156 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
20157 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20158 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20159 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
20160 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
20161 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
20162 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
20163 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
20164 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
20165 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
20166 only the current thread.
20167
20168 @item show thread pause
20169 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
20170 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
20171
20172 @item set thread run
20173 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20174
20175 @item show thread run
20176 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20177
20178 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
20179 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20180 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20181 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
20182 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
20183 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
20184 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
20185
20186 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
20187 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
20188 detaching.
20189
20190 @item set thread exception-port
20191 @itemx set thread excp
20192 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
20193 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
20194 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
20195
20196 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
20197 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
20198 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
20199 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
20200
20201 @item set thread default
20202 @itemx show thread default
20203 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20204 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
20205 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
20206 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
20207 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
20208 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
20209 the non-default commands.
20210 @end table
20211
20212 @node Darwin
20213 @subsection Darwin
20214 @cindex Darwin
20215
20216 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
20217
20218 @table @code
20219 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
20220 @kindex set debug darwin
20221 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
20222 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
20223
20224 @item show debug darwin
20225 @kindex show debug darwin
20226 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
20227
20228 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
20229 @kindex set debug mach-o
20230 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
20231 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
20232 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
20233 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
20234 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
20235 usage.
20236
20237 @item show debug mach-o
20238 @kindex show debug mach-o
20239 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
20240
20241 @item set mach-exceptions on
20242 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
20243 @kindex set mach-exceptions
20244 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
20245 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
20246 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
20247 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
20248
20249 @item show mach-exceptions
20250 @kindex show mach-exceptions
20251 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
20252 @end table
20253
20254
20255 @node Embedded OS
20256 @section Embedded Operating Systems
20257
20258 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
20259 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
20260 architectures.
20261
20262 @menu
20263 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20264 @end menu
20265
20266 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
20267 various real-time operating systems.
20268
20269 @node VxWorks
20270 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20271
20272 @cindex VxWorks
20273
20274 @table @code
20275
20276 @kindex target vxworks
20277 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
20278 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
20279 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
20280
20281 @end table
20282
20283 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
20284 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
20285
20286 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
20287 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
20288 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
20289 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
20290 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
20291 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
20292 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
20293
20294 @table @code
20295 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
20296 @kindex vxworks-timeout
20297 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
20298 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
20299 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
20300 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
20301 of a thin network line.
20302 @end table
20303
20304 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
20305 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
20306 procedures.
20307
20308 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
20309 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
20310 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
20311 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
20312 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
20313 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
20314 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
20315 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
20316 manual.
20317 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
20318
20319 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
20320 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
20321 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
20322 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
20323
20324 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
20325
20326 @smallexample
20327 (vxgdb)
20328 @end smallexample
20329
20330 @menu
20331 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
20332 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
20333 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
20334 @end menu
20335
20336 @node VxWorks Connection
20337 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
20338
20339 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
20340 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
20341
20342 @smallexample
20343 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
20344 @end smallexample
20345
20346 @need 750
20347 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
20348
20349 @smallexample
20350 Attaching remote machine across net...
20351 Connected to tt.
20352 @end smallexample
20353
20354 @need 1000
20355 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
20356 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
20357 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
20358 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
20359 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
20360
20361 @smallexample
20362 prog.o: No such file or directory.
20363 @end smallexample
20364
20365 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
20366 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
20367 command again.
20368
20369 @node VxWorks Download
20370 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
20371
20372 @cindex download to VxWorks
20373 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
20374 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
20375 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
20376 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
20377 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
20378 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
20379 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
20380 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
20381 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
20382 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
20383 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
20384 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
20385 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
20386 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
20387 program, type this on VxWorks:
20388
20389 @smallexample
20390 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
20391 @end smallexample
20392
20393 @noindent
20394 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
20395
20396 @smallexample
20397 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
20398 (vxgdb) load prog.o
20399 @end smallexample
20400
20401 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
20402
20403 @smallexample
20404 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
20405 @end smallexample
20406
20407 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
20408 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
20409 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
20410 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
20411 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
20412 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
20413 table.)
20414
20415 @node VxWorks Attach
20416 @subsubsection Running Tasks
20417
20418 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
20419 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
20420 follows:
20421
20422 @smallexample
20423 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
20424 @end smallexample
20425
20426 @noindent
20427 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
20428 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
20429 the time of attachment.
20430
20431 @node Embedded Processors
20432 @section Embedded Processors
20433
20434 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20435 configurations.
20436
20437 @cindex send command to simulator
20438 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20439 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20440
20441 @table @code
20442 @item sim @var{command}
20443 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20444 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20445 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20446 acceptable commands.
20447 @end table
20448
20449
20450 @menu
20451 * ARM:: ARM RDI
20452 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20453 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20454 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20455 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20456 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20457 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20458 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20459 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20460 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20461 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
20462 * CRIS:: CRIS
20463 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20464 @end menu
20465
20466 @node ARM
20467 @subsection ARM
20468 @cindex ARM RDI
20469
20470 @table @code
20471 @kindex target rdi
20472 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20473 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20474 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20475 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
20476
20477 @kindex target rdp
20478 @item target rdp @var{dev}
20479 ARM Demon monitor.
20480
20481 @end table
20482
20483 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
20484
20485 @table @code
20486 @item set arm disassembler
20487 @kindex set arm
20488 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
20489 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
20490
20491 @item show arm disassembler
20492 @kindex show arm
20493 Show the current disassembly style.
20494
20495 @item set arm apcs32
20496 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
20497 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
20498
20499 @item show arm apcs32
20500 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
20501
20502 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
20503 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
20504 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
20505
20506 @table @code
20507 @item auto
20508 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
20509 @item softfpa
20510 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
20511 processors.
20512 @item fpa
20513 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
20514 @item softvfp
20515 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
20516 @item vfp
20517 VFP co-processor.
20518 @end table
20519
20520 @item show arm fpu
20521 Show the current type of the FPU.
20522
20523 @item set arm abi
20524 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
20525
20526 @item show arm abi
20527 Show the currently used ABI.
20528
20529 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20530 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
20531 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
20532 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
20533 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
20534 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
20535 register).
20536
20537 @item show arm fallback-mode
20538 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
20539
20540 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20541 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
20542 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
20543 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
20544 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
20545
20546 @item show arm force-mode
20547 Show the current forced instruction mode.
20548
20549 @item set debug arm
20550 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
20551 target support subsystem.
20552
20553 @item show debug arm
20554 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
20555 @end table
20556
20557 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
20558 using the RDI interface:
20559
20560 @table @code
20561 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20562 @kindex rdilogfile
20563 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
20564 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
20565 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
20566 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
20567 @file{rdi.log}.
20568
20569 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
20570 @kindex rdilogenable
20571 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
20572 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
20573 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
20574 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
20575 are logged to a file.
20576
20577 @item set rdiromatzero
20578 @kindex set rdiromatzero
20579 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
20580 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
20581 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
20582 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
20583 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
20584
20585 @item show rdiromatzero
20586 @kindex show rdiromatzero
20587 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
20588
20589 @item set rdiheartbeat
20590 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
20591 @cindex RDI heartbeat
20592 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
20593 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
20594 well as the Angel monitor.
20595
20596 @item show rdiheartbeat
20597 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
20598 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
20599 @end table
20600
20601 @table @code
20602 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20603 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
20604
20605 @table @code
20606 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
20607 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
20608 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
20609 The default value is @code{all}.
20610
20611 @table @code
20612 @item none
20613 @item demon
20614 @item angel
20615 @item redboot
20616 @item all
20617 @end table
20618 @end table
20619 @end table
20620
20621 @node M32R/D
20622 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
20623
20624 @table @code
20625 @kindex target m32r
20626 @item target m32r @var{dev}
20627 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
20628
20629 @kindex target m32rsdi
20630 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
20631 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
20632 @end table
20633
20634 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
20635
20636 @table @code
20637 @item set download-path @var{path}
20638 @kindex set download-path
20639 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
20640 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20641
20642 @item show download-path
20643 @kindex show download-path
20644 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20645
20646 @item set board-address @var{addr}
20647 @kindex set board-address
20648 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
20649 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
20650
20651 @item show board-address
20652 @kindex show board-address
20653 Show the current IP address of the target board.
20654
20655 @item set server-address @var{addr}
20656 @kindex set server-address
20657 @cindex download server address (M32R)
20658 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
20659 host machine.
20660
20661 @item show server-address
20662 @kindex show server-address
20663 Display the IP address of the download server.
20664
20665 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20666 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
20667 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
20668 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
20669 executable file is uploaded.
20670
20671 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20672 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
20673 Test the @code{upload} command.
20674 @end table
20675
20676 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
20677
20678 @table @code
20679 @item sdireset
20680 @kindex sdireset
20681 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
20682 This command resets the SDI connection.
20683
20684 @item sdistatus
20685 @kindex sdistatus
20686 This command shows the SDI connection status.
20687
20688 @item debug_chaos
20689 @kindex debug_chaos
20690 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
20691 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
20692
20693 @item use_debug_dma
20694 @kindex use_debug_dma
20695 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
20696
20697 @item use_mon_code
20698 @kindex use_mon_code
20699 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
20700
20701 @item use_ib_break
20702 @kindex use_ib_break
20703 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
20704
20705 @item use_dbt_break
20706 @kindex use_dbt_break
20707 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
20708 @end table
20709
20710 @node M68K
20711 @subsection M68k
20712
20713 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
20714 target command for the following ROM monitor.
20715
20716 @table @code
20717
20718 @kindex target dbug
20719 @item target dbug @var{dev}
20720 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
20721
20722 @end table
20723
20724 @node MicroBlaze
20725 @subsection MicroBlaze
20726 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
20727 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
20728
20729 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
20730 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
20731 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
20732 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
20733 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
20734 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
20735 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
20736 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
20737 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
20738 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
20739 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
20740
20741 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
20742
20743 @table @code
20744 @item target remote :1234
20745 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
20746 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
20747
20748 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
20749 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
20750 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
20751
20752 @item load
20753 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
20754
20755 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
20756 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
20757
20758 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
20759 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
20760 @end table
20761
20762 @node MIPS Embedded
20763 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
20764
20765 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
20766 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
20767 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
20768 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
20769
20770 @need 1000
20771 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
20772
20773 @table @code
20774 @item target mips @var{port}
20775 @kindex target mips @var{port}
20776 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
20777 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
20778 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
20779 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
20780 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
20781 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
20782
20783 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
20784 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
20785 debugger:
20786
20787 @smallexample
20788 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
20789 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
20790 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
20791 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
20792 (@value{GDBP}) run
20793 @end smallexample
20794
20795 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
20796 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
20797 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
20798 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
20799 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
20800
20801 @item target pmon @var{port}
20802 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
20803 PMON ROM monitor.
20804
20805 @item target ddb @var{port}
20806 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
20807 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
20808
20809 @item target lsi @var{port}
20810 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
20811 LSI variant of PMON.
20812
20813 @kindex target r3900
20814 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
20815 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
20816
20817 @kindex target array
20818 @item target array @var{dev}
20819 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
20820
20821 @end table
20822
20823
20824 @noindent
20825 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
20826
20827 @table @code
20828 @item set mipsfpu double
20829 @itemx set mipsfpu single
20830 @itemx set mipsfpu none
20831 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
20832 @itemx show mipsfpu
20833 @kindex set mipsfpu
20834 @kindex show mipsfpu
20835 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
20836 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
20837 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
20838 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
20839 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
20840 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
20841 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
20842 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
20843 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
20844 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
20845 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
20846 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
20847 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
20848
20849 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
20850 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
20851 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
20852
20853 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
20854 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
20855
20856 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
20857 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
20858 @itemx show timeout
20859 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
20860 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20861 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
20862 @kindex set timeout
20863 @kindex show timeout
20864 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
20865 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
20866 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
20867 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
20868 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
20869 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
20870 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
20871 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
20872 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
20873 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
20874
20875 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
20876 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
20877 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
20878 to run before stopping.
20879
20880 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
20881 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20882 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
20883 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
20884 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
20885 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
20886
20887 @item show syn-garbage-limit
20888 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20889 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
20890 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
20891
20892 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
20893 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20894 @cindex remote monitor prompt
20895 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
20896 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
20897 @table @asis
20898 @item pmon target
20899 @samp{PMON}
20900 @item ddb target
20901 @samp{NEC010}
20902 @item lsi target
20903 @samp{PMON>}
20904 @end table
20905
20906 @item show monitor-prompt
20907 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20908 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
20909 remote monitor.
20910
20911 @item set monitor-warnings
20912 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20913 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
20914 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
20915 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
20916 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
20917
20918 @item show monitor-warnings
20919 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20920 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
20921
20922 @item pmon @var{command}
20923 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
20924 @cindex send PMON command
20925 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
20926 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
20927 @end table
20928
20929 @node PowerPC Embedded
20930 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
20931
20932 @cindex DVC register
20933 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
20934 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
20935
20936 @smallexample
20937 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
20938 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
20939 @end smallexample
20940
20941 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
20942 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
20943 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
20944 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
20945 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
20946 or newer.
20947
20948 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
20949 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
20950 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
20951 watching variables of scalar types.
20952
20953 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
20954 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
20955
20956 @smallexample
20957 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
20958 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
20959 @end smallexample
20960
20961 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
20962 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
20963
20964 @cindex ranged breakpoint
20965 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
20966 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
20967 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
20968 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
20969 use the @code{break-range} command.
20970
20971 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
20972
20973 @table @code
20974 @kindex break-range
20975 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
20976 Set a breakpoint for an address range.
20977 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location} can specify a function name,
20978 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
20979 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
20980 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
20981 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
20982 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
20983 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
20984
20985 @kindex set powerpc
20986 @item set powerpc soft-float
20987 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
20988 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
20989 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
20990 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
20991
20992 @item set powerpc vector-abi
20993 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
20994 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
20995 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
20996 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
20997 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
20998 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
20999 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21000
21001 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21002 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21003 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21004 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21005 address of its first byte.
21006
21007 @kindex target dink32
21008 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21009 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21010
21011 @kindex target ppcbug
21012 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21013 @kindex target ppcbug1
21014 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21015 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21016
21017 @kindex target sds
21018 @item target sds @var{dev}
21019 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21020 @end table
21021
21022 @cindex SDS protocol
21023 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21024 by @value{GDBN}:
21025
21026 @table @code
21027 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21028 @kindex set sdstimeout
21029 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21030 default is 2 seconds.
21031
21032 @item show sdstimeout
21033 @kindex show sdstimeout
21034 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21035
21036 @item sds @var{command}
21037 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21038 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21039 @end table
21040
21041
21042 @node PA
21043 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21044
21045 @table @code
21046
21047 @kindex target op50n
21048 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21049 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21050
21051 @kindex target w89k
21052 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21053 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21054
21055 @end table
21056
21057 @node Sparclet
21058 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21059
21060 @cindex Sparclet
21061
21062 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21063 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21064 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21065 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21066 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21067
21068 @table @code
21069 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21070 @kindex remotetimeout
21071 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21072 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21073 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21074 @end table
21075
21076 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21077 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21078 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21079 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21080 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21081
21082 @smallexample
21083 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21084 @end smallexample
21085
21086 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21087
21088 @smallexample
21089 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21090 @end smallexample
21091
21092 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21093 Once you have set
21094 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21095 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21096 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21097
21098 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21099
21100 @smallexample
21101 (gdbslet)
21102 @end smallexample
21103
21104 @menu
21105 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21106 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21107 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21108 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21109 @end menu
21110
21111 @node Sparclet File
21112 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21113
21114 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21115
21116 @smallexample
21117 (gdbslet) file prog
21118 @end smallexample
21119
21120 @need 1000
21121 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21122 @value{GDBN} locates
21123 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21124 path.
21125 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21126 files will be searched as well.
21127 @value{GDBN} locates
21128 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21129 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21130 If it fails
21131 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21132
21133 @smallexample
21134 prog: No such file or directory.
21135 @end smallexample
21136
21137 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21138 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21139 @code{target} command again.
21140
21141 @node Sparclet Connection
21142 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21143
21144 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21145 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21146
21147 @smallexample
21148 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21149 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21150 main () at ../prog.c:3
21151 @end smallexample
21152
21153 @need 750
21154 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21155
21156 @smallexample
21157 Connected to ttya.
21158 @end smallexample
21159
21160 @node Sparclet Download
21161 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21162
21163 @cindex download to Sparclet
21164 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21165 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21166 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21167 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21168 command.
21169 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21170 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21171 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21172 of each of the file's sections.
21173 For instance, if the program
21174 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21175 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21176
21177 @smallexample
21178 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21179 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21180 @end smallexample
21181
21182 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21183 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21184 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21185
21186 @node Sparclet Execution
21187 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21188
21189 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21190 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21191 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21192 manual for the list of commands.
21193
21194 @smallexample
21195 (gdbslet) b main
21196 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21197 (gdbslet) run
21198 Starting program: prog
21199 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21200 3 char *symarg = 0;
21201 (gdbslet) step
21202 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21203 (gdbslet)
21204 @end smallexample
21205
21206 @node Sparclite
21207 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21208
21209 @table @code
21210
21211 @kindex target sparclite
21212 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21213 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21214 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21215 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21216 remote protocol.
21217
21218 @end table
21219
21220 @node Z8000
21221 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21222
21223 @cindex Z8000
21224 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21225 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21226
21227 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21228 a Z8000 simulator.
21229
21230 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21231 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21232 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21233 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21234
21235 @table @code
21236 @item target sim @var{args}
21237 @kindex sim
21238 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21239 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21240 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21241 @end table
21242
21243 @noindent
21244 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21245 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21246 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21247 to run your program, and so on.
21248
21249 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21250 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21251 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21252
21253 @table @code
21254
21255 @item cycles
21256 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21257
21258 @item insts
21259 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21260
21261 @item time
21262 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21263
21264 @end table
21265
21266 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21267 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21268 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21269 simulated clock ticks.
21270
21271 @node AVR
21272 @subsection Atmel AVR
21273 @cindex AVR
21274
21275 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21276 following AVR-specific commands:
21277
21278 @table @code
21279 @item info io_registers
21280 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21281 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21282 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21283 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21284 @end table
21285
21286 @node CRIS
21287 @subsection CRIS
21288 @cindex CRIS
21289
21290 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21291 following CRIS-specific commands:
21292
21293 @table @code
21294 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21295 @cindex CRIS version
21296 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21297 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21298 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21299
21300 @item show cris-version
21301 Show the current CRIS version.
21302
21303 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21304 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21305 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21306 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21307 @code{R59}.
21308
21309 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21310 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21311
21312 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21313 @cindex CRIS mode
21314 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21315 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21316 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21317
21318 @item show cris-mode
21319 Show the current CRIS mode.
21320 @end table
21321
21322 @node Super-H
21323 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21324 @cindex Super-H
21325
21326 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21327 commands:
21328
21329 @table @code
21330 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21331 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21332 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21333 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21334 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21335 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21336 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21337 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21338 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21339 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21340 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21341 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21342
21343 @item show sh calling-convention
21344 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21345 Show the current calling convention setting.
21346
21347 @end table
21348
21349
21350 @node Architectures
21351 @section Architectures
21352
21353 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21354 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21355
21356 @menu
21357 * AArch64::
21358 * i386::
21359 * Alpha::
21360 * MIPS::
21361 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21362 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21363 * PowerPC::
21364 * Nios II::
21365 @end menu
21366
21367 @node AArch64
21368 @subsection AArch64
21369 @cindex AArch64 support
21370
21371 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21372 following special commands:
21373
21374 @table @code
21375 @item set debug aarch64
21376 @kindex set debug aarch64
21377 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21378 messages are to be displayed.
21379
21380 @item show debug aarch64
21381 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21382
21383 @end table
21384
21385 @node i386
21386 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21387
21388 @table @code
21389 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21390 @kindex set struct-convention
21391 @cindex struct return convention
21392 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21393 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21394 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21395 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21396 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21397 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21398 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21399 be returned in a register.
21400
21401 @item show struct-convention
21402 @kindex show struct-convention
21403 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21404 from functions.
21405 @end table
21406
21407 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
21408 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
21409
21410 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
21411 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
21412 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
21413 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
21414 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
21415 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
21416 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
21417
21418 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
21419 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
21420 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
21421 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
21422 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
21423 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
21424
21425 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
21426 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
21427 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
21428
21429 @smallexample
21430 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
21431 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
21432 @end smallexample
21433
21434 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
21435 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
21436 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
21437 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
21438 the pointer.
21439
21440 @node Alpha
21441 @subsection Alpha
21442
21443 See the following section.
21444
21445 @node MIPS
21446 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21447
21448 @cindex stack on Alpha
21449 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21450 @cindex Alpha stack
21451 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21452 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21453 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21454 find the beginning of a function.
21455
21456 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21457 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21458 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21459 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21460 commands:
21461
21462 @table @code
21463 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21464 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21465 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21466 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21467 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21468 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21469 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21470 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21471
21472 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21473 Display the current limit.
21474 @end table
21475
21476 @noindent
21477 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
21478 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
21479
21480 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
21481 programs:
21482
21483 @table @code
21484 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
21485 @kindex set mips abi
21486 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
21487 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
21488 values of @var{arg} are:
21489
21490 @table @samp
21491 @item auto
21492 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
21493 default).
21494 @item o32
21495 @item o64
21496 @item n32
21497 @item n64
21498 @item eabi32
21499 @item eabi64
21500 @end table
21501
21502 @item show mips abi
21503 @kindex show mips abi
21504 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21505
21506 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
21507 @kindex set mips compression
21508 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
21509 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
21510 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
21511 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
21512 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
21513 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
21514 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
21515 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
21516 provided by the executable.
21517
21518 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
21519 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
21520 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
21521 identified as such.
21522
21523 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
21524 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
21525 implicitly from an executable.
21526
21527 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
21528 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
21529 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
21530 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
21531 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
21532
21533 @item show mips compression
21534 @kindex show mips compression
21535 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
21536 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21537
21538 @item set mipsfpu
21539 @itemx show mipsfpu
21540 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
21541
21542 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
21543 @kindex set mips mask-address
21544 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
21545 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
21546 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
21547 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
21548 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
21549
21550 @item show mips mask-address
21551 @kindex show mips mask-address
21552 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
21553 not.
21554
21555 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21556 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21557 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
21558 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
21559 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
21560 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
21561
21562 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21563 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21564 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
21565
21566 @item set debug mips
21567 @kindex set debug mips
21568 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
21569 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21570
21571 @item show debug mips
21572 @kindex show debug mips
21573 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
21574 @end table
21575
21576
21577 @node HPPA
21578 @subsection HPPA
21579 @cindex HPPA support
21580
21581 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
21582 following special commands:
21583
21584 @table @code
21585 @item set debug hppa
21586 @kindex set debug hppa
21587 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
21588 messages are to be displayed.
21589
21590 @item show debug hppa
21591 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
21592
21593 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
21594 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
21595 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
21596 given @var{address}.
21597
21598 @end table
21599
21600
21601 @node SPU
21602 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21603 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
21604 @cindex SPU
21605
21606 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
21607 it provides the following special commands:
21608
21609 @table @code
21610 @item info spu event
21611 @kindex info spu
21612 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
21613 and pending event status.
21614
21615 @item info spu signal
21616 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
21617 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
21618 notification channels.
21619
21620 @item info spu mailbox
21621 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
21622 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
21623 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
21624
21625 @item info spu dma
21626 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21627 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21628 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21629
21630 @item info spu proxydma
21631 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21632 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21633 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21634
21635 @end table
21636
21637 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
21638 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
21639 special commands:
21640
21641 @table @code
21642 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
21643 @kindex set spu
21644 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
21645 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
21646 function. The default is @code{off}.
21647
21648 @item show spu stop-on-load
21649 @kindex show spu
21650 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
21651
21652 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
21653 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
21654 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
21655 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
21656 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
21657 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
21658
21659 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
21660 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
21661
21662 @end table
21663
21664 @node PowerPC
21665 @subsection PowerPC
21666 @cindex PowerPC architecture
21667
21668 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
21669 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
21670 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
21671 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
21672 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
21673
21674 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
21675 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
21676 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
21677
21678 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
21679 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
21680
21681 @node Nios II
21682 @subsection Nios II
21683 @cindex Nios II architecture
21684
21685 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
21686 it provides the following special commands:
21687
21688 @table @code
21689
21690 @item set debug nios2
21691 @kindex set debug nios2
21692 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
21693 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21694
21695 @item show debug nios2
21696 @kindex show debug nios2
21697 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
21698 @end table
21699
21700 @node Controlling GDB
21701 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
21702
21703 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
21704 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
21705 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
21706 described here.
21707
21708 @menu
21709 * Prompt:: Prompt
21710 * Editing:: Command editing
21711 * Command History:: Command history
21712 * Screen Size:: Screen size
21713 * Numbers:: Numbers
21714 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
21715 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
21716 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
21717 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
21718 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
21719 @end menu
21720
21721 @node Prompt
21722 @section Prompt
21723
21724 @cindex prompt
21725
21726 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
21727 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
21728 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
21729 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
21730 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
21731 which one you are talking to.
21732
21733 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
21734 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
21735 or a prompt that does not.
21736
21737 @table @code
21738 @kindex set prompt
21739 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
21740 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
21741
21742 @kindex show prompt
21743 @item show prompt
21744 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
21745 @end table
21746
21747 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
21748 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
21749 are:
21750
21751 @table @code
21752 @kindex set extended-prompt
21753 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
21754 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
21755 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
21756 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
21757 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
21758 is displayed.
21759
21760 For example:
21761
21762 @smallexample
21763 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
21764 @end smallexample
21765
21766 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
21767 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
21768
21769 @kindex show extended-prompt
21770 @item show extended-prompt
21771 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
21772 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
21773 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
21774 @end table
21775
21776 @node Editing
21777 @section Command Editing
21778 @cindex readline
21779 @cindex command line editing
21780
21781 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
21782 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
21783 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
21784 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
21785 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
21786 debugging sessions.
21787
21788 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
21789 command @code{set}.
21790
21791 @table @code
21792 @kindex set editing
21793 @cindex editing
21794 @item set editing
21795 @itemx set editing on
21796 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
21797
21798 @item set editing off
21799 Disable command line editing.
21800
21801 @kindex show editing
21802 @item show editing
21803 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
21804 @end table
21805
21806 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21807 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
21808 @end ifset
21809 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21810 @xref{Command Line Editing},
21811 @end ifclear
21812 for more details about the Readline
21813 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
21814 encouraged to read that chapter.
21815
21816 @node Command History
21817 @section Command History
21818 @cindex command history
21819
21820 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
21821 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
21822 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
21823 history facility.
21824
21825 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
21826 package, to provide the history facility.
21827 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21828 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
21829 @end ifset
21830 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21831 @xref{Using History Interactively},
21832 @end ifclear
21833 for the detailed description of the History library.
21834
21835 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
21836 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
21837 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
21838 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
21839 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
21840 pressed on a line by itself.
21841
21842 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
21843 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21844 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21845 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21846
21847 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
21848 history.
21849
21850 @table @code
21851 @cindex history substitution
21852 @cindex history file
21853 @kindex set history filename
21854 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
21855 @item set history filename @var{fname}
21856 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
21857 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
21858 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
21859 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
21860 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
21861 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
21862 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
21863 is not set.
21864
21865 @cindex save command history
21866 @kindex set history save
21867 @item set history save
21868 @itemx set history save on
21869 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
21870 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
21871
21872 @item set history save off
21873 Stop recording command history in a file.
21874
21875 @cindex history size
21876 @kindex set history size
21877 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
21878 @item set history size @var{size}
21879 @itemx set history size unlimited
21880 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
21881 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
21882 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
21883 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
21884 history list is unlimited.
21885 @end table
21886
21887 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
21888 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21889 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
21890 @end ifset
21891 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21892 @xref{Event Designators},
21893 @end ifclear
21894 for more details.
21895
21896 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
21897 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
21898 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
21899 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
21900 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
21901 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
21902 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
21903 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
21904
21905 The commands to control history expansion are:
21906
21907 @table @code
21908 @item set history expansion on
21909 @itemx set history expansion
21910 @kindex set history expansion
21911 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
21912
21913 @item set history expansion off
21914 Disable history expansion.
21915
21916 @c @group
21917 @kindex show history
21918 @item show history
21919 @itemx show history filename
21920 @itemx show history save
21921 @itemx show history size
21922 @itemx show history expansion
21923 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
21924 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
21925 @c @end group
21926 @end table
21927
21928 @table @code
21929 @kindex show commands
21930 @cindex show last commands
21931 @cindex display command history
21932 @item show commands
21933 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
21934
21935 @item show commands @var{n}
21936 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
21937
21938 @item show commands +
21939 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
21940 @end table
21941
21942 @node Screen Size
21943 @section Screen Size
21944 @cindex size of screen
21945 @cindex pauses in output
21946
21947 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
21948 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
21949 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
21950 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
21951 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
21952 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
21953 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
21954 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
21955
21956 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
21957 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
21958 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
21959 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
21960 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
21961 width} commands:
21962
21963 @table @code
21964 @kindex set height
21965 @kindex set width
21966 @kindex show width
21967 @kindex show height
21968 @item set height @var{lpp}
21969 @itemx set height unlimited
21970 @itemx show height
21971 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
21972 @itemx set width unlimited
21973 @itemx show width
21974 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
21975 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
21976 commands display the current settings.
21977
21978 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
21979 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
21980 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
21981 buffer.
21982
21983 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
21984 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
21985
21986 @item set pagination on
21987 @itemx set pagination off
21988 @kindex set pagination
21989 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
21990 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
21991 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
21992 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
21993
21994 @item show pagination
21995 @kindex show pagination
21996 Show the current pagination mode.
21997 @end table
21998
21999 @node Numbers
22000 @section Numbers
22001 @cindex number representation
22002 @cindex entering numbers
22003
22004 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22005 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22006 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22007 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22008 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22009 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22010 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22011 both input and output with the commands described below.
22012
22013 @table @code
22014 @kindex set input-radix
22015 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22016 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22017 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
22018 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22019 example, any of
22020
22021 @smallexample
22022 set input-radix 012
22023 set input-radix 10.
22024 set input-radix 0xa
22025 @end smallexample
22026
22027 @noindent
22028 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22029 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22030 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22031 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22032 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22033 change the radix.
22034
22035 @kindex set output-radix
22036 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22037 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22038 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
22039 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22040
22041 @kindex show input-radix
22042 @item show input-radix
22043 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22044
22045 @kindex show output-radix
22046 @item show output-radix
22047 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22048
22049 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22050 @itemx show radix
22051 @kindex set radix
22052 @kindex show radix
22053 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22054 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22055 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22056 default value of 10.
22057
22058 @end table
22059
22060 @node ABI
22061 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22062
22063 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22064 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22065 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22066 current ABI.
22067
22068 @cindex OS ABI
22069 @kindex set osabi
22070 @kindex show osabi
22071 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22072
22073 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22074 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22075 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22076 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22077 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22078 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22079 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22080 platform provides.
22081
22082 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22083 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22084 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22085 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22086
22087 @table @code
22088 @item show osabi
22089 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22090
22091 @item set osabi
22092 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22093
22094 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22095 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22096 @end table
22097
22098 @cindex float promotion
22099
22100 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22101 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22102 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22103 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22104 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22105 @code{double} and then passed.
22106
22107 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22108 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22109 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22110
22111 @table @code
22112 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22113 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22114 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22115 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22116 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22117
22118 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22119 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22120 functions.
22121
22122 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22123 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22124 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22125 @end table
22126
22127 @kindex set cp-abi
22128 @kindex show cp-abi
22129 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22130 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22131 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22132 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22133 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22134 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22135 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22136 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22137 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22138 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22139 ``auto''.
22140
22141 @table @code
22142 @item show cp-abi
22143 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22144
22145 @item set cp-abi
22146 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22147
22148 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22149 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22150 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22151 @end table
22152
22153 @node Auto-loading
22154 @section Automatically loading associated files
22155 @cindex auto-loading
22156
22157 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22158 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22159 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22160 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22161 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22162 sources).
22163
22164 @menu
22165 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22166 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22167
22168 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22169 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22170 @end menu
22171
22172 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22173 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22174 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22175
22176 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22177 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22178 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22179
22180 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22181 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22182
22183 @table @code
22184 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22185 @kindex set auto-load off
22186 @item set auto-load off
22187 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22188 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22189 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22190 @smallexample
22191 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22192 @end smallexample
22193
22194 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22195 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22196 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22197 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22198 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22199 @code{set auto-load no}.
22200
22201 @anchor{show auto-load}
22202 @kindex show auto-load
22203 @item show auto-load
22204 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22205 or disabled.
22206
22207 @smallexample
22208 (gdb) show auto-load
22209 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22210 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22211 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22212 is on.
22213 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22214 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22215 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22216 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22217 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22218 @end smallexample
22219
22220 @anchor{info auto-load}
22221 @kindex info auto-load
22222 @item info auto-load
22223 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22224 not.
22225
22226 @smallexample
22227 (gdb) info auto-load
22228 gdb-scripts:
22229 Loaded Script
22230 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22231 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22232 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22233 loaded.
22234 python-scripts:
22235 Loaded Script
22236 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22237 @end smallexample
22238 @end table
22239
22240 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22241
22242 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22243 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22244 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22245 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22246 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22247 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22248 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22249 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22250 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22251 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22252 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22253 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22254 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22255 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22256 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22257 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22258 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22259 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22260 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22261 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22262 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22263 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22264 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22265 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22266 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22267 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22268 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22269 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22270 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22271 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22272 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22273 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22274 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22275 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22276 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22277 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22278 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22279 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22280 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22281 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22282 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22283 @end multitable
22284
22285 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22286 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22287 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22288
22289 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22290 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22291 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22292
22293 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22294 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22295
22296 @table @code
22297 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22298 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22299 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22300 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22301 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22302
22303 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22304 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22305 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22306 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22307 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22308
22309 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22310 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22311 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22312 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22313 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22314 @end table
22315
22316 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22317 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22318 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22319
22320 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22321
22322 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22323 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22324
22325 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22326 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22327 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22328 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22329 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22330 library.
22331
22332 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22333 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22334
22335 @table @code
22336 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22337 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22338 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22339 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22340
22341 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22342 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22343 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22344 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22345 enabled or disabled.
22346
22347 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22348 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22349 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22350 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22351 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22352 @end table
22353
22354 @node Auto-loading safe path
22355 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22356 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22357
22358 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22359 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22360 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22361 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22362 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22363
22364 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22365 get loaded:
22366
22367 @smallexample
22368 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
22369 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22370 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22371 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22372 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22373 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22374 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22375 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22376 @end smallexample
22377
22378 @noindent
22379 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22380 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22381
22382 @smallexample
22383 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22384 @end smallexample
22385
22386 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22387
22388 @table @code
22389 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22390 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22391 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22392 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22393 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22394 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22395 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22396 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22397 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22398 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22399
22400 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22401 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22402 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22403
22404 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22405 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22406 @item show auto-load safe-path
22407 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22408 scripts.
22409
22410 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22411 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22412 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22413 Add an entry (or list of entries) the list of directories trusted for automatic
22414 loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited by the
22415 host platform path separator in use.
22416 @end table
22417
22418 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22419 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22420 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22421 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22422 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22423
22424 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22425 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22426 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22427 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22428 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22429 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22430 init file in the current directory
22431 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22432
22433 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22434 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22435
22436 @table @asis
22437 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22438 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22439 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22440 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22441
22442 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22443 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22444 @value{GDBN} session.
22445
22446 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22447 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22448 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22449 from trusted sources.
22450
22451 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22452 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22453 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22454 trusted sources.
22455 @end table
22456
22457 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22458 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22459
22460 @table @asis
22461 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22462 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22463
22464 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
22465 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
22466 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
22467 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
22468 @end table
22469
22470 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
22471 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
22472 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
22473 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
22474 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
22475 recommended to be entered.
22476
22477 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
22478 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
22479 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
22480
22481 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
22482 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
22483 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
22484 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
22485 be printed.
22486
22487 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22488 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
22489 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
22490
22491 @smallexample
22492 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
22493 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
22494 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
22495 for objfile "/tmp/true".
22496 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
22497 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
22498 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
22499 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
22500 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
22501 @end smallexample
22502
22503 @table @code
22504 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
22505 @kindex set debug auto-load
22506 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
22507 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
22508
22509 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
22510 @kindex show debug auto-load
22511 @item show debug auto-load
22512 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
22513 on or off.
22514 @end table
22515
22516 @node Messages/Warnings
22517 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
22518
22519 @cindex verbose operation
22520 @cindex optional warnings
22521 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
22522 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
22523 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
22524 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
22525
22526 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
22527 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
22528 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
22529
22530 @table @code
22531 @kindex set verbose
22532 @item set verbose on
22533 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22534
22535 @item set verbose off
22536 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22537
22538 @kindex show verbose
22539 @item show verbose
22540 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
22541 @end table
22542
22543 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
22544 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
22545 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
22546 Symbol Files}).
22547
22548 @table @code
22549
22550 @kindex set complaints
22551 @item set complaints @var{limit}
22552 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
22553 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
22554 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
22555 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
22556
22557 @kindex show complaints
22558 @item show complaints
22559 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
22560
22561 @end table
22562
22563 @anchor{confirmation requests}
22564 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
22565 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
22566 you try to run a program which is already running:
22567
22568 @smallexample
22569 (@value{GDBP}) run
22570 The program being debugged has been started already.
22571 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
22572 @end smallexample
22573
22574 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
22575 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
22576
22577 @table @code
22578
22579 @kindex set confirm
22580 @cindex flinching
22581 @cindex confirmation
22582 @cindex stupid questions
22583 @item set confirm off
22584 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
22585 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
22586 automatically disables confirmation requests.
22587
22588 @item set confirm on
22589 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
22590
22591 @kindex show confirm
22592 @item show confirm
22593 Displays state of confirmation requests.
22594
22595 @end table
22596
22597 @cindex command tracing
22598 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
22599 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
22600 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
22601 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
22602
22603 @table @code
22604 @kindex set trace-commands
22605 @cindex command scripts, debugging
22606 @item set trace-commands on
22607 Enable command tracing.
22608 @item set trace-commands off
22609 Disable command tracing.
22610 @item show trace-commands
22611 Display the current state of command tracing.
22612 @end table
22613
22614 @node Debugging Output
22615 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
22616 @cindex optional debugging messages
22617
22618 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
22619 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
22620 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
22621 section documents those commands.
22622
22623 @table @code
22624 @kindex set exec-done-display
22625 @item set exec-done-display
22626 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
22627 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
22628 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
22629 @kindex show exec-done-display
22630 @item show exec-done-display
22631 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
22632 notification.
22633 @kindex set debug
22634 @cindex ARM AArch64
22635 @item set debug aarch64
22636 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
22637 The default is off.
22638 @kindex show debug
22639 @item show debug aarch64
22640 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22641 ARM AArch64.
22642 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
22643 @cindex architecture debugging info
22644 @item set debug arch
22645 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
22646 @item show debug arch
22647 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
22648 @item set debug aix-solib
22649 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
22650 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
22651 support module. The default is off.
22652 @item show debug aix-thread
22653 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
22654 @item set debug aix-thread
22655 @cindex AIX threads
22656 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
22657 module.
22658 @item show debug aix-thread
22659 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
22660 @item set debug check-physname
22661 @cindex physname
22662 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
22663 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
22664 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
22665 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
22666 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
22667 both ways and display any discrepancies.
22668 @item show debug check-physname
22669 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
22670 @item set debug coff-pe-read
22671 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
22672 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
22673 exported symbols. The default is off.
22674 @item show debug coff-pe-read
22675 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22676 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22677 @item set debug dwarf2-die
22678 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
22679 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
22680 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
22681 A value of zero turns off the display.
22682 @item show debug dwarf2-die
22683 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
22684 @item set debug dwarf2-read
22685 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
22686 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
22687 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
22688 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22689 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22690 @item show debug dwarf2-read
22691 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
22692 @item set debug displaced
22693 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
22694 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
22695 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
22696 @item show debug displaced
22697 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
22698 related to displaced stepping.
22699 @item set debug event
22700 @cindex event debugging info
22701 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
22702 default is off.
22703 @item show debug event
22704 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
22705 info.
22706 @item set debug expression
22707 @cindex expression debugging info
22708 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
22709 expression parsing. The default is off.
22710 @item show debug expression
22711 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
22712 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
22713 @item set debug frame
22714 @cindex frame debugging info
22715 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
22716 default is off.
22717 @item show debug frame
22718 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
22719 info.
22720 @item set debug gnu-nat
22721 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
22722 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
22723 @item show debug gnu-nat
22724 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
22725 @item set debug infrun
22726 @cindex inferior debugging info
22727 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
22728 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
22729 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
22730 @item show debug infrun
22731 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
22732 @item set debug jit
22733 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
22734 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
22735 @item show debug jit
22736 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
22737 @item set debug lin-lwp
22738 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
22739 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
22740 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
22741 @item show debug lin-lwp
22742 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
22743 @item set debug mach-o
22744 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
22745 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
22746 processing. The default is off.
22747 @item show debug mach-o
22748 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22749 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22750 @item set debug notification
22751 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
22752 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
22753 The default is off.
22754 @item show debug notification
22755 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
22756 @item set debug observer
22757 @cindex observer debugging info
22758 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
22759 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
22760 @item show debug observer
22761 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
22762 @item set debug overload
22763 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
22764 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
22765 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
22766 is off.
22767 @item show debug overload
22768 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
22769 debugging info.
22770 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
22771 @cindex debug expression parser
22772 @item set debug parser
22773 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
22774 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
22775 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
22776 details. The default is off.
22777 @item show debug parser
22778 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
22779 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
22780 @cindex serial connections, debugging
22781 @cindex debug remote protocol
22782 @cindex remote protocol debugging
22783 @cindex display remote packets
22784 @item set debug remote
22785 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
22786 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
22787 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
22788 @item show debug remote
22789 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
22790 @item set debug serial
22791 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
22792 default is off.
22793 @item show debug serial
22794 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
22795 info.
22796 @item set debug solib-frv
22797 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
22798 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
22799 @item show debug solib-frv
22800 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
22801 messages.
22802 @item set debug symfile
22803 @cindex symbol file functions
22804 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
22805 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
22806 @item show debug symfile
22807 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
22808 @item set debug symtab-create
22809 @cindex symbol table creation
22810 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
22811 The default is 0 (off).
22812 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22813 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22814 @item show debug symtab-create
22815 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
22816 @item set debug target
22817 @cindex target debugging info
22818 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
22819 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
22820 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
22821 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
22822 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
22823 @item show debug target
22824 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
22825 info.
22826 @item set debug timestamp
22827 @cindex timestampping debugging info
22828 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
22829 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
22830 message.
22831 @item show debug timestamp
22832 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
22833 debugging info.
22834 @item set debugvarobj
22835 @cindex variable object debugging info
22836 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
22837 info. The default is off.
22838 @item show debugvarobj
22839 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
22840 debugging info.
22841 @item set debug xml
22842 @cindex XML parser debugging
22843 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
22844 @item show debug xml
22845 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
22846 @end table
22847
22848 @node Other Misc Settings
22849 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
22850 @cindex miscellaneous settings
22851
22852 @table @code
22853 @kindex set interactive-mode
22854 @item set interactive-mode
22855 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
22856 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
22857 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
22858 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
22859 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
22860 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
22861 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
22862 is, non-interactively otherwise.
22863
22864 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
22865 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
22866 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
22867 inside a cygwin window.
22868
22869 @kindex show interactive-mode
22870 @item show interactive-mode
22871 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
22872 @end table
22873
22874 @node Extending GDB
22875 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
22876 @cindex extending GDB
22877
22878 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
22879 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
22880 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
22881 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
22882 being debugged.
22883
22884 @menu
22885 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
22886 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
22887 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
22888 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
22889 @end menu
22890
22891 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
22892 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
22893 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
22894 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
22895 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22896 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
22897
22898 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
22899 setting:
22900
22901 @table @code
22902 @kindex set script-extension
22903 @kindex show script-extension
22904 @item set script-extension off
22905 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
22906
22907 @item set script-extension soft
22908 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
22909 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
22910 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
22911 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
22912
22913 @item set script-extension strict
22914 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
22915 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
22916 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
22917
22918 @item show script-extension
22919 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
22920
22921 @end table
22922
22923 @node Sequences
22924 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
22925
22926 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
22927 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
22928 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
22929 files.
22930
22931 @menu
22932 * Define:: How to define your own commands
22933 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
22934 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
22935 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
22936 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
22937 @end menu
22938
22939 @node Define
22940 @subsection User-defined Commands
22941
22942 @cindex user-defined command
22943 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
22944 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
22945 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
22946 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
22947 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
22948 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
22949
22950 @smallexample
22951 define adder
22952 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
22953 end
22954 @end smallexample
22955
22956 @noindent
22957 To execute the command use:
22958
22959 @smallexample
22960 adder 1 2 3
22961 @end smallexample
22962
22963 @noindent
22964 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
22965 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
22966 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
22967 functions calls.
22968
22969 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
22970 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
22971 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
22972 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
22973
22974 @smallexample
22975 define adder
22976 if $argc == 2
22977 print $arg0 + $arg1
22978 end
22979 if $argc == 3
22980 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
22981 end
22982 end
22983 @end smallexample
22984
22985 @table @code
22986
22987 @kindex define
22988 @item define @var{commandname}
22989 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
22990 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
22991 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
22992 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
22993 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
22994 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
22995
22996 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
22997 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
22998 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
22999
23000 @kindex document
23001 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23002 @item document @var{commandname}
23003 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23004 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23005 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23006 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23007 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23008 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23009
23010 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23011 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23012 does not change the documentation.
23013
23014 @kindex dont-repeat
23015 @cindex don't repeat command
23016 @item dont-repeat
23017 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23018 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23019 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23020
23021 @kindex help user-defined
23022 @item help user-defined
23023 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23024 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23025 included (if any).
23026
23027 @kindex show user
23028 @item show user
23029 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23030 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23031 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23032 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23033 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23034
23035 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23036 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23037 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23038 @item show max-user-call-depth
23039 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23040 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23041 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23042 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23043 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23044 @end table
23045
23046 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23047 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23048
23049 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23050 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23051 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23052
23053 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23054 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23055 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23056 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23057
23058 @node Hooks
23059 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23060 @cindex command hooks
23061 @cindex hooks, for commands
23062 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23063
23064 @kindex hook
23065 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23066 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23067 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23068 before that command.
23069
23070 @cindex hooks, post-command
23071 @kindex hookpost
23072 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23073 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23074 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23075 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23076 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23077
23078 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23079 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23080
23081 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23082 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23083
23084 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23085 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23086 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23087 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23088 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23089
23090 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23091 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23092 you could define:
23093
23094 @smallexample
23095 define hook-stop
23096 handle SIGALRM nopass
23097 end
23098
23099 define hook-run
23100 handle SIGALRM pass
23101 end
23102
23103 define hook-continue
23104 handle SIGALRM pass
23105 end
23106 @end smallexample
23107
23108 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23109 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23110 you could define:
23111
23112 @smallexample
23113 define hook-echo
23114 echo <<<---
23115 end
23116
23117 define hookpost-echo
23118 echo --->>>\n
23119 end
23120
23121 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23122 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23123 (@value{GDBP})
23124
23125 @end smallexample
23126
23127 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23128 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23129 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23130 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23131 @c or not?
23132 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23133 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23134 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23135
23136 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23137 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23138 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23139
23140 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23141 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23142
23143 @node Command Files
23144 @subsection Command Files
23145
23146 @cindex command files
23147 @cindex scripting commands
23148 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23149 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23150 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23151 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23152 terminal.
23153
23154 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23155 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23156 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23157 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23158 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23159
23160 @table @code
23161 @kindex source
23162 @cindex execute commands from a file
23163 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23164 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23165 @end table
23166
23167 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23168 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23169 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23170 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23171 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23172
23173 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23174 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23175 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23176 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23177 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23178 is not relevant to scripts.
23179
23180 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23181 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23182 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23183 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23184 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23185 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23186 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23187 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23188 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23189 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23190 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23191 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23192 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23193 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23194
23195 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23196 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23197 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23198
23199 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23200 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23201 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23202 when called from command files.
23203
23204 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23205 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23206 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23207 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23208 the next command.
23209
23210 @smallexample
23211 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23212 @end smallexample
23213
23214 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23215 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23216 would be directed to @file{log}.
23217
23218 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23219 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23220 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23221 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23222 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23223 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23224 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23225 conditionally, etc.
23226
23227 @table @code
23228 @kindex if
23229 @kindex else
23230 @item if
23231 @itemx else
23232 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23233 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23234 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23235 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23236 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23237 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23238 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23239
23240 @kindex while
23241 @item while
23242 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23243 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23244 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23245 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23246 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23247 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23248
23249 @kindex loop_break
23250 @item loop_break
23251 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23252 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23253 line.
23254
23255 @kindex loop_continue
23256 @item loop_continue
23257 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23258 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23259 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23260 the controlling expression.
23261
23262 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23263 @item end
23264 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23265 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23266 @end table
23267
23268
23269 @node Output
23270 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23271
23272 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23273 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23274 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23275 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23276 want.
23277
23278 @table @code
23279 @kindex echo
23280 @item echo @var{text}
23281 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23282 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23283 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23284 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23285 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23286 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23287 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23288 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23289 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23290 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23291 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23292
23293 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23294 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23295
23296 @smallexample
23297 echo This is some text\n\
23298 which is continued\n\
23299 onto several lines.\n
23300 @end smallexample
23301
23302 produces the same output as
23303
23304 @smallexample
23305 echo This is some text\n
23306 echo which is continued\n
23307 echo onto several lines.\n
23308 @end smallexample
23309
23310 @kindex output
23311 @item output @var{expression}
23312 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23313 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23314 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23315 on expressions.
23316
23317 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23318 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23319 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23320 Formats}, for more information.
23321
23322 @kindex printf
23323 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23324 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23325 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23326 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23327 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23328 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23329 executing the code below:
23330
23331 @smallexample
23332 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23333 @end smallexample
23334
23335 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23336 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23337 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23338 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23339 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23340 printed.
23341
23342 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23343
23344 @smallexample
23345 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23346 @end smallexample
23347
23348 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23349 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23350 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23351
23352 @itemize @bullet
23353 @item
23354 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23355
23356 @item
23357 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23358 width.
23359
23360 @item
23361 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23362 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23363
23364 @item
23365 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23366 supported.
23367
23368 @item
23369 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23370
23371 @item
23372 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23373 @end itemize
23374
23375 @noindent
23376 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23377 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23378 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23379 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23380
23381 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23382 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23383 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23384 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23385 supported.
23386
23387 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23388 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23389 together with a floating point specifier.
23390 letters:
23391
23392 @itemize @bullet
23393 @item
23394 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23395
23396 @item
23397 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23398
23399 @item
23400 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23401 @end itemize
23402
23403 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23404 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23405 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23406
23407 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23408 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23409
23410 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23411 @smallexample
23412 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23413 @end smallexample
23414
23415 @kindex eval
23416 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23417 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23418 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23419
23420 @end table
23421
23422 @node Auto-loading sequences
23423 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
23424 @cindex native script auto-loading
23425
23426 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23427 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23428 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
23429 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23430
23431 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23432 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23433
23434 @table @code
23435 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
23436 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
23437 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
23438 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
23439
23440 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
23441 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
23442 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
23443 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
23444 disabled.
23445
23446 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
23447 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
23448 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
23449 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
23450 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
23451 auto-loaded.
23452 @end table
23453
23454 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
23455 matching names are printed.
23456
23457 @node Python
23458 @section Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23459 @cindex python scripting
23460 @cindex scripting with python
23461
23462 You can extend @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
23463 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
23464 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
23465
23466 @cindex python directory
23467 Python scripts used by @value{GDBN} should be installed in
23468 @file{@var{data-directory}/python}, where @var{data-directory} is
23469 the data directory as determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).
23470 This directory, known as the @dfn{python directory},
23471 is automatically added to the Python Search Path in order to allow
23472 the Python interpreter to locate all scripts installed at this location.
23473
23474 Additionally, @value{GDBN} commands and convenience functions which
23475 are written in Python and are located in the
23476 @file{@var{data-directory}/python/gdb/command} or
23477 @file{@var{data-directory}/python/gdb/function} directories are
23478 automatically imported when @value{GDBN} starts.
23479
23480 @menu
23481 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
23482 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
23483 * Python Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
23484 * Python modules:: Python modules provided by @value{GDBN}.
23485 @end menu
23486
23487 @node Python Commands
23488 @subsection Python Commands
23489 @cindex python commands
23490 @cindex commands to access python
23491
23492 @value{GDBN} provides two commands for accessing the Python interpreter,
23493 and one related setting:
23494
23495 @table @code
23496 @kindex python-interactive
23497 @kindex pi
23498 @item python-interactive @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
23499 @itemx pi @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
23500 Without an argument, the @code{python-interactive} command can be used
23501 to start an interactive Python prompt. To return to @value{GDBN},
23502 type the @code{EOF} character (e.g., @kbd{Ctrl-D} on an empty prompt).
23503
23504 Alternatively, a single-line Python command can be given as an
23505 argument and evaluated. If the command is an expression, the result
23506 will be printed; otherwise, nothing will be printed. For example:
23507
23508 @smallexample
23509 (@value{GDBP}) python-interactive 2 + 3
23510 5
23511 @end smallexample
23512
23513 @kindex python
23514 @kindex py
23515 @item python @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
23516 @itemx py @r{[}@var{command}@r{]}
23517 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
23518
23519 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
23520 argument as a Python command. For example:
23521
23522 @smallexample
23523 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
23524 23
23525 @end smallexample
23526
23527 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
23528 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
23529 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
23530 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
23531 containing @code{end}. For example:
23532
23533 @smallexample
23534 (@value{GDBP}) python
23535 Type python script
23536 End with a line saying just "end".
23537 >print 23
23538 >end
23539 23
23540 @end smallexample
23541
23542 @kindex set python print-stack
23543 @item set python print-stack
23544 By default, @value{GDBN} will print only the message component of a
23545 Python exception when an error occurs in a Python script. This can be
23546 controlled using @code{set python print-stack}: if @code{full}, then
23547 full Python stack printing is enabled; if @code{none}, then Python stack
23548 and message printing is disabled; if @code{message}, the default, only
23549 the message component of the error is printed.
23550 @end table
23551
23552 It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
23553 interpreter:
23554
23555 @table @code
23556 @item source @file{script-name}
23557 The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
23558 to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
23559 the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
23560
23561 @item python execfile ("script-name")
23562 This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
23563 and thus is always available.
23564 @end table
23565
23566 @node Python API
23567 @subsection Python API
23568 @cindex python api
23569 @cindex programming in python
23570
23571 You can get quick online help for @value{GDBN}'s Python API by issuing
23572 the command @w{@kbd{python help (gdb)}}.
23573
23574 Functions and methods which have two or more optional arguments allow
23575 them to be specified using keyword syntax. This allows passing some
23576 optional arguments while skipping others. Example:
23577 @w{@code{gdb.some_function ('foo', bar = 1, baz = 2)}}.
23578
23579 @menu
23580 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
23581 * Exception Handling:: How Python exceptions are translated.
23582 * Values From Inferior:: Python representation of values.
23583 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
23584 * Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
23585 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
23586 * Writing a Pretty-Printer:: Writing a Pretty-Printer.
23587 * Type Printing API:: Pretty-printing types.
23588 * Frame Filter API:: Filtering Frames.
23589 * Frame Decorator API:: Decorating Frames.
23590 * Writing a Frame Filter:: Writing a Frame Filter.
23591 * Inferiors In Python:: Python representation of inferiors (processes)
23592 * Events In Python:: Listening for events from @value{GDBN}.
23593 * Threads In Python:: Accessing inferior threads from Python.
23594 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
23595 * Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
23596 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
23597 * Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
23598 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
23599 * Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
23600 * Blocks In Python:: Accessing blocks from Python.
23601 * Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
23602 * Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
23603 * Line Tables In Python:: Python representation of line tables.
23604 * Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
23605 * Finish Breakpoints in Python:: Setting Breakpoints on function return
23606 using Python.
23607 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
23608 * Architectures In Python:: Python representation of architectures.
23609 @end menu
23610
23611 @node Basic Python
23612 @subsubsection Basic Python
23613
23614 @cindex python stdout
23615 @cindex python pagination
23616 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
23617 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
23618 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
23619 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
23620 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
23621
23622 Some care must be taken when writing Python code to run in
23623 @value{GDBN}. Two things worth noting in particular:
23624
23625 @itemize @bullet
23626 @item
23627 @value{GDBN} install handlers for @code{SIGCHLD} and @code{SIGINT}.
23628 Python code must not override these, or even change the options using
23629 @code{sigaction}. If your program changes the handling of these
23630 signals, @value{GDBN} will most likely stop working correctly. Note
23631 that it is unfortunately common for GUI toolkits to install a
23632 @code{SIGCHLD} handler.
23633
23634 @item
23635 @value{GDBN} takes care to mark its internal file descriptors as
23636 close-on-exec. However, this cannot be done in a thread-safe way on
23637 all platforms. Your Python programs should be aware of this and
23638 should both create new file descriptors with the close-on-exec flag
23639 set and arrange to close unneeded file descriptors before starting a
23640 child process.
23641 @end itemize
23642
23643 @cindex python functions
23644 @cindex python module
23645 @cindex gdb module
23646 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
23647 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
23648 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
23649 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
23650
23651 @findex gdb.PYTHONDIR
23652 @defvar gdb.PYTHONDIR
23653 A string containing the python directory (@pxref{Python}).
23654 @end defvar
23655
23656 @findex gdb.execute
23657 @defun gdb.execute (command @r{[}, from_tty @r{[}, to_string@r{]]})
23658 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
23659 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
23660 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
23661
23662 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
23663 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
23664 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
23665
23666 By default, any output produced by @var{command} is sent to
23667 @value{GDBN}'s standard output. If the @var{to_string} parameter is
23668 @code{True}, then output will be collected by @code{gdb.execute} and
23669 returned as a string. The default is @code{False}, in which case the
23670 return value is @code{None}. If @var{to_string} is @code{True}, the
23671 @value{GDBN} virtual terminal will be temporarily set to unlimited width
23672 and height, and its pagination will be disabled; @pxref{Screen Size}.
23673 @end defun
23674
23675 @findex gdb.breakpoints
23676 @defun gdb.breakpoints ()
23677 Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
23678 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
23679 @end defun
23680
23681 @findex gdb.parameter
23682 @defun gdb.parameter (parameter)
23683 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
23684 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
23685 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
23686 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
23687
23688 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
23689 @code{gdb.error} (@pxref{Exception Handling}). Otherwise, the
23690 parameter's value is converted to a Python value of the appropriate
23691 type, and returned.
23692 @end defun
23693
23694 @findex gdb.history
23695 @defun gdb.history (number)
23696 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
23697 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
23698 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
23699 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
23700 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
23701 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
23702 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{gdb.error} exception will be
23703 raised.
23704
23705 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
23706 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
23707 @end defun
23708
23709 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
23710 @defun gdb.parse_and_eval (expression)
23711 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
23712 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
23713 @var{expression} must be a string.
23714
23715 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
23716 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
23717 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
23718 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
23719 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
23720 @end defun
23721
23722 @findex gdb.find_pc_line
23723 @defun gdb.find_pc_line (pc)
23724 Return the @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object corresponding to the
23725 @var{pc} value. @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}. If an invalid
23726 value of @var{pc} is passed as an argument, then the @code{symtab} and
23727 @code{line} attributes of the returned @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object
23728 will be @code{None} and 0 respectively.
23729 @end defun
23730
23731 @findex gdb.post_event
23732 @defun gdb.post_event (event)
23733 Put @var{event}, a callable object taking no arguments, into
23734 @value{GDBN}'s internal event queue. This callable will be invoked at
23735 some later point, during @value{GDBN}'s event processing. Events
23736 posted using @code{post_event} will be run in the order in which they
23737 were posted; however, there is no way to know when they will be
23738 processed relative to other events inside @value{GDBN}.
23739
23740 @value{GDBN} is not thread-safe. If your Python program uses multiple
23741 threads, you must be careful to only call @value{GDBN}-specific
23742 functions in the main @value{GDBN} thread. @code{post_event} ensures
23743 this. For example:
23744
23745 @smallexample
23746 (@value{GDBP}) python
23747 >import threading
23748 >
23749 >class Writer():
23750 > def __init__(self, message):
23751 > self.message = message;
23752 > def __call__(self):
23753 > gdb.write(self.message)
23754 >
23755 >class MyThread1 (threading.Thread):
23756 > def run (self):
23757 > gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello "))
23758 >
23759 >class MyThread2 (threading.Thread):
23760 > def run (self):
23761 > gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n"))
23762 >
23763 >MyThread1().start()
23764 >MyThread2().start()
23765 >end
23766 (@value{GDBP}) Hello World
23767 @end smallexample
23768 @end defun
23769
23770 @findex gdb.write
23771 @defun gdb.write (string @r{[}, stream{]})
23772 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated output stream. The
23773 optional @var{stream} determines the stream to print to. The default
23774 stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible stream
23775 values are:
23776
23777 @table @code
23778 @findex STDOUT
23779 @findex gdb.STDOUT
23780 @item gdb.STDOUT
23781 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
23782
23783 @findex STDERR
23784 @findex gdb.STDERR
23785 @item gdb.STDERR
23786 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
23787
23788 @findex STDLOG
23789 @findex gdb.STDLOG
23790 @item gdb.STDLOG
23791 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
23792 @end table
23793
23794 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
23795 call this function and will automatically direct the output to the
23796 relevant stream.
23797 @end defun
23798
23799 @findex gdb.flush
23800 @defun gdb.flush ()
23801 Flush the buffer of a @value{GDBN} paginated stream so that the
23802 contents are displayed immediately. @value{GDBN} will flush the
23803 contents of a stream automatically when it encounters a newline in the
23804 buffer. The optional @var{stream} determines the stream to flush. The
23805 default stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible
23806 stream values are:
23807
23808 @table @code
23809 @findex STDOUT
23810 @findex gdb.STDOUT
23811 @item gdb.STDOUT
23812 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
23813
23814 @findex STDERR
23815 @findex gdb.STDERR
23816 @item gdb.STDERR
23817 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
23818
23819 @findex STDLOG
23820 @findex gdb.STDLOG
23821 @item gdb.STDLOG
23822 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
23823
23824 @end table
23825
23826 Flushing @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
23827 call this function for the relevant stream.
23828 @end defun
23829
23830 @findex gdb.target_charset
23831 @defun gdb.target_charset ()
23832 Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
23833 Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
23834 that @samp{auto} is never returned.
23835 @end defun
23836
23837 @findex gdb.target_wide_charset
23838 @defun gdb.target_wide_charset ()
23839 Return the name of the current target wide character set
23840 (@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
23841 @code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
23842 never returned.
23843 @end defun
23844
23845 @findex gdb.solib_name
23846 @defun gdb.solib_name (address)
23847 Return the name of the shared library holding the given @var{address}
23848 as a string, or @code{None}.
23849 @end defun
23850
23851 @findex gdb.decode_line
23852 @defun gdb.decode_line @r{[}expression@r{]}
23853 Return locations of the line specified by @var{expression}, or of the
23854 current line if no argument was given. This function returns a Python
23855 tuple containing two elements. The first element contains a string
23856 holding any unparsed section of @var{expression} (or @code{None} if
23857 the expression has been fully parsed). The second element contains
23858 either @code{None} or another tuple that contains all the locations
23859 that match the expression represented as @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line}
23860 objects (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}). If @var{expression} is
23861 provided, it is decoded the way that @value{GDBN}'s inbuilt
23862 @code{break} or @code{edit} commands do (@pxref{Specify Location}).
23863 @end defun
23864
23865 @defun gdb.prompt_hook (current_prompt)
23866 @anchor{prompt_hook}
23867
23868 If @var{prompt_hook} is callable, @value{GDBN} will call the method
23869 assigned to this operation before a prompt is displayed by
23870 @value{GDBN}.
23871
23872 The parameter @code{current_prompt} contains the current @value{GDBN}
23873 prompt. This method must return a Python string, or @code{None}. If
23874 a string is returned, the @value{GDBN} prompt will be set to that
23875 string. If @code{None} is returned, @value{GDBN} will continue to use
23876 the current prompt.
23877
23878 Some prompts cannot be substituted in @value{GDBN}. Secondary prompts
23879 such as those used by readline for command input, and annotation
23880 related prompts are prohibited from being changed.
23881 @end defun
23882
23883 @node Exception Handling
23884 @subsubsection Exception Handling
23885 @cindex python exceptions
23886 @cindex exceptions, python
23887
23888 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
23889 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
23890 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
23891 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
23892 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
23893 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
23894 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
23895
23896 @smallexample
23897 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
23898 Traceback (most recent call last):
23899 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
23900 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
23901 @end smallexample
23902
23903 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by
23904 Python code are converted to Python exceptions. The type of the
23905 Python exception depends on the error.
23906
23907 @ftable @code
23908 @item gdb.error
23909 This is the base class for most exceptions generated by @value{GDBN}.
23910 It is derived from @code{RuntimeError}, for compatibility with earlier
23911 versions of @value{GDBN}.
23912
23913 If an error occurring in @value{GDBN} does not fit into some more
23914 specific category, then the generated exception will have this type.
23915
23916 @item gdb.MemoryError
23917 This is a subclass of @code{gdb.error} which is thrown when an
23918 operation tried to access invalid memory in the inferior.
23919
23920 @item KeyboardInterrupt
23921 User interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
23922 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception.
23923 @end ftable
23924
23925 In all cases, your exception handler will see the @value{GDBN} error
23926 message as its value and the Python call stack backtrace at the Python
23927 statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
23928 traceback.
23929
23930 @findex gdb.GdbError
23931 When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
23932 it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
23933 traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
23934 command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
23935 to handle this case. Example:
23936
23937 @smallexample
23938 (gdb) python
23939 >class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
23940 > """Greet the whole world."""
23941 > def __init__ (self):
23942 > super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_USER)
23943 > def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
23944 > argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
23945 > if len (argv) != 0:
23946 > raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
23947 > print "Hello, World!"
23948 >HelloWorld ()
23949 >end
23950 (gdb) hello-world 42
23951 hello-world takes no arguments
23952 @end smallexample
23953
23954 @node Values From Inferior
23955 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
23956 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
23957 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
23958
23959 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
23960 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
23961 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
23962 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
23963 fetching values when necessary.
23964
23965 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
23966 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
23967 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
23968
23969 @smallexample
23970 bar = some_val + 2
23971 @end smallexample
23972
23973 @noindent
23974 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
23975 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
23976
23977 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
23978 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
23979 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
23980 can access its @code{foo} element with:
23981
23982 @smallexample
23983 bar = some_val['foo']
23984 @end smallexample
23985
23986 @cindex getting structure elements using gdb.Field objects as subscripts
23987 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object. Structure
23988 elements can also be accessed by using @code{gdb.Field} objects as
23989 subscripts (@pxref{Types In Python}, for more information on
23990 @code{gdb.Field} objects). For example, if @code{foo_field} is a
23991 @code{gdb.Field} object corresponding to element @code{foo} of the above
23992 structure, then @code{bar} can also be accessed as follows:
23993
23994 @smallexample
23995 bar = some_val[foo_field]
23996 @end smallexample
23997
23998 A @code{gdb.Value} that represents a function can be executed via
23999 inferior function call. Any arguments provided to the call must match
24000 the function's prototype, and must be provided in the order specified
24001 by that prototype.
24002
24003 For example, @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance
24004 representing a function that takes two integers as arguments. To
24005 execute this function, call it like so:
24006
24007 @smallexample
24008 result = some_val (10,20)
24009 @end smallexample
24010
24011 Any values returned from a function call will be stored as a
24012 @code{gdb.Value}.
24013
24014 The following attributes are provided:
24015
24016 @defvar Value.address
24017 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
24018 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
24019 this attribute holds @code{None}.
24020 @end defvar
24021
24022 @cindex optimized out value in Python
24023 @defvar Value.is_optimized_out
24024 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
24025 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
24026 @end defvar
24027
24028 @defvar Value.type
24029 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
24030 @code{gdb.Type} object (@pxref{Types In Python}).
24031 @end defvar
24032
24033 @defvar Value.dynamic_type
24034 The dynamic type of this @code{gdb.Value}. This uses C@t{++} run-time
24035 type information (@acronym{RTTI}) to determine the dynamic type of the
24036 value. If this value is of class type, it will return the class in
24037 which the value is embedded, if any. If this value is of pointer or
24038 reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type of the
24039 referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type,
24040 respectively. In all other cases, it will return the value's static
24041 type.
24042
24043 Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C@t{++} program
24044 that includes @acronym{RTTI} for the object in question. Otherwise,
24045 it will just return the static type of the value as in @kbd{ptype foo}
24046 (@pxref{Symbols, ptype}).
24047 @end defvar
24048
24049 @defvar Value.is_lazy
24050 The value of this read-only boolean attribute is @code{True} if this
24051 @code{gdb.Value} has not yet been fetched from the inferior.
24052 @value{GDBN} does not fetch values until necessary, for efficiency.
24053 For example:
24054
24055 @smallexample
24056 myval = gdb.parse_and_eval ('somevar')
24057 @end smallexample
24058
24059 The value of @code{somevar} is not fetched at this time. It will be
24060 fetched when the value is needed, or when the @code{fetch_lazy}
24061 method is invoked.
24062 @end defvar
24063
24064 The following methods are provided:
24065
24066 @defun Value.__init__ (@var{val})
24067 Many Python values can be converted directly to a @code{gdb.Value} via
24068 this object initializer. Specifically:
24069
24070 @table @asis
24071 @item Python boolean
24072 A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current
24073 language.
24074
24075 @item Python integer
24076 A Python integer is converted to the C @code{long} type for the
24077 current architecture.
24078
24079 @item Python long
24080 A Python long is converted to the C @code{long long} type for the
24081 current architecture.
24082
24083 @item Python float
24084 A Python float is converted to the C @code{double} type for the
24085 current architecture.
24086
24087 @item Python string
24088 A Python string is converted to a target string, using the current
24089 target encoding.
24090
24091 @item @code{gdb.Value}
24092 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.Value}, then a copy of the value is made.
24093
24094 @item @code{gdb.LazyString}
24095 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings In
24096 Python}), then the lazy string's @code{value} method is called, and
24097 its result is used.
24098 @end table
24099 @end defun
24100
24101 @defun Value.cast (type)
24102 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
24103 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
24104 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
24105 reason, this method throws an exception.
24106 @end defun
24107
24108 @defun Value.dereference ()
24109 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
24110 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
24111 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
24112
24113 @smallexample
24114 int *foo;
24115 @end smallexample
24116
24117 @noindent
24118 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
24119 @code{foo} points to like this:
24120
24121 @smallexample
24122 bar = foo.dereference ()
24123 @end smallexample
24124
24125 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
24126 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
24127
24128 A similar function @code{Value.referenced_value} exists which also
24129 returns @code{gdb.Value} objects corresonding to the values pointed to
24130 by pointer values (and additionally, values referenced by reference
24131 values). However, the behavior of @code{Value.dereference}
24132 differs from @code{Value.referenced_value} by the fact that the
24133 behavior of @code{Value.dereference} is identical to applying the C
24134 unary operator @code{*} on a given value. For example, consider a
24135 reference to a pointer @code{ptrref}, declared in your C@t{++} program
24136 as
24137
24138 @smallexample
24139 typedef int *intptr;
24140 ...
24141 int val = 10;
24142 intptr ptr = &val;
24143 intptr &ptrref = ptr;
24144 @end smallexample
24145
24146 Though @code{ptrref} is a reference value, one can apply the method
24147 @code{Value.dereference} to the @code{gdb.Value} object corresponding
24148 to it and obtain a @code{gdb.Value} which is identical to that
24149 corresponding to @code{val}. However, if you apply the method
24150 @code{Value.referenced_value}, the result would be a @code{gdb.Value}
24151 object identical to that corresponding to @code{ptr}.
24152
24153 @smallexample
24154 py_ptrref = gdb.parse_and_eval ("ptrref")
24155 py_val = py_ptrref.dereference ()
24156 py_ptr = py_ptrref.referenced_value ()
24157 @end smallexample
24158
24159 The @code{gdb.Value} object @code{py_val} is identical to that
24160 corresponding to @code{val}, and @code{py_ptr} is identical to that
24161 corresponding to @code{ptr}. In general, @code{Value.dereference} can
24162 be applied whenever the C unary operator @code{*} can be applied
24163 to the corresponding C value. For those cases where applying both
24164 @code{Value.dereference} and @code{Value.referenced_value} is allowed,
24165 the results obtained need not be identical (as we have seen in the above
24166 example). The results are however identical when applied on
24167 @code{gdb.Value} objects corresponding to pointers (@code{gdb.Value}
24168 objects with type code @code{TYPE_CODE_PTR}) in a C/C@t{++} program.
24169 @end defun
24170
24171 @defun Value.referenced_value ()
24172 For pointer or reference data types, this method returns a new
24173 @code{gdb.Value} object corresponding to the value referenced by the
24174 pointer/reference value. For pointer data types,
24175 @code{Value.dereference} and @code{Value.referenced_value} produce
24176 identical results. The difference between these methods is that
24177 @code{Value.dereference} cannot get the values referenced by reference
24178 values. For example, consider a reference to an @code{int}, declared
24179 in your C@t{++} program as
24180
24181 @smallexample
24182 int val = 10;
24183 int &ref = val;
24184 @end smallexample
24185
24186 @noindent
24187 then applying @code{Value.dereference} to the @code{gdb.Value} object
24188 corresponding to @code{ref} will result in an error, while applying
24189 @code{Value.referenced_value} will result in a @code{gdb.Value} object
24190 identical to that corresponding to @code{val}.
24191
24192 @smallexample
24193 py_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval ("ref")
24194 er_ref = py_ref.dereference () # Results in error
24195 py_val = py_ref.referenced_value () # Returns the referenced value
24196 @end smallexample
24197
24198 The @code{gdb.Value} object @code{py_val} is identical to that
24199 corresponding to @code{val}.
24200 @end defun
24201
24202 @defun Value.dynamic_cast (type)
24203 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{dynamic_cast}
24204 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
24205 @end defun
24206
24207 @defun Value.reinterpret_cast (type)
24208 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{reinterpret_cast}
24209 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
24210 @end defun
24211
24212 @defun Value.string (@r{[}encoding@r{[}, errors@r{[}, length@r{]]]})
24213 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
24214 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
24215 throw an exception.
24216
24217 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
24218 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
24219 language.
24220
24221 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
24222 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
24223 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
24224 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
24225 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
24226
24227 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
24228 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
24229 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
24230 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
24231 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
24232 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
24233 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
24234 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
24235 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
24236
24237 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
24238 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
24239
24240 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
24241 fetched and converted to the given length.
24242 @end defun
24243
24244 @defun Value.lazy_string (@r{[}encoding @r{[}, length@r{]]})
24245 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
24246 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
24247 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
24248
24249 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
24250 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
24251 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
24252 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
24253 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
24254
24255 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
24256 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
24257 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
24258 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
24259 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
24260 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
24261
24262 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
24263 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
24264 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
24265 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
24266 @end defun
24267
24268 @defun Value.fetch_lazy ()
24269 If the @code{gdb.Value} object is currently a lazy value
24270 (@code{gdb.Value.is_lazy} is @code{True}), then the value is
24271 fetched from the inferior. Any errors that occur in the process
24272 will produce a Python exception.
24273
24274 If the @code{gdb.Value} object is not a lazy value, this method
24275 has no effect.
24276
24277 This method does not return a value.
24278 @end defun
24279
24280
24281 @node Types In Python
24282 @subsubsection Types In Python
24283 @cindex types in Python
24284 @cindex Python, working with types
24285
24286 @tindex gdb.Type
24287 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
24288 @code{gdb.Type}.
24289
24290 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
24291 module:
24292
24293 @findex gdb.lookup_type
24294 @defun gdb.lookup_type (name @r{[}, block@r{]})
24295 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
24296 type to look up. It must be a string.
24297
24298 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
24299 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
24300
24301 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
24302 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
24303 @end defun
24304
24305 If the type is a structure or class type, or an enum type, the fields
24306 of that type can be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}.
24307 For example, if @code{some_type} is a @code{gdb.Type} instance holding
24308 a structure type, you can access its @code{foo} field with:
24309
24310 @smallexample
24311 bar = some_type['foo']
24312 @end smallexample
24313
24314 @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Field} object; see below under the
24315 description of the @code{Type.fields} method for a description of the
24316 @code{gdb.Field} class.
24317
24318 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
24319
24320 @defvar Type.code
24321 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
24322 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
24323 @end defvar
24324
24325 @defvar Type.name
24326 The name of this type. If this type has no name, then @code{None}
24327 is returned.
24328 @end defvar
24329
24330 @defvar Type.sizeof
24331 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
24332 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
24333 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
24334 @end defvar
24335
24336 @defvar Type.tag
24337 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
24338 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
24339 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
24340 @code{None} is returned.
24341 @end defvar
24342
24343 The following methods are provided:
24344
24345 @defun Type.fields ()
24346 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
24347 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
24348 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
24349 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
24350 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
24351 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
24352
24353 Each field is a @code{gdb.Field} object, with some pre-defined attributes:
24354 @table @code
24355 @item bitpos
24356 This attribute is not available for @code{enum} or @code{static}
24357 (as in C@t{++} or Java) fields. The value is the position, counting
24358 in bits, from the start of the containing type.
24359
24360 @item enumval
24361 This attribute is only available for @code{enum} fields, and its value
24362 is the enumeration member's integer representation.
24363
24364 @item name
24365 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
24366
24367 @item artificial
24368 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
24369 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
24370 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
24371
24372 @item is_base_class
24373 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
24374 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
24375 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
24376 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
24377
24378 @item bitsize
24379 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
24380 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
24381 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
24382
24383 @item type
24384 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
24385 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
24386
24387 @item parent_type
24388 The type which contains this field. This is an instance of
24389 @code{gdb.Type}.
24390 @end table
24391 @end defun
24392
24393 @defun Type.array (@var{n1} @r{[}, @var{n2}@r{]})
24394 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an array of this
24395 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
24396 the array; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
24397 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the array, and the
24398 second argument is the upper bound of the array. An array's length
24399 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
24400 @end defun
24401
24402 @defun Type.vector (@var{n1} @r{[}, @var{n2}@r{]})
24403 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a vector of this
24404 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
24405 the vector; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
24406 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the vector, and the
24407 second argument is the upper bound of the vector. A vector's length
24408 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
24409
24410 The difference between an @code{array} and a @code{vector} is that
24411 arrays behave like in C: when used in expressions they decay to a pointer
24412 to the first element whereas vectors are treated as first class values.
24413 @end defun
24414
24415 @defun Type.const ()
24416 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
24417 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
24418 @end defun
24419
24420 @defun Type.volatile ()
24421 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
24422 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
24423 @end defun
24424
24425 @defun Type.unqualified ()
24426 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
24427 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
24428 @code{volatile}.
24429 @end defun
24430
24431 @defun Type.range ()
24432 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
24433 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
24434 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
24435 @code{gdb.error} exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
24436 @end defun
24437
24438 @defun Type.reference ()
24439 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
24440 type.
24441 @end defun
24442
24443 @defun Type.pointer ()
24444 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
24445 type.
24446 @end defun
24447
24448 @defun Type.strip_typedefs ()
24449 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
24450 after removing all layers of typedefs.
24451 @end defun
24452
24453 @defun Type.target ()
24454 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
24455 of this type.
24456
24457 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
24458 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
24459 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
24460 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
24461 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
24462 target type is the aliased type.
24463
24464 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
24465 exception.
24466 @end defun
24467
24468 @defun Type.template_argument (n @r{[}, block@r{]})
24469 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
24470 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
24471 @var{n}th template argument.
24472
24473 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
24474 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
24475
24476 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
24477 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
24478 @end defun
24479
24480
24481 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
24482 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
24483 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
24484
24485 @table @code
24486 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
24487 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
24488 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
24489 The type is a pointer.
24490
24491 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
24492 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
24493 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
24494 The type is an array.
24495
24496 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
24497 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
24498 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
24499 The type is a structure.
24500
24501 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
24502 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
24503 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
24504 The type is a union.
24505
24506 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
24507 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
24508 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
24509 The type is an enum.
24510
24511 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
24512 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
24513 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
24514 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
24515
24516 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
24517 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
24518 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
24519 The type is a function.
24520
24521 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
24522 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
24523 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
24524 The type is an integer type.
24525
24526 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
24527 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
24528 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
24529 A floating point type.
24530
24531 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
24532 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
24533 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
24534 The special type @code{void}.
24535
24536 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
24537 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
24538 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
24539 A Pascal set type.
24540
24541 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
24542 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
24543 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
24544 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
24545
24546 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
24547 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
24548 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
24549 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
24550 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
24551
24552 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
24553 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
24554 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
24555 A string of bits. It is deprecated.
24556
24557 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
24558 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
24559 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
24560 An unknown or erroneous type.
24561
24562 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
24563 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
24564 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
24565 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
24566
24567 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
24568 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
24569 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
24570 A pointer-to-member-function.
24571
24572 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
24573 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
24574 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
24575 A pointer-to-member.
24576
24577 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
24578 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
24579 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
24580 A reference type.
24581
24582 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
24583 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
24584 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
24585 A character type.
24586
24587 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
24588 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
24589 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
24590 A boolean type.
24591
24592 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
24593 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
24594 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
24595 A complex float type.
24596
24597 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
24598 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
24599 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
24600 A typedef to some other type.
24601
24602 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
24603 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
24604 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
24605 A C@t{++} namespace.
24606
24607 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
24608 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
24609 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
24610 A decimal floating point type.
24611
24612 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
24613 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
24614 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
24615 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
24616 convenience functions.
24617 @end table
24618
24619 Further support for types is provided in the @code{gdb.types}
24620 Python module (@pxref{gdb.types}).
24621
24622 @node Pretty Printing API
24623 @subsubsection Pretty Printing API
24624
24625 An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
24626
24627 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
24628 specific interface, defined here.
24629
24630 @defun pretty_printer.children (self)
24631 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
24632 children of the pretty-printer's value.
24633
24634 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
24635 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
24636 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
24637 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
24638 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
24639
24640 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
24641 as though the value has no children.
24642 @end defun
24643
24644 @defun pretty_printer.display_hint (self)
24645 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
24646 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
24647 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
24648 printed.
24649
24650 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
24651 string.
24652
24653 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
24654
24655 @table @samp
24656 @item array
24657 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
24658 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
24659 @code{set print array}.
24660
24661 @item map
24662 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
24663 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
24664 values.
24665
24666 @item string
24667 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
24668 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
24669 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
24670 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
24671 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
24672 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
24673 @end table
24674 @end defun
24675
24676 @defun pretty_printer.to_string (self)
24677 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
24678 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
24679
24680 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
24681 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
24682 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
24683 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
24684 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
24685 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
24686 the result of @code{children}.
24687
24688 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
24689
24690 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
24691 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
24692 another pretty-printer.
24693
24694 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
24695 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
24696 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
24697 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
24698 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
24699
24700 Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
24701 are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
24702
24703 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
24704 @end defun
24705
24706 @value{GDBN} provides a function which can be used to look up the
24707 default pretty-printer for a @code{gdb.Value}:
24708
24709 @findex gdb.default_visualizer
24710 @defun gdb.default_visualizer (value)
24711 This function takes a @code{gdb.Value} object as an argument. If a
24712 pretty-printer for this value exists, then it is returned. If no such
24713 printer exists, then this returns @code{None}.
24714 @end defun
24715
24716 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
24717 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
24718
24719 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
24720 functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition
24721 as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list are called @code{global}
24722 printers, they're available when debugging all inferiors.
24723 Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
24724 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
24725 attribute.
24726
24727 Each function on these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
24728 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
24729 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
24730 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
24731 @code{None}.
24732
24733 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
24734 @code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
24735 each enabled lookup routine in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile}
24736 until it receives a pretty-printer object.
24737 If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
24738 searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
24739 calling each enabled function until an object is returned.
24740 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
24741 @code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an
24742 object is returned.
24743
24744 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
24745 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
24746 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
24747 object is returned.
24748
24749 For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work.
24750 For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and
24751 the pretty-printer is out of date.
24752
24753 The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that
24754 @value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual
24755 printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on,
24756 a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed
24757 with a broken printer.
24758
24759 Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled}
24760 attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute
24761 is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise
24762 the printer is enabled.
24763
24764 @node Writing a Pretty-Printer
24765 @subsubsection Writing a Pretty-Printer
24766 @cindex writing a pretty-printer
24767
24768 A pretty-printer consists of two parts: a lookup function to detect
24769 if the type is supported, and the printer itself.
24770
24771 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
24772 written. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for details on the API this class
24773 must provide.
24774
24775 @smallexample
24776 class StdStringPrinter(object):
24777 "Print a std::string"
24778
24779 def __init__(self, val):
24780 self.val = val
24781
24782 def to_string(self):
24783 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
24784
24785 def display_hint(self):
24786 return 'string'
24787 @end smallexample
24788
24789 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
24790 example above might be written.
24791
24792 @smallexample
24793 def str_lookup_function(val):
24794 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
24795 if lookup_tag == None:
24796 return None
24797 regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
24798 if regex.match(lookup_tag):
24799 return StdStringPrinter(val)
24800 return None
24801 @end smallexample
24802
24803 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
24804 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
24805 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
24806 returns @code{None}.
24807
24808 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
24809 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
24810 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
24811 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
24812 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
24813 different names.
24814
24815 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Python Auto-loading}) such that it
24816 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
24817 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
24818 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
24819 the current objfile.
24820
24821 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
24822 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
24823 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
24824 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
24825 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
24826 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
24827 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
24828 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
24829 inferior.
24830
24831 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
24832 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
24833
24834 @smallexample
24835 def register_printers(objfile):
24836 objfile.pretty_printers.append(str_lookup_function)
24837 @end smallexample
24838
24839 @noindent
24840 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
24841
24842 @smallexample
24843 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
24844 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile())
24845 @end smallexample
24846
24847 The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer.
24848 There are a few things that can be improved on.
24849 The printer doesn't have a name, making it hard to identify in a
24850 list of installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but
24851 lookup functions can have arbitrary, even identical, names.
24852
24853 Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has
24854 several types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type
24855 in the library, but one could also have a single lookup function recognize
24856 several types. The latter is the conventional way this is handled.
24857 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
24858 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
24859
24860 The @code{gdb.printing} module provides a formal way of solving these
24861 problems (@pxref{gdb.printing}).
24862 Here is another example that handles multiple types.
24863
24864 These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
24865
24866 @smallexample
24867 struct foo @{ int a, b; @};
24868 struct bar @{ struct foo x, y; @};
24869 @end smallexample
24870
24871 Here are the printers:
24872
24873 @smallexample
24874 class fooPrinter:
24875 """Print a foo object."""
24876
24877 def __init__(self, val):
24878 self.val = val
24879
24880 def to_string(self):
24881 return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) +
24882 "> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">")
24883
24884 class barPrinter:
24885 """Print a bar object."""
24886
24887 def __init__(self, val):
24888 self.val = val
24889
24890 def to_string(self):
24891 return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) +
24892 "> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">")
24893 @end smallexample
24894
24895 This example doesn't need a lookup function, that is handled by the
24896 @code{gdb.printing} module. Instead a function is provided to build up
24897 the object that handles the lookup.
24898
24899 @smallexample
24900 import gdb.printing
24901
24902 def build_pretty_printer():
24903 pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter(
24904 "my_library")
24905 pp.add_printer('foo', '^foo$', fooPrinter)
24906 pp.add_printer('bar', '^bar$', barPrinter)
24907 return pp
24908 @end smallexample
24909
24910 And here is the autoload support:
24911
24912 @smallexample
24913 import gdb.printing
24914 import my_library
24915 gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer(
24916 gdb.current_objfile(),
24917 my_library.build_pretty_printer())
24918 @end smallexample
24919
24920 Finally, when this printer is loaded into @value{GDBN}, here is the
24921 corresponding output of @samp{info pretty-printer}:
24922
24923 @smallexample
24924 (gdb) info pretty-printer
24925 my_library.so:
24926 my_library
24927 foo
24928 bar
24929 @end smallexample
24930
24931 @node Type Printing API
24932 @subsubsection Type Printing API
24933 @cindex type printing API for Python
24934
24935 @value{GDBN} provides a way for Python code to customize type display.
24936 This is mainly useful for substituting canonical typedef names for
24937 types.
24938
24939 @cindex type printer
24940 A @dfn{type printer} is just a Python object conforming to a certain
24941 protocol. A simple base class implementing the protocol is provided;
24942 see @ref{gdb.types}. A type printer must supply at least:
24943
24944 @defivar type_printer enabled
24945 A boolean which is True if the printer is enabled, and False
24946 otherwise. This is manipulated by the @code{enable type-printer}
24947 and @code{disable type-printer} commands.
24948 @end defivar
24949
24950 @defivar type_printer name
24951 The name of the type printer. This must be a string. This is used by
24952 the @code{enable type-printer} and @code{disable type-printer}
24953 commands.
24954 @end defivar
24955
24956 @defmethod type_printer instantiate (self)
24957 This is called by @value{GDBN} at the start of type-printing. It is
24958 only called if the type printer is enabled. This method must return a
24959 new object that supplies a @code{recognize} method, as described below.
24960 @end defmethod
24961
24962
24963 When displaying a type, say via the @code{ptype} command, @value{GDBN}
24964 will compute a list of type recognizers. This is done by iterating
24965 first over the per-objfile type printers (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}),
24966 followed by the per-progspace type printers (@pxref{Progspaces In
24967 Python}), and finally the global type printers.
24968
24969 @value{GDBN} will call the @code{instantiate} method of each enabled
24970 type printer. If this method returns @code{None}, then the result is
24971 ignored; otherwise, it is appended to the list of recognizers.
24972
24973 Then, when @value{GDBN} is going to display a type name, it iterates
24974 over the list of recognizers. For each one, it calls the recognition
24975 function, stopping if the function returns a non-@code{None} value.
24976 The recognition function is defined as:
24977
24978 @defmethod type_recognizer recognize (self, type)
24979 If @var{type} is not recognized, return @code{None}. Otherwise,
24980 return a string which is to be printed as the name of @var{type}.
24981 @var{type} will be an instance of @code{gdb.Type} (@pxref{Types In
24982 Python}).
24983 @end defmethod
24984
24985 @value{GDBN} uses this two-pass approach so that type printers can
24986 efficiently cache information without holding on to it too long. For
24987 example, it can be convenient to look up type information in a type
24988 printer and hold it for a recognizer's lifetime; if a single pass were
24989 done then type printers would have to make use of the event system in
24990 order to avoid holding information that could become stale as the
24991 inferior changed.
24992
24993 @node Frame Filter API
24994 @subsubsection Filtering Frames.
24995 @cindex frame filters api
24996
24997 Frame filters are Python objects that manipulate the visibility of a
24998 frame or frames when a backtrace (@pxref{Backtrace}) is printed by
24999 @value{GDBN}.
25000
25001 Only commands that print a backtrace, or, in the case of @sc{gdb/mi}
25002 commands (@pxref{GDB/MI}), those that return a collection of frames
25003 are affected. The commands that work with frame filters are:
25004
25005 @code{backtrace} (@pxref{backtrace-command,, The backtrace command}),
25006 @code{-stack-list-frames}
25007 (@pxref{-stack-list-frames,, The -stack-list-frames command}),
25008 @code{-stack-list-variables} (@pxref{-stack-list-variables,, The
25009 -stack-list-variables command}), @code{-stack-list-arguments}
25010 @pxref{-stack-list-arguments,, The -stack-list-arguments command}) and
25011 @code{-stack-list-locals} (@pxref{-stack-list-locals,, The
25012 -stack-list-locals command}).
25013
25014 A frame filter works by taking an iterator as an argument, applying
25015 actions to the contents of that iterator, and returning another
25016 iterator (or, possibly, the same iterator it was provided in the case
25017 where the filter does not perform any operations). Typically, frame
25018 filters utilize tools such as the Python's @code{itertools} module to
25019 work with and create new iterators from the source iterator.
25020 Regardless of how a filter chooses to apply actions, it must not alter
25021 the underlying @value{GDBN} frame or frames, or attempt to alter the
25022 call-stack within @value{GDBN}. This preserves data integrity within
25023 @value{GDBN}. Frame filters are executed on a priority basis and care
25024 should be taken that some frame filters may have been executed before,
25025 and that some frame filters will be executed after.
25026
25027 An important consideration when designing frame filters, and well
25028 worth reflecting upon, is that frame filters should avoid unwinding
25029 the call stack if possible. Some stacks can run very deep, into the
25030 tens of thousands in some cases. To search every frame when a frame
25031 filter executes may be too expensive at that step. The frame filter
25032 cannot know how many frames it has to iterate over, and it may have to
25033 iterate through them all. This ends up duplicating effort as
25034 @value{GDBN} performs this iteration when it prints the frames. If
25035 the filter can defer unwinding frames until frame decorators are
25036 executed, after the last filter has executed, it should. @xref{Frame
25037 Decorator API}, for more information on decorators. Also, there are
25038 examples for both frame decorators and filters in later chapters.
25039 @xref{Writing a Frame Filter}, for more information.
25040
25041 The Python dictionary @code{gdb.frame_filters} contains key/object
25042 pairings that comprise a frame filter. Frame filters in this
25043 dictionary are called @code{global} frame filters, and they are
25044 available when debugging all inferiors. These frame filters must
25045 register with the dictionary directly. In addition to the
25046 @code{global} dictionary, there are other dictionaries that are loaded
25047 with different inferiors via auto-loading (@pxref{Python
25048 Auto-loading}). The two other areas where frame filter dictionaries
25049 can be found are: @code{gdb.Progspace} which contains a
25050 @code{frame_filters} dictionary attribute, and each @code{gdb.Objfile}
25051 object which also contains a @code{frame_filters} dictionary
25052 attribute.
25053
25054 When a command is executed from @value{GDBN} that is compatible with
25055 frame filters, @value{GDBN} combines the @code{global},
25056 @code{gdb.Progspace} and all @code{gdb.Objfile} dictionaries currently
25057 loaded. All of the @code{gdb.Objfile} dictionaries are combined, as
25058 several frames, and thus several object files, might be in use.
25059 @value{GDBN} then prunes any frame filter whose @code{enabled}
25060 attribute is @code{False}. This pruned list is then sorted according
25061 to the @code{priority} attribute in each filter.
25062
25063 Once the dictionaries are combined, pruned and sorted, @value{GDBN}
25064 creates an iterator which wraps each frame in the call stack in a
25065 @code{FrameDecorator} object, and calls each filter in order. The
25066 output from the previous filter will always be the input to the next
25067 filter, and so on.
25068
25069 Frame filters have a mandatory interface which each frame filter must
25070 implement, defined here:
25071
25072 @defun FrameFilter.filter (iterator)
25073 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a frame filter when it has
25074 reached the order in the priority list for that filter.
25075
25076 For example, if there are four frame filters:
25077
25078 @smallexample
25079 Name Priority
25080
25081 Filter1 5
25082 Filter2 10
25083 Filter3 100
25084 Filter4 1
25085 @end smallexample
25086
25087 The order that the frame filters will be called is:
25088
25089 @smallexample
25090 Filter3 -> Filter2 -> Filter1 -> Filter4
25091 @end smallexample
25092
25093 Note that the output from @code{Filter3} is passed to the input of
25094 @code{Filter2}, and so on.
25095
25096 This @code{filter} method is passed a Python iterator. This iterator
25097 contains a sequence of frame decorators that wrap each
25098 @code{gdb.Frame}, or a frame decorator that wraps another frame
25099 decorator. The first filter that is executed in the sequence of frame
25100 filters will receive an iterator entirely comprised of default
25101 @code{FrameDecorator} objects. However, after each frame filter is
25102 executed, the previous frame filter may have wrapped some or all of
25103 the frame decorators with their own frame decorator. As frame
25104 decorators must also conform to a mandatory interface, these
25105 decorators can be assumed to act in a uniform manner (@pxref{Frame
25106 Decorator API}).
25107
25108 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
25109 protocol. Each item in the iterator must be an object conforming to
25110 the frame decorator interface. If a frame filter does not wish to
25111 perform any operations on this iterator, it should return that
25112 iterator untouched.
25113
25114 This method is not optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will
25115 raise and print an error.
25116 @end defun
25117
25118 @defvar FrameFilter.name
25119 The @code{name} attribute must be Python string which contains the
25120 name of the filter displayed by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Frame Filter
25121 Management}). This attribute may contain any combination of letters
25122 or numbers. Care should be taken to ensure that it is unique. This
25123 attribute is mandatory.
25124 @end defvar
25125
25126 @defvar FrameFilter.enabled
25127 The @code{enabled} attribute must be Python boolean. This attribute
25128 indicates to @value{GDBN} whether the frame filter is enabled, and
25129 should be considered when frame filters are executed. If
25130 @code{enabled} is @code{True}, then the frame filter will be executed
25131 when any of the backtrace commands detailed earlier in this chapter
25132 are executed. If @code{enabled} is @code{False}, then the frame
25133 filter will not be executed. This attribute is mandatory.
25134 @end defvar
25135
25136 @defvar FrameFilter.priority
25137 The @code{priority} attribute must be Python integer. This attribute
25138 controls the order of execution in relation to other frame filters.
25139 There are no imposed limits on the range of @code{priority} other than
25140 it must be a valid integer. The higher the @code{priority} attribute,
25141 the sooner the frame filter will be executed in relation to other
25142 frame filters. Although @code{priority} can be negative, it is
25143 recommended practice to assume zero is the lowest priority that a
25144 frame filter can be assigned. Frame filters that have the same
25145 priority are executed in unsorted order in that priority slot. This
25146 attribute is mandatory.
25147 @end defvar
25148
25149 @node Frame Decorator API
25150 @subsubsection Decorating Frames.
25151 @cindex frame decorator api
25152
25153 Frame decorators are sister objects to frame filters (@pxref{Frame
25154 Filter API}). Frame decorators are applied by a frame filter and can
25155 only be used in conjunction with frame filters.
25156
25157 The purpose of a frame decorator is to customize the printed content
25158 of each @code{gdb.Frame} in commands where frame filters are executed.
25159 This concept is called decorating a frame. Frame decorators decorate
25160 a @code{gdb.Frame} with Python code contained within each API call.
25161 This separates the actual data contained in a @code{gdb.Frame} from
25162 the decorated data produced by a frame decorator. This abstraction is
25163 necessary to maintain integrity of the data contained in each
25164 @code{gdb.Frame}.
25165
25166 Frame decorators have a mandatory interface, defined below.
25167
25168 @value{GDBN} already contains a frame decorator called
25169 @code{FrameDecorator}. This contains substantial amounts of
25170 boilerplate code to decorate the content of a @code{gdb.Frame}. It is
25171 recommended that other frame decorators inherit and extend this
25172 object, and only to override the methods needed.
25173
25174 @defun FrameDecorator.elided (self)
25175
25176 The @code{elided} method groups frames together in a hierarchical
25177 system. An example would be an interpreter, where multiple low-level
25178 frames make up a single call in the interpreted language. In this
25179 example, the frame filter would elide the low-level frames and present
25180 a single high-level frame, representing the call in the interpreted
25181 language, to the user.
25182
25183 The @code{elided} function must return an iterable and this iterable
25184 must contain the frames that are being elided wrapped in a suitable
25185 frame decorator. If no frames are being elided this function may
25186 return an empty iterable, or @code{None}. Elided frames are indented
25187 from normal frames in a @code{CLI} backtrace, or in the case of
25188 @code{GDB/MI}, are placed in the @code{children} field of the eliding
25189 frame.
25190
25191 It is the frame filter's task to also filter out the elided frames from
25192 the source iterator. This will avoid printing the frame twice.
25193 @end defun
25194
25195 @defun FrameDecorator.function (self)
25196
25197 This method returns the name of the function in the frame that is to
25198 be printed.
25199
25200 This method must return a Python string describing the function, or
25201 @code{None}.
25202
25203 If this function returns @code{None}, @value{GDBN} will not print any
25204 data for this field.
25205 @end defun
25206
25207 @defun FrameDecorator.address (self)
25208
25209 This method returns the address of the frame that is to be printed.
25210
25211 This method must return a Python numeric integer type of sufficient
25212 size to describe the address of the frame, or @code{None}.
25213
25214 If this function returns a @code{None}, @value{GDBN} will not print
25215 any data for this field.
25216 @end defun
25217
25218 @defun FrameDecorator.filename (self)
25219
25220 This method returns the filename and path associated with this frame.
25221
25222 This method must return a Python string containing the filename and
25223 the path to the object file backing the frame, or @code{None}.
25224
25225 If this function returns a @code{None}, @value{GDBN} will not print
25226 any data for this field.
25227 @end defun
25228
25229 @defun FrameDecorator.line (self):
25230
25231 This method returns the line number associated with the current
25232 position within the function addressed by this frame.
25233
25234 This method must return a Python integer type, or @code{None}.
25235
25236 If this function returns a @code{None}, @value{GDBN} will not print
25237 any data for this field.
25238 @end defun
25239
25240 @defun FrameDecorator.frame_args (self)
25241 @anchor{frame_args}
25242
25243 This method must return an iterable, or @code{None}. Returning an
25244 empty iterable, or @code{None} means frame arguments will not be
25245 printed for this frame. This iterable must contain objects that
25246 implement two methods, described here.
25247
25248 This object must implement a @code{argument} method which takes a
25249 single @code{self} parameter and must return a @code{gdb.Symbol}
25250 (@pxref{Symbols In Python}), or a Python string. The object must also
25251 implement a @code{value} method which takes a single @code{self}
25252 parameter and must return a @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From
25253 Inferior}), a Python value, or @code{None}. If the @code{value}
25254 method returns @code{None}, and the @code{argument} method returns a
25255 @code{gdb.Symbol}, @value{GDBN} will look-up and print the value of
25256 the @code{gdb.Symbol} automatically.
25257
25258 A brief example:
25259
25260 @smallexample
25261 class SymValueWrapper():
25262
25263 def __init__(self, symbol, value):
25264 self.sym = symbol
25265 self.val = value
25266
25267 def value(self):
25268 return self.val
25269
25270 def symbol(self):
25271 return self.sym
25272
25273 class SomeFrameDecorator()
25274 ...
25275 ...
25276 def frame_args(self):
25277 args = []
25278 try:
25279 block = self.inferior_frame.block()
25280 except:
25281 return None
25282
25283 # Iterate over all symbols in a block. Only add
25284 # symbols that are arguments.
25285 for sym in block:
25286 if not sym.is_argument:
25287 continue
25288 args.append(SymValueWrapper(sym,None))
25289
25290 # Add example synthetic argument.
25291 args.append(SymValueWrapper(``foo'', 42))
25292
25293 return args
25294 @end smallexample
25295 @end defun
25296
25297 @defun FrameDecorator.frame_locals (self)
25298
25299 This method must return an iterable or @code{None}. Returning an
25300 empty iterable, or @code{None} means frame local arguments will not be
25301 printed for this frame.
25302
25303 The object interface, the description of the various strategies for
25304 reading frame locals, and the example are largely similar to those
25305 described in the @code{frame_args} function, (@pxref{frame_args,,The
25306 frame filter frame_args function}). Below is a modified example:
25307
25308 @smallexample
25309 class SomeFrameDecorator()
25310 ...
25311 ...
25312 def frame_locals(self):
25313 vars = []
25314 try:
25315 block = self.inferior_frame.block()
25316 except:
25317 return None
25318
25319 # Iterate over all symbols in a block. Add all
25320 # symbols, except arguments.
25321 for sym in block:
25322 if sym.is_argument:
25323 continue
25324 vars.append(SymValueWrapper(sym,None))
25325
25326 # Add an example of a synthetic local variable.
25327 vars.append(SymValueWrapper(``bar'', 99))
25328
25329 return vars
25330 @end smallexample
25331 @end defun
25332
25333 @defun FrameDecorator.inferior_frame (self):
25334
25335 This method must return the underlying @code{gdb.Frame} that this
25336 frame decorator is decorating. @value{GDBN} requires the underlying
25337 frame for internal frame information to determine how to print certain
25338 values when printing a frame.
25339 @end defun
25340
25341 @node Writing a Frame Filter
25342 @subsubsection Writing a Frame Filter
25343 @cindex writing a frame filter
25344
25345 There are three basic elements that a frame filter must implement: it
25346 must correctly implement the documented interface (@pxref{Frame Filter
25347 API}), it must register itself with @value{GDBN}, and finally, it must
25348 decide if it is to work on the data provided by @value{GDBN}. In all
25349 cases, whether it works on the iterator or not, each frame filter must
25350 return an iterator. A bare-bones frame filter follows the pattern in
25351 the following example.
25352
25353 @smallexample
25354 import gdb
25355
25356 class FrameFilter():
25357
25358 def __init__(self):
25359 # Frame filter attribute creation.
25360 #
25361 # 'name' is the name of the filter that GDB will display.
25362 #
25363 # 'priority' is the priority of the filter relative to other
25364 # filters.
25365 #
25366 # 'enabled' is a boolean that indicates whether this filter is
25367 # enabled and should be executed.
25368
25369 self.name = "Foo"
25370 self.priority = 100
25371 self.enabled = True
25372
25373 # Register this frame filter with the global frame_filters
25374 # dictionary.
25375 gdb.frame_filters[self.name] = self
25376
25377 def filter(self, frame_iter):
25378 # Just return the iterator.
25379 return frame_iter
25380 @end smallexample
25381
25382 The frame filter in the example above implements the three
25383 requirements for all frame filters. It implements the API, self
25384 registers, and makes a decision on the iterator (in this case, it just
25385 returns the iterator untouched).
25386
25387 The first step is attribute creation and assignment, and as shown in
25388 the comments the filter assigns the following attributes: @code{name},
25389 @code{priority} and whether the filter should be enabled with the
25390 @code{enabled} attribute.
25391
25392 The second step is registering the frame filter with the dictionary or
25393 dictionaries that the frame filter has interest in. As shown in the
25394 comments, this filter just registers itself with the global dictionary
25395 @code{gdb.frame_filters}. As noted earlier, @code{gdb.frame_filters}
25396 is a dictionary that is initialized in the @code{gdb} module when
25397 @value{GDBN} starts. What dictionary a filter registers with is an
25398 important consideration. Generally, if a filter is specific to a set
25399 of code, it should be registered either in the @code{objfile} or
25400 @code{progspace} dictionaries as they are specific to the program
25401 currently loaded in @value{GDBN}. The global dictionary is always
25402 present in @value{GDBN} and is never unloaded. Any filters registered
25403 with the global dictionary will exist until @value{GDBN} exits. To
25404 avoid filters that may conflict, it is generally better to register
25405 frame filters against the dictionaries that more closely align with
25406 the usage of the filter currently in question. @xref{Python
25407 Auto-loading}, for further information on auto-loading Python scripts.
25408
25409 @value{GDBN} takes a hands-off approach to frame filter registration,
25410 therefore it is the frame filter's responsibility to ensure
25411 registration has occurred, and that any exceptions are handled
25412 appropriately. In particular, you may wish to handle exceptions
25413 relating to Python dictionary key uniqueness. It is mandatory that
25414 the dictionary key is the same as frame filter's @code{name}
25415 attribute. When a user manages frame filters (@pxref{Frame Filter
25416 Management}), the names @value{GDBN} will display are those contained
25417 in the @code{name} attribute.
25418
25419 The final step of this example is the implementation of the
25420 @code{filter} method. As shown in the example comments, we define the
25421 @code{filter} method and note that the method must take an iterator,
25422 and also must return an iterator. In this bare-bones example, the
25423 frame filter is not very useful as it just returns the iterator
25424 untouched. However this is a valid operation for frame filters that
25425 have the @code{enabled} attribute set, but decide not to operate on
25426 any frames.
25427
25428 In the next example, the frame filter operates on all frames and
25429 utilizes a frame decorator to perform some work on the frames.
25430 @xref{Frame Decorator API}, for further information on the frame
25431 decorator interface.
25432
25433 This example works on inlined frames. It highlights frames which are
25434 inlined by tagging them with an ``[inlined]'' tag. By applying a
25435 frame decorator to all frames with the Python @code{itertools imap}
25436 method, the example defers actions to the frame decorator. Frame
25437 decorators are only processed when @value{GDBN} prints the backtrace.
25438
25439 This introduces a new decision making topic: whether to perform
25440 decision making operations at the filtering step, or at the printing
25441 step. In this example's approach, it does not perform any filtering
25442 decisions at the filtering step beyond mapping a frame decorator to
25443 each frame. This allows the actual decision making to be performed
25444 when each frame is printed. This is an important consideration, and
25445 well worth reflecting upon when designing a frame filter. An issue
25446 that frame filters should avoid is unwinding the stack if possible.
25447 Some stacks can run very deep, into the tens of thousands in some
25448 cases. To search every frame to determine if it is inlined ahead of
25449 time may be too expensive at the filtering step. The frame filter
25450 cannot know how many frames it has to iterate over, and it would have
25451 to iterate through them all. This ends up duplicating effort as
25452 @value{GDBN} performs this iteration when it prints the frames.
25453
25454 In this example decision making can be deferred to the printing step.
25455 As each frame is printed, the frame decorator can examine each frame
25456 in turn when @value{GDBN} iterates. From a performance viewpoint,
25457 this is the most appropriate decision to make as it avoids duplicating
25458 the effort that the printing step would undertake anyway. Also, if
25459 there are many frame filters unwinding the stack during filtering, it
25460 can substantially delay the printing of the backtrace which will
25461 result in large memory usage, and a poor user experience.
25462
25463 @smallexample
25464 class InlineFilter():
25465
25466 def __init__(self):
25467 self.name = "InlinedFrameFilter"
25468 self.priority = 100
25469 self.enabled = True
25470 gdb.frame_filters[self.name] = self
25471
25472 def filter(self, frame_iter):
25473 frame_iter = itertools.imap(InlinedFrameDecorator,
25474 frame_iter)
25475 return frame_iter
25476 @end smallexample
25477
25478 This frame filter is somewhat similar to the earlier example, except
25479 that the @code{filter} method applies a frame decorator object called
25480 @code{InlinedFrameDecorator} to each element in the iterator. The
25481 @code{imap} Python method is light-weight. It does not proactively
25482 iterate over the iterator, but rather creates a new iterator which
25483 wraps the existing one.
25484
25485 Below is the frame decorator for this example.
25486
25487 @smallexample
25488 class InlinedFrameDecorator(FrameDecorator):
25489
25490 def __init__(self, fobj):
25491 super(InlinedFrameDecorator, self).__init__(fobj)
25492
25493 def function(self):
25494 frame = fobj.inferior_frame()
25495 name = str(frame.name())
25496
25497 if frame.type() == gdb.INLINE_FRAME:
25498 name = name + " [inlined]"
25499
25500 return name
25501 @end smallexample
25502
25503 This frame decorator only defines and overrides the @code{function}
25504 method. It lets the supplied @code{FrameDecorator}, which is shipped
25505 with @value{GDBN}, perform the other work associated with printing
25506 this frame.
25507
25508 The combination of these two objects create this output from a
25509 backtrace:
25510
25511 @smallexample
25512 #0 0x004004e0 in bar () at inline.c:11
25513 #1 0x00400566 in max [inlined] (b=6, a=12) at inline.c:21
25514 #2 0x00400566 in main () at inline.c:31
25515 @end smallexample
25516
25517 So in the case of this example, a frame decorator is applied to all
25518 frames, regardless of whether they may be inlined or not. As
25519 @value{GDBN} iterates over the iterator produced by the frame filters,
25520 @value{GDBN} executes each frame decorator which then makes a decision
25521 on what to print in the @code{function} callback. Using a strategy
25522 like this is a way to defer decisions on the frame content to printing
25523 time.
25524
25525 @subheading Eliding Frames
25526
25527 It might be that the above example is not desirable for representing
25528 inlined frames, and a hierarchical approach may be preferred. If we
25529 want to hierarchically represent frames, the @code{elided} frame
25530 decorator interface might be preferable.
25531
25532 This example approaches the issue with the @code{elided} method. This
25533 example is quite long, but very simplistic. It is out-of-scope for
25534 this section to write a complete example that comprehensively covers
25535 all approaches of finding and printing inlined frames. However, this
25536 example illustrates the approach an author might use.
25537
25538 This example comprises of three sections.
25539
25540 @smallexample
25541 class InlineFrameFilter():
25542
25543 def __init__(self):
25544 self.name = "InlinedFrameFilter"
25545 self.priority = 100
25546 self.enabled = True
25547 gdb.frame_filters[self.name] = self
25548
25549 def filter(self, frame_iter):
25550 return ElidingInlineIterator(frame_iter)
25551 @end smallexample
25552
25553 This frame filter is very similar to the other examples. The only
25554 difference is this frame filter is wrapping the iterator provided to
25555 it (@code{frame_iter}) with a custom iterator called
25556 @code{ElidingInlineIterator}. This again defers actions to when
25557 @value{GDBN} prints the backtrace, as the iterator is not traversed
25558 until printing.
25559
25560 The iterator for this example is as follows. It is in this section of
25561 the example where decisions are made on the content of the backtrace.
25562
25563 @smallexample
25564 class ElidingInlineIterator:
25565 def __init__(self, ii):
25566 self.input_iterator = ii
25567
25568 def __iter__(self):
25569 return self
25570
25571 def next(self):
25572 frame = next(self.input_iterator)
25573
25574 if frame.inferior_frame().type() != gdb.INLINE_FRAME:
25575 return frame
25576
25577 try:
25578 eliding_frame = next(self.input_iterator)
25579 except StopIteration:
25580 return frame
25581 return ElidingFrameDecorator(eliding_frame, [frame])
25582 @end smallexample
25583
25584 This iterator implements the Python iterator protocol. When the
25585 @code{next} function is called (when @value{GDBN} prints each frame),
25586 the iterator checks if this frame decorator, @code{frame}, is wrapping
25587 an inlined frame. If it is not, it returns the existing frame decorator
25588 untouched. If it is wrapping an inlined frame, it assumes that the
25589 inlined frame was contained within the next oldest frame,
25590 @code{eliding_frame}, which it fetches. It then creates and returns a
25591 frame decorator, @code{ElidingFrameDecorator}, which contains both the
25592 elided frame, and the eliding frame.
25593
25594 @smallexample
25595 class ElidingInlineDecorator(FrameDecorator):
25596
25597 def __init__(self, frame, elided_frames):
25598 super(ElidingInlineDecorator, self).__init__(frame)
25599 self.frame = frame
25600 self.elided_frames = elided_frames
25601
25602 def elided(self):
25603 return iter(self.elided_frames)
25604 @end smallexample
25605
25606 This frame decorator overrides one function and returns the inlined
25607 frame in the @code{elided} method. As before it lets
25608 @code{FrameDecorator} do the rest of the work involved in printing
25609 this frame. This produces the following output.
25610
25611 @smallexample
25612 #0 0x004004e0 in bar () at inline.c:11
25613 #2 0x00400529 in main () at inline.c:25
25614 #1 0x00400529 in max (b=6, a=12) at inline.c:15
25615 @end smallexample
25616
25617 In that output, @code{max} which has been inlined into @code{main} is
25618 printed hierarchically. Another approach would be to combine the
25619 @code{function} method, and the @code{elided} method to both print a
25620 marker in the inlined frame, and also show the hierarchical
25621 relationship.
25622
25623 @node Inferiors In Python
25624 @subsubsection Inferiors In Python
25625 @cindex inferiors in Python
25626
25627 @findex gdb.Inferior
25628 Programs which are being run under @value{GDBN} are called inferiors
25629 (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). Python scripts can access
25630 information about and manipulate inferiors controlled by @value{GDBN}
25631 via objects of the @code{gdb.Inferior} class.
25632
25633 The following inferior-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
25634 module:
25635
25636 @defun gdb.inferiors ()
25637 Return a tuple containing all inferior objects.
25638 @end defun
25639
25640 @defun gdb.selected_inferior ()
25641 Return an object representing the current inferior.
25642 @end defun
25643
25644 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following attributes:
25645
25646 @defvar Inferior.num
25647 ID of inferior, as assigned by GDB.
25648 @end defvar
25649
25650 @defvar Inferior.pid
25651 Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating
25652 system.
25653 @end defvar
25654
25655 @defvar Inferior.was_attached
25656 Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using `attach', or
25657 started by @value{GDBN} itself.
25658 @end defvar
25659
25660 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following methods:
25661
25662 @defun Inferior.is_valid ()
25663 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Inferior} object is valid,
25664 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Inferior} object will become invalid
25665 if the inferior no longer exists within @value{GDBN}. All other
25666 @code{gdb.Inferior} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid
25667 at the time the method is called.
25668 @end defun
25669
25670 @defun Inferior.threads ()
25671 This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid
25672 when it is called. If there are no valid threads, the method will
25673 return an empty tuple.
25674 @end defun
25675
25676 @findex Inferior.read_memory
25677 @defun Inferior.read_memory (address, length)
25678 Read @var{length} bytes of memory from the inferior, starting at
25679 @var{address}. Returns a buffer object, which behaves much like an array
25680 or a string. It can be modified and given to the
25681 @code{Inferior.write_memory} function. In @code{Python} 3, the return
25682 value is a @code{memoryview} object.
25683 @end defun
25684
25685 @findex Inferior.write_memory
25686 @defun Inferior.write_memory (address, buffer @r{[}, length@r{]})
25687 Write the contents of @var{buffer} to the inferior, starting at
25688 @var{address}. The @var{buffer} parameter must be a Python object
25689 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
25690 object returned from @code{Inferior.read_memory}. If given, @var{length}
25691 determines the number of bytes from @var{buffer} to be written.
25692 @end defun
25693
25694 @findex gdb.search_memory
25695 @defun Inferior.search_memory (address, length, pattern)
25696 Search a region of the inferior memory starting at @var{address} with
25697 the given @var{length} using the search pattern supplied in
25698 @var{pattern}. The @var{pattern} parameter must be a Python object
25699 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
25700 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. Returns a Python @code{Long}
25701 containing the address where the pattern was found, or @code{None} if
25702 the pattern could not be found.
25703 @end defun
25704
25705 @node Events In Python
25706 @subsubsection Events In Python
25707 @cindex inferior events in Python
25708
25709 @value{GDBN} provides a general event facility so that Python code can be
25710 notified of various state changes, particularly changes that occur in
25711 the inferior.
25712
25713 An @dfn{event} is just an object that describes some state change. The
25714 type of the object and its attributes will vary depending on the details
25715 of the change. All the existing events are described below.
25716
25717 In order to be notified of an event, you must register an event handler
25718 with an @dfn{event registry}. An event registry is an object in the
25719 @code{gdb.events} module which dispatches particular events. A registry
25720 provides methods to register and unregister event handlers:
25721
25722 @defun EventRegistry.connect (object)
25723 Add the given callable @var{object} to the registry. This object will be
25724 called when an event corresponding to this registry occurs.
25725 @end defun
25726
25727 @defun EventRegistry.disconnect (object)
25728 Remove the given @var{object} from the registry. Once removed, the object
25729 will no longer receive notifications of events.
25730 @end defun
25731
25732 Here is an example:
25733
25734 @smallexample
25735 def exit_handler (event):
25736 print "event type: exit"
25737 print "exit code: %d" % (event.exit_code)
25738
25739 gdb.events.exited.connect (exit_handler)
25740 @end smallexample
25741
25742 In the above example we connect our handler @code{exit_handler} to the
25743 registry @code{events.exited}. Once connected, @code{exit_handler} gets
25744 called when the inferior exits. The argument @dfn{event} in this example is
25745 of type @code{gdb.ExitedEvent}. As you can see in the example the
25746 @code{ExitedEvent} object has an attribute which indicates the exit code of
25747 the inferior.
25748
25749 The following is a listing of the event registries that are available and
25750 details of the events they emit:
25751
25752 @table @code
25753
25754 @item events.cont
25755 Emits @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
25756
25757 Some events can be thread specific when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
25758 mode. When represented in Python, these events all extend
25759 @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}. Note, this event is not emitted directly; instead,
25760 events which are emitted by this or other modules might extend this event.
25761 Examples of these events are @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} and
25762 @code{gdb.ContinueEvent}.
25763
25764 @defvar ThreadEvent.inferior_thread
25765 In non-stop mode this attribute will be set to the specific thread which was
25766 involved in the emitted event. Otherwise, it will be set to @code{None}.
25767 @end defvar
25768
25769 Emits @code{gdb.ContinueEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
25770
25771 This event indicates that the inferior has been continued after a stop. For
25772 inherited attribute refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above.
25773
25774 @item events.exited
25775 Emits @code{events.ExitedEvent} which indicates that the inferior has exited.
25776 @code{events.ExitedEvent} has two attributes:
25777 @defvar ExitedEvent.exit_code
25778 An integer representing the exit code, if available, which the inferior
25779 has returned. (The exit code could be unavailable if, for example,
25780 @value{GDBN} detaches from the inferior.) If the exit code is unavailable,
25781 the attribute does not exist.
25782 @end defvar
25783 @defvar ExitedEvent inferior
25784 A reference to the inferior which triggered the @code{exited} event.
25785 @end defvar
25786
25787 @item events.stop
25788 Emits @code{gdb.StopEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
25789
25790 Indicates that the inferior has stopped. All events emitted by this registry
25791 extend StopEvent. As a child of @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}, @code{gdb.StopEvent}
25792 will indicate the stopped thread when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
25793 mode. Refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above for more details.
25794
25795 Emits @code{gdb.SignalEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
25796
25797 This event indicates that the inferior or one of its threads has received as
25798 signal. @code{gdb.SignalEvent} has the following attributes:
25799
25800 @defvar SignalEvent.stop_signal
25801 A string representing the signal received by the inferior. A list of possible
25802 signal values can be obtained by running the command @code{info signals} in
25803 the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25804 @end defvar
25805
25806 Also emits @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
25807
25808 @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} event indicates that one or more breakpoints have
25809 been hit, and has the following attributes:
25810
25811 @defvar BreakpointEvent.breakpoints
25812 A sequence containing references to all the breakpoints (type
25813 @code{gdb.Breakpoint}) that were hit.
25814 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Breakpoint} object.
25815 @end defvar
25816 @defvar BreakpointEvent.breakpoint
25817 A reference to the first breakpoint that was hit.
25818 This function is maintained for backward compatibility and is now deprecated
25819 in favor of the @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent.breakpoints} attribute.
25820 @end defvar
25821
25822 @item events.new_objfile
25823 Emits @code{gdb.NewObjFileEvent} which indicates that a new object file has
25824 been loaded by @value{GDBN}. @code{gdb.NewObjFileEvent} has one attribute:
25825
25826 @defvar NewObjFileEvent.new_objfile
25827 A reference to the object file (@code{gdb.Objfile}) which has been loaded.
25828 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Objfile} object.
25829 @end defvar
25830
25831 @end table
25832
25833 @node Threads In Python
25834 @subsubsection Threads In Python
25835 @cindex threads in python
25836
25837 @findex gdb.InferiorThread
25838 Python scripts can access information about, and manipulate inferior threads
25839 controlled by @value{GDBN}, via objects of the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} class.
25840
25841 The following thread-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
25842 module:
25843
25844 @findex gdb.selected_thread
25845 @defun gdb.selected_thread ()
25846 This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there
25847 is no selected thread, this will return @code{None}.
25848 @end defun
25849
25850 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following attributes:
25851
25852 @defvar InferiorThread.name
25853 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using
25854 @code{thread name}, then this returns that name. Otherwise, if an
25855 OS-supplied name is available, then it is returned. Otherwise, this
25856 returns @code{None}.
25857
25858 This attribute can be assigned to. The new value must be a string
25859 object, which sets the new name, or @code{None}, which removes any
25860 user-specified thread name.
25861 @end defvar
25862
25863 @defvar InferiorThread.num
25864 ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB.
25865 @end defvar
25866
25867 @defvar InferiorThread.ptid
25868 ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a
25869 tuple containing three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second
25870 is the Lightweight Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID).
25871 Either the LWPID or TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system
25872 does not use that identifier.
25873 @end defvar
25874
25875 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following methods:
25876
25877 @defun InferiorThread.is_valid ()
25878 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object is valid,
25879 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object will become
25880 invalid if the thread exits, or the inferior that the thread belongs
25881 is deleted. All other @code{gdb.InferiorThread} methods will throw an
25882 exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
25883 @end defun
25884
25885 @defun InferiorThread.switch ()
25886 This changes @value{GDBN}'s currently selected thread to the one represented
25887 by this object.
25888 @end defun
25889
25890 @defun InferiorThread.is_stopped ()
25891 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped.
25892 @end defun
25893
25894 @defun InferiorThread.is_running ()
25895 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running.
25896 @end defun
25897
25898 @defun InferiorThread.is_exited ()
25899 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited.
25900 @end defun
25901
25902 @node Commands In Python
25903 @subsubsection Commands In Python
25904
25905 @cindex commands in python
25906 @cindex python commands
25907 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
25908 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
25909 class, most commonly using a subclass.
25910
25911 @defun Command.__init__ (name, @var{command_class} @r{[}, @var{completer_class} @r{[}, @var{prefix}@r{]]})
25912 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
25913 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
25914 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
25915
25916 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
25917 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
25918 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
25919 an exception is raised.
25920
25921 There is no support for multi-line commands.
25922
25923 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
25924 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
25925 new command in the help system.
25926
25927 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
25928 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
25929 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
25930 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
25931 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
25932 error will occur when completion is attempted.
25933
25934 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
25935 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
25936 registered.
25937
25938 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
25939 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
25940 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
25941 not documented.'' is used.
25942 @end defun
25943
25944 @cindex don't repeat Python command
25945 @defun Command.dont_repeat ()
25946 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
25947 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
25948 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
25949 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
25950 @end defun
25951
25952 @defun Command.invoke (argument, from_tty)
25953 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
25954
25955 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
25956 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
25957
25958 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
25959 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
25960 that the command came from elsewhere.
25961
25962 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
25963 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
25964
25965 @findex gdb.string_to_argv
25966 To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
25967 @code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
25968 @value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
25969 It is recommended to use this for consistency.
25970 Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
25971 Example:
25972
25973 @smallexample
25974 print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
25975 ['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
25976 @end smallexample
25977
25978 @end defun
25979
25980 @cindex completion of Python commands
25981 @defun Command.complete (text, word)
25982 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
25983 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
25984 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
25985 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
25986 complete}).
25987
25988 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
25989 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
25990 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
25991 using a word-breaking heuristic.
25992
25993 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
25994 @itemize @bullet
25995 @item
25996 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
25997 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
25998 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
25999 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
26000 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
26001 sequence are ignored.
26002
26003 @item
26004 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
26005 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
26006 function is invoked, and its result is used.
26007
26008 @item
26009 All other results are treated as though there were no available
26010 completions.
26011 @end itemize
26012 @end defun
26013
26014 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
26015 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
26016 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
26017 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
26018 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
26019 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
26020
26021 @table @code
26022 @findex COMMAND_NONE
26023 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
26024 @item gdb.COMMAND_NONE
26025 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
26026 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
26027
26028 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
26029 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
26030 @item gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
26031 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
26032 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
26033 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
26034 commands in this category.
26035
26036 @findex COMMAND_DATA
26037 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
26038 @item gdb.COMMAND_DATA
26039 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
26040 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
26041 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
26042 in this category.
26043
26044 @findex COMMAND_STACK
26045 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
26046 @item gdb.COMMAND_STACK
26047 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
26048 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
26049 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
26050 list of commands in this category.
26051
26052 @findex COMMAND_FILES
26053 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
26054 @item gdb.COMMAND_FILES
26055 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
26056 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
26057 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
26058 commands in this category.
26059
26060 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
26061 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
26062 @item gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
26063 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
26064 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
26065 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
26066 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
26067 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
26068 commands in this category.
26069
26070 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
26071 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
26072 @item gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
26073 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
26074 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
26075 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
26076 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
26077
26078 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
26079 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
26080 @item gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
26081 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
26082 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
26083 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
26084 this category.
26085
26086 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
26087 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
26088 @item gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
26089 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
26090 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
26091 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
26092 commands in this category.
26093
26094 @findex COMMAND_USER
26095 @findex gdb.COMMAND_USER
26096 @item gdb.COMMAND_USER
26097 The command is a general purpose command for the user, and typically
26098 does not fit in one of the other categories.
26099 Type @kbd{help user-defined} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see
26100 a list of commands in this category, as well as the list of gdb macros
26101 (@pxref{Sequences}).
26102
26103 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
26104 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
26105 @item gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
26106 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
26107 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
26108 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
26109 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
26110 category.
26111
26112 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
26113 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
26114 @item gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
26115 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
26116 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
26117 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
26118 commands in this category.
26119 @end table
26120
26121 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
26122 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
26123 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
26124 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
26125
26126 @table @code
26127 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
26128 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
26129 @item gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
26130 This constant means that no completion should be done.
26131
26132 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
26133 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
26134 @item gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
26135 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
26136
26137 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
26138 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
26139 @item gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
26140 This constant means that location completion should be done.
26141 @xref{Specify Location}.
26142
26143 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
26144 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
26145 @item gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
26146 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
26147 command names.
26148
26149 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
26150 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
26151 @item gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
26152 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
26153 as the source.
26154
26155 @findex COMPLETE_EXPRESSION
26156 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_EXPRESSION
26157 @item gdb.COMPLETE_EXPRESSION
26158 This constant means that completion should be done on expressions.
26159 Often this means completing on symbol names, but some language
26160 parsers also have support for completing on field names.
26161 @end table
26162
26163 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
26164 implemented in Python:
26165
26166 @smallexample
26167 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
26168 """Greet the whole world."""
26169
26170 def __init__ (self):
26171 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_USER)
26172
26173 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
26174 print "Hello, World!"
26175
26176 HelloWorld ()
26177 @end smallexample
26178
26179 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
26180 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
26181 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
26182 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
26183
26184 @node Parameters In Python
26185 @subsubsection Parameters In Python
26186
26187 @cindex parameters in python
26188 @cindex python parameters
26189 @tindex gdb.Parameter
26190 @tindex Parameter
26191 You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
26192 parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
26193 class.
26194
26195 Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
26196 @code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
26197
26198 There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
26199 @value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
26200 @code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
26201 behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
26202 can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
26203
26204 @defun Parameter.__init__ (name, @var{command-class}, @var{parameter-class} @r{[}, @var{enum-sequence}@r{]})
26205 The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
26206 parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
26207 from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
26208
26209 @var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
26210 of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
26211 parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
26212 @code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
26213 @code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
26214 parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
26215 @value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
26216
26217 If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
26218 can be found, an exception is raised.
26219
26220 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
26221 (@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
26222 categorize the new parameter in the help system.
26223
26224 @var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
26225 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
26226 parameter; this information is used for input validation and
26227 completion.
26228
26229 If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
26230 @var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
26231 represent the possible values for the parameter.
26232
26233 If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
26234 of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
26235
26236 The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
26237 documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
26238 there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
26239 @end defun
26240
26241 @defvar Parameter.set_doc
26242 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
26243 the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
26244 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
26245 have no effect.
26246 @end defvar
26247
26248 @defvar Parameter.show_doc
26249 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
26250 the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
26251 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
26252 have no effect.
26253 @end defvar
26254
26255 @defvar Parameter.value
26256 The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
26257 parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
26258 attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
26259 @end defvar
26260
26261 There are two methods that should be implemented in any
26262 @code{Parameter} class. These are:
26263
26264 @defun Parameter.get_set_string (self)
26265 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s value has
26266 been changed via the @code{set} API (for example, @kbd{set foo off}).
26267 The @code{value} attribute has already been populated with the new
26268 value and may be used in output. This method must return a string.
26269 @end defun
26270
26271 @defun Parameter.get_show_string (self, svalue)
26272 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s
26273 @code{show} API has been invoked (for example, @kbd{show foo}). The
26274 argument @code{svalue} receives the string representation of the
26275 current value. This method must return a string.
26276 @end defun
26277
26278 When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
26279 available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
26280 module:
26281
26282 @table @code
26283 @findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
26284 @findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
26285 @item gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
26286 The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
26287 and @code{False} are the only valid values.
26288
26289 @findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
26290 @findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
26291 @item gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
26292 The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
26293 Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
26294 @samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
26295
26296 @findex PARAM_UINTEGER
26297 @findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
26298 @item gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
26299 The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
26300 interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
26301
26302 @findex PARAM_INTEGER
26303 @findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
26304 @item gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
26305 The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
26306 to mean ``unlimited''.
26307
26308 @findex PARAM_STRING
26309 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
26310 @item gdb.PARAM_STRING
26311 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
26312 sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
26313 translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
26314 host charset.
26315
26316 @findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
26317 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
26318 @item gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
26319 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
26320 passed through untranslated.
26321
26322 @findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
26323 @findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
26324 @item gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
26325 The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
26326
26327 @findex PARAM_FILENAME
26328 @findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
26329 @item gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
26330 The value is a filename. This is just like
26331 @code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
26332
26333 @findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
26334 @findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
26335 @item gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
26336 The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
26337 is interpreted as itself.
26338
26339 @findex PARAM_ENUM
26340 @findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
26341 @item gdb.PARAM_ENUM
26342 The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
26343 constants provided when the parameter is created.
26344 @end table
26345
26346 @node Functions In Python
26347 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
26348
26349 @cindex writing convenience functions
26350 @cindex convenience functions in python
26351 @cindex python convenience functions
26352 @tindex gdb.Function
26353 @tindex Function
26354 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
26355 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
26356 class @code{gdb.Function}.
26357
26358 @defun Function.__init__ (name)
26359 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
26360 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
26361 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
26362 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
26363 the given @var{name}.
26364
26365 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
26366 string for the new class.
26367 @end defun
26368
26369 @defun Function.invoke (@var{*args})
26370 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
26371 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
26372 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
26373 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
26374 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
26375 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
26376 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
26377
26378 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
26379 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
26380 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
26381 @end defun
26382
26383 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
26384 be implemented in Python:
26385
26386 @smallexample
26387 class Greet (gdb.Function):
26388 """Return string to greet someone.
26389 Takes a name as argument."""
26390
26391 def __init__ (self):
26392 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
26393
26394 def invoke (self, name):
26395 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
26396
26397 Greet ()
26398 @end smallexample
26399
26400 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
26401 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
26402 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
26403 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
26404
26405 Now you can use the function in an expression:
26406
26407 @smallexample
26408 (gdb) print $greet("Bob")
26409 $1 = "Hello, Bob!"
26410 @end smallexample
26411
26412 @node Progspaces In Python
26413 @subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
26414
26415 @cindex progspaces in python
26416 @tindex gdb.Progspace
26417 @tindex Progspace
26418 A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
26419 of an address space.
26420 It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
26421 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
26422 @xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
26423 about program spaces.
26424
26425 The following progspace-related functions are available in the
26426 @code{gdb} module:
26427
26428 @findex gdb.current_progspace
26429 @defun gdb.current_progspace ()
26430 This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
26431 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
26432 @end defun
26433
26434 @findex gdb.progspaces
26435 @defun gdb.progspaces ()
26436 Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
26437 @end defun
26438
26439 Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
26440 class.
26441
26442 @defvar Progspace.filename
26443 The file name of the progspace as a string.
26444 @end defvar
26445
26446 @defvar Progspace.pretty_printers
26447 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
26448 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
26449 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
26450 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
26451 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
26452 information.
26453 @end defvar
26454
26455 @defvar Progspace.type_printers
26456 The @code{type_printers} attribute is a list of type printer objects.
26457 @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information.
26458 @end defvar
26459
26460 @defvar Progspace.frame_filters
26461 The @code{frame_filters} attribute is a dictionary of frame filter
26462 objects. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for more information.
26463 @end defvar
26464
26465 @node Objfiles In Python
26466 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
26467
26468 @cindex objfiles in python
26469 @tindex gdb.Objfile
26470 @tindex Objfile
26471 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
26472 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
26473 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
26474 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
26475 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
26476
26477 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
26478 @code{gdb} module:
26479
26480 @findex gdb.current_objfile
26481 @defun gdb.current_objfile ()
26482 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Python Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
26483 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
26484 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
26485 this function returns @code{None}.
26486 @end defun
26487
26488 @findex gdb.objfiles
26489 @defun gdb.objfiles ()
26490 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
26491 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
26492 @end defun
26493
26494 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
26495 class.
26496
26497 @defvar Objfile.filename
26498 The file name of the objfile as a string.
26499 @end defvar
26500
26501 @defvar Objfile.pretty_printers
26502 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
26503 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
26504 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
26505 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
26506 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
26507 information.
26508 @end defvar
26509
26510 @defvar Objfile.type_printers
26511 The @code{type_printers} attribute is a list of type printer objects.
26512 @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information.
26513 @end defvar
26514
26515 @defvar Objfile.frame_filters
26516 The @code{frame_filters} attribute is a dictionary of frame filter
26517 objects. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for more information.
26518 @end defvar
26519
26520 A @code{gdb.Objfile} object has the following methods:
26521
26522 @defun Objfile.is_valid ()
26523 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Objfile} object is valid,
26524 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Objfile} object can become invalid
26525 if the object file it refers to is not loaded in @value{GDBN} any
26526 longer. All other @code{gdb.Objfile} methods will throw an exception
26527 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
26528 @end defun
26529
26530 @node Frames In Python
26531 @subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
26532
26533 @cindex frames in python
26534 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
26535 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
26536 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
26537 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
26538 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{gdb.error}
26539 exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
26540
26541 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
26542 operator, like:
26543
26544 @smallexample
26545 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
26546 True
26547 @end smallexample
26548
26549 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
26550
26551 @findex gdb.selected_frame
26552 @defun gdb.selected_frame ()
26553 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
26554 @end defun
26555
26556 @findex gdb.newest_frame
26557 @defun gdb.newest_frame ()
26558 Return the newest frame object for the selected thread.
26559 @end defun
26560
26561 @defun gdb.frame_stop_reason_string (reason)
26562 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
26563 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
26564 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
26565 @end defun
26566
26567 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
26568
26569 @defun Frame.is_valid ()
26570 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
26571 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
26572 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
26573 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
26574 @end defun
26575
26576 @defun Frame.name ()
26577 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
26578 obtained.
26579 @end defun
26580
26581 @defun Frame.architecture ()
26582 Returns the @code{gdb.Architecture} object corresponding to the frame's
26583 architecture. @xref{Architectures In Python}.
26584 @end defun
26585
26586 @defun Frame.type ()
26587 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of:
26588 @table @code
26589 @item gdb.NORMAL_FRAME
26590 An ordinary stack frame.
26591
26592 @item gdb.DUMMY_FRAME
26593 A fake stack frame that was created by @value{GDBN} when performing an
26594 inferior function call.
26595
26596 @item gdb.INLINE_FRAME
26597 A frame representing an inlined function. The function was inlined
26598 into a @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME} that is older than this one.
26599
26600 @item gdb.TAILCALL_FRAME
26601 A frame representing a tail call. @xref{Tail Call Frames}.
26602
26603 @item gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME
26604 A signal trampoline frame. This is the frame created by the OS when
26605 it calls into a signal handler.
26606
26607 @item gdb.ARCH_FRAME
26608 A fake stack frame representing a cross-architecture call.
26609
26610 @item gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME
26611 This is like @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, but it is only used for the
26612 newest frame.
26613 @end table
26614 @end defun
26615
26616 @defun Frame.unwind_stop_reason ()
26617 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
26618 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
26619 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
26620 function to a string. The value can be one of:
26621
26622 @table @code
26623 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_REASON
26624 No particular reason (older frames should be available).
26625
26626 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NULL_ID
26627 The previous frame's analyzer returns an invalid result. This is no
26628 longer used by @value{GDBN}, and is kept only for backward
26629 compatibility.
26630
26631 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_OUTERMOST
26632 This frame is the outermost.
26633
26634 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_UNAVAILABLE
26635 Cannot unwind further, because that would require knowing the
26636 values of registers or memory that have not been collected.
26637
26638 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_INNER_ID
26639 This frame ID looks like it ought to belong to a NEXT frame,
26640 but we got it for a PREV frame. Normally, this is a sign of
26641 unwinder failure. It could also indicate stack corruption.
26642
26643 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_SAME_ID
26644 This frame has the same ID as the previous one. That means
26645 that unwinding further would almost certainly give us another
26646 frame with exactly the same ID, so break the chain. Normally,
26647 this is a sign of unwinder failure. It could also indicate
26648 stack corruption.
26649
26650 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_SAVED_PC
26651 The frame unwinder did not find any saved PC, but we needed
26652 one to unwind further.
26653
26654 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR
26655 Any stop reason greater or equal to this value indicates some kind
26656 of error. This special value facilitates writing code that tests
26657 for errors in unwinding in a way that will work correctly even if
26658 the list of the other values is modified in future @value{GDBN}
26659 versions. Using it, you could write:
26660 @smallexample
26661 reason = gdb.selected_frame().unwind_stop_reason ()
26662 reason_str = gdb.frame_stop_reason_string (reason)
26663 if reason >= gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR:
26664 print "An error occured: %s" % reason_str
26665 @end smallexample
26666 @end table
26667
26668 @end defun
26669
26670 @defun Frame.pc ()
26671 Returns the frame's resume address.
26672 @end defun
26673
26674 @defun Frame.block ()
26675 Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
26676 @end defun
26677
26678 @defun Frame.function ()
26679 Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
26680 @xref{Symbols In Python}.
26681 @end defun
26682
26683 @defun Frame.older ()
26684 Return the frame that called this frame.
26685 @end defun
26686
26687 @defun Frame.newer ()
26688 Return the frame called by this frame.
26689 @end defun
26690
26691 @defun Frame.find_sal ()
26692 Return the frame's symtab and line object.
26693 @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
26694 @end defun
26695
26696 @defun Frame.read_var (variable @r{[}, block@r{]})
26697 Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
26698 argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
26699 block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
26700 determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
26701 must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
26702 @code{gdb.Block} object.
26703 @end defun
26704
26705 @defun Frame.select ()
26706 Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
26707 Stack}.
26708 @end defun
26709
26710 @node Blocks In Python
26711 @subsubsection Accessing blocks from Python.
26712
26713 @cindex blocks in python
26714 @tindex gdb.Block
26715
26716 In @value{GDBN}, symbols are stored in blocks. A block corresponds
26717 roughly to a scope in the source code. Blocks are organized
26718 hierarchically, and are represented individually in Python as a
26719 @code{gdb.Block}. Blocks rely on debugging information being
26720 available.
26721
26722 A frame has a block. Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more
26723 in-depth discussion of frames.
26724
26725 The outermost block is known as the @dfn{global block}. The global
26726 block typically holds public global variables and functions.
26727
26728 The block nested just inside the global block is the @dfn{static
26729 block}. The static block typically holds file-scoped variables and
26730 functions.
26731
26732 @value{GDBN} provides a method to get a block's superblock, but there
26733 is currently no way to examine the sub-blocks of a block, or to
26734 iterate over all the blocks in a symbol table (@pxref{Symbol Tables In
26735 Python}).
26736
26737 Here is a short example that should help explain blocks:
26738
26739 @smallexample
26740 /* This is in the global block. */
26741 int global;
26742
26743 /* This is in the static block. */
26744 static int file_scope;
26745
26746 /* 'function' is in the global block, and 'argument' is
26747 in a block nested inside of 'function'. */
26748 int function (int argument)
26749 @{
26750 /* 'local' is in a block inside 'function'. It may or may
26751 not be in the same block as 'argument'. */
26752 int local;
26753
26754 @{
26755 /* 'inner' is in a block whose superblock is the one holding
26756 'local'. */
26757 int inner;
26758
26759 /* If this call is expanded by the compiler, you may see
26760 a nested block here whose function is 'inline_function'
26761 and whose superblock is the one holding 'inner'. */
26762 inline_function ();
26763 @}
26764 @}
26765 @end smallexample
26766
26767 A @code{gdb.Block} is iterable. The iterator returns the symbols
26768 (@pxref{Symbols In Python}) local to the block. Python programs
26769 should not assume that a specific block object will always contain a
26770 given symbol, since changes in @value{GDBN} features and
26771 infrastructure may cause symbols move across blocks in a symbol
26772 table.
26773
26774 The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
26775 module:
26776
26777 @findex gdb.block_for_pc
26778 @defun gdb.block_for_pc (pc)
26779 Return the innermost @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc}
26780 value. If the block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified,
26781 the function will return @code{None}.
26782 @end defun
26783
26784 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following methods:
26785
26786 @defun Block.is_valid ()
26787 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is valid,
26788 @code{False} if not. A block object can become invalid if the block it
26789 refers to doesn't exist anymore in the inferior. All other
26790 @code{gdb.Block} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at
26791 the time the method is called. The block's validity is also checked
26792 during iteration over symbols of the block.
26793 @end defun
26794
26795 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
26796
26797 @defvar Block.start
26798 The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
26799 @end defvar
26800
26801 @defvar Block.end
26802 The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
26803 @end defvar
26804
26805 @defvar Block.function
26806 The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
26807 block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
26808 attribute is not writable.
26809
26810 For ordinary function blocks, the superblock is the static block.
26811 However, you should note that it is possible for a function block to
26812 have a superblock that is not the static block -- for instance this
26813 happens for an inlined function.
26814 @end defvar
26815
26816 @defvar Block.superblock
26817 The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
26818 this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
26819 @end defvar
26820
26821 @defvar Block.global_block
26822 The global block associated with this block. This attribute is not
26823 writable.
26824 @end defvar
26825
26826 @defvar Block.static_block
26827 The static block associated with this block. This attribute is not
26828 writable.
26829 @end defvar
26830
26831 @defvar Block.is_global
26832 @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is a global block,
26833 @code{False} if not. This attribute is not
26834 writable.
26835 @end defvar
26836
26837 @defvar Block.is_static
26838 @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is a static block,
26839 @code{False} if not. This attribute is not writable.
26840 @end defvar
26841
26842 @node Symbols In Python
26843 @subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
26844
26845 @cindex symbols in python
26846 @tindex gdb.Symbol
26847
26848 @value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
26849 entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
26850 Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
26851 @code{gdb.Symbol} object.
26852
26853 The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
26854 module:
26855
26856 @findex gdb.lookup_symbol
26857 @defun gdb.lookup_symbol (name @r{[}, block @r{[}, domain@r{]]})
26858 This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
26859 restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
26860 arguments.
26861
26862 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
26863 optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
26864 in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
26865 @code{gdb.Block} object. If omitted, the block for the current frame
26866 is used. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
26867 the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
26868 domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
26869 in this chapter.
26870
26871 The result is a tuple of two elements.
26872 The first element is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
26873 is not found.
26874 If the symbol is found, the second element is @code{True} if the symbol
26875 is a field of a method's object (e.g., @code{this} in C@t{++}),
26876 otherwise it is @code{False}.
26877 If the symbol is not found, the second element is @code{False}.
26878 @end defun
26879
26880 @findex gdb.lookup_global_symbol
26881 @defun gdb.lookup_global_symbol (name @r{[}, domain@r{]})
26882 This function searches for a global symbol by name.
26883 The search scope can be restricted to by the domain argument.
26884
26885 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string.
26886 The optional @var{domain} argument restricts the search to the domain type.
26887 The @var{domain} argument must be a domain constant defined in the @code{gdb}
26888 module and described later in this chapter.
26889
26890 The result is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
26891 is not found.
26892 @end defun
26893
26894 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
26895
26896 @defvar Symbol.type
26897 The type of the symbol or @code{None} if no type is recorded.
26898 This attribute is represented as a @code{gdb.Type} object.
26899 @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not writable.
26900 @end defvar
26901
26902 @defvar Symbol.symtab
26903 The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
26904 represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
26905 Python}. This attribute is not writable.
26906 @end defvar
26907
26908 @defvar Symbol.line
26909 The line number in the source code at which the symbol was defined.
26910 This is an integer.
26911 @end defvar
26912
26913 @defvar Symbol.name
26914 The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
26915 @end defvar
26916
26917 @defvar Symbol.linkage_name
26918 The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
26919 This attribute is not writable.
26920 @end defvar
26921
26922 @defvar Symbol.print_name
26923 The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
26924 @code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
26925 asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
26926 @end defvar
26927
26928 @defvar Symbol.addr_class
26929 The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
26930 of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
26931 @code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
26932 @end defvar
26933
26934 @defvar Symbol.needs_frame
26935 This is @code{True} if evaluating this symbol's value requires a frame
26936 (@pxref{Frames In Python}) and @code{False} otherwise. Typically,
26937 local variables will require a frame, but other symbols will not.
26938 @end defvar
26939
26940 @defvar Symbol.is_argument
26941 @code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
26942 @end defvar
26943
26944 @defvar Symbol.is_constant
26945 @code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
26946 @end defvar
26947
26948 @defvar Symbol.is_function
26949 @code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
26950 @end defvar
26951
26952 @defvar Symbol.is_variable
26953 @code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
26954 @end defvar
26955
26956 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following methods:
26957
26958 @defun Symbol.is_valid ()
26959 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symbol} object is valid,
26960 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symbol} object can become invalid if
26961 the symbol it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any longer.
26962 All other @code{gdb.Symbol} methods will throw an exception if it is
26963 invalid at the time the method is called.
26964 @end defun
26965
26966 @defun Symbol.value (@r{[}frame@r{]})
26967 Compute the value of the symbol, as a @code{gdb.Value}. For
26968 functions, this computes the address of the function, cast to the
26969 appropriate type. If the symbol requires a frame in order to compute
26970 its value, then @var{frame} must be given. If @var{frame} is not
26971 given, or if @var{frame} is invalid, then this method will throw an
26972 exception.
26973 @end defun
26974
26975 The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
26976 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
26977
26978 @table @code
26979 @findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
26980 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
26981 @item gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
26982 This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
26983 following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
26984 in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
26985 @findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
26986 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
26987 @item gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
26988 This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
26989 type values.
26990 @findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
26991 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
26992 @item gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
26993 This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
26994 @findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
26995 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
26996 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
26997 This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
26998 @findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
26999 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
27000 @item gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
27001 This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
27002 contains everything minus functions and types.
27003 @findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
27004 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
27005 @item gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
27006 This domain contains all functions.
27007 @findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
27008 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
27009 @item gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
27010 This domain contains all types.
27011 @end table
27012
27013 The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
27014 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
27015
27016 @table @code
27017 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
27018 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
27019 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
27020 If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
27021 the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
27022 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
27023 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
27024 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
27025 Value is constant int.
27026 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
27027 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
27028 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
27029 Value is at a fixed address.
27030 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
27031 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
27032 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
27033 Value is in a register.
27034 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
27035 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
27036 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
27037 Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
27038 symbol inside the frame's argument list.
27039 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
27040 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
27041 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
27042 Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
27043 @code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
27044 offset, not the value itself.
27045 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
27046 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
27047 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
27048 Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
27049 the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
27050 itself.
27051 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
27052 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
27053 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
27054 Value is a local variable.
27055 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
27056 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
27057 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
27058 Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
27059 have this class.
27060 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
27061 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
27062 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
27063 Value is a block.
27064 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
27065 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
27066 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
27067 Value is a byte-sequence.
27068 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
27069 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
27070 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
27071 Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
27072 determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
27073 referenced.
27074 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
27075 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
27076 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
27077 The value does not actually exist in the program.
27078 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
27079 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
27080 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
27081 The value's address is a computed location.
27082 @end table
27083
27084 @node Symbol Tables In Python
27085 @subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
27086
27087 @cindex symbol tables in python
27088 @tindex gdb.Symtab
27089 @tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
27090
27091 Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
27092 is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
27093 @code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
27094 from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
27095 @xref{Frames In Python}.
27096
27097 For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
27098 @ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
27099
27100 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
27101
27102 @defvar Symtab_and_line.symtab
27103 The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
27104 This attribute is not writable.
27105 @end defvar
27106
27107 @defvar Symtab_and_line.pc
27108 Indicates the start of the address range occupied by code for the
27109 current source line. This attribute is not writable.
27110 @end defvar
27111
27112 @defvar Symtab_and_line.last
27113 Indicates the end of the address range occupied by code for the current
27114 source line. This attribute is not writable.
27115 @end defvar
27116
27117 @defvar Symtab_and_line.line
27118 Indicates the current line number for this object. This
27119 attribute is not writable.
27120 @end defvar
27121
27122 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following methods:
27123
27124 @defun Symtab_and_line.is_valid ()
27125 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object is valid,
27126 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object can become
27127 invalid if the Symbol table and line object it refers to does not
27128 exist in @value{GDBN} any longer. All other
27129 @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} methods will throw an exception if it is
27130 invalid at the time the method is called.
27131 @end defun
27132
27133 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
27134
27135 @defvar Symtab.filename
27136 The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
27137 @end defvar
27138
27139 @defvar Symtab.objfile
27140 The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
27141 This attribute is not writable.
27142 @end defvar
27143
27144 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following methods:
27145
27146 @defun Symtab.is_valid ()
27147 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab} object is valid,
27148 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab} object can become invalid if
27149 the symbol table it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any
27150 longer. All other @code{gdb.Symtab} methods will throw an exception
27151 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
27152 @end defun
27153
27154 @defun Symtab.fullname ()
27155 Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
27156 @end defun
27157
27158 @defun Symtab.global_block ()
27159 Return the global block of the underlying symbol table.
27160 @xref{Blocks In Python}.
27161 @end defun
27162
27163 @defun Symtab.static_block ()
27164 Return the static block of the underlying symbol table.
27165 @xref{Blocks In Python}.
27166 @end defun
27167
27168 @defun Symtab.linetable ()
27169 Return the line table associated with the symbol table.
27170 @xref{Line Tables In Python}.
27171 @end defun
27172
27173 @node Line Tables In Python
27174 @subsubsection Manipulating line tables using Python
27175
27176 @cindex line tables in python
27177 @tindex gdb.LineTable
27178
27179 Python code can request and inspect line table information from a
27180 symbol table that is loaded in @value{GDBN}. A line table is a
27181 mapping of source lines to their executable locations in memory. To
27182 acquire the line table information for a particular symbol table, use
27183 the @code{linetable} function (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}).
27184
27185 A @code{gdb.LineTable} is iterable. The iterator returns
27186 @code{LineTableEntry} objects that correspond to the source line and
27187 address for each line table entry. @code{LineTableEntry} objects have
27188 the following attributes:
27189
27190 @defvar LineTableEntry.line
27191 The source line number for this line table entry. This number
27192 corresponds to the actual line of source. This attribute is not
27193 writable.
27194 @end defvar
27195
27196 @defvar LineTableEntry.pc
27197 The address that is associated with the line table entry where the
27198 executable code for that source line resides in memory. This
27199 attribute is not writable.
27200 @end defvar
27201
27202 As there can be multiple addresses for a single source line, you may
27203 receive multiple @code{LineTableEntry} objects with matching
27204 @code{line} attributes, but with different @code{pc} attributes. The
27205 iterator is sorted in ascending @code{pc} order. Here is a small
27206 example illustrating iterating over a line table.
27207
27208 @smallexample
27209 symtab = gdb.selected_frame().find_sal().symtab
27210 linetable = symtab.linetable()
27211 for line in linetable:
27212 print "Line: "+str(line.line)+" Address: "+hex(line.pc)
27213 @end smallexample
27214
27215 This will have the following output:
27216
27217 @smallexample
27218 Line: 33 Address: 0x4005c8L
27219 Line: 37 Address: 0x4005caL
27220 Line: 39 Address: 0x4005d2L
27221 Line: 40 Address: 0x4005f8L
27222 Line: 42 Address: 0x4005ffL
27223 Line: 44 Address: 0x400608L
27224 Line: 42 Address: 0x40060cL
27225 Line: 45 Address: 0x400615L
27226 @end smallexample
27227
27228 In addition to being able to iterate over a @code{LineTable}, it also
27229 has the following direct access methods:
27230
27231 @defun LineTable.line (line)
27232 Return a Python @code{Tuple} of @code{LineTableEntry} objects for any
27233 entries in the line table for the given @var{line}. @var{line} refers
27234 to the source code line. If there are no entries for that source code
27235 @var{line}, the Python @code{None} is returned.
27236 @end defun
27237
27238 @defun LineTable.has_line (line)
27239 Return a Python @code{Boolean} indicating whether there is an entry in
27240 the line table for this source line. Return @code{True} if an entry
27241 is found, or @code{False} if not.
27242 @end defun
27243
27244 @defun LineTable.source_lines ()
27245 Return a Python @code{List} of the source line numbers in the symbol
27246 table. Only lines with executable code locations are returned. The
27247 contents of the @code{List} will just be the source line entries
27248 represented as Python @code{Long} values.
27249 @end defun
27250
27251 @node Breakpoints In Python
27252 @subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
27253
27254 @cindex breakpoints in python
27255 @tindex gdb.Breakpoint
27256
27257 Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
27258 class.
27259
27260 @defun Breakpoint.__init__ (spec @r{[}, type @r{[}, wp_class @r{[},internal @r{[},temporary@r{]]]]})
27261 Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the location
27262 of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a watchpoint. The
27263 contents can be any location recognized by the @code{break} command,
27264 or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch} command. The
27265 optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create from the types
27266 defined later in this chapter. This argument can be either:
27267 @code{gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
27268 defaults to @code{gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{internal}
27269 argument allows the breakpoint to become invisible to the user. The
27270 breakpoint will neither be reported when created, nor will it be
27271 listed in the output from @code{info breakpoints} (but will be listed
27272 with the @code{maint info breakpoints} command). The optional
27273 @var{temporary} argument makes the breakpoint a temporary breakpoint.
27274 Temporary breakpoints are deleted after they have been hit. Any
27275 further access to the Python breakpoint after it has been hit will
27276 result in a runtime error (as that breakpoint has now been
27277 automatically deleted). The optional @var{wp_class} argument defines
27278 the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
27279 @code{gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not provided, it
27280 is assumed to be a @code{gdb.WP_WRITE} class.
27281 @end defun
27282
27283 @defun Breakpoint.stop (self)
27284 The @code{gdb.Breakpoint} class can be sub-classed and, in
27285 particular, you may choose to implement the @code{stop} method.
27286 If this method is defined in a sub-class of @code{gdb.Breakpoint},
27287 it will be called when the inferior reaches any location of a
27288 breakpoint which instantiates that sub-class. If the method returns
27289 @code{True}, the inferior will be stopped at the location of the
27290 breakpoint, otherwise the inferior will continue.
27291
27292 If there are multiple breakpoints at the same location with a
27293 @code{stop} method, each one will be called regardless of the
27294 return status of the previous. This ensures that all @code{stop}
27295 methods have a chance to execute at that location. In this scenario
27296 if one of the methods returns @code{True} but the others return
27297 @code{False}, the inferior will still be stopped.
27298
27299 You should not alter the execution state of the inferior (i.e.@:, step,
27300 next, etc.), alter the current frame context (i.e.@:, change the current
27301 active frame), or alter, add or delete any breakpoint. As a general
27302 rule, you should not alter any data within @value{GDBN} or the inferior
27303 at this time.
27304
27305 Example @code{stop} implementation:
27306
27307 @smallexample
27308 class MyBreakpoint (gdb.Breakpoint):
27309 def stop (self):
27310 inf_val = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo")
27311 if inf_val == 3:
27312 return True
27313 return False
27314 @end smallexample
27315 @end defun
27316
27317 The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
27318 @code{gdb} module:
27319
27320 @table @code
27321 @findex WP_READ
27322 @findex gdb.WP_READ
27323 @item gdb.WP_READ
27324 Read only watchpoint.
27325
27326 @findex WP_WRITE
27327 @findex gdb.WP_WRITE
27328 @item gdb.WP_WRITE
27329 Write only watchpoint.
27330
27331 @findex WP_ACCESS
27332 @findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
27333 @item gdb.WP_ACCESS
27334 Read/Write watchpoint.
27335 @end table
27336
27337 @defun Breakpoint.is_valid ()
27338 Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
27339 @code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
27340 if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
27341 exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
27342 watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
27343 inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
27344 @end defun
27345
27346 @defun Breakpoint.delete
27347 Permanently deletes the @value{GDBN} breakpoint. This also
27348 invalidates the Python @code{Breakpoint} object. Any further access
27349 to this object's attributes or methods will raise an error.
27350 @end defun
27351
27352 @defvar Breakpoint.enabled
27353 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
27354 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
27355 @end defvar
27356
27357 @defvar Breakpoint.silent
27358 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
27359 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
27360
27361 Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
27362 first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
27363 @code{silent} attribute.
27364 @end defvar
27365
27366 @defvar Breakpoint.thread
27367 If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
27368 id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
27369 @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
27370 @end defvar
27371
27372 @defvar Breakpoint.task
27373 If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
27374 id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
27375 language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
27376 is writable.
27377 @end defvar
27378
27379 @defvar Breakpoint.ignore_count
27380 This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
27381 This attribute is writable.
27382 @end defvar
27383
27384 @defvar Breakpoint.number
27385 This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
27386 the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
27387 @end defvar
27388
27389 @defvar Breakpoint.type
27390 This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
27391 determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
27392 writable.
27393 @end defvar
27394
27395 @defvar Breakpoint.visible
27396 This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user
27397 when set, or when the @samp{info breakpoints} command is run. This
27398 attribute is not writable.
27399 @end defvar
27400
27401 @defvar Breakpoint.temporary
27402 This attribute indicates whether the breakpoint was created as a
27403 temporary breakpoint. Temporary breakpoints are automatically deleted
27404 after that breakpoint has been hit. Access to this attribute, and all
27405 other attributes and functions other than the @code{is_valid}
27406 function, will result in an error after the breakpoint has been hit
27407 (as it has been automatically deleted). This attribute is not
27408 writable.
27409 @end defvar
27410
27411 The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
27412 module:
27413
27414 @table @code
27415 @findex BP_BREAKPOINT
27416 @findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
27417 @item gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
27418 Normal code breakpoint.
27419
27420 @findex BP_WATCHPOINT
27421 @findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
27422 @item gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
27423 Watchpoint breakpoint.
27424
27425 @findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
27426 @findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
27427 @item gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
27428 Hardware assisted watchpoint.
27429
27430 @findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
27431 @findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
27432 @item gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
27433 Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
27434
27435 @findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
27436 @findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
27437 @item gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
27438 Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
27439 @end table
27440
27441 @defvar Breakpoint.hit_count
27442 This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
27443 This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
27444 @end defvar
27445
27446 @defvar Breakpoint.location
27447 This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
27448 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
27449 (that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
27450 attribute is not writable.
27451 @end defvar
27452
27453 @defvar Breakpoint.expression
27454 This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
27455 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
27456 expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
27457 is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
27458 @end defvar
27459
27460 @defvar Breakpoint.condition
27461 This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
27462 the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
27463 value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
27464 @end defvar
27465
27466 @defvar Breakpoint.commands
27467 This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
27468 there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
27469 commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
27470 attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
27471 @end defvar
27472
27473 @node Finish Breakpoints in Python
27474 @subsubsection Finish Breakpoints
27475
27476 @cindex python finish breakpoints
27477 @tindex gdb.FinishBreakpoint
27478
27479 A finish breakpoint is a temporary breakpoint set at the return address of
27480 a frame, based on the @code{finish} command. @code{gdb.FinishBreakpoint}
27481 extends @code{gdb.Breakpoint}. The underlying breakpoint will be disabled
27482 and deleted when the execution will run out of the breakpoint scope (i.e.@:
27483 @code{Breakpoint.stop} or @code{FinishBreakpoint.out_of_scope} triggered).
27484 Finish breakpoints are thread specific and must be create with the right
27485 thread selected.
27486
27487 @defun FinishBreakpoint.__init__ (@r{[}frame@r{]} @r{[}, internal@r{]})
27488 Create a finish breakpoint at the return address of the @code{gdb.Frame}
27489 object @var{frame}. If @var{frame} is not provided, this defaults to the
27490 newest frame. The optional @var{internal} argument allows the breakpoint to
27491 become invisible to the user. @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for further
27492 details about this argument.
27493 @end defun
27494
27495 @defun FinishBreakpoint.out_of_scope (self)
27496 In some circumstances (e.g.@: @code{longjmp}, C@t{++} exceptions, @value{GDBN}
27497 @code{return} command, @dots{}), a function may not properly terminate, and
27498 thus never hit the finish breakpoint. When @value{GDBN} notices such a
27499 situation, the @code{out_of_scope} callback will be triggered.
27500
27501 You may want to sub-class @code{gdb.FinishBreakpoint} and override this
27502 method:
27503
27504 @smallexample
27505 class MyFinishBreakpoint (gdb.FinishBreakpoint)
27506 def stop (self):
27507 print "normal finish"
27508 return True
27509
27510 def out_of_scope ():
27511 print "abnormal finish"
27512 @end smallexample
27513 @end defun
27514
27515 @defvar FinishBreakpoint.return_value
27516 When @value{GDBN} is stopped at a finish breakpoint and the frame
27517 used to build the @code{gdb.FinishBreakpoint} object had debug symbols, this
27518 attribute will contain a @code{gdb.Value} object corresponding to the return
27519 value of the function. The value will be @code{None} if the function return
27520 type is @code{void} or if the return value was not computable. This attribute
27521 is not writable.
27522 @end defvar
27523
27524 @node Lazy Strings In Python
27525 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
27526
27527 @cindex lazy strings in python
27528 @tindex gdb.LazyString
27529
27530 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
27531 encoded until it is needed.
27532
27533 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
27534 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
27535 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
27536 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
27537 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
27538 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
27539 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
27540 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
27541 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
27542
27543 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
27544
27545 @defun LazyString.value ()
27546 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
27547 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
27548 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
27549 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
27550 @end defun
27551
27552 @defvar LazyString.address
27553 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
27554 writable.
27555 @end defvar
27556
27557 @defvar LazyString.length
27558 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
27559 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
27560 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
27561 @end defvar
27562
27563 @defvar LazyString.encoding
27564 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
27565 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
27566 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
27567 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
27568 is not writable.
27569 @end defvar
27570
27571 @defvar LazyString.type
27572 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
27573 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
27574 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
27575 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
27576 writable.
27577 @end defvar
27578
27579 @node Architectures In Python
27580 @subsubsection Python representation of architectures
27581 @cindex Python architectures
27582
27583 @value{GDBN} uses architecture specific parameters and artifacts in a
27584 number of its various computations. An architecture is represented
27585 by an instance of the @code{gdb.Architecture} class.
27586
27587 A @code{gdb.Architecture} class has the following methods:
27588
27589 @defun Architecture.name ()
27590 Return the name (string value) of the architecture.
27591 @end defun
27592
27593 @defun Architecture.disassemble (@var{start_pc} @r{[}, @var{end_pc} @r{[}, @var{count}@r{]]})
27594 Return a list of disassembled instructions starting from the memory
27595 address @var{start_pc}. The optional arguments @var{end_pc} and
27596 @var{count} determine the number of instructions in the returned list.
27597 If both the optional arguments @var{end_pc} and @var{count} are
27598 specified, then a list of at most @var{count} disassembled instructions
27599 whose start address falls in the closed memory address interval from
27600 @var{start_pc} to @var{end_pc} are returned. If @var{end_pc} is not
27601 specified, but @var{count} is specified, then @var{count} number of
27602 instructions starting from the address @var{start_pc} are returned. If
27603 @var{count} is not specified but @var{end_pc} is specified, then all
27604 instructions whose start address falls in the closed memory address
27605 interval from @var{start_pc} to @var{end_pc} are returned. If neither
27606 @var{end_pc} nor @var{count} are specified, then a single instruction at
27607 @var{start_pc} is returned. For all of these cases, each element of the
27608 returned list is a Python @code{dict} with the following string keys:
27609
27610 @table @code
27611
27612 @item addr
27613 The value corresponding to this key is a Python long integer capturing
27614 the memory address of the instruction.
27615
27616 @item asm
27617 The value corresponding to this key is a string value which represents
27618 the instruction with assembly language mnemonics. The assembly
27619 language flavor used is the same as that specified by the current CLI
27620 variable @code{disassembly-flavor}. @xref{Machine Code}.
27621
27622 @item length
27623 The value corresponding to this key is the length (integer value) of the
27624 instruction in bytes.
27625
27626 @end table
27627 @end defun
27628
27629 @node Python Auto-loading
27630 @subsection Python Auto-loading
27631 @cindex Python auto-loading
27632
27633 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
27634 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
27635 @value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
27636 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
27637 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
27638
27639 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
27640 debugging commands and scripts.
27641
27642 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
27643 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
27644
27645 @table @code
27646 @anchor{set auto-load python-scripts}
27647 @kindex set auto-load python-scripts
27648 @item set auto-load python-scripts [on|off]
27649 Enable or disable the auto-loading of Python scripts.
27650
27651 @anchor{show auto-load python-scripts}
27652 @kindex show auto-load python-scripts
27653 @item show auto-load python-scripts
27654 Show whether auto-loading of Python scripts is enabled or disabled.
27655
27656 @anchor{info auto-load python-scripts}
27657 @kindex info auto-load python-scripts
27658 @cindex print list of auto-loaded Python scripts
27659 @item info auto-load python-scripts [@var{regexp}]
27660 Print the list of all Python scripts that @value{GDBN} auto-loaded.
27661
27662 Also printed is the list of Python scripts that were mentioned in
27663 the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section and were not found
27664 (@pxref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}).
27665 This is useful because their names are not printed when @value{GDBN}
27666 tries to load them and fails. There may be many of them, and printing
27667 an error message for each one is problematic.
27668
27669 If @var{regexp} is supplied only Python scripts with matching names are printed.
27670
27671 Example:
27672
27673 @smallexample
27674 (gdb) info auto-load python-scripts
27675 Loaded Script
27676 Yes py-section-script.py
27677 full name: /tmp/py-section-script.py
27678 No my-foo-pretty-printers.py
27679 @end smallexample
27680 @end table
27681
27682 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
27683 @dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
27684 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
27685 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers and frame-filters.
27686
27687 @node Python modules
27688 @subsection Python modules
27689 @cindex python modules
27690
27691 @value{GDBN} comes with several modules to assist writing Python code.
27692
27693 @menu
27694 * gdb.printing:: Building and registering pretty-printers.
27695 * gdb.types:: Utilities for working with types.
27696 * gdb.prompt:: Utilities for prompt value substitution.
27697 @end menu
27698
27699 @node gdb.printing
27700 @subsubsection gdb.printing
27701 @cindex gdb.printing
27702
27703 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
27704 pretty-printers.
27705
27706 @table @code
27707 @item PrettyPrinter (@var{name}, @var{subprinters}=None)
27708 This class specifies the API that makes @samp{info pretty-printer},
27709 @samp{enable pretty-printer} and @samp{disable pretty-printer} work.
27710 Pretty-printers should generally inherit from this class.
27711
27712 @item SubPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
27713 For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the
27714 corresponding API for the subprinters.
27715
27716 @item RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
27717 Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via
27718 regular expressions.
27719 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for an example.
27720
27721 @item FlagEnumerationPrinter (@var{name})
27722 A pretty-printer which handles printing of @code{enum} values. Unlike
27723 @value{GDBN}'s built-in @code{enum} printing, this printer attempts to
27724 work properly when there is some overlap between the enumeration
27725 constants. @var{name} is the name of the printer and also the name of
27726 the @code{enum} type to look up.
27727
27728 @item register_pretty_printer (@var{obj}, @var{printer}, @var{replace}=False)
27729 Register @var{printer} with the pretty-printer list of @var{obj}.
27730 If @var{replace} is @code{True} then any existing copy of the printer
27731 is replaced. Otherwise a @code{RuntimeError} exception is raised
27732 if a printer with the same name already exists.
27733 @end table
27734
27735 @node gdb.types
27736 @subsubsection gdb.types
27737 @cindex gdb.types
27738
27739 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
27740 @code{gdb.Type} objects.
27741
27742 @table @code
27743 @item get_basic_type (@var{type})
27744 Return @var{type} with const and volatile qualifiers stripped,
27745 and with typedefs and C@t{++} references converted to the underlying type.
27746
27747 C@t{++} example:
27748
27749 @smallexample
27750 typedef const int const_int;
27751 const_int foo (3);
27752 const_int& foo_ref (foo);
27753 int main () @{ return 0; @}
27754 @end smallexample
27755
27756 Then in gdb:
27757
27758 @smallexample
27759 (gdb) start
27760 (gdb) python import gdb.types
27761 (gdb) python foo_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo_ref")
27762 (gdb) python print gdb.types.get_basic_type(foo_ref.type)
27763 int
27764 @end smallexample
27765
27766 @item has_field (@var{type}, @var{field})
27767 Return @code{True} if @var{type}, assumed to be a type with fields
27768 (e.g., a structure or union), has field @var{field}.
27769
27770 @item make_enum_dict (@var{enum_type})
27771 Return a Python @code{dictionary} type produced from @var{enum_type}.
27772
27773 @item deep_items (@var{type})
27774 Returns a Python iterator similar to the standard
27775 @code{gdb.Type.iteritems} method, except that the iterator returned
27776 by @code{deep_items} will recursively traverse anonymous struct or
27777 union fields. For example:
27778
27779 @smallexample
27780 struct A
27781 @{
27782 int a;
27783 union @{
27784 int b0;
27785 int b1;
27786 @};
27787 @};
27788 @end smallexample
27789
27790 @noindent
27791 Then in @value{GDBN}:
27792 @smallexample
27793 (@value{GDBP}) python import gdb.types
27794 (@value{GDBP}) python struct_a = gdb.lookup_type("struct A")
27795 (@value{GDBP}) python print struct_a.keys ()
27796 @{['a', '']@}
27797 (@value{GDBP}) python print [k for k,v in gdb.types.deep_items(struct_a)]
27798 @{['a', 'b0', 'b1']@}
27799 @end smallexample
27800
27801 @item get_type_recognizers ()
27802 Return a list of the enabled type recognizers for the current context.
27803 This is called by @value{GDBN} during the type-printing process
27804 (@pxref{Type Printing API}).
27805
27806 @item apply_type_recognizers (recognizers, type_obj)
27807 Apply the type recognizers, @var{recognizers}, to the type object
27808 @var{type_obj}. If any recognizer returns a string, return that
27809 string. Otherwise, return @code{None}. This is called by
27810 @value{GDBN} during the type-printing process (@pxref{Type Printing
27811 API}).
27812
27813 @item register_type_printer (locus, printer)
27814 This is a convenience function to register a type printer.
27815 @var{printer} is the type printer to register. It must implement the
27816 type printer protocol. @var{locus} is either a @code{gdb.Objfile}, in
27817 which case the printer is registered with that objfile; a
27818 @code{gdb.Progspace}, in which case the printer is registered with
27819 that progspace; or @code{None}, in which case the printer is
27820 registered globally.
27821
27822 @item TypePrinter
27823 This is a base class that implements the type printer protocol. Type
27824 printers are encouraged, but not required, to derive from this class.
27825 It defines a constructor:
27826
27827 @defmethod TypePrinter __init__ (self, name)
27828 Initialize the type printer with the given name. The new printer
27829 starts in the enabled state.
27830 @end defmethod
27831
27832 @end table
27833
27834 @node gdb.prompt
27835 @subsubsection gdb.prompt
27836 @cindex gdb.prompt
27837
27838 This module provides a method for prompt value-substitution.
27839
27840 @table @code
27841 @item substitute_prompt (@var{string})
27842 Return @var{string} with escape sequences substituted by values. Some
27843 escape sequences take arguments. You can specify arguments inside
27844 ``@{@}'' immediately following the escape sequence.
27845
27846 The escape sequences you can pass to this function are:
27847
27848 @table @code
27849 @item \\
27850 Substitute a backslash.
27851 @item \e
27852 Substitute an ESC character.
27853 @item \f
27854 Substitute the selected frame; an argument names a frame parameter.
27855 @item \n
27856 Substitute a newline.
27857 @item \p
27858 Substitute a parameter's value; the argument names the parameter.
27859 @item \r
27860 Substitute a carriage return.
27861 @item \t
27862 Substitute the selected thread; an argument names a thread parameter.
27863 @item \v
27864 Substitute the version of GDB.
27865 @item \w
27866 Substitute the current working directory.
27867 @item \[
27868 Begin a sequence of non-printing characters. These sequences are
27869 typically used with the ESC character, and are not counted in the string
27870 length. Example: ``\[\e[0;34m\](gdb)\[\e[0m\]'' will return a
27871 blue-colored ``(gdb)'' prompt where the length is five.
27872 @item \]
27873 End a sequence of non-printing characters.
27874 @end table
27875
27876 For example:
27877
27878 @smallexample
27879 substitute_prompt (``frame: \f,
27880 print arguments: \p@{print frame-arguments@}'')
27881 @end smallexample
27882
27883 @exdent will return the string:
27884
27885 @smallexample
27886 "frame: main, print arguments: scalars"
27887 @end smallexample
27888 @end table
27889
27890 @node Auto-loading extensions
27891 @section Auto-loading extensions
27892 @cindex auto-loading extensions
27893
27894 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
27895 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
27896 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
27897 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
27898 section of modern file formats like ELF.
27899
27900 @menu
27901 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
27902 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27903 * Which flavor to choose?::
27904 @end menu
27905
27906 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
27907 debugging commands and features.
27908
27909 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
27910 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
27911 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
27912 for more information.
27913 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
27914 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
27915
27916 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
27917 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27918
27919 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
27920 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
27921 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
27922 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
27923 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
27924
27925 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
27926 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
27927 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
27928 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
27929
27930 @table @code
27931 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
27932 GDB's own command language
27933 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
27934 Python
27935 @end table
27936
27937 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
27938 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
27939 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
27940 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
27941 script in the specified extension language.
27942
27943 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
27944 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
27945
27946 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
27947 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27948
27949 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
27950 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
27951 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
27952 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
27953 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
27954 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
27955
27956 @table @code
27957 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
27958 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
27959 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
27960 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
27961 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
27962 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
27963
27964 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
27965 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
27966
27967 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
27968 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
27969 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
27970 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
27971
27972 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
27973 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
27974 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
27975 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
27976 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
27977 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
27978 platform.
27979
27980 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
27981 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
27982 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
27983
27984 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
27985 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
27986 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
27987 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
27988 @end table
27989
27990 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
27991 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
27992 @var{objfile} is opened.
27993 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
27994 is evaluated more than once.
27995
27996 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
27997 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27998 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27999
28000 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
28001 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
28002 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
28003 If this section exists, its contents is a list of NUL-terminated names
28004 of scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-NULL prefix byte that
28005 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language.
28006
28007 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
28008 current directory and then along the source search path
28009 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
28010 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
28011 directory is not relevant to scripts.
28012
28013 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
28014 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
28015
28016 @example
28017 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
28018 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
28019 asm("\
28020 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
28021 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
28022 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
28023 .popsection \n\
28024 ");
28025 @end example
28026
28027 @noindent
28028 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
28029
28030 @example
28031 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
28032 @end example
28033
28034 The script name may include directories if desired.
28035
28036 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
28037 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
28038
28039 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
28040 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
28041 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
28042 will remove duplicates.
28043
28044 @node Which flavor to choose?
28045 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
28046
28047 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
28048 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
28049
28050 @noindent
28051 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
28052
28053 @itemize @bullet
28054 @item
28055 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
28056
28057 @item
28058 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
28059
28060 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
28061 in the source search path.
28062 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
28063 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
28064
28065 @item
28066 Doesn't require source code additions.
28067 @end itemize
28068
28069 @noindent
28070 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
28071
28072 @itemize @bullet
28073 @item
28074 Works with static linking.
28075
28076 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
28077 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
28078 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
28079 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
28080 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
28081
28082 @item
28083 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
28084
28085 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
28086 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
28087
28088 @item
28089 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
28090
28091 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
28092 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
28093 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
28094 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
28095 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
28096 top of the source tree to the source search path.
28097 @end itemize
28098
28099 @node Aliases
28100 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
28101 @cindex aliases for commands
28102
28103 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
28104 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
28105 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
28106 that involves less typing.
28107
28108 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
28109 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
28110 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
28111
28112 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
28113 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
28114 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
28115
28116 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
28117
28118 @table @code
28119
28120 @kindex alias
28121 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
28122
28123 @end table
28124
28125 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
28126 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
28127 underscores.
28128
28129 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
28130 that is being aliased.
28131
28132 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
28133 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
28134 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
28135
28136 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
28137 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
28138
28139 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
28140 of a command so that there is less to type.
28141 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
28142 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
28143 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
28144 The following will accomplish this.
28145
28146 @smallexample
28147 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
28148 @end smallexample
28149
28150 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
28151 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
28152 for it with the @samp{document} command.
28153 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
28154
28155 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
28156 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
28157 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
28158 of a command.
28159
28160 @smallexample
28161 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
28162 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
28163 (gdb) set p elms 20
28164 (gdb) show p elms
28165 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
28166 @end smallexample
28167
28168 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
28169 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
28170 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
28171
28172 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
28173 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
28174
28175 @smallexample
28176 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
28177 @end smallexample
28178
28179 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
28180 alias for a more complex command.
28181 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
28182
28183 @smallexample
28184 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
28185 (gdb) spe 20
28186 @end smallexample
28187
28188 @node Interpreters
28189 @chapter Command Interpreters
28190 @cindex command interpreters
28191
28192 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
28193 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
28194 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
28195
28196 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
28197 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
28198 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
28199 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
28200
28201 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
28202 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
28203 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
28204 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
28205
28206 @table @code
28207 @item console
28208 @cindex console interpreter
28209 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
28210 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
28211 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
28212
28213 @item mi
28214 @cindex mi interpreter
28215 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
28216 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
28217 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
28218 Interface}.
28219
28220 @item mi2
28221 @cindex mi2 interpreter
28222 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
28223
28224 @item mi1
28225 @cindex mi1 interpreter
28226 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
28227
28228 @end table
28229
28230 @cindex invoke another interpreter
28231 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
28232 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
28233 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
28234 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
28235 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
28236 the IDE inoperable!
28237
28238 @kindex interpreter-exec
28239 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
28240 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
28241 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
28242 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
28243
28244 @smallexample
28245 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
28246 @end smallexample
28247
28248 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
28249 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
28250
28251 @node TUI
28252 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
28253 @cindex TUI
28254 @cindex Text User Interface
28255
28256 @menu
28257 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
28258 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
28259 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
28260 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
28261 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
28262 @end menu
28263
28264 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
28265 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
28266 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
28267 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
28268 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
28269 is available.
28270
28271 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
28272 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
28273 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
28274 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
28275 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
28276
28277 @node TUI Overview
28278 @section TUI Overview
28279
28280 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
28281
28282 @table @emph
28283 @item command
28284 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
28285 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
28286 managed using readline.
28287
28288 @item source
28289 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
28290 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
28291
28292 @item assembly
28293 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
28294
28295 @item register
28296 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
28297 when their values change.
28298 @end table
28299
28300 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
28301 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
28302 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
28303 indicates the breakpoint type:
28304
28305 @table @code
28306 @item B
28307 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
28308
28309 @item b
28310 Breakpoint which was never hit.
28311
28312 @item H
28313 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
28314
28315 @item h
28316 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
28317 @end table
28318
28319 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
28320
28321 @table @code
28322 @item +
28323 Breakpoint is enabled.
28324
28325 @item -
28326 Breakpoint is disabled.
28327 @end table
28328
28329 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
28330 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
28331 changes.
28332
28333 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
28334 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
28335 layouts:
28336
28337 @itemize @bullet
28338 @item
28339 source only,
28340
28341 @item
28342 assembly only,
28343
28344 @item
28345 source and assembly,
28346
28347 @item
28348 source and registers, or
28349
28350 @item
28351 assembly and registers.
28352 @end itemize
28353
28354 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
28355
28356 @table @emph
28357 @item target
28358 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
28359 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
28360
28361 @item process
28362 Gives the current process or thread number.
28363 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
28364
28365 @item function
28366 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
28367 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
28368 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
28369 the string @code{??} is displayed.
28370
28371 @item line
28372 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
28373 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
28374
28375 @item pc
28376 Indicates the current program counter address.
28377 @end table
28378
28379 @node TUI Keys
28380 @section TUI Key Bindings
28381 @cindex TUI key bindings
28382
28383 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
28384 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
28385 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
28386 @end ifset
28387 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
28388 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
28389 @end ifclear
28390 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
28391 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
28392
28393 @table @kbd
28394 @kindex C-x C-a
28395 @item C-x C-a
28396 @kindex C-x a
28397 @itemx C-x a
28398 @kindex C-x A
28399 @itemx C-x A
28400 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
28401 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
28402 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
28403 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
28404 The screen is then refreshed.
28405
28406 @kindex C-x 1
28407 @item C-x 1
28408 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
28409 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
28410 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
28411
28412 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
28413
28414 @kindex C-x 2
28415 @item C-x 2
28416 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
28417 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
28418 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
28419 previous layout and the new one.
28420
28421 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
28422
28423 @kindex C-x o
28424 @item C-x o
28425 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
28426 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
28427 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
28428
28429 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
28430
28431 @kindex C-x s
28432 @item C-x s
28433 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
28434 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
28435 @end table
28436
28437 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
28438
28439 @table @asis
28440 @kindex PgUp
28441 @item @key{PgUp}
28442 Scroll the active window one page up.
28443
28444 @kindex PgDn
28445 @item @key{PgDn}
28446 Scroll the active window one page down.
28447
28448 @kindex Up
28449 @item @key{Up}
28450 Scroll the active window one line up.
28451
28452 @kindex Down
28453 @item @key{Down}
28454 Scroll the active window one line down.
28455
28456 @kindex Left
28457 @item @key{Left}
28458 Scroll the active window one column left.
28459
28460 @kindex Right
28461 @item @key{Right}
28462 Scroll the active window one column right.
28463
28464 @kindex C-L
28465 @item @kbd{C-L}
28466 Refresh the screen.
28467 @end table
28468
28469 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
28470 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
28471 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
28472 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
28473 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
28474
28475 @node TUI Single Key Mode
28476 @section TUI Single Key Mode
28477 @cindex TUI single key mode
28478
28479 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
28480 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
28481 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
28482
28483 @table @kbd
28484 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28485 @item c
28486 continue
28487
28488 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28489 @item d
28490 down
28491
28492 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28493 @item f
28494 finish
28495
28496 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28497 @item n
28498 next
28499
28500 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28501 @item q
28502 exit the SingleKey mode.
28503
28504 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28505 @item r
28506 run
28507
28508 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28509 @item s
28510 step
28511
28512 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28513 @item u
28514 up
28515
28516 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28517 @item v
28518 info locals
28519
28520 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
28521 @item w
28522 where
28523 @end table
28524
28525 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
28526 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
28527 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
28528 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
28529 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
28530 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
28531
28532
28533 @node TUI Commands
28534 @section TUI-specific Commands
28535 @cindex TUI commands
28536
28537 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
28538 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
28539 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
28540 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
28541
28542 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
28543 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
28544 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
28545 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
28546 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
28547
28548 @table @code
28549 @item info win
28550 @kindex info win
28551 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
28552
28553 @item layout next
28554 @kindex layout
28555 Display the next layout.
28556
28557 @item layout prev
28558 Display the previous layout.
28559
28560 @item layout src
28561 Display the source window only.
28562
28563 @item layout asm
28564 Display the assembly window only.
28565
28566 @item layout split
28567 Display the source and assembly window.
28568
28569 @item layout regs
28570 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
28571
28572 @item focus next
28573 @kindex focus
28574 Make the next window active for scrolling.
28575
28576 @item focus prev
28577 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
28578
28579 @item focus src
28580 Make the source window active for scrolling.
28581
28582 @item focus asm
28583 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
28584
28585 @item focus regs
28586 Make the register window active for scrolling.
28587
28588 @item focus cmd
28589 Make the command window active for scrolling.
28590
28591 @item refresh
28592 @kindex refresh
28593 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
28594
28595 @item tui reg float
28596 @kindex tui reg
28597 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
28598
28599 @item tui reg general
28600 Show the general registers in the register window.
28601
28602 @item tui reg next
28603 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
28604 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
28605 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
28606 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
28607
28608 @item tui reg system
28609 Show the system registers in the register window.
28610
28611 @item update
28612 @kindex update
28613 Update the source window and the current execution point.
28614
28615 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
28616 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
28617 @kindex winheight
28618 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
28619 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
28620 decrease it.
28621
28622 @item tabset @var{nchars}
28623 @kindex tabset
28624 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
28625 @end table
28626
28627 @node TUI Configuration
28628 @section TUI Configuration Variables
28629 @cindex TUI configuration variables
28630
28631 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
28632
28633 @table @code
28634 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
28635 @kindex set tui border-kind
28636 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
28637 The possible values are the following:
28638 @table @code
28639 @item space
28640 Use a space character to draw the border.
28641
28642 @item ascii
28643 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
28644
28645 @item acs
28646 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
28647 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
28648 @end table
28649
28650 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
28651 @kindex set tui border-mode
28652 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
28653 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
28654 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
28655 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
28656 @table @code
28657 @item normal
28658 Use normal attributes to display the border.
28659
28660 @item standout
28661 Use standout mode.
28662
28663 @item reverse
28664 Use reverse video mode.
28665
28666 @item half
28667 Use half bright mode.
28668
28669 @item half-standout
28670 Use half bright and standout mode.
28671
28672 @item bold
28673 Use extra bright or bold mode.
28674
28675 @item bold-standout
28676 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
28677 @end table
28678 @end table
28679
28680 @node Emacs
28681 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
28682
28683 @cindex Emacs
28684 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
28685 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
28686 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
28687 @value{GDBN}.
28688
28689 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
28690 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
28691 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
28692 created Emacs buffer.
28693 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
28694
28695 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
28696 things:
28697
28698 @itemize @bullet
28699 @item
28700 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
28701 the GUD buffer.
28702
28703 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
28704 and output done by the program you are debugging.
28705
28706 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
28707 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
28708 in this way.
28709
28710 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
28711 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
28712 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
28713 stop.
28714
28715 @item
28716 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
28717
28718 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
28719 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
28720 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
28721 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
28722 and the source.
28723
28724 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
28725 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
28726 @end itemize
28727
28728 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
28729 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
28730 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
28731 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
28732
28733 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
28734 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
28735 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
28736 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
28737 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
28738 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
28739 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
28740 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
28741 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
28742
28743 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
28744 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
28745 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
28746 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
28747
28748 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
28749 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
28750 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
28751 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
28752 one you want.
28753
28754 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
28755 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
28756
28757 @table @kbd
28758 @item C-h m
28759 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
28760
28761 @item C-c C-s
28762 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
28763 update the display window to show the current file and location.
28764
28765 @item C-c C-n
28766 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
28767 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
28768 to show the current file and location.
28769
28770 @item C-c C-i
28771 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
28772 display window accordingly.
28773
28774 @item C-c C-f
28775 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
28776 @code{finish} command.
28777
28778 @item C-c C-r
28779 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
28780 command.
28781
28782 @item C-c <
28783 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
28784 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
28785 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
28786
28787 @item C-c >
28788 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
28789 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
28790 @end table
28791
28792 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
28793 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
28794
28795 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
28796 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
28797 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
28798 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
28799 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
28800 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
28801 speedbar displays watch expressions.
28802
28803 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
28804 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
28805 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
28806 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
28807 frame.
28808
28809 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
28810 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
28811 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
28812 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
28813 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
28814 to correspond properly with the code.
28815
28816 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
28817 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
28818 Emacs Manual}).
28819
28820 @node GDB/MI
28821 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
28822
28823 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
28824
28825 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
28826 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
28827 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
28828 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
28829 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
28830 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
28831
28832 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
28833 in the form of a reference manual.
28834
28835 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
28836 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
28837 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
28838
28839 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
28840
28841 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
28842 This chapter uses the following notation:
28843
28844 @itemize @bullet
28845 @item
28846 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
28847
28848 @item
28849 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
28850 it may or may not be given.
28851
28852 @item
28853 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
28854 may repeat zero or more times.
28855
28856 @item
28857 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
28858 may repeat one or more times.
28859
28860 @item
28861 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
28862 @end itemize
28863
28864 @ignore
28865 @heading Dependencies
28866 @end ignore
28867
28868 @menu
28869 * GDB/MI General Design::
28870 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
28871 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
28872 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
28873 * GDB/MI Output Records::
28874 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
28875 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
28876 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
28877 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28878 * GDB/MI Program Context::
28879 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
28880 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
28881 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
28882 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
28883 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
28884 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
28885 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
28886 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
28887 * GDB/MI File Commands::
28888 @ignore
28889 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
28890 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
28891 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
28892 @end ignore
28893 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
28894 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
28895 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
28896 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
28897 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
28898 @end menu
28899
28900 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28901 @node GDB/MI General Design
28902 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
28903 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
28904
28905 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
28906 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
28907 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
28908 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
28909 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
28910 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
28911 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
28912 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
28913 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
28914 a command and reported as part of that command response.
28915
28916 The important examples of notifications are:
28917 @itemize @bullet
28918
28919 @item
28920 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
28921 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
28922 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
28923 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
28924 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
28925 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
28926 command itself was successfully executed.
28927
28928 @item
28929 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
28930 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
28931 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
28932 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
28933 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
28934 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
28935
28936 @item
28937 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
28938 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
28939 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
28940 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
28941 orthogonal frontend design.
28942
28943 @end itemize
28944
28945 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
28946 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
28947 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
28948 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
28949 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
28950 the user interface.
28951
28952
28953 @menu
28954 * Context management::
28955 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
28956 * Thread groups::
28957 @end menu
28958
28959 @node Context management
28960 @subsection Context management
28961
28962 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
28963
28964 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
28965 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
28966 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
28967 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
28968 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
28969 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
28970 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
28971 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
28972 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
28973
28974 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
28975 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
28976 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
28977 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
28978 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
28979 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
28980 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
28981 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
28982 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
28983 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
28984 for thread and frame to operate on.
28985
28986 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
28987 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
28988 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
28989 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
28990 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
28991 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
28992 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
28993 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
28994 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
28995 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
28996
28997 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
28998 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
28999 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
29000 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
29001 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
29002 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
29003 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
29004 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
29005 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
29006 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
29007 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
29008 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
29009 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
29010 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
29011 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
29012 @samp{--frame} options.
29013
29014 @subsubsection Language
29015
29016 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
29017 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
29018 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
29019 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
29020 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
29021 For instance:
29022
29023 @smallexample
29024 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
29025 ^done,value="4"
29026 (gdb)
29027 @end smallexample
29028
29029 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
29030 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
29031 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
29032
29033 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
29034 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
29035
29036 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
29037 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
29038 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
29039 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
29040 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
29041 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
29042 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
29043 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
29044 @code{-list-target-features} command.
29045
29046 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
29047 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
29048 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
29049 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
29050 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
29051 are running.
29052
29053 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
29054 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
29055 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
29056 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
29057 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
29058 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
29059 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
29060 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
29061 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
29062 @samp{--thread} option).
29063
29064 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
29065 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
29066 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
29067 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
29068
29069 @node Thread groups
29070 @subsection Thread groups
29071 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
29072 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
29073 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
29074 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
29075 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
29076
29077 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
29078 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
29079 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
29080 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
29081 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
29082 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
29083 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
29084 into processes.
29085
29086 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
29087 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
29088 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
29089 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
29090 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
29091 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
29092 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
29093 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
29094 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
29095 the members of specific thread group.
29096
29097 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
29098 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
29099 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
29100 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
29101 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
29102 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
29103 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
29104 after attaching to that thread group.
29105
29106 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
29107 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
29108 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
29109 such thread groups.
29110
29111 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29112 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
29113 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
29114
29115 @menu
29116 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
29117 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
29118 @end menu
29119
29120 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
29121 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
29122
29123 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
29124 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
29125 @table @code
29126 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
29127 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
29128
29129 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
29130 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
29131 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
29132
29133 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
29134 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
29135 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
29136
29137 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
29138 "any sequence of digits"
29139
29140 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
29141 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
29142
29143 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
29144 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
29145
29146 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
29147 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
29148
29149 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
29150 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
29151 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
29152
29153 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
29154 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
29155
29156 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
29157 @code{CR | CR-LF}
29158 @end table
29159
29160 @noindent
29161 Notes:
29162
29163 @itemize @bullet
29164 @item
29165 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
29166 output is described below.
29167
29168 @item
29169 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
29170 finishes.
29171
29172 @item
29173 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
29174 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
29175 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
29176 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
29177 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
29178 @end itemize
29179
29180 Pragmatics:
29181
29182 @itemize @bullet
29183 @item
29184 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
29185
29186 @item
29187 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
29188 @end itemize
29189
29190 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
29191 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
29192
29193 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
29194 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
29195 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
29196 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
29197 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
29198 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
29199
29200 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
29201 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
29202 @var{token}.
29203
29204 @table @code
29205 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
29206 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
29207
29208 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
29209 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
29210
29211 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
29212 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
29213
29214 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
29215 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
29216
29217 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
29218 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
29219
29220 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
29221 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
29222
29223 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
29224 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
29225
29226 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
29227 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
29228
29229 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
29230 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
29231
29232 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
29233 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
29234 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
29235
29236 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
29237 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
29238
29239 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
29240 @code{ @var{string} }
29241
29242 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
29243 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
29244
29245 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
29246 @code{@var{c-string}}
29247
29248 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
29249 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
29250
29251 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
29252 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
29253 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
29254
29255 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
29256 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
29257
29258 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
29259 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
29260
29261 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
29262 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
29263
29264 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
29265 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
29266
29267 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
29268 @code{CR | CR-LF}
29269
29270 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
29271 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
29272 @end table
29273
29274 @noindent
29275 Notes:
29276
29277 @itemize @bullet
29278 @item
29279 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
29280
29281 @item
29282 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
29283 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
29284 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
29285 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
29286 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
29287 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
29288 prior command.
29289
29290 @item
29291 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29292 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
29293 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
29294 prefixed by @samp{+}.
29295
29296 @item
29297 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29298 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
29299 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
29300 @samp{*}.
29301
29302 @item
29303 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29304 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
29305 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
29306 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
29307
29308 @item
29309 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29310 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
29311 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
29312 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
29313
29314 @item
29315 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29316 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
29317 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
29318
29319 @item
29320 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29321 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
29322 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
29323 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
29324
29325 @item
29326 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
29327 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
29328 @var{values}.
29329
29330
29331 @end itemize
29332
29333 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
29334 details about the various output records.
29335
29336 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29337 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
29338 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
29339
29340 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
29341 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
29342
29343 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
29344 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
29345 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
29346 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
29347 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
29348 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
29349
29350 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
29351 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
29352 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
29353
29354 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29355 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
29356 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
29357 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
29358
29359 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
29360 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
29361
29362 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
29363 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
29364 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
29365 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
29366 might change.
29367
29368 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
29369 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
29370 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
29371 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
29372
29373 @itemize @bullet
29374 @item
29375 New MI commands may be added.
29376
29377 @item
29378 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
29379
29380 @item
29381 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
29382 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
29383
29384 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
29385 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
29386
29387 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
29388 @c resolve inconsistencies.
29389 @end itemize
29390
29391 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
29392 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
29393 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
29394 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
29395 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
29396
29397 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
29398 @c version?
29399
29400 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
29401 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
29402 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
29403 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
29404 @cindex mailing lists
29405
29406 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29407 @node GDB/MI Output Records
29408 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
29409
29410 @menu
29411 * GDB/MI Result Records::
29412 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
29413 * GDB/MI Async Records::
29414 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
29415 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
29416 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
29417 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
29418 @end menu
29419
29420 @node GDB/MI Result Records
29421 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
29422
29423 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
29424 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
29425 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
29426 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
29427
29428 @table @code
29429 @findex ^done
29430 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
29431 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
29432 values.
29433
29434 @item "^running"
29435 @findex ^running
29436 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
29437 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
29438 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
29439 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
29440 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
29441 which threads are resumed.
29442
29443 @item "^connected"
29444 @findex ^connected
29445 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
29446
29447 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
29448 @findex ^error
29449 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
29450 the corresponding error message.
29451
29452 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
29453 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
29454 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
29455
29456 @table @samp
29457 @item "undefined-command"
29458 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
29459 @end table
29460
29461 @item "^exit"
29462 @findex ^exit
29463 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
29464
29465 @end table
29466
29467 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
29468 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
29469
29470 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
29471 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
29472 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
29473 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
29474 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
29475
29476 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
29477 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
29478 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
29479 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
29480 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
29481
29482 @table @code
29483 @item "~" @var{string-output}
29484 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
29485 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
29486
29487 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
29488 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
29489 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
29490 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
29491
29492 @item "&" @var{string-output}
29493 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
29494 internals.
29495 @end table
29496
29497 @node GDB/MI Async Records
29498 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
29499
29500 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
29501 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
29502 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
29503 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
29504 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
29505 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
29506
29507 The following is the list of possible async records:
29508
29509 @table @code
29510
29511 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
29512 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
29513 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
29514 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
29515 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
29516 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
29517 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
29518 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
29519 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
29520 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
29521
29522 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
29523 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
29524 following values:
29525
29526 @table @code
29527 @item breakpoint-hit
29528 A breakpoint was reached.
29529 @item watchpoint-trigger
29530 A watchpoint was triggered.
29531 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
29532 A read watchpoint was triggered.
29533 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
29534 An access watchpoint was triggered.
29535 @item function-finished
29536 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
29537 @item location-reached
29538 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
29539 @item watchpoint-scope
29540 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
29541 @item end-stepping-range
29542 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
29543 similar CLI command was accomplished.
29544 @item exited-signalled
29545 The inferior exited because of a signal.
29546 @item exited
29547 The inferior exited.
29548 @item exited-normally
29549 The inferior exited normally.
29550 @item signal-received
29551 A signal was received by the inferior.
29552 @item solib-event
29553 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
29554 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
29555 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
29556 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
29557 @item fork
29558 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
29559 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29560 @item vfork
29561 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
29562 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29563 @item syscall-entry
29564 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
29565 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29566 @item syscall-entry
29567 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
29568 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29569 @item exec
29570 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
29571 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
29572 @end table
29573
29574 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
29575 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
29576 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
29577 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
29578 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
29579 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
29580 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
29581 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
29582 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
29583 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
29584 if such information is not available.
29585
29586 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
29587 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
29588 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
29589 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
29590 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
29591 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
29592 cannot be used in any way.
29593
29594 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
29595 A thread group became associated with a running program,
29596 either because the program was just started or the thread group
29597 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
29598 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
29599 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
29600
29601 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
29602 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
29603 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
29604 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
29605 thread group. @var{code} is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
29606 only when the inferior exited with some code.
29607
29608 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
29609 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
29610 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
29611 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
29612 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
29613
29614 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
29615 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
29616 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
29617 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
29618 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
29619 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
29620 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
29621
29622 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
29623 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
29624 that thread.
29625
29626 @item =library-loaded,...
29627 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
29628 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
29629 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
29630 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
29631 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
29632 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
29633 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
29634 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
29635 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
29636 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
29637 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
29638 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
29639 thread groups.
29640
29641 @item =library-unloaded,...
29642 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
29643 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
29644 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
29645 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
29646 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
29647 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
29648 thread groups.
29649
29650 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
29651 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
29652 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
29653 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
29654 frame is @var{tpnum}.
29655
29656 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
29657 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
29658 initial value @var{initial}.
29659
29660 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
29661 @itemx =tsv-deleted
29662 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
29663 trace state variables are deleted.
29664
29665 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
29666 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
29667 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
29668 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
29669 value of trace state variable is known.
29670
29671 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
29672 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
29673 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
29674 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
29675 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
29676 user.
29677
29678 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
29679 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
29680 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
29681
29682 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
29683 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
29684
29685 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
29686 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
29687 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
29688 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
29689 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
29690
29691 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
29692 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
29693 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
29694 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
29695 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
29696 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
29697
29698 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
29699 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
29700 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
29701 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
29702 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
29703 executable code.
29704 @end table
29705
29706 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
29707 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
29708
29709 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
29710 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
29711 following fields:
29712
29713 @table @code
29714 @item number
29715 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
29716 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
29717 @samp{1.2}.
29718
29719 @item type
29720 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
29721 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
29722
29723 @item catch-type
29724 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
29725 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
29726
29727 @item disp
29728 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
29729 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
29730 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
29731
29732 @item enabled
29733 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
29734 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
29735 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
29736
29737 @item addr
29738 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
29739 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
29740 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
29741 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
29742 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
29743
29744 @item func
29745 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
29746 If not known, this field is not present.
29747
29748 @item filename
29749 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
29750 If not known, this field is not present.
29751
29752 @item fullname
29753 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
29754 known. If not known, this field is not present.
29755
29756 @item line
29757 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
29758 If not known, this field is not present.
29759
29760 @item at
29761 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
29762 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
29763 by a symbol name.
29764
29765 @item pending
29766 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
29767 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
29768
29769 @item evaluated-by
29770 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
29771 @samp{target}.
29772
29773 @item thread
29774 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
29775 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
29776
29777 @item task
29778 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
29779 field will hold the task identifier.
29780
29781 @item cond
29782 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
29783
29784 @item ignore
29785 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
29786
29787 @item enable
29788 The enable count of the breakpoint.
29789
29790 @item traceframe-usage
29791 FIXME.
29792
29793 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
29794 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
29795
29796 @item mask
29797 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
29798
29799 @item pass
29800 A tracepoint's pass count.
29801
29802 @item original-location
29803 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
29804 This field is optional.
29805
29806 @item times
29807 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
29808
29809 @item installed
29810 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
29811 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
29812 is not.
29813
29814 @item what
29815 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
29816
29817 @end table
29818
29819 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
29820 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
29821
29822 @smallexample
29823 -> -break-insert main
29824 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29825 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29826 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
29827 times="0"@}
29828 <- (gdb)
29829 @end smallexample
29830
29831 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
29832 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
29833
29834 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
29835 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
29836 fields:
29837
29838 @table @code
29839 @item level
29840 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
29841 zero. This field is always present.
29842
29843 @item func
29844 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
29845 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
29846
29847 @item addr
29848 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
29849
29850 @item file
29851 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
29852 address. This field may be absent.
29853
29854 @item line
29855 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
29856 may be absent.
29857
29858 @item from
29859 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
29860 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
29861
29862 @end table
29863
29864 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
29865 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
29866
29867 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
29868 uses a tuple with the following fields:
29869
29870 @table @code
29871 @item id
29872 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
29873 always present.
29874
29875 @item target-id
29876 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
29877
29878 @item details
29879 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
29880 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
29881 frontend. This field is optional.
29882
29883 @item state
29884 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
29885 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
29886
29887 @item core
29888 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
29889 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
29890 @end table
29891
29892 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
29893 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
29894
29895 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
29896 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
29897 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
29898 the @code{exception-name} field.
29899
29900 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29901 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
29902 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
29903 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
29904
29905 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
29906 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
29907 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
29908 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
29909
29910 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
29911 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
29912
29913 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
29914
29915 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
29916 information of the breakpoint.
29917
29918 @smallexample
29919 -> -break-insert main
29920 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29921 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29922 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
29923 times="0"@}
29924 <- (gdb)
29925 @end smallexample
29926
29927 @subheading Program Execution
29928
29929 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
29930 reason that execution stopped.
29931
29932 @smallexample
29933 -> -exec-run
29934 <- ^running
29935 <- (gdb)
29936 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
29937 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
29938 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
29939 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
29940 <- (gdb)
29941 -> -exec-continue
29942 <- ^running
29943 <- (gdb)
29944 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29945 <- (gdb)
29946 @end smallexample
29947
29948 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
29949
29950 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
29951
29952 @smallexample
29953 -> (gdb)
29954 <- -gdb-exit
29955 <- ^exit
29956 @end smallexample
29957
29958 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
29959 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
29960 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
29961 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
29962 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
29963 fails to exit in reasonable time.
29964
29965 @subheading A Bad Command
29966
29967 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
29968
29969 @smallexample
29970 -> -rubbish
29971 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
29972 <- (gdb)
29973 @end smallexample
29974
29975
29976 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29977 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
29978 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
29979
29980 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
29981 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
29982
29983 @subheading Motivation
29984
29985 The motivation for this collection of commands.
29986
29987 @subheading Introduction
29988
29989 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
29990
29991 @subheading Commands
29992
29993 For each command in the block, the following is described:
29994
29995 @subsubheading Synopsis
29996
29997 @smallexample
29998 -command @var{args}@dots{}
29999 @end smallexample
30000
30001 @subsubheading Result
30002
30003 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30004
30005 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
30006
30007 @subsubheading Example
30008
30009 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
30010 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
30011
30012
30013 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30014 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
30015 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
30016
30017 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
30018 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
30019 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
30020 breakpoints.
30021
30022 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
30023 @findex -break-after
30024
30025 @subsubheading Synopsis
30026
30027 @smallexample
30028 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
30029 @end smallexample
30030
30031 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
30032 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
30033 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
30034 @samp{-break-list} command below.
30035
30036 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30037
30038 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
30039
30040 @subsubheading Example
30041
30042 @smallexample
30043 (gdb)
30044 -break-insert main
30045 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30046 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
30047 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
30048 times="0"@}
30049 (gdb)
30050 -break-after 1 3
30051 ~
30052 ^done
30053 (gdb)
30054 -break-list
30055 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30056 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30057 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30058 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30059 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30060 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30061 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30062 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30063 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
30064 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
30065 (gdb)
30066 @end smallexample
30067
30068 @ignore
30069 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
30070 @findex -break-catch
30071 @end ignore
30072
30073 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
30074 @findex -break-commands
30075
30076 @subsubheading Synopsis
30077
30078 @smallexample
30079 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
30080 @end smallexample
30081
30082 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
30083 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
30084 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
30085 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
30086 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
30087 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
30088
30089 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30090
30091 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
30092
30093 @subsubheading Example
30094
30095 @smallexample
30096 (gdb)
30097 -break-insert main
30098 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30099 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
30100 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
30101 times="0"@}
30102 (gdb)
30103 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
30104 ^done
30105 (gdb)
30106 @end smallexample
30107
30108 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
30109 @findex -break-condition
30110
30111 @subsubheading Synopsis
30112
30113 @smallexample
30114 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
30115 @end smallexample
30116
30117 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
30118 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
30119 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
30120 command below).
30121
30122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30123
30124 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
30125
30126 @subsubheading Example
30127
30128 @smallexample
30129 (gdb)
30130 -break-condition 1 1
30131 ^done
30132 (gdb)
30133 -break-list
30134 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30135 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30136 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30137 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30138 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30139 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30140 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30141 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30142 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
30143 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
30144 (gdb)
30145 @end smallexample
30146
30147 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
30148 @findex -break-delete
30149
30150 @subsubheading Synopsis
30151
30152 @smallexample
30153 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
30154 @end smallexample
30155
30156 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
30157 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
30158
30159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30160
30161 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
30162
30163 @subsubheading Example
30164
30165 @smallexample
30166 (gdb)
30167 -break-delete 1
30168 ^done
30169 (gdb)
30170 -break-list
30171 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
30172 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30173 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30174 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30175 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30176 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30177 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30178 body=[]@}
30179 (gdb)
30180 @end smallexample
30181
30182 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
30183 @findex -break-disable
30184
30185 @subsubheading Synopsis
30186
30187 @smallexample
30188 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
30189 @end smallexample
30190
30191 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
30192 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
30193
30194 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30195
30196 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
30197
30198 @subsubheading Example
30199
30200 @smallexample
30201 (gdb)
30202 -break-disable 2
30203 ^done
30204 (gdb)
30205 -break-list
30206 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30207 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30208 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30209 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30210 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30211 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30212 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30213 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
30214 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
30215 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
30216 (gdb)
30217 @end smallexample
30218
30219 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
30220 @findex -break-enable
30221
30222 @subsubheading Synopsis
30223
30224 @smallexample
30225 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
30226 @end smallexample
30227
30228 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
30229
30230 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30231
30232 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
30233
30234 @subsubheading Example
30235
30236 @smallexample
30237 (gdb)
30238 -break-enable 2
30239 ^done
30240 (gdb)
30241 -break-list
30242 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30243 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30244 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30245 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30246 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30247 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30248 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30249 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30250 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
30251 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
30252 (gdb)
30253 @end smallexample
30254
30255 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
30256 @findex -break-info
30257
30258 @subsubheading Synopsis
30259
30260 @smallexample
30261 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
30262 @end smallexample
30263
30264 @c REDUNDANT???
30265 Get information about a single breakpoint.
30266
30267 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
30268 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
30269 table.
30270
30271 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30272
30273 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
30274
30275 @subsubheading Example
30276 N.A.
30277
30278 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
30279 @findex -break-insert
30280
30281 @subsubheading Synopsis
30282
30283 @smallexample
30284 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
30285 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
30286 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
30287 @end smallexample
30288
30289 @noindent
30290 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
30291
30292 @itemize @bullet
30293 @item function
30294 @c @item +offset
30295 @c @item -offset
30296 @c @item linenum
30297 @item filename:linenum
30298 @item filename:function
30299 @item *address
30300 @end itemize
30301
30302 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
30303
30304 @table @samp
30305 @item -t
30306 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
30307 @item -h
30308 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
30309 @item -f
30310 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
30311 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
30312 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
30313 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
30314 cannot be parsed.
30315 @item -d
30316 Create a disabled breakpoint.
30317 @item -a
30318 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
30319 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
30320 @item -c @var{condition}
30321 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30322 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
30323 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
30324 @item -p @var{thread-id}
30325 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
30326 @end table
30327
30328 @subsubheading Result
30329
30330 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
30331 resulting breakpoint.
30332
30333 Note: this format is open to change.
30334 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
30335
30336 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30337
30338 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
30339 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
30340
30341 @subsubheading Example
30342
30343 @smallexample
30344 (gdb)
30345 -break-insert main
30346 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
30347 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
30348 times="0"@}
30349 (gdb)
30350 -break-insert -t foo
30351 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
30352 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
30353 times="0"@}
30354 (gdb)
30355 -break-list
30356 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
30357 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30358 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30359 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30360 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30361 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30362 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30363 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30364 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
30365 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
30366 times="0"@},
30367 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
30368 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
30369 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
30370 times="0"@}]@}
30371 (gdb)
30372 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
30373 @c ~int foo(int, int);
30374 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
30375 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
30376 @c times="0"@}
30377 @c (gdb)
30378 @end smallexample
30379
30380 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
30381 @findex -dprintf-insert
30382
30383 @subsubheading Synopsis
30384
30385 @smallexample
30386 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
30387 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
30388 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
30389 [ @var{argument} ]
30390 @end smallexample
30391
30392 @noindent
30393 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
30394
30395 @itemize @bullet
30396 @item @var{function}
30397 @c @item +offset
30398 @c @item -offset
30399 @c @item @var{linenum}
30400 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
30401 @item @var{filename}:function
30402 @item *@var{address}
30403 @end itemize
30404
30405 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
30406
30407 @table @samp
30408 @item -t
30409 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
30410 @item -f
30411 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
30412 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
30413 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
30414 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
30415 cannot be parsed.
30416 @item -d
30417 Create a disabled breakpoint.
30418 @item -c @var{condition}
30419 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30420 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
30421 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
30422 to @var{ignore-count}.
30423 @item -p @var{thread-id}
30424 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
30425 @end table
30426
30427 @subsubheading Result
30428
30429 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
30430 resulting breakpoint.
30431
30432 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
30433
30434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30435
30436 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
30437
30438 @subsubheading Example
30439
30440 @smallexample
30441 (gdb)
30442 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
30443 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30444 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
30445 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
30446 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
30447 original-location="foo"@}
30448 (gdb)
30449 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
30450 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30451 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
30452 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
30453 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
30454 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
30455 (gdb)
30456 @end smallexample
30457
30458 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
30459 @findex -break-list
30460
30461 @subsubheading Synopsis
30462
30463 @smallexample
30464 -break-list
30465 @end smallexample
30466
30467 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
30468
30469 @table @samp
30470 @item Number
30471 number of the breakpoint
30472 @item Type
30473 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
30474 @item Disposition
30475 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
30476 or @samp{nokeep}
30477 @item Enabled
30478 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
30479 @item Address
30480 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
30481 @item What
30482 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
30483 name, line number
30484 @item Thread-groups
30485 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
30486 @item Times
30487 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
30488 @end table
30489
30490 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
30491 @code{body} field is an empty list.
30492
30493 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30494
30495 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
30496
30497 @subsubheading Example
30498
30499 @smallexample
30500 (gdb)
30501 -break-list
30502 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
30503 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30504 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30505 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30506 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30507 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30508 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30509 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30510 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
30511 times="0"@},
30512 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30513 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
30514 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
30515 (gdb)
30516 @end smallexample
30517
30518 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
30519
30520 @smallexample
30521 (gdb)
30522 -break-list
30523 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
30524 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30525 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30526 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30527 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30528 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30529 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30530 body=[]@}
30531 (gdb)
30532 @end smallexample
30533
30534 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
30535 @findex -break-passcount
30536
30537 @subsubheading Synopsis
30538
30539 @smallexample
30540 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
30541 @end smallexample
30542
30543 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
30544 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
30545 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
30546 command @samp{passcount}.
30547
30548 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
30549 @findex -break-watch
30550
30551 @subsubheading Synopsis
30552
30553 @smallexample
30554 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
30555 @end smallexample
30556
30557 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
30558 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
30559 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
30560 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
30561 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
30562 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
30563 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
30564 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
30565
30566 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
30567 breakpoints inserted.
30568
30569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30570
30571 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
30572 @samp{rwatch}.
30573
30574 @subsubheading Example
30575
30576 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
30577
30578 @smallexample
30579 (gdb)
30580 -break-watch x
30581 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
30582 (gdb)
30583 -exec-continue
30584 ^running
30585 (gdb)
30586 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
30587 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
30588 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
30589 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
30590 (gdb)
30591 @end smallexample
30592
30593 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
30594 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
30595 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
30596
30597 @smallexample
30598 (gdb)
30599 -break-watch C
30600 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
30601 (gdb)
30602 -exec-continue
30603 ^running
30604 (gdb)
30605 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
30606 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
30607 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30608 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30609 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
30610 (gdb)
30611 -exec-continue
30612 ^running
30613 (gdb)
30614 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
30615 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
30616 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30617 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30618 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
30619 (gdb)
30620 @end smallexample
30621
30622 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
30623 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
30624 deleted.
30625
30626 @smallexample
30627 (gdb)
30628 -break-watch C
30629 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
30630 (gdb)
30631 -break-list
30632 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
30633 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30634 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30635 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30636 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30637 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30638 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30639 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30640 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30641 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30642 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
30643 times="1"@},
30644 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
30645 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
30646 (gdb)
30647 -exec-continue
30648 ^running
30649 (gdb)
30650 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
30651 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
30652 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30653 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30654 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
30655 (gdb)
30656 -break-list
30657 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
30658 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30659 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30660 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30661 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30662 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30663 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30664 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30665 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30666 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30667 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
30668 times="1"@},
30669 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
30670 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
30671 (gdb)
30672 -exec-continue
30673 ^running
30674 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
30675 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
30676 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30677 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30678 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
30679 (gdb)
30680 -break-list
30681 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30682 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30683 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30684 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30685 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30686 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30687 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30688 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30689 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30690 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30691 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30692 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
30693 (gdb)
30694 @end smallexample
30695
30696
30697 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30698 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30699 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
30700
30701 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
30702 catchpoints.
30703
30704 @menu
30705 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30706 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30707 @end menu
30708
30709 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30710 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30711
30712 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
30713 @findex -catch-load
30714
30715 @subsubheading Synopsis
30716
30717 @smallexample
30718 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30719 @end smallexample
30720
30721 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
30722 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30723 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
30724 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30725 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
30726
30727
30728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30729
30730 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
30731
30732 @subsubheading Example
30733
30734 @smallexample
30735 -catch-load -t foo.so
30736 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
30737 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
30738 (gdb)
30739 @end smallexample
30740
30741
30742 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
30743 @findex -catch-unload
30744
30745 @subsubheading Synopsis
30746
30747 @smallexample
30748 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30749 @end smallexample
30750
30751 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
30752 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30753 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
30754 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30755 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
30756
30757 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30758
30759 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
30760
30761 @subsubheading Example
30762
30763 @smallexample
30764 -catch-unload -d bar.so
30765 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
30766 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
30767 (gdb)
30768 @end smallexample
30769
30770 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30771 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30772
30773 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
30774 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
30775
30776 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
30777 @findex -catch-assert
30778
30779 @subsubheading Synopsis
30780
30781 @smallexample
30782 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
30783 @end smallexample
30784
30785 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
30786
30787 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30788
30789 @table @samp
30790 @item -c @var{condition}
30791 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30792 @item -d
30793 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30794 @item -t
30795 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30796 @end table
30797
30798 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30799
30800 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
30801
30802 @subsubheading Example
30803
30804 @smallexample
30805 -catch-assert
30806 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30807 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
30808 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
30809 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
30810 (gdb)
30811 @end smallexample
30812
30813 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
30814 @findex -catch-exception
30815
30816 @subsubheading Synopsis
30817
30818 @smallexample
30819 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
30820 [ -t ] [ -u ]
30821 @end smallexample
30822
30823 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
30824 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
30825 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
30826 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
30827 catchpoints.
30828
30829 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30830
30831 @table @samp
30832 @item -c @var{condition}
30833 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30834 @item -d
30835 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30836 @item -e @var{exception-name}
30837 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
30838 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
30839 @item -t
30840 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30841 @item -u
30842 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
30843 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
30844 @end table
30845
30846 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30847
30848 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
30849 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
30850
30851 @subsubheading Example
30852
30853 @smallexample
30854 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
30855 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30856 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
30857 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
30858 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
30859 (gdb)
30860 @end smallexample
30861
30862 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30863 @node GDB/MI Program Context
30864 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
30865
30866 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
30867 @findex -exec-arguments
30868
30869
30870 @subsubheading Synopsis
30871
30872 @smallexample
30873 -exec-arguments @var{args}
30874 @end smallexample
30875
30876 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
30877 @samp{-exec-run}.
30878
30879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30880
30881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
30882
30883 @subsubheading Example
30884
30885 @smallexample
30886 (gdb)
30887 -exec-arguments -v word
30888 ^done
30889 (gdb)
30890 @end smallexample
30891
30892
30893 @ignore
30894 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
30895 @findex -exec-show-arguments
30896
30897 @subsubheading Synopsis
30898
30899 @smallexample
30900 -exec-show-arguments
30901 @end smallexample
30902
30903 Print the arguments of the program.
30904
30905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30906
30907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
30908
30909 @subsubheading Example
30910 N.A.
30911 @end ignore
30912
30913
30914 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
30915 @findex -environment-cd
30916
30917 @subsubheading Synopsis
30918
30919 @smallexample
30920 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
30921 @end smallexample
30922
30923 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
30924
30925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30926
30927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
30928
30929 @subsubheading Example
30930
30931 @smallexample
30932 (gdb)
30933 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
30934 ^done
30935 (gdb)
30936 @end smallexample
30937
30938
30939 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
30940 @findex -environment-directory
30941
30942 @subsubheading Synopsis
30943
30944 @smallexample
30945 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
30946 @end smallexample
30947
30948 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
30949 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
30950 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
30951 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
30952 occurs as normal.
30953 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
30954 multiple directories in a single command
30955 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
30956 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
30957 If blanks are needed as
30958 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
30959 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
30960 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
30961 character must not be used
30962 in any directory name.
30963 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
30964
30965 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30966
30967 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
30968
30969 @subsubheading Example
30970
30971 @smallexample
30972 (gdb)
30973 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
30974 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
30975 (gdb)
30976 -environment-directory ""
30977 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
30978 (gdb)
30979 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
30980 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
30981 (gdb)
30982 -environment-directory -r
30983 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
30984 (gdb)
30985 @end smallexample
30986
30987
30988 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
30989 @findex -environment-path
30990
30991 @subsubheading Synopsis
30992
30993 @smallexample
30994 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
30995 @end smallexample
30996
30997 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
30998 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
30999 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
31000 supplied in addition to the
31001 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
31002 occurs as normal.
31003 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
31004 multiple directories in a single command
31005 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
31006 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
31007 If blanks are needed as
31008 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
31009 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
31010 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
31011 character must not be used
31012 in any directory name.
31013 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
31014
31015
31016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31017
31018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
31019
31020 @subsubheading Example
31021
31022 @smallexample
31023 (gdb)
31024 -environment-path
31025 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
31026 (gdb)
31027 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
31028 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
31029 (gdb)
31030 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
31031 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
31032 (gdb)
31033 @end smallexample
31034
31035
31036 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
31037 @findex -environment-pwd
31038
31039 @subsubheading Synopsis
31040
31041 @smallexample
31042 -environment-pwd
31043 @end smallexample
31044
31045 Show the current working directory.
31046
31047 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31048
31049 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
31050
31051 @subsubheading Example
31052
31053 @smallexample
31054 (gdb)
31055 -environment-pwd
31056 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
31057 (gdb)
31058 @end smallexample
31059
31060 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31061 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
31062 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
31063
31064
31065 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
31066 @findex -thread-info
31067
31068 @subsubheading Synopsis
31069
31070 @smallexample
31071 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
31072 @end smallexample
31073
31074 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
31075 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
31076 threads. When printing information about all threads,
31077 also reports the current thread.
31078
31079 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31080
31081 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
31082 about all threads.
31083
31084 @subsubheading Result
31085
31086 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
31087 defined for a given thread:
31088
31089 @table @samp
31090 @item current
31091 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
31092
31093 @item id
31094 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
31095
31096 @item target-id
31097 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
31098
31099 @item details
31100 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
31101 field is optional.
31102
31103 @item name
31104 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
31105 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
31106 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
31107 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
31108 field is omitted.
31109
31110 @item frame
31111 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
31112
31113 @item state
31114 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
31115 values:
31116
31117 @table @code
31118 @item stopped
31119 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
31120 threads.
31121
31122 @item running
31123 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
31124 threads.
31125
31126 @end table
31127
31128 @item core
31129 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
31130 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
31131
31132 @end table
31133
31134 @subsubheading Example
31135
31136 @smallexample
31137 -thread-info
31138 ^done,threads=[
31139 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31140 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
31141 args=[]@},state="running"@},
31142 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31143 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
31144 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31145 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
31146 state="running"@}],
31147 current-thread-id="1"
31148 (gdb)
31149 @end smallexample
31150
31151 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
31152 @findex -thread-list-ids
31153
31154 @subsubheading Synopsis
31155
31156 @smallexample
31157 -thread-list-ids
31158 @end smallexample
31159
31160 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
31161 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
31162
31163 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
31164 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
31165
31166 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31167
31168 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
31169
31170 @subsubheading Example
31171
31172 @smallexample
31173 (gdb)
31174 -thread-list-ids
31175 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
31176 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
31177 (gdb)
31178 @end smallexample
31179
31180
31181 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
31182 @findex -thread-select
31183
31184 @subsubheading Synopsis
31185
31186 @smallexample
31187 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
31188 @end smallexample
31189
31190 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
31191 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
31192
31193 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
31194 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
31195
31196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31197
31198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
31199
31200 @subsubheading Example
31201
31202 @smallexample
31203 (gdb)
31204 -exec-next
31205 ^running
31206 (gdb)
31207 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
31208 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
31209 (gdb)
31210 -thread-list-ids
31211 ^done,
31212 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
31213 number-of-threads="3"
31214 (gdb)
31215 -thread-select 3
31216 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
31217 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
31218 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
31219 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
31220 (gdb)
31221 @end smallexample
31222
31223 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31224 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
31225 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
31226
31227 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
31228 @findex -ada-task-info
31229
31230 @subsubheading Synopsis
31231
31232 @smallexample
31233 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
31234 @end smallexample
31235
31236 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
31237 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
31238
31239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31240
31241 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
31242 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
31243
31244 @subsubheading Result
31245
31246 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
31247 defined for each Ada task:
31248
31249 @table @samp
31250 @item current
31251 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
31252
31253 @item id
31254 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
31255
31256 @item task-id
31257 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
31258
31259 @item thread-id
31260 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
31261
31262 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
31263 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
31264 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
31265
31266 @item parent-id
31267 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
31268 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
31269
31270 @item priority
31271 The base priority of the task.
31272
31273 @item state
31274 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
31275 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
31276
31277 @item name
31278 The name of the task.
31279
31280 @end table
31281
31282 @subsubheading Example
31283
31284 @smallexample
31285 -ada-task-info
31286 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
31287 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
31288 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
31289 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
31290 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
31291 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
31292 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
31293 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
31294 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
31295 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
31296 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
31297 (gdb)
31298 @end smallexample
31299
31300 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31301 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
31302 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
31303
31304 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
31305 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
31306 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
31307 other cases.
31308
31309 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
31310 @findex -exec-continue
31311
31312 @subsubheading Synopsis
31313
31314 @smallexample
31315 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
31316 @end smallexample
31317
31318 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
31319 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
31320 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
31321 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
31322 @itemize @bullet
31323 @item
31324 breakpoints or watchpoints
31325 @item
31326 signals or exceptions
31327 @item
31328 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
31329 @item
31330 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
31331 @end itemize
31332 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
31333 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
31334 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
31335 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
31336 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
31337 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
31338
31339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31340
31341 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
31342
31343 @subsubheading Example
31344
31345 @smallexample
31346 -exec-continue
31347 ^running
31348 (gdb)
31349 @@Hello world
31350 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
31351 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
31352 line="13"@}
31353 (gdb)
31354 @end smallexample
31355
31356
31357 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
31358 @findex -exec-finish
31359
31360 @subsubheading Synopsis
31361
31362 @smallexample
31363 -exec-finish [--reverse]
31364 @end smallexample
31365
31366 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
31367 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
31368 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
31369 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
31370 function was called.
31371
31372 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31373
31374 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
31375
31376 @subsubheading Example
31377
31378 Function returning @code{void}.
31379
31380 @smallexample
31381 -exec-finish
31382 ^running
31383 (gdb)
31384 @@hello from foo
31385 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
31386 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
31387 (gdb)
31388 @end smallexample
31389
31390 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
31391 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
31392 value itself.
31393
31394 @smallexample
31395 -exec-finish
31396 ^running
31397 (gdb)
31398 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
31399 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
31400 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
31401 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
31402 (gdb)
31403 @end smallexample
31404
31405
31406 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
31407 @findex -exec-interrupt
31408
31409 @subsubheading Synopsis
31410
31411 @smallexample
31412 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
31413 @end smallexample
31414
31415 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
31416 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
31417 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
31418 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
31419 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
31420
31421 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
31422 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
31423 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
31424 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
31425
31426 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
31427 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
31428 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
31429 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
31430
31431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31432
31433 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
31434
31435 @subsubheading Example
31436
31437 @smallexample
31438 (gdb)
31439 111-exec-continue
31440 111^running
31441
31442 (gdb)
31443 222-exec-interrupt
31444 222^done
31445 (gdb)
31446 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
31447 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31448 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
31449 (gdb)
31450
31451 (gdb)
31452 -exec-interrupt
31453 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
31454 (gdb)
31455 @end smallexample
31456
31457 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
31458 @findex -exec-jump
31459
31460 @subsubheading Synopsis
31461
31462 @smallexample
31463 -exec-jump @var{location}
31464 @end smallexample
31465
31466 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
31467 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
31468 different forms of @var{location}.
31469
31470 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31471
31472 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
31473
31474 @subsubheading Example
31475
31476 @smallexample
31477 -exec-jump foo.c:10
31478 *running,thread-id="all"
31479 ^running
31480 @end smallexample
31481
31482
31483 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
31484 @findex -exec-next
31485
31486 @subsubheading Synopsis
31487
31488 @smallexample
31489 -exec-next [--reverse]
31490 @end smallexample
31491
31492 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
31493 of the next source line is reached.
31494
31495 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
31496 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
31497 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
31498 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
31499 source line where the function was called.
31500
31501
31502 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31503
31504 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
31505
31506 @subsubheading Example
31507
31508 @smallexample
31509 -exec-next
31510 ^running
31511 (gdb)
31512 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
31513 (gdb)
31514 @end smallexample
31515
31516
31517 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
31518 @findex -exec-next-instruction
31519
31520 @subsubheading Synopsis
31521
31522 @smallexample
31523 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
31524 @end smallexample
31525
31526 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
31527 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
31528 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
31529 printed as well.
31530
31531 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
31532 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
31533 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
31534 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
31535 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
31536
31537 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31538
31539 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
31540
31541 @subsubheading Example
31542
31543 @smallexample
31544 (gdb)
31545 -exec-next-instruction
31546 ^running
31547
31548 (gdb)
31549 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31550 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
31551 (gdb)
31552 @end smallexample
31553
31554
31555 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
31556 @findex -exec-return
31557
31558 @subsubheading Synopsis
31559
31560 @smallexample
31561 -exec-return
31562 @end smallexample
31563
31564 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
31565 Displays the new current frame.
31566
31567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31568
31569 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
31570
31571 @subsubheading Example
31572
31573 @smallexample
31574 (gdb)
31575 200-break-insert callee4
31576 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
31577 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
31578 (gdb)
31579 000-exec-run
31580 000^running
31581 (gdb)
31582 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
31583 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
31584 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31585 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
31586 (gdb)
31587 205-break-delete
31588 205^done
31589 (gdb)
31590 111-exec-return
31591 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
31592 args=[@{name="strarg",
31593 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
31594 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31595 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
31596 (gdb)
31597 @end smallexample
31598
31599
31600 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
31601 @findex -exec-run
31602
31603 @subsubheading Synopsis
31604
31605 @smallexample
31606 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
31607 @end smallexample
31608
31609 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
31610 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
31611 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
31612 the program has exited exceptionally.
31613
31614 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
31615 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
31616 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
31617 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
31618 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
31619
31620 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
31621 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
31622 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
31623 (@pxref{Starting}).
31624
31625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31626
31627 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
31628
31629 @subsubheading Examples
31630
31631 @smallexample
31632 (gdb)
31633 -break-insert main
31634 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
31635 (gdb)
31636 -exec-run
31637 ^running
31638 (gdb)
31639 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
31640 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
31641 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
31642 (gdb)
31643 @end smallexample
31644
31645 @noindent
31646 Program exited normally:
31647
31648 @smallexample
31649 (gdb)
31650 -exec-run
31651 ^running
31652 (gdb)
31653 x = 55
31654 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
31655 (gdb)
31656 @end smallexample
31657
31658 @noindent
31659 Program exited exceptionally:
31660
31661 @smallexample
31662 (gdb)
31663 -exec-run
31664 ^running
31665 (gdb)
31666 x = 55
31667 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
31668 (gdb)
31669 @end smallexample
31670
31671 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
31672 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
31673
31674 @smallexample
31675 (gdb)
31676 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
31677 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
31678 @end smallexample
31679
31680
31681 @c @subheading -exec-signal
31682
31683
31684 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
31685 @findex -exec-step
31686
31687 @subsubheading Synopsis
31688
31689 @smallexample
31690 -exec-step [--reverse]
31691 @end smallexample
31692
31693 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
31694 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
31695 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
31696 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
31697 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
31698 previously executed source line.
31699
31700 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31701
31702 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
31703
31704 @subsubheading Example
31705
31706 Stepping into a function:
31707
31708 @smallexample
31709 -exec-step
31710 ^running
31711 (gdb)
31712 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31713 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
31714 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
31715 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
31716 (gdb)
31717 @end smallexample
31718
31719 Regular stepping:
31720
31721 @smallexample
31722 -exec-step
31723 ^running
31724 (gdb)
31725 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
31726 (gdb)
31727 @end smallexample
31728
31729
31730 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
31731 @findex -exec-step-instruction
31732
31733 @subsubheading Synopsis
31734
31735 @smallexample
31736 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
31737 @end smallexample
31738
31739 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
31740 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
31741 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
31742 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
31743 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
31744 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
31745 as well.
31746
31747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31748
31749 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
31750
31751 @subsubheading Example
31752
31753 @smallexample
31754 (gdb)
31755 -exec-step-instruction
31756 ^running
31757
31758 (gdb)
31759 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31760 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31761 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
31762 (gdb)
31763 -exec-step-instruction
31764 ^running
31765
31766 (gdb)
31767 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31768 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31769 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
31770 (gdb)
31771 @end smallexample
31772
31773
31774 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
31775 @findex -exec-until
31776
31777 @subsubheading Synopsis
31778
31779 @smallexample
31780 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
31781 @end smallexample
31782
31783 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
31784 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
31785 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
31786 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
31787
31788 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31789
31790 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
31791
31792 @subsubheading Example
31793
31794 @smallexample
31795 (gdb)
31796 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
31797 ^running
31798 (gdb)
31799 x = 55
31800 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
31801 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
31802 (gdb)
31803 @end smallexample
31804
31805 @ignore
31806 @subheading -file-clear
31807 Is this going away????
31808 @end ignore
31809
31810 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31811 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
31812 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
31813
31814 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
31815 @findex -enable-frame-filters
31816
31817 @smallexample
31818 -enable-frame-filters
31819 @end smallexample
31820
31821 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
31822 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
31823 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31824 request that this functionality be enabled.
31825
31826 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31827
31828 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31829 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31830
31831 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
31832 @findex -stack-info-frame
31833
31834 @subsubheading Synopsis
31835
31836 @smallexample
31837 -stack-info-frame
31838 @end smallexample
31839
31840 Get info on the selected frame.
31841
31842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31843
31844 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
31845 (without arguments).
31846
31847 @subsubheading Example
31848
31849 @smallexample
31850 (gdb)
31851 -stack-info-frame
31852 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
31853 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31854 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
31855 (gdb)
31856 @end smallexample
31857
31858 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
31859 @findex -stack-info-depth
31860
31861 @subsubheading Synopsis
31862
31863 @smallexample
31864 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
31865 @end smallexample
31866
31867 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
31868 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
31869
31870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31871
31872 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31873
31874 @subsubheading Example
31875
31876 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
31877
31878 @smallexample
31879 (gdb)
31880 -stack-info-depth
31881 ^done,depth="12"
31882 (gdb)
31883 -stack-info-depth 4
31884 ^done,depth="4"
31885 (gdb)
31886 -stack-info-depth 12
31887 ^done,depth="12"
31888 (gdb)
31889 -stack-info-depth 11
31890 ^done,depth="11"
31891 (gdb)
31892 -stack-info-depth 13
31893 ^done,depth="12"
31894 (gdb)
31895 @end smallexample
31896
31897 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
31898 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
31899 @findex -stack-list-arguments
31900
31901 @subsubheading Synopsis
31902
31903 @smallexample
31904 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
31905 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
31906 @end smallexample
31907
31908 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
31909 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
31910 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
31911 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
31912 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
31913 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
31914 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
31915 which case only existing frames will be returned.
31916
31917 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31918 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31919 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31920 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31921 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
31922 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
31923
31924 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
31925 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
31926 are still displayed, however.
31927
31928 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
31929 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
31930
31931 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31932
31933 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
31934 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
31935 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
31936
31937 @subsubheading Example
31938
31939 @smallexample
31940 (gdb)
31941 -stack-list-frames
31942 ^done,
31943 stack=[
31944 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
31945 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31946 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
31947 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
31948 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31949 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
31950 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
31951 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31952 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
31953 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
31954 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31955 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
31956 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
31957 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31958 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
31959 (gdb)
31960 -stack-list-arguments 0
31961 ^done,
31962 stack-args=[
31963 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
31964 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
31965 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
31966 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
31967 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
31968 (gdb)
31969 -stack-list-arguments 1
31970 ^done,
31971 stack-args=[
31972 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
31973 frame=@{level="1",
31974 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
31975 frame=@{level="2",args=[
31976 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31977 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
31978 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
31979 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31980 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
31981 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
31982 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
31983 (gdb)
31984 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
31985 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
31986 (gdb)
31987 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
31988 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
31989 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31990 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
31991 (gdb)
31992 @end smallexample
31993
31994 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
31995
31996
31997 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
31998 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
31999 @findex -stack-list-frames
32000
32001 @subsubheading Synopsis
32002
32003 @smallexample
32004 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
32005 @end smallexample
32006
32007 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
32008 following info:
32009
32010 @table @samp
32011 @item @var{level}
32012 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
32013 @item @var{addr}
32014 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
32015 @item @var{func}
32016 Function name.
32017 @item @var{file}
32018 File name of the source file where the function lives.
32019 @item @var{fullname}
32020 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
32021 @item @var{line}
32022 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
32023 @item @var{from}
32024 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
32025 if the frame's function is not known.
32026 @end table
32027
32028 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
32029 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
32030 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
32031 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
32032 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
32033 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
32034 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
32035 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
32036 Python frame filters will not be executed.
32037
32038 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32039
32040 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
32041
32042 @subsubheading Example
32043
32044 Full stack backtrace:
32045
32046 @smallexample
32047 (gdb)
32048 -stack-list-frames
32049 ^done,stack=
32050 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
32051 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
32052 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32053 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32054 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32055 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32056 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32057 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32058 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32059 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32060 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32061 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32062 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32063 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32064 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32065 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32066 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32067 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32068 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32069 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32070 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32071 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32072 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
32073 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
32074 (gdb)
32075 @end smallexample
32076
32077 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
32078
32079 @smallexample
32080 (gdb)
32081 -stack-list-frames 3 5
32082 ^done,stack=
32083 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32084 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32085 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32086 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
32087 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32088 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
32089 (gdb)
32090 @end smallexample
32091
32092 Show a single frame:
32093
32094 @smallexample
32095 (gdb)
32096 -stack-list-frames 3 3
32097 ^done,stack=
32098 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
32099 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
32100 (gdb)
32101 @end smallexample
32102
32103
32104 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
32105 @findex -stack-list-locals
32106 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
32107
32108 @subsubheading Synopsis
32109
32110 @smallexample
32111 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
32112 @end smallexample
32113
32114 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
32115 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
32116 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
32117 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
32118 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
32119 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
32120 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
32121 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
32122 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
32123 Python frame filters will not be executed.
32124
32125 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
32126 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
32127 variables are still displayed, however.
32128
32129 This command is deprecated in favor of the
32130 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
32131
32132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32133
32134 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
32135
32136 @subsubheading Example
32137
32138 @smallexample
32139 (gdb)
32140 -stack-list-locals 0
32141 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
32142 (gdb)
32143 -stack-list-locals --all-values
32144 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
32145 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
32146 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
32147 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
32148 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
32149 (gdb)
32150 @end smallexample
32151
32152 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
32153 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
32154 @findex -stack-list-variables
32155
32156 @subsubheading Synopsis
32157
32158 @smallexample
32159 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
32160 @end smallexample
32161
32162 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
32163 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
32164 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
32165 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
32166 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
32167 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
32168 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
32169
32170 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
32171 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
32172 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
32173
32174 @subsubheading Example
32175
32176 @smallexample
32177 (gdb)
32178 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
32179 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
32180 (gdb)
32181 @end smallexample
32182
32183
32184 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
32185 @findex -stack-select-frame
32186
32187 @subsubheading Synopsis
32188
32189 @smallexample
32190 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
32191 @end smallexample
32192
32193 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
32194 the stack.
32195
32196 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
32197 option to every command.
32198
32199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32200
32201 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
32202 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
32203
32204 @subsubheading Example
32205
32206 @smallexample
32207 (gdb)
32208 -stack-select-frame 2
32209 ^done
32210 (gdb)
32211 @end smallexample
32212
32213 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32214 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
32215 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
32216
32217 @ignore
32218
32219 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
32220
32221 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
32222 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
32223 used by @code{Insight}.
32224
32225 The two main reasons for that are:
32226
32227 @enumerate 1
32228 @item
32229 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
32230
32231 @item
32232 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
32233 now).
32234 @end enumerate
32235
32236 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
32237 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
32238 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
32239 hints about their use.
32240
32241 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
32242 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
32243 least, the following operations:
32244
32245 @itemize @bullet
32246 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
32247 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
32248 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
32249 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
32250 @end itemize
32251
32252 @end ignore
32253
32254 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
32255
32256 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
32257
32258 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
32259 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
32260 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
32261 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
32262 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
32263 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
32264 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
32265 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
32266 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
32267 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
32268 object, or to change display format.
32269
32270 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
32271 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
32272 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
32273 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
32274 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
32275 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
32276 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
32277 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
32278 child will be created.
32279
32280 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
32281 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
32282 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
32283 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
32284 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
32285
32286 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
32287 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
32288 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
32289 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
32290 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
32291 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
32292 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
32293 variables that frontend has created.
32294
32295 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
32296 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
32297 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
32298 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
32299 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
32300 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
32301 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
32302 implicitly updated.
32303
32304 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
32305 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
32306 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
32307 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
32308 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
32309 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
32310 frame. Consider this example:
32311
32312 @smallexample
32313 void do_work(...)
32314 @{
32315 struct work_state state;
32316
32317 if (...)
32318 do_work(...);
32319 @}
32320 @end smallexample
32321
32322 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
32323 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
32324 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
32325 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
32326 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
32327
32328 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
32329 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
32330 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
32331 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
32332 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
32333 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
32334
32335 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
32336 access this functionality:
32337
32338 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
32339 @item @strong{Operation}
32340 @tab @strong{Description}
32341
32342 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
32343 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
32344 @item @code{-var-create}
32345 @tab create a variable object
32346 @item @code{-var-delete}
32347 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
32348 @item @code{-var-set-format}
32349 @tab set the display format of this variable
32350 @item @code{-var-show-format}
32351 @tab show the display format of this variable
32352 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
32353 @tab tells how many children this object has
32354 @item @code{-var-list-children}
32355 @tab return a list of the object's children
32356 @item @code{-var-info-type}
32357 @tab show the type of this variable object
32358 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
32359 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
32360 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
32361 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
32362 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
32363 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
32364 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
32365 @tab get the value of this variable
32366 @item @code{-var-assign}
32367 @tab set the value of this variable
32368 @item @code{-var-update}
32369 @tab update the variable and its children
32370 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
32371 @tab set frozeness attribute
32372 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
32373 @tab set range of children to display on update
32374 @end multitable
32375
32376 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
32377 how it can be used.
32378
32379 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
32380
32381 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
32382 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
32383
32384 @smallexample
32385 -enable-pretty-printing
32386 @end smallexample
32387
32388 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
32389 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
32390 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
32391 request that this functionality be enabled.
32392
32393 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
32394
32395 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
32396 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
32397
32398 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
32399 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
32400
32401 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
32402 @findex -var-create
32403
32404 @subsubheading Synopsis
32405
32406 @smallexample
32407 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
32408 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
32409 @end smallexample
32410
32411 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
32412 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
32413 register.
32414
32415 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
32416 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
32417 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
32418 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
32419 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
32420
32421 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
32422 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
32423 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
32424 object must be created.
32425
32426 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
32427 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
32428
32429 @itemize @bullet
32430 @item
32431 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
32432
32433 @item
32434 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
32435
32436 @item
32437 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
32438 @end itemize
32439
32440 @cindex dynamic varobj
32441 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
32442 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
32443 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
32444 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
32445 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
32446 compatibility for existing clients.
32447
32448 @subsubheading Result
32449
32450 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
32451 are:
32452
32453 @table @samp
32454 @item name
32455 The name of the varobj.
32456
32457 @item numchild
32458 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
32459 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
32460 @samp{has_more} attribute.
32461
32462 @item value
32463 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
32464 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
32465 will not be interesting.
32466
32467 @item type
32468 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
32469 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
32470 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
32471 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
32472 @emph{declared} one.
32473
32474 @item thread-id
32475 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
32476 thread's identifier.
32477
32478 @item has_more
32479 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
32480 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
32481
32482 @item dynamic
32483 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32484 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32485 then this attribute will not be present.
32486
32487 @item displayhint
32488 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32489 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32490 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32491 @end table
32492
32493 Typical output will look like this:
32494
32495 @smallexample
32496 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
32497 has_more="@var{has_more}"
32498 @end smallexample
32499
32500
32501 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
32502 @findex -var-delete
32503
32504 @subsubheading Synopsis
32505
32506 @smallexample
32507 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
32508 @end smallexample
32509
32510 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
32511 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
32512
32513 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
32514
32515
32516 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
32517 @findex -var-set-format
32518
32519 @subsubheading Synopsis
32520
32521 @smallexample
32522 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
32523 @end smallexample
32524
32525 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
32526 @var{format-spec}.
32527
32528 @anchor{-var-set-format}
32529 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
32530
32531 @smallexample
32532 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
32533 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
32534 @end smallexample
32535
32536 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
32537 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
32538 for pointers, etc.).
32539
32540 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
32541 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
32542
32543 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
32544 @findex -var-show-format
32545
32546 @subsubheading Synopsis
32547
32548 @smallexample
32549 -var-show-format @var{name}
32550 @end smallexample
32551
32552 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
32553
32554 @smallexample
32555 @var{format} @expansion{}
32556 @var{format-spec}
32557 @end smallexample
32558
32559
32560 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
32561 @findex -var-info-num-children
32562
32563 @subsubheading Synopsis
32564
32565 @smallexample
32566 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
32567 @end smallexample
32568
32569 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
32570
32571 @smallexample
32572 numchild=@var{n}
32573 @end smallexample
32574
32575 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
32576 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
32577 be available.
32578
32579
32580 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
32581 @findex -var-list-children
32582
32583 @subsubheading Synopsis
32584
32585 @smallexample
32586 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
32587 @end smallexample
32588 @anchor{-var-list-children}
32589
32590 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
32591 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
32592 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
32593 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
32594 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
32595 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
32596 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
32597 and unions.
32598
32599 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
32600 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
32601 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
32602 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
32603 reported.
32604
32605 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
32606 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
32607 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
32608 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
32609 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
32610 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
32611 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
32612 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
32613 the visible items.
32614
32615 For each child the following results are returned:
32616
32617 @table @var
32618
32619 @item name
32620 Name of the variable object created for this child.
32621
32622 @item exp
32623 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
32624 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
32625
32626 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
32627 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
32628
32629 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
32630 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
32631 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
32632 type and value are not present.
32633
32634 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
32635 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
32636 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
32637
32638 @item numchild
32639 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
32640 0.
32641
32642 @item type
32643 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
32644 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
32645 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
32646 @emph{declared} one.
32647
32648 @item value
32649 If values were requested, this is the value.
32650
32651 @item thread-id
32652 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
32653 Otherwise this result is not present.
32654
32655 @item frozen
32656 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
32657
32658 @item displayhint
32659 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32660 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32661 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32662
32663 @item dynamic
32664 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32665 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32666 then this attribute will not be present.
32667
32668 @end table
32669
32670 The result may have its own attributes:
32671
32672 @table @samp
32673 @item displayhint
32674 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32675 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32676 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32677
32678 @item has_more
32679 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
32680 remaining after the end of the selected range.
32681 @end table
32682
32683 @subsubheading Example
32684
32685 @smallexample
32686 (gdb)
32687 -var-list-children n
32688 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
32689 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
32690 (gdb)
32691 -var-list-children --all-values n
32692 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
32693 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
32694 @end smallexample
32695
32696
32697 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
32698 @findex -var-info-type
32699
32700 @subsubheading Synopsis
32701
32702 @smallexample
32703 -var-info-type @var{name}
32704 @end smallexample
32705
32706 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
32707 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
32708 @value{GDBN} CLI:
32709
32710 @smallexample
32711 type=@var{typename}
32712 @end smallexample
32713
32714
32715 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
32716 @findex -var-info-expression
32717
32718 @subsubheading Synopsis
32719
32720 @smallexample
32721 -var-info-expression @var{name}
32722 @end smallexample
32723
32724 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
32725 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
32726 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
32727
32728 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
32729 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
32730
32731 @smallexample
32732 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
32733 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
32734 @end smallexample
32735
32736 @noindent
32737 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
32738 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
32739
32740 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
32741 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
32742 is of limited use.
32743
32744 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
32745 @findex -var-info-path-expression
32746
32747 @subsubheading Synopsis
32748
32749 @smallexample
32750 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
32751 @end smallexample
32752
32753 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
32754 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
32755 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
32756 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
32757 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
32758 watchpoint from a variable object.
32759
32760 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
32761 and will give an error when invoked on one.
32762
32763 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
32764 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
32765 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
32766 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
32767 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
32768 @smallexample
32769 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
32770 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
32771 @end smallexample
32772
32773 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
32774 @findex -var-show-attributes
32775
32776 @subsubheading Synopsis
32777
32778 @smallexample
32779 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
32780 @end smallexample
32781
32782 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
32783
32784 @smallexample
32785 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
32786 @end smallexample
32787
32788 @noindent
32789 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
32790
32791 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
32792 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
32793
32794 @subsubheading Synopsis
32795
32796 @smallexample
32797 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
32798 @end smallexample
32799
32800 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
32801 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
32802 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
32803 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
32804 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
32805 the current display format will be used. The current display format
32806 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
32807
32808 @smallexample
32809 value=@var{value}
32810 @end smallexample
32811
32812 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
32813 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
32814
32815 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
32816 @findex -var-assign
32817
32818 @subsubheading Synopsis
32819
32820 @smallexample
32821 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
32822 @end smallexample
32823
32824 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
32825 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
32826 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
32827 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
32828
32829 @subsubheading Example
32830
32831 @smallexample
32832 (gdb)
32833 -var-assign var1 3
32834 ^done,value="3"
32835 (gdb)
32836 -var-update *
32837 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
32838 (gdb)
32839 @end smallexample
32840
32841 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
32842 @findex -var-update
32843
32844 @subsubheading Synopsis
32845
32846 @smallexample
32847 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
32848 @end smallexample
32849
32850 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
32851 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
32852 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
32853 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
32854 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
32855 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
32856 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
32857 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
32858 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
32859 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
32860 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
32861 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
32862 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
32863
32864 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
32865 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
32866 diagnostic.
32867
32868 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
32869 only the selected range of children will be reported.
32870
32871 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
32872 @samp{changelist}.
32873
32874 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
32875
32876 @table @samp
32877 @item name
32878 The name of the varobj.
32879
32880 @item value
32881 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
32882 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
32883
32884 @item in_scope
32885 @anchor{-var-update}
32886 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
32887
32888 @table @code
32889 @item "true"
32890 The variable object's current value is valid.
32891
32892 @item "false"
32893 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
32894 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
32895 scope.
32896
32897 @item "invalid"
32898 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
32899 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
32900 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
32901 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
32902 objects.
32903 @end table
32904
32905 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
32906 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
32907
32908 @item type_changed
32909 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
32910 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
32911 be @samp{false}.
32912
32913 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
32914 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
32915 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
32916 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
32917 unset.
32918
32919 @item new_type
32920 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
32921 hold the new type.
32922
32923 @item new_num_children
32924 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
32925 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
32926
32927 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
32928 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
32929 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
32930 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
32931 children which may be available.
32932
32933 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
32934 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
32935 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
32936 only happen at the end of the update range).
32937
32938 @item displayhint
32939 The display hint, if any.
32940
32941 @item has_more
32942 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
32943 available outside the varobj's update range.
32944
32945 @item dynamic
32946 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32947 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32948 then this attribute will not be present.
32949
32950 @item new_children
32951 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
32952 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
32953 be listed in this attribute.
32954 @end table
32955
32956 @subsubheading Example
32957
32958 @smallexample
32959 (gdb)
32960 -var-assign var1 3
32961 ^done,value="3"
32962 (gdb)
32963 -var-update --all-values var1
32964 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
32965 type_changed="false"@}]
32966 (gdb)
32967 @end smallexample
32968
32969 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
32970 @findex -var-set-frozen
32971 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
32972
32973 @subsubheading Synopsis
32974
32975 @smallexample
32976 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
32977 @end smallexample
32978
32979 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
32980 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
32981 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
32982 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
32983 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
32984 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
32985 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
32986 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
32987 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
32988 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
32989 @code{-var-update} does.
32990
32991 @subsubheading Example
32992
32993 @smallexample
32994 (gdb)
32995 -var-set-frozen V 1
32996 ^done
32997 (gdb)
32998 @end smallexample
32999
33000 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
33001 @findex -var-set-update-range
33002 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
33003
33004 @subsubheading Synopsis
33005
33006 @smallexample
33007 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
33008 @end smallexample
33009
33010 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
33011 @code{-var-update}.
33012
33013 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
33014 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
33015 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
33016 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
33017
33018 @subsubheading Example
33019
33020 @smallexample
33021 (gdb)
33022 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
33023 ^done
33024 @end smallexample
33025
33026 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
33027 @findex -var-set-visualizer
33028 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
33029
33030 @subsubheading Synopsis
33031
33032 @smallexample
33033 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
33034 @end smallexample
33035
33036 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
33037
33038 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
33039 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
33040
33041 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
33042 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
33043 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
33044 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
33045 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
33046 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
33047 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
33048
33049 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
33050 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
33051 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
33052 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
33053
33054 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
33055 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
33056 can be used to check this.
33057
33058 @subsubheading Example
33059
33060 Resetting the visualizer:
33061
33062 @smallexample
33063 (gdb)
33064 -var-set-visualizer V None
33065 ^done
33066 @end smallexample
33067
33068 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
33069
33070 @smallexample
33071 (gdb)
33072 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
33073 ^done
33074 @end smallexample
33075
33076 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
33077 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
33078
33079 @smallexample
33080 (gdb)
33081 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
33082 ^done
33083 @end smallexample
33084
33085 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33086 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
33087 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
33088
33089 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
33090 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
33091 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
33092 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
33093
33094 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
33095 @c @subheading -data-assign
33096 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
33097 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
33098 @c set variable
33099 @c @subsubheading Example
33100 @c N.A.
33101
33102 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
33103 @findex -data-disassemble
33104
33105 @subsubheading Synopsis
33106
33107 @smallexample
33108 -data-disassemble
33109 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
33110 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
33111 -- @var{mode}
33112 @end smallexample
33113
33114 @noindent
33115 Where:
33116
33117 @table @samp
33118 @item @var{start-addr}
33119 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
33120 @item @var{end-addr}
33121 is the end address
33122 @item @var{filename}
33123 is the name of the file to disassemble
33124 @item @var{linenum}
33125 is the line number to disassemble around
33126 @item @var{lines}
33127 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
33128 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
33129 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
33130 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
33131 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
33132 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
33133 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
33134 are displayed.
33135 @item @var{mode}
33136 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
33137 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
33138 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
33139 @end table
33140
33141 @subsubheading Result
33142
33143 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
33144 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
33145 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
33146
33147 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
33148 following fields:
33149
33150 @table @code
33151 @item address
33152 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
33153
33154 @item func-name
33155 The name of the function this instruction is within.
33156
33157 @item offset
33158 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
33159
33160 @item inst
33161 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
33162
33163 @item opcodes
33164 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
33165 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
33166
33167 @end table
33168
33169 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
33170 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
33171
33172 @table @code
33173 @item line
33174 The line number within @samp{file}.
33175
33176 @item file
33177 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
33178 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
33179 used.
33180
33181 @item fullname
33182 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
33183 using the source file search path
33184 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
33185 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
33186
33187 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
33188 present in the debug information.
33189
33190 @item line_asm_insn
33191 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
33192 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
33193 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
33194 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
33195 @samp{opcodes}.
33196
33197 @end table
33198
33199 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
33200 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
33201 adjust its format.
33202
33203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33204
33205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
33206
33207 @subsubheading Example
33208
33209 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
33210
33211 @smallexample
33212 (gdb)
33213 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
33214 ^done,
33215 asm_insns=[
33216 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
33217 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
33218 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
33219 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
33220 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
33221 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
33222 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
33223 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
33224 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
33225 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
33226 (gdb)
33227 @end smallexample
33228
33229 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
33230 @code{main}.
33231
33232 @smallexample
33233 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
33234 ^done,asm_insns=[
33235 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
33236 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
33237 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
33238 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
33239 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
33240 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
33241 [@dots{}]
33242 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
33243 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
33244 (gdb)
33245 @end smallexample
33246
33247 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
33248
33249 @smallexample
33250 (gdb)
33251 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
33252 ^done,asm_insns=[
33253 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
33254 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
33255 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
33256 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
33257 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
33258 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
33259 (gdb)
33260 @end smallexample
33261
33262 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
33263
33264 @smallexample
33265 (gdb)
33266 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
33267 ^done,asm_insns=[
33268 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
33269 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33270 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33271 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
33272 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
33273 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
33274 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33275 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
33276 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
33277 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
33278 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
33279 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
33280 (gdb)
33281 @end smallexample
33282
33283
33284 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
33285 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
33286
33287 @subsubheading Synopsis
33288
33289 @smallexample
33290 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
33291 @end smallexample
33292
33293 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
33294 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
33295 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
33296
33297 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33298
33299 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
33300 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
33301 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
33302
33303 @subsubheading Example
33304
33305 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
33306 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
33307 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
33308 output.
33309
33310 @smallexample
33311 211-data-evaluate-expression A
33312 211^done,value="1"
33313 (gdb)
33314 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
33315 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
33316 (gdb)
33317 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
33318 411^done,value="4"
33319 (gdb)
33320 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
33321 511^done,value="4"
33322 (gdb)
33323 @end smallexample
33324
33325
33326 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
33327 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
33328
33329 @subsubheading Synopsis
33330
33331 @smallexample
33332 -data-list-changed-registers
33333 @end smallexample
33334
33335 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
33336
33337 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33338
33339 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
33340 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
33341
33342 @subsubheading Example
33343
33344 On a PPC MBX board:
33345
33346 @smallexample
33347 (gdb)
33348 -exec-continue
33349 ^running
33350
33351 (gdb)
33352 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
33353 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
33354 line="5"@}
33355 (gdb)
33356 -data-list-changed-registers
33357 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
33358 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
33359 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
33360 (gdb)
33361 @end smallexample
33362
33363
33364 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
33365 @findex -data-list-register-names
33366
33367 @subsubheading Synopsis
33368
33369 @smallexample
33370 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
33371 @end smallexample
33372
33373 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
33374 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
33375 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
33376 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
33377 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
33378 include empty register names.
33379
33380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33381
33382 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
33383 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
33384 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
33385
33386 @subsubheading Example
33387
33388 For the PPC MBX board:
33389 @smallexample
33390 (gdb)
33391 -data-list-register-names
33392 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
33393 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
33394 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
33395 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
33396 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
33397 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
33398 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
33399 (gdb)
33400 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
33401 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
33402 (gdb)
33403 @end smallexample
33404
33405 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
33406 @findex -data-list-register-values
33407
33408 @subsubheading Synopsis
33409
33410 @smallexample
33411 -data-list-register-values
33412 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
33413 @end smallexample
33414
33415 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
33416 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
33417 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
33418 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be
33419 returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option indicates that only
33420 the available registers are to be returned.
33421
33422 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
33423
33424 @table @code
33425 @item x
33426 Hexadecimal
33427 @item o
33428 Octal
33429 @item t
33430 Binary
33431 @item d
33432 Decimal
33433 @item r
33434 Raw
33435 @item N
33436 Natural
33437 @end table
33438
33439 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33440
33441 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
33442 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
33443
33444 @subsubheading Example
33445
33446 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
33447 don't appear in the actual output):
33448
33449 @smallexample
33450 (gdb)
33451 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
33452 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
33453 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
33454 (gdb)
33455 -data-list-register-values x
33456 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
33457 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
33458 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
33459 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
33460 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
33461 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
33462 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
33463 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
33464 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
33465 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
33466 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
33467 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
33468 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
33469 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
33470 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
33471 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
33472 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
33473 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
33474 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
33475 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
33476 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
33477 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
33478 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
33479 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
33480 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
33481 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
33482 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
33483 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
33484 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
33485 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
33486 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
33487 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
33488 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
33489 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
33490 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
33491 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
33492 (gdb)
33493 @end smallexample
33494
33495
33496 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
33497 @findex -data-read-memory
33498
33499 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
33500
33501 @subsubheading Synopsis
33502
33503 @smallexample
33504 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
33505 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
33506 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
33507 @end smallexample
33508
33509 @noindent
33510 where:
33511
33512 @table @samp
33513 @item @var{address}
33514 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
33515 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33516 quoted using the C convention.
33517
33518 @item @var{word-format}
33519 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
33520 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
33521 ,Output Formats}).
33522
33523 @item @var{word-size}
33524 The size of each memory word in bytes.
33525
33526 @item @var{nr-rows}
33527 The number of rows in the output table.
33528
33529 @item @var{nr-cols}
33530 The number of columns in the output table.
33531
33532 @item @var{aschar}
33533 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
33534 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
33535 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
33536 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
33537
33538 @item @var{byte-offset}
33539 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
33540 @end table
33541
33542 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
33543 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
33544 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
33545 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
33546 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
33547 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
33548 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
33549 @samp{addr}.
33550
33551 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
33552 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
33553 @samp{prev-page}.
33554
33555 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33556
33557 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
33558 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
33559
33560 @subsubheading Example
33561
33562 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
33563 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
33564 word. Display each word in hex.
33565
33566 @smallexample
33567 (gdb)
33568 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
33569 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
33570 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
33571 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
33572 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
33573 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
33574 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
33575 (gdb)
33576 @end smallexample
33577
33578 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
33579 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
33580
33581 @smallexample
33582 (gdb)
33583 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
33584 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
33585 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
33586 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
33587 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
33588 (gdb)
33589 @end smallexample
33590
33591 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
33592 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
33593 used as the non-printable character.
33594
33595 @smallexample
33596 (gdb)
33597 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
33598 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
33599 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
33600 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
33601 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33602 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33603 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33604 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33605 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
33606 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
33607 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
33608 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
33609 (gdb)
33610 @end smallexample
33611
33612 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
33613 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
33614
33615 @subsubheading Synopsis
33616
33617 @smallexample
33618 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
33619 @var{address} @var{count}
33620 @end smallexample
33621
33622 @noindent
33623 where:
33624
33625 @table @samp
33626 @item @var{address}
33627 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
33628 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33629 quoted using the C convention.
33630
33631 @item @var{count}
33632 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
33633
33634 @item @var{byte-offset}
33635 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
33636 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
33637 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
33638 perform address arithmetics itself.
33639
33640 @end table
33641
33642 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
33643 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
33644 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
33645 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
33646 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
33647 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
33648
33649 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
33650 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
33651 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
33652 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
33653 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
33654 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
33655 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
33656 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
33657
33658 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
33659 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
33660 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
33661 and has the following fields:
33662
33663 @table @code
33664 @item begin
33665 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
33666
33667 @item end
33668 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
33669
33670 @item offset
33671 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
33672 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
33673
33674 @item contents
33675 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
33676
33677 @end table
33678
33679
33680
33681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33682
33683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
33684
33685 @subsubheading Example
33686
33687 @smallexample
33688 (gdb)
33689 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
33690 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
33691 end="0xbffff15e",
33692 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
33693 (gdb)
33694 @end smallexample
33695
33696
33697 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
33698 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
33699
33700 @subsubheading Synopsis
33701
33702 @smallexample
33703 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
33704 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
33705 @end smallexample
33706
33707 @noindent
33708 where:
33709
33710 @table @samp
33711 @item @var{address}
33712 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
33713 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33714 quoted using the C convention.
33715
33716 @item @var{contents}
33717 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
33718
33719 @item @var{count}
33720 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
33721 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
33722 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
33723
33724 @end table
33725
33726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33727
33728 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33729
33730 @subsubheading Example
33731
33732 @smallexample
33733 (gdb)
33734 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
33735 ^done
33736 (gdb)
33737 @end smallexample
33738
33739 @smallexample
33740 (gdb)
33741 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
33742 ^done
33743 (gdb)
33744 @end smallexample
33745
33746 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33747 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
33748 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
33749
33750 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
33751 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
33752
33753 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
33754 @findex -trace-find
33755
33756 @subsubheading Synopsis
33757
33758 @smallexample
33759 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
33760 @end smallexample
33761
33762 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
33763 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
33764 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
33765
33766 @table @samp
33767
33768 @item none
33769 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
33770
33771 @item frame-number
33772 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
33773 that index.
33774
33775 @item tracepoint-number
33776 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
33777 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
33778
33779 @item pc
33780 An address is required as parameter. Finds
33781 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
33782 address.
33783
33784 @item pc-inside-range
33785 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
33786 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
33787 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
33788
33789 @item pc-outside-range
33790 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
33791 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
33792 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
33793
33794 @item line
33795 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
33796 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
33797 the specified location.
33798
33799 @end table
33800
33801 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
33802 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
33803
33804 @table @samp
33805 @item found
33806 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
33807 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
33808
33809 @item traceframe
33810 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
33811 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
33812
33813 @item tracepoint
33814 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
33815 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
33816
33817 @item frame
33818 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
33819 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
33820 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
33821
33822 @end table
33823
33824 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33825
33826 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
33827
33828 @subheading -trace-define-variable
33829 @findex -trace-define-variable
33830
33831 @subsubheading Synopsis
33832
33833 @smallexample
33834 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
33835 @end smallexample
33836
33837 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
33838 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
33839 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
33840 with the @samp{$} character.
33841
33842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33843
33844 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
33845
33846 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
33847 @findex -trace-frame-collected
33848
33849 @subsubheading Synopsis
33850
33851 @smallexample
33852 -trace-frame-collected
33853 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
33854 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
33855 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
33856 [--memory-contents]
33857 @end smallexample
33858
33859 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
33860 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
33861 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
33862 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
33863 See the output description table below for more details.
33864
33865 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
33866 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
33867 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
33868 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
33869 memory range and which is a computed expression.
33870
33871 For instance, if the actions were
33872 @smallexample
33873 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
33874 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
33875 @end smallexample
33876
33877 @noindent
33878 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
33879 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
33880 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
33881 objects would be computed expressions.
33882
33883 An example output would be:
33884
33885 @smallexample
33886 (gdb)
33887 -trace-frame-collected
33888 ^done,
33889 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
33890 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
33891 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
33892 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
33893 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
33894 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
33895 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
33896 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
33897 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
33898 ...
33899 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
33900 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
33901 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
33902 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
33903 (gdb)
33904 @end smallexample
33905
33906 Where:
33907
33908 @table @code
33909 @item explicit-variables
33910 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
33911 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
33912 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
33913 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
33914 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
33915 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
33916 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
33917 arrays, structures and unions.
33918
33919 @item computed-expressions
33920 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
33921 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
33922 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
33923 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
33924
33925 @item registers
33926 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
33927 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
33928 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
33929 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
33930 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
33931
33932 @item tvars
33933 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
33934 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
33935 current value are returned.
33936
33937 @item memory
33938 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
33939 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
33940 collected memory range and has the following fields:
33941
33942 @table @code
33943 @item address
33944 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
33945
33946 @item length
33947 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
33948
33949 @item contents
33950 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
33951 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
33952
33953 @end table
33954
33955 @end table
33956
33957 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33958
33959 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33960
33961 @subsubheading Example
33962
33963 @subheading -trace-list-variables
33964 @findex -trace-list-variables
33965
33966 @subsubheading Synopsis
33967
33968 @smallexample
33969 -trace-list-variables
33970 @end smallexample
33971
33972 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
33973 table has the following fields:
33974
33975 @table @samp
33976 @item name
33977 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
33978
33979 @item initial
33980 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
33981 field is always present.
33982
33983 @item current
33984 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
33985 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
33986 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
33987 presently running.
33988
33989 @end table
33990
33991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33992
33993 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
33994
33995 @subsubheading Example
33996
33997 @smallexample
33998 (gdb)
33999 -trace-list-variables
34000 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
34001 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
34002 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
34003 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
34004 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
34005 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
34006 (gdb)
34007 @end smallexample
34008
34009 @subheading -trace-save
34010 @findex -trace-save
34011
34012 @subsubheading Synopsis
34013
34014 @smallexample
34015 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
34016 @end smallexample
34017
34018 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
34019 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
34020 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
34021 to perform the save.
34022
34023 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34024
34025 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
34026
34027
34028 @subheading -trace-start
34029 @findex -trace-start
34030
34031 @subsubheading Synopsis
34032
34033 @smallexample
34034 -trace-start
34035 @end smallexample
34036
34037 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
34038 have any fields.
34039
34040 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34041
34042 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
34043
34044 @subheading -trace-status
34045 @findex -trace-status
34046
34047 @subsubheading Synopsis
34048
34049 @smallexample
34050 -trace-status
34051 @end smallexample
34052
34053 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
34054 the following fields:
34055
34056 @table @samp
34057
34058 @item supported
34059 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
34060 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
34061 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
34062 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
34063 started. This field is always present.
34064
34065 @item running
34066 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
34067 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
34068 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
34069
34070 @item stop-reason
34071 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
34072 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
34073 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
34074 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
34075 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
34076 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
34077 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
34078 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
34079 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
34080
34081 @item stopping-tracepoint
34082 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
34083 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
34084 @samp{passcount}.
34085
34086 @item frames
34087 @itemx frames-created
34088 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
34089 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
34090 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
34091 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
34092
34093 @item buffer-size
34094 @itemx buffer-free
34095 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
34096 remaining space. These fields are optional.
34097
34098 @item circular
34099 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
34100 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
34101 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
34102 and may fill up.
34103
34104 @item disconnected
34105 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
34106 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
34107 that the trace run will stop.
34108
34109 @item trace-file
34110 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
34111 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
34112
34113 @end table
34114
34115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34116
34117 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
34118
34119 @subheading -trace-stop
34120 @findex -trace-stop
34121
34122 @subsubheading Synopsis
34123
34124 @smallexample
34125 -trace-stop
34126 @end smallexample
34127
34128 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
34129 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
34130 @samp{running} fields are not output.
34131
34132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34133
34134 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
34135
34136
34137 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34138 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
34139 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
34140
34141
34142 @ignore
34143 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
34144 @findex -symbol-info-address
34145
34146 @subsubheading Synopsis
34147
34148 @smallexample
34149 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
34150 @end smallexample
34151
34152 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
34153
34154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34155
34156 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
34157
34158 @subsubheading Example
34159 N.A.
34160
34161
34162 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
34163 @findex -symbol-info-file
34164
34165 @subsubheading Synopsis
34166
34167 @smallexample
34168 -symbol-info-file
34169 @end smallexample
34170
34171 Show the file for the symbol.
34172
34173 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34174
34175 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
34176 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
34177
34178 @subsubheading Example
34179 N.A.
34180
34181
34182 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
34183 @findex -symbol-info-function
34184
34185 @subsubheading Synopsis
34186
34187 @smallexample
34188 -symbol-info-function
34189 @end smallexample
34190
34191 Show which function the symbol lives in.
34192
34193 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34194
34195 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
34196
34197 @subsubheading Example
34198 N.A.
34199
34200
34201 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
34202 @findex -symbol-info-line
34203
34204 @subsubheading Synopsis
34205
34206 @smallexample
34207 -symbol-info-line
34208 @end smallexample
34209
34210 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
34211
34212 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34213
34214 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
34215 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
34216
34217 @subsubheading Example
34218 N.A.
34219
34220
34221 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
34222 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
34223
34224 @subsubheading Synopsis
34225
34226 @smallexample
34227 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
34228 @end smallexample
34229
34230 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
34231
34232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34233
34234 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
34235
34236 @subsubheading Example
34237 N.A.
34238
34239
34240 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
34241 @findex -symbol-list-functions
34242
34243 @subsubheading Synopsis
34244
34245 @smallexample
34246 -symbol-list-functions
34247 @end smallexample
34248
34249 List the functions in the executable.
34250
34251 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34252
34253 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
34254 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
34255
34256 @subsubheading Example
34257 N.A.
34258 @end ignore
34259
34260
34261 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
34262 @findex -symbol-list-lines
34263
34264 @subsubheading Synopsis
34265
34266 @smallexample
34267 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
34268 @end smallexample
34269
34270 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
34271 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
34272 ascending PC order.
34273
34274 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34275
34276 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
34277
34278 @subsubheading Example
34279 @smallexample
34280 (gdb)
34281 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
34282 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
34283 (gdb)
34284 @end smallexample
34285
34286
34287 @ignore
34288 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
34289 @findex -symbol-list-types
34290
34291 @subsubheading Synopsis
34292
34293 @smallexample
34294 -symbol-list-types
34295 @end smallexample
34296
34297 List all the type names.
34298
34299 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34300
34301 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
34302 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
34303
34304 @subsubheading Example
34305 N.A.
34306
34307
34308 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
34309 @findex -symbol-list-variables
34310
34311 @subsubheading Synopsis
34312
34313 @smallexample
34314 -symbol-list-variables
34315 @end smallexample
34316
34317 List all the global and static variable names.
34318
34319 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34320
34321 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
34322
34323 @subsubheading Example
34324 N.A.
34325
34326
34327 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
34328 @findex -symbol-locate
34329
34330 @subsubheading Synopsis
34331
34332 @smallexample
34333 -symbol-locate
34334 @end smallexample
34335
34336 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34337
34338 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
34339
34340 @subsubheading Example
34341 N.A.
34342
34343
34344 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
34345 @findex -symbol-type
34346
34347 @subsubheading Synopsis
34348
34349 @smallexample
34350 -symbol-type @var{variable}
34351 @end smallexample
34352
34353 Show type of @var{variable}.
34354
34355 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34356
34357 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
34358 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
34359
34360 @subsubheading Example
34361 N.A.
34362 @end ignore
34363
34364
34365 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34366 @node GDB/MI File Commands
34367 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
34368
34369 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
34370 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
34371
34372 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
34373 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
34374
34375 @subsubheading Synopsis
34376
34377 @smallexample
34378 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
34379 @end smallexample
34380
34381 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
34382 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
34383 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
34384 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
34385 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
34386 notification.
34387
34388 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34389
34390 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
34391
34392 @subsubheading Example
34393
34394 @smallexample
34395 (gdb)
34396 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
34397 ^done
34398 (gdb)
34399 @end smallexample
34400
34401
34402 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
34403 @findex -file-exec-file
34404
34405 @subsubheading Synopsis
34406
34407 @smallexample
34408 -file-exec-file @var{file}
34409 @end smallexample
34410
34411 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
34412 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
34413 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
34414 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
34415 notification.
34416
34417 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34418
34419 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
34420
34421 @subsubheading Example
34422
34423 @smallexample
34424 (gdb)
34425 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
34426 ^done
34427 (gdb)
34428 @end smallexample
34429
34430
34431 @ignore
34432 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
34433 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
34434
34435 @subsubheading Synopsis
34436
34437 @smallexample
34438 -file-list-exec-sections
34439 @end smallexample
34440
34441 List the sections of the current executable file.
34442
34443 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34444
34445 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
34446 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
34447 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
34448
34449 @subsubheading Example
34450 N.A.
34451 @end ignore
34452
34453
34454 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
34455 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
34456
34457 @subsubheading Synopsis
34458
34459 @smallexample
34460 -file-list-exec-source-file
34461 @end smallexample
34462
34463 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
34464 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
34465 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
34466 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
34467
34468 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34469
34470 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
34471
34472 @subsubheading Example
34473
34474 @smallexample
34475 (gdb)
34476 123-file-list-exec-source-file
34477 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
34478 (gdb)
34479 @end smallexample
34480
34481
34482 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
34483 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
34484
34485 @subsubheading Synopsis
34486
34487 @smallexample
34488 -file-list-exec-source-files
34489 @end smallexample
34490
34491 List the source files for the current executable.
34492
34493 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
34494 name) of a source file.
34495
34496 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34497
34498 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
34499 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
34500
34501 @subsubheading Example
34502 @smallexample
34503 (gdb)
34504 -file-list-exec-source-files
34505 ^done,files=[
34506 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
34507 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
34508 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
34509 (gdb)
34510 @end smallexample
34511
34512 @ignore
34513 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
34514 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
34515
34516 @subsubheading Synopsis
34517
34518 @smallexample
34519 -file-list-shared-libraries
34520 @end smallexample
34521
34522 List the shared libraries in the program.
34523
34524 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34525
34526 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
34527
34528 @subsubheading Example
34529 N.A.
34530
34531
34532 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
34533 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
34534
34535 @subsubheading Synopsis
34536
34537 @smallexample
34538 -file-list-symbol-files
34539 @end smallexample
34540
34541 List symbol files.
34542
34543 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34544
34545 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
34546
34547 @subsubheading Example
34548 N.A.
34549 @end ignore
34550
34551
34552 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
34553 @findex -file-symbol-file
34554
34555 @subsubheading Synopsis
34556
34557 @smallexample
34558 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
34559 @end smallexample
34560
34561 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
34562 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
34563 produced, except for a completion notification.
34564
34565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34566
34567 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
34568
34569 @subsubheading Example
34570
34571 @smallexample
34572 (gdb)
34573 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
34574 ^done
34575 (gdb)
34576 @end smallexample
34577
34578 @ignore
34579 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34580 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
34581 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
34582
34583 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
34584
34585 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
34586
34587 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
34588
34589 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
34590
34591 @c @subheading -overlay-map
34592
34593 @c @subheading -overlay-off
34594
34595 @c @subheading -overlay-on
34596
34597 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
34598
34599 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34600 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
34601 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
34602
34603 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
34604
34605 @c @subheading -signal-handle
34606
34607 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
34608
34609 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
34610 @end ignore
34611
34612
34613 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34614 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
34615 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
34616
34617
34618 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
34619 @findex -target-attach
34620
34621 @subsubheading Synopsis
34622
34623 @smallexample
34624 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
34625 @end smallexample
34626
34627 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
34628 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
34629 group, the id previously returned by
34630 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
34631
34632 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34633
34634 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
34635
34636 @subsubheading Example
34637 @smallexample
34638 (gdb)
34639 -target-attach 34
34640 =thread-created,id="1"
34641 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
34642 ^done
34643 (gdb)
34644 @end smallexample
34645
34646 @ignore
34647 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
34648 @findex -target-compare-sections
34649
34650 @subsubheading Synopsis
34651
34652 @smallexample
34653 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
34654 @end smallexample
34655
34656 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
34657 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
34658
34659 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34660
34661 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
34662
34663 @subsubheading Example
34664 N.A.
34665 @end ignore
34666
34667
34668 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
34669 @findex -target-detach
34670
34671 @subsubheading Synopsis
34672
34673 @smallexample
34674 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
34675 @end smallexample
34676
34677 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
34678 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
34679 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
34680
34681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34682
34683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
34684
34685 @subsubheading Example
34686
34687 @smallexample
34688 (gdb)
34689 -target-detach
34690 ^done
34691 (gdb)
34692 @end smallexample
34693
34694
34695 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
34696 @findex -target-disconnect
34697
34698 @subsubheading Synopsis
34699
34700 @smallexample
34701 -target-disconnect
34702 @end smallexample
34703
34704 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
34705 generally not resumed.
34706
34707 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34708
34709 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
34710
34711 @subsubheading Example
34712
34713 @smallexample
34714 (gdb)
34715 -target-disconnect
34716 ^done
34717 (gdb)
34718 @end smallexample
34719
34720
34721 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
34722 @findex -target-download
34723
34724 @subsubheading Synopsis
34725
34726 @smallexample
34727 -target-download
34728 @end smallexample
34729
34730 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
34731 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
34732
34733 @table @samp
34734 @item section
34735 The name of the section.
34736 @item section-sent
34737 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
34738 @item section-size
34739 The size of the section.
34740 @item total-sent
34741 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
34742 @item total-size
34743 The size of the overall executable to download.
34744 @end table
34745
34746 @noindent
34747 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
34748 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
34749
34750 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
34751 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
34752
34753 @table @samp
34754 @item section
34755 The name of the section.
34756 @item section-size
34757 The size of the section.
34758 @item total-size
34759 The size of the overall executable to download.
34760 @end table
34761
34762 @noindent
34763 At the end, a summary is printed.
34764
34765 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34766
34767 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
34768
34769 @subsubheading Example
34770
34771 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
34772 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
34773
34774 @smallexample
34775 (gdb)
34776 -target-download
34777 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
34778 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
34779 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
34780 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
34781 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
34782 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
34783 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
34784 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
34785 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
34786 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
34787 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
34788 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
34789 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
34790 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
34791 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
34792 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
34793 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
34794 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
34795 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
34796 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
34797 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
34798 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
34799 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
34800 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
34801 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
34802 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
34803 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
34804 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
34805 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
34806 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
34807 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
34808 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
34809 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
34810 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
34811 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
34812 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
34813 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
34814 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
34815 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
34816 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
34817 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
34818 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
34819 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
34820 write-rate="429"
34821 (gdb)
34822 @end smallexample
34823
34824
34825 @ignore
34826 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
34827 @findex -target-exec-status
34828
34829 @subsubheading Synopsis
34830
34831 @smallexample
34832 -target-exec-status
34833 @end smallexample
34834
34835 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
34836 not, for instance).
34837
34838 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34839
34840 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
34841
34842 @subsubheading Example
34843 N.A.
34844
34845
34846 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
34847 @findex -target-list-available-targets
34848
34849 @subsubheading Synopsis
34850
34851 @smallexample
34852 -target-list-available-targets
34853 @end smallexample
34854
34855 List the possible targets to connect to.
34856
34857 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34858
34859 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
34860
34861 @subsubheading Example
34862 N.A.
34863
34864
34865 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
34866 @findex -target-list-current-targets
34867
34868 @subsubheading Synopsis
34869
34870 @smallexample
34871 -target-list-current-targets
34872 @end smallexample
34873
34874 Describe the current target.
34875
34876 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34877
34878 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
34879 other things).
34880
34881 @subsubheading Example
34882 N.A.
34883
34884
34885 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
34886 @findex -target-list-parameters
34887
34888 @subsubheading Synopsis
34889
34890 @smallexample
34891 -target-list-parameters
34892 @end smallexample
34893
34894 @c ????
34895 @end ignore
34896
34897 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34898
34899 No equivalent.
34900
34901 @subsubheading Example
34902 N.A.
34903
34904
34905 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
34906 @findex -target-select
34907
34908 @subsubheading Synopsis
34909
34910 @smallexample
34911 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
34912 @end smallexample
34913
34914 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
34915
34916 @table @samp
34917 @item @var{type}
34918 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
34919 @item @var{parameters}
34920 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
34921 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
34922 @end table
34923
34924 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
34925 which the target program is, in the following form:
34926
34927 @smallexample
34928 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
34929 args=[@var{arg list}]
34930 @end smallexample
34931
34932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34933
34934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
34935
34936 @subsubheading Example
34937
34938 @smallexample
34939 (gdb)
34940 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
34941 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
34942 (gdb)
34943 @end smallexample
34944
34945 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34946 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
34947 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
34948
34949
34950 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
34951 @findex -target-file-put
34952
34953 @subsubheading Synopsis
34954
34955 @smallexample
34956 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
34957 @end smallexample
34958
34959 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
34960 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
34961
34962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34963
34964 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
34965
34966 @subsubheading Example
34967
34968 @smallexample
34969 (gdb)
34970 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
34971 ^done
34972 (gdb)
34973 @end smallexample
34974
34975
34976 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
34977 @findex -target-file-get
34978
34979 @subsubheading Synopsis
34980
34981 @smallexample
34982 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
34983 @end smallexample
34984
34985 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
34986 on the host system.
34987
34988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34989
34990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
34991
34992 @subsubheading Example
34993
34994 @smallexample
34995 (gdb)
34996 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
34997 ^done
34998 (gdb)
34999 @end smallexample
35000
35001
35002 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
35003 @findex -target-file-delete
35004
35005 @subsubheading Synopsis
35006
35007 @smallexample
35008 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
35009 @end smallexample
35010
35011 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
35012
35013 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35014
35015 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
35016
35017 @subsubheading Example
35018
35019 @smallexample
35020 (gdb)
35021 -target-file-delete remotefile
35022 ^done
35023 (gdb)
35024 @end smallexample
35025
35026
35027 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35028 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
35029 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
35030
35031 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
35032 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
35033
35034 @subsubheading Synopsis
35035
35036 @smallexample
35037 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
35038 @end smallexample
35039
35040 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
35041 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
35042 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
35043
35044 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35045
35046 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
35047
35048 @subsubheading Result
35049
35050 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
35051 defined for each exception:
35052
35053 @table @samp
35054 @item name
35055 The name of the exception.
35056
35057 @item address
35058 The address of the exception.
35059
35060 @end table
35061
35062 @subsubheading Example
35063
35064 @smallexample
35065 -info-ada-exceptions aint
35066 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
35067 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
35068 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
35069 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
35070 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
35071 @end smallexample
35072
35073 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
35074
35075 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
35076 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
35077 Catchpoint Commands}.
35078
35079
35080 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35081 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
35082 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
35083
35084 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
35085 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
35086 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
35087 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
35088
35089 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
35090 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
35091 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
35092
35093 @subsubheading Synopsis
35094
35095 @smallexample
35096 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
35097 @end smallexample
35098
35099 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
35100
35101 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
35102 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
35103 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
35104 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
35105 dash.
35106
35107 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35108
35109 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
35110
35111 @subsubheading Result
35112
35113 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
35114
35115 @table @samp
35116 @item exists
35117 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
35118 @code{"false"} otherwise.
35119
35120 @end table
35121
35122 @subsubheading Example
35123
35124 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
35125
35126 @smallexample
35127 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
35128 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
35129 @end smallexample
35130
35131 @noindent
35132 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
35133 to the debugger:
35134
35135 @smallexample
35136 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
35137 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
35138 @end smallexample
35139
35140 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
35141 @findex -list-features
35142 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
35143
35144 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
35145 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
35146 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
35147 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
35148 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
35149 startup.
35150
35151 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
35152 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
35153 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
35154 is given below.
35155
35156 Example output:
35157
35158 @smallexample
35159 (gdb) -list-features
35160 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
35161 @end smallexample
35162
35163 The current list of features is:
35164
35165 @ftable @samp
35166 @item frozen-varobjs
35167 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
35168 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
35169 of @code{-varobj-create}.
35170 @item pending-breakpoints
35171 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
35172 command.
35173 @item python
35174 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
35175 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
35176 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
35177 @item thread-info
35178 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
35179 @item data-read-memory-bytes
35180 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
35181 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
35182 @item breakpoint-notifications
35183 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
35184 CLI will be announced via async records.
35185 @item ada-task-info
35186 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
35187 @item language-option
35188 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
35189 option (@pxref{Context management}).
35190 @item info-gdb-mi-command
35191 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
35192 @item undefined-command-error-code
35193 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
35194 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
35195 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
35196 @item exec-run-start-option
35197 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
35198 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
35199 @end ftable
35200
35201 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
35202 @findex -list-target-features
35203
35204 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
35205 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
35206 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
35207 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
35208 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
35209 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
35210 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
35211 Example output:
35212
35213 @smallexample
35214 (gdb) -list-target-features
35215 ^done,result=["async"]
35216 @end smallexample
35217
35218 The current list of features is:
35219
35220 @table @samp
35221 @item async
35222 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
35223 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
35224 while the target is running.
35225
35226 @item reverse
35227 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
35228 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35229
35230 @end table
35231
35232 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
35233 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
35234 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
35235
35236 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
35237
35238 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
35239 @findex -gdb-exit
35240
35241 @subsubheading Synopsis
35242
35243 @smallexample
35244 -gdb-exit
35245 @end smallexample
35246
35247 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
35248
35249 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35250
35251 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
35252
35253 @subsubheading Example
35254
35255 @smallexample
35256 (gdb)
35257 -gdb-exit
35258 ^exit
35259 @end smallexample
35260
35261
35262 @ignore
35263 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
35264 @findex -exec-abort
35265
35266 @subsubheading Synopsis
35267
35268 @smallexample
35269 -exec-abort
35270 @end smallexample
35271
35272 Kill the inferior running program.
35273
35274 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35275
35276 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
35277
35278 @subsubheading Example
35279 N.A.
35280 @end ignore
35281
35282
35283 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
35284 @findex -gdb-set
35285
35286 @subsubheading Synopsis
35287
35288 @smallexample
35289 -gdb-set
35290 @end smallexample
35291
35292 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
35293 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
35294
35295 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35296
35297 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
35298
35299 @subsubheading Example
35300
35301 @smallexample
35302 (gdb)
35303 -gdb-set $foo=3
35304 ^done
35305 (gdb)
35306 @end smallexample
35307
35308
35309 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
35310 @findex -gdb-show
35311
35312 @subsubheading Synopsis
35313
35314 @smallexample
35315 -gdb-show
35316 @end smallexample
35317
35318 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
35319
35320 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35321
35322 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
35323
35324 @subsubheading Example
35325
35326 @smallexample
35327 (gdb)
35328 -gdb-show annotate
35329 ^done,value="0"
35330 (gdb)
35331 @end smallexample
35332
35333 @c @subheading -gdb-source
35334
35335
35336 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
35337 @findex -gdb-version
35338
35339 @subsubheading Synopsis
35340
35341 @smallexample
35342 -gdb-version
35343 @end smallexample
35344
35345 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
35346
35347 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35348
35349 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
35350 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
35351
35352 @subsubheading Example
35353
35354 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
35355 @c box in TeX.
35356 @smallexample
35357 (gdb)
35358 -gdb-version
35359 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
35360 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
35361 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
35362 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
35363 ~ certain conditions.
35364 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
35365 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
35366 ~ details.
35367 ~This GDB was configured as
35368 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
35369 ^done
35370 (gdb)
35371 @end smallexample
35372
35373 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
35374 @findex -list-thread-groups
35375
35376 @subheading Synopsis
35377
35378 @smallexample
35379 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
35380 @end smallexample
35381
35382 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
35383 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
35384 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
35385 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
35386 top-level thread groups.
35387
35388 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
35389 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
35390 available on the target.
35391
35392 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
35393 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
35394 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
35395 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
35396 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
35397 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
35398 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
35399 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
35400
35401 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
35402 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
35403 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
35404 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
35405 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
35406 @samp{threads} field.
35407
35408 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
35409 the following caveats:
35410
35411 @itemize @bullet
35412 @item
35413 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
35414 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
35415 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
35416
35417 @item
35418 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
35419 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
35420 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
35421 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
35422 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
35423 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
35424
35425 @end itemize
35426
35427 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
35428 have the following fields:
35429
35430 @table @code
35431 @item id
35432 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
35433 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
35434 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
35435
35436 @item type
35437 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
35438 valid type.
35439
35440 @item pid
35441 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
35442 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
35443
35444 @item num_children
35445 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
35446 absent for an available thread group.
35447
35448 @item threads
35449 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
35450 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
35451 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
35452
35453 @item cores
35454 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
35455 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
35456 such information is not available.
35457
35458 @item executable
35459 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
35460 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
35461 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
35462
35463 @end table
35464
35465 @subheading Example
35466
35467 @smallexample
35468 @value{GDBP}
35469 -list-thread-groups
35470 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
35471 -list-thread-groups 17
35472 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
35473 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
35474 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
35475 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
35476 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
35477 -list-thread-groups --available
35478 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
35479 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
35480 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
35481 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
35482 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
35483 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
35484 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
35485 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
35486 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
35487 @end smallexample
35488
35489 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
35490 @findex -info-os
35491
35492 @subsubheading Synopsis
35493
35494 @smallexample
35495 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
35496 @end smallexample
35497
35498 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
35499 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
35500 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
35501 of data of that type.
35502
35503 The types of information available depend on the target operating
35504 system.
35505
35506 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35507
35508 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
35509
35510 @subsubheading Example
35511
35512 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
35513 like this:
35514
35515 @smallexample
35516 @value{GDBP}
35517 -info-os
35518 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
35519 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
35520 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
35521 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
35522 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
35523 col2="Processes"@},
35524 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
35525 col2="Process groups"@},
35526 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
35527 col2="Threads"@},
35528 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
35529 col2="File descriptors"@},
35530 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
35531 col2="Sockets"@},
35532 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
35533 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
35534 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
35535 col2="Semaphores"@},
35536 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
35537 col2="Message queues"@},
35538 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
35539 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
35540 @value{GDBP}
35541 -info-os processes
35542 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
35543 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
35544 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
35545 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
35546 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
35547 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
35548 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
35549 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
35550 ...
35551 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
35552 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
35553 (gdb)
35554 @end smallexample
35555
35556 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
35557 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
35558 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
35559 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
35560 @code{info os} omits it.)
35561
35562 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
35563 @findex -add-inferior
35564
35565 @subheading Synopsis
35566
35567 @smallexample
35568 -add-inferior
35569 @end smallexample
35570
35571 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
35572 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
35573 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
35574 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
35575 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
35576 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
35577
35578 @subheading Example
35579
35580 @smallexample
35581 @value{GDBP}
35582 -add-inferior
35583 ^done,inferior="i3"
35584 @end smallexample
35585
35586 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
35587 @findex -interpreter-exec
35588
35589 @subheading Synopsis
35590
35591 @smallexample
35592 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
35593 @end smallexample
35594 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
35595
35596 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
35597
35598 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35599
35600 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
35601
35602 @subheading Example
35603
35604 @smallexample
35605 (gdb)
35606 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
35607 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
35608 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
35609 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
35610 ^done
35611 (gdb)
35612 @end smallexample
35613
35614 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
35615 @findex -inferior-tty-set
35616
35617 @subheading Synopsis
35618
35619 @smallexample
35620 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35621 @end smallexample
35622
35623 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
35624
35625 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35626
35627 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
35628
35629 @subheading Example
35630
35631 @smallexample
35632 (gdb)
35633 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35634 ^done
35635 (gdb)
35636 @end smallexample
35637
35638 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
35639 @findex -inferior-tty-show
35640
35641 @subheading Synopsis
35642
35643 @smallexample
35644 -inferior-tty-show
35645 @end smallexample
35646
35647 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
35648
35649 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35650
35651 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
35652
35653 @subheading Example
35654
35655 @smallexample
35656 (gdb)
35657 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35658 ^done
35659 (gdb)
35660 -inferior-tty-show
35661 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
35662 (gdb)
35663 @end smallexample
35664
35665 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
35666 @findex -enable-timings
35667
35668 @subheading Synopsis
35669
35670 @smallexample
35671 -enable-timings [yes | no]
35672 @end smallexample
35673
35674 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
35675 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
35676 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
35677 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
35678
35679 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35680
35681 No equivalent.
35682
35683 @subheading Example
35684
35685 @smallexample
35686 (gdb)
35687 -enable-timings
35688 ^done
35689 (gdb)
35690 -break-insert main
35691 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
35692 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
35693 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
35694 times="0"@},
35695 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
35696 (gdb)
35697 -enable-timings no
35698 ^done
35699 (gdb)
35700 -exec-run
35701 ^running
35702 (gdb)
35703 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
35704 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
35705 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
35706 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
35707 (gdb)
35708 @end smallexample
35709
35710 @node Annotations
35711 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
35712
35713 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
35714 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
35715 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
35716 relatively high level.
35717
35718 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
35719 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
35720
35721 @ignore
35722 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
35723 @end ignore
35724
35725 @menu
35726 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
35727 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
35728 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
35729 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
35730 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
35731 * Annotations for Running::
35732 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
35733 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
35734 @end menu
35735
35736 @node Annotations Overview
35737 @section What is an Annotation?
35738 @cindex annotations
35739
35740 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
35741 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
35742 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
35743 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
35744 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
35745 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
35746 cannot contain newline characters.
35747
35748 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
35749 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
35750 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
35751 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
35752 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
35753 means those three characters as output.
35754
35755 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
35756 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
35757 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
35758 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
35759 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
35760 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
35761 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
35762 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
35763 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
35764
35765 @table @code
35766 @kindex set annotate
35767 @item set annotate @var{level}
35768 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
35769 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
35770
35771 @item show annotate
35772 @kindex show annotate
35773 Show the current annotation level.
35774 @end table
35775
35776 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
35777
35778 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
35779
35780 @smallexample
35781 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
35782 GNU gdb 6.0
35783 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
35784 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
35785 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
35786 under certain conditions.
35787 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
35788 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
35789 for details.
35790 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
35791
35792 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
35793 (@value{GDBP})
35794 ^Z^Zprompt
35795 @kbd{quit}
35796
35797 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
35798 $
35799 @end smallexample
35800
35801 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
35802 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
35803 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
35804 output from @value{GDBN}.
35805
35806 @node Server Prefix
35807 @section The Server Prefix
35808 @cindex server prefix
35809
35810 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
35811 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
35812 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
35813 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
35814 a transparent manner.
35815
35816 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
35817 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
35818 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
35819 @code{print} command.
35820
35821 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
35822 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
35823
35824 @node Prompting
35825 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
35826
35827 @cindex annotations for prompts
35828 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
35829 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
35830 over, etc.
35831
35832 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
35833 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
35834 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
35835 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
35836 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
35837 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
35838 features the following annotations:
35839
35840 @smallexample
35841 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
35842 ^Z^Zprompt
35843 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
35844 @end smallexample
35845
35846 The input types are
35847
35848 @table @code
35849 @findex pre-prompt annotation
35850 @findex prompt annotation
35851 @findex post-prompt annotation
35852 @item prompt
35853 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
35854
35855 @findex pre-commands annotation
35856 @findex commands annotation
35857 @findex post-commands annotation
35858 @item commands
35859 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
35860 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
35861
35862 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
35863 @findex overload-choice annotation
35864 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
35865 @item overload-choice
35866 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
35867
35868 @findex pre-query annotation
35869 @findex query annotation
35870 @findex post-query annotation
35871 @item query
35872 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
35873
35874 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
35875 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
35876 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
35877 @item prompt-for-continue
35878 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
35879 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
35880 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
35881 presence of annotations.
35882 @end table
35883
35884 @node Errors
35885 @section Errors
35886 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
35887
35888 @findex quit annotation
35889 @smallexample
35890 ^Z^Zquit
35891 @end smallexample
35892
35893 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
35894
35895 @findex error annotation
35896 @smallexample
35897 ^Z^Zerror
35898 @end smallexample
35899
35900 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
35901
35902 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
35903 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
35904 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
35905 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
35906 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
35907 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
35908 to the top level.
35909
35910 @findex error-begin annotation
35911 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
35912
35913 @smallexample
35914 ^Z^Zerror-begin
35915 @end smallexample
35916
35917 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
35918 message.
35919
35920 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
35921 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
35922 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
35923
35924 @node Invalidation
35925 @section Invalidation Notices
35926
35927 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
35928 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
35929 changed.
35930
35931 @table @code
35932 @findex frames-invalid annotation
35933 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
35934
35935 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
35936 have changed.
35937
35938 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
35939 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
35940
35941 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
35942 deleted a breakpoint.
35943 @end table
35944
35945 @node Annotations for Running
35946 @section Running the Program
35947 @cindex annotations for running programs
35948
35949 @findex starting annotation
35950 @findex stopping annotation
35951 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
35952 @code{step} or @code{continue},
35953
35954 @smallexample
35955 ^Z^Zstarting
35956 @end smallexample
35957
35958 is output. When the program stops,
35959
35960 @smallexample
35961 ^Z^Zstopped
35962 @end smallexample
35963
35964 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
35965 annotations describe how the program stopped.
35966
35967 @table @code
35968 @findex exited annotation
35969 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
35970 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
35971 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
35972
35973 @findex signalled annotation
35974 @findex signal-name annotation
35975 @findex signal-name-end annotation
35976 @findex signal-string annotation
35977 @findex signal-string-end annotation
35978 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
35979 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
35980 annotation continues:
35981
35982 @smallexample
35983 @var{intro-text}
35984 ^Z^Zsignal-name
35985 @var{name}
35986 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
35987 @var{middle-text}
35988 ^Z^Zsignal-string
35989 @var{string}
35990 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
35991 @var{end-text}
35992 @end smallexample
35993
35994 @noindent
35995 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
35996 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
35997 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
35998 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
35999 user's benefit and have no particular format.
36000
36001 @findex signal annotation
36002 @item ^Z^Zsignal
36003 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
36004 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
36005 terminated with it.
36006
36007 @findex breakpoint annotation
36008 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
36009 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
36010
36011 @findex watchpoint annotation
36012 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
36013 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
36014 @end table
36015
36016 @node Source Annotations
36017 @section Displaying Source
36018 @cindex annotations for source display
36019
36020 @findex source annotation
36021 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
36022
36023 @smallexample
36024 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
36025 @end smallexample
36026
36027 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
36028 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
36029 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
36030 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
36031 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
36032 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
36033 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
36034 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
36035 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
36036 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
36037 depend on the language).
36038
36039 @node JIT Interface
36040 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
36041 @cindex just-in-time compilation
36042 @cindex JIT compilation interface
36043
36044 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
36045 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
36046 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
36047 performance while maintaining platform independence.
36048
36049 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
36050 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
36051 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
36052 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
36053 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
36054 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
36055
36056 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
36057 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
36058 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
36059 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
36060 LLVM JIT.
36061
36062 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
36063 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
36064 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
36065 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
36066 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
36067 out about additional code.
36068
36069 @menu
36070 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
36071 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
36072 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
36073 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
36074 @end menu
36075
36076 @node Declarations
36077 @section JIT Declarations
36078
36079 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
36080 implement the interface:
36081
36082 @smallexample
36083 typedef enum
36084 @{
36085 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
36086 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
36087 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
36088 @} jit_actions_t;
36089
36090 struct jit_code_entry
36091 @{
36092 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
36093 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
36094 const char *symfile_addr;
36095 uint64_t symfile_size;
36096 @};
36097
36098 struct jit_descriptor
36099 @{
36100 uint32_t version;
36101 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
36102 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
36103 uint32_t action_flag;
36104 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
36105 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
36106 @};
36107
36108 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
36109 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
36110
36111 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
36112 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
36113 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
36114 @end smallexample
36115
36116 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
36117 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
36118 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
36119
36120 @node Registering Code
36121 @section Registering Code
36122
36123 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
36124
36125 @itemize @bullet
36126 @item
36127 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
36128 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
36129
36130 @item
36131 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
36132 file.
36133
36134 @item
36135 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
36136
36137 @item
36138 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
36139
36140 @item
36141 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
36142 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
36143 @end itemize
36144
36145 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
36146 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
36147 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
36148 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
36149
36150 @node Unregistering Code
36151 @section Unregistering Code
36152
36153 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
36154
36155 @itemize @bullet
36156 @item
36157 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
36158
36159 @item
36160 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
36161
36162 @item
36163 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
36164 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
36165 @end itemize
36166
36167 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
36168 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
36169
36170 @node Custom Debug Info
36171 @section Custom Debug Info
36172 @cindex custom JIT debug info
36173 @cindex JIT debug info reader
36174
36175 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
36176 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
36177 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
36178 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
36179 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
36180 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
36181 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
36182 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
36183 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
36184
36185 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
36186 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
36187 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
36188 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
36189 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
36190 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
36191 compiler.
36192
36193 @menu
36194 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
36195 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
36196 @end menu
36197
36198 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
36199 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
36200 @kindex jit-reader-load
36201 @kindex jit-reader-unload
36202
36203 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
36204 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
36205
36206 @table @code
36207 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
36208 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}. @var{reader} is a shared
36209 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
36210 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
36211 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
36212 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
36213 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
36214
36215 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
36216 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
36217 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
36218 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
36219 @code{jit-reader-load}.
36220
36221 @item jit-reader-unload
36222 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
36223
36224 @end table
36225
36226 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
36227 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
36228 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
36229
36230 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
36231 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
36232
36233 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
36234 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
36235 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
36236 the system include directory.
36237
36238 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
36239 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
36240 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
36241
36242 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
36243 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
36244
36245 @findex gdb_init_reader
36246 @smallexample
36247 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
36248 @end smallexample
36249
36250 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
36251
36252 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
36253 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
36254 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
36255 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
36256 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
36257 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
36258
36259 @smallexample
36260 struct gdb_reader_funcs
36261 @{
36262 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
36263 int reader_version;
36264
36265 /* For use by the reader. */
36266 void *priv_data;
36267
36268 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
36269 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
36270 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
36271 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
36272 @};
36273 @end smallexample
36274
36275 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
36276 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
36277
36278 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
36279 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
36280 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
36281 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
36282 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
36283 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
36284 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
36285 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
36286 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
36287 target's address space.
36288
36289 @node In-Process Agent
36290 @chapter In-Process Agent
36291 @cindex debugging agent
36292 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
36293 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
36294 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
36295 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
36296 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
36297 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
36298 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
36299 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
36300 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
36301 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
36302 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
36303 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
36304 behavior without interrupting it.
36305
36306 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
36307 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
36308 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
36309 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
36310 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
36311 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
36312 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
36313 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
36314 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
36315
36316 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
36317 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
36318 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
36319 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
36320
36321 @anchor{Control Agent}
36322 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
36323 debugging with the following commands:
36324
36325 @table @code
36326 @kindex set agent on
36327 @item set agent on
36328 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
36329 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
36330 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
36331 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
36332 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
36333 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
36334
36335 @kindex set agent off
36336 @item set agent off
36337 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
36338 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
36339
36340 @kindex show agent
36341 @item show agent
36342 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
36343 the in-process agent.
36344 @end table
36345
36346 @menu
36347 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
36348 @end menu
36349
36350 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
36351 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
36352 @cindex in-process agent protocol
36353
36354 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
36355 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
36356 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
36357 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
36358 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
36359 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
36360 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
36361 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
36362 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
36363
36364 @menu
36365 * IPA Protocol Objects::
36366 * IPA Protocol Commands::
36367 @end menu
36368
36369 @node IPA Protocol Objects
36370 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
36371 @cindex ipa protocol objects
36372
36373 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
36374 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
36375
36376 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
36377 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
36378 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
36379 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
36380
36381 @enumerate
36382 @item
36383 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
36384 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
36385 @item
36386 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
36387 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
36388 the other one.
36389 @end enumerate
36390
36391 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
36392
36393 @enumerate
36394 @item
36395 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
36396 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
36397 @anchor{agent expression object}
36398 @item
36399 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
36400 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
36401 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
36402 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
36403 @item
36404 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36405 @anchor{tracepoint object}
36406
36407 @end enumerate
36408
36409 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
36410 object:
36411
36412 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
36413 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
36414 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
36415 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
36416 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
36417 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
36418 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36419 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
36420 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
36421 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
36422 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
36423 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
36424 memory address for collecting.
36425 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
36426 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36427 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
36428 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36429 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
36430 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36431 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
36432 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
36433 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
36434 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
36435 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
36436 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
36437 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
36438 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
36439 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
36440 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
36441 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
36442 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
36443 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
36444 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
36445 @ref{agent expression object}
36446 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
36447 @ref{agent expression object}
36448 @item actions @tab variable
36449 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
36450 @end multitable
36451
36452 @node IPA Protocol Commands
36453 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
36454 @cindex ipa protocol commands
36455
36456 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
36457 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
36458
36459 @table @samp
36460
36461 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
36462 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
36463 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
36464 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
36465 in IPA finally.
36466
36467 Replies:
36468 @table @samp
36469 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
36470 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
36471 @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
36472 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
36473 @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
36474 @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
36475 @item E @var{NN}
36476 for an error
36477
36478 @end table
36479
36480 @item close
36481 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
36482 is about to kill inferiors.
36483
36484 @item qTfSTM
36485 @xref{qTfSTM}.
36486 @item qTsSTM
36487 @xref{qTsSTM}.
36488 @item qTSTMat
36489 @xref{qTSTMat}.
36490 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
36491 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
36492
36493 Replies:
36494 @table @samp
36495 @item E @var{NN}
36496 for an error
36497 @end table
36498 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
36499 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
36500 @end table
36501
36502 @node GDB Bugs
36503 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
36504 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
36505 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
36506
36507 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
36508
36509 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
36510 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
36511 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
36512 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
36513
36514 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
36515 information that enables us to fix the bug.
36516
36517 @menu
36518 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
36519 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
36520 @end menu
36521
36522 @node Bug Criteria
36523 @section Have You Found a Bug?
36524 @cindex bug criteria
36525
36526 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
36527
36528 @itemize @bullet
36529 @cindex fatal signal
36530 @cindex debugger crash
36531 @cindex crash of debugger
36532 @item
36533 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
36534 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
36535
36536 @cindex error on valid input
36537 @item
36538 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
36539 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
36540 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
36541
36542 @cindex invalid input
36543 @item
36544 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
36545 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
36546 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
36547 for traditional practice''.
36548
36549 @item
36550 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
36551 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
36552 @end itemize
36553
36554 @node Bug Reporting
36555 @section How to Report Bugs
36556 @cindex bug reports
36557 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
36558
36559 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
36560 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
36561 contact that organization first.
36562
36563 You can find contact information for many support companies and
36564 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
36565 distribution.
36566 @c should add a web page ref...
36567
36568 @ifset BUGURL
36569 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
36570 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
36571 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
36572 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
36573 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
36574 be used.
36575
36576 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
36577 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
36578 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
36579 @samp{bug-gdb}.
36580
36581 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
36582 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
36583 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
36584 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
36585 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
36586 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
36587 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
36588 bug reports to the mailing list.
36589 @end ifset
36590 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
36591 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
36592 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
36593 @end ifclear
36594 @end ifset
36595
36596 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
36597 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
36598 fact or leave it out, state it!
36599
36600 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
36601 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
36602 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
36603 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
36604 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
36605 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
36606 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
36607 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
36608 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
36609
36610 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
36611 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
36612 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
36613 self-contained.
36614
36615 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36616 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
36617 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
36618 bugs properly.
36619
36620 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
36621
36622 @itemize @bullet
36623 @item
36624 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
36625 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
36626 version}.
36627
36628 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
36629 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
36630
36631 @item
36632 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
36633 version number.
36634
36635 @item
36636 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
36637 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
36638 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
36639 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
36640
36641 @item
36642 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
36643 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
36644
36645 @item
36646 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
36647 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
36648 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
36649 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
36650 those compilers.
36651
36652 @item
36653 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
36654 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
36655 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
36656 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
36657
36658 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
36659 and then we might not encounter the bug.
36660
36661 @item
36662 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
36663 reproduce the bug.
36664
36665 @item
36666 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
36667 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
36668
36669 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
36670 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
36671 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
36672 a chance to make a mistake.
36673
36674 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
36675 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
36676 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
36677 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
36678 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
36679 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
36680 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
36681 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
36682
36683 @pindex script
36684 @cindex recording a session script
36685 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
36686 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
36687 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
36688 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
36689
36690 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
36691 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
36692
36693 @item
36694 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
36695 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
36696 it by context, not by line number.
36697
36698 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
36699 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
36700
36701 @end itemize
36702
36703 Here are some things that are not necessary:
36704
36705 @itemize @bullet
36706 @item
36707 A description of the envelope of the bug.
36708
36709 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
36710 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
36711 changes will not affect it.
36712
36713 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
36714 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
36715 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
36716 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
36717
36718 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
36719 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
36720 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
36721 less time, and so on.
36722
36723 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
36724 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
36725
36726 @item
36727 A patch for the bug.
36728
36729 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
36730 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
36731 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
36732 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
36733
36734 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
36735 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
36736 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
36737 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
36738
36739 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
36740 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
36741 help us to understand.
36742
36743 @item
36744 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
36745
36746 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
36747 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
36748 @end itemize
36749
36750 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
36751 @c and consists of the two following files:
36752 @c rluser.texi
36753 @c hsuser.texi
36754 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
36755 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
36756 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
36757 @include rluser.texi
36758 @include hsuser.texi
36759 @end ifclear
36760
36761 @node In Memoriam
36762 @appendix In Memoriam
36763
36764 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
36765 contributors:
36766
36767 @table @code
36768 @item Fred Fish
36769 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
36770 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
36771 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
36772
36773 @item Michael Snyder
36774 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
36775 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
36776 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
36777 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
36778 @end table
36779
36780 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
36781 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
36782
36783 @node Formatting Documentation
36784 @appendix Formatting Documentation
36785
36786 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
36787 @cindex reference card
36788 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
36789 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
36790 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
36791 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
36792 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
36793 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
36794
36795 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
36796 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
36797
36798 @smallexample
36799 make refcard.dvi
36800 @end smallexample
36801
36802 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
36803 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
36804 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
36805 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
36806 your @sc{dvi} output program.
36807
36808 @cindex documentation
36809
36810 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
36811 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
36812 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
36813 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
36814 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
36815 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
36816
36817 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
36818 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
36819 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
36820 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
36821 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
36822 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
36823 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
36824 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
36825
36826 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
36827 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
36828 @code{makeinfo}.
36829
36830 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
36831 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
36832 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
36833
36834 @smallexample
36835 cd gdb
36836 make gdb.info
36837 @end smallexample
36838
36839 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
36840 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
36841 Texinfo definitions file.
36842
36843 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
36844 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
36845 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
36846 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
36847 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
36848 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
36849 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
36850
36851 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
36852 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
36853 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
36854 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
36855 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
36856 directory.
36857
36858 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
36859 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
36860 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
36861 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
36862
36863 @smallexample
36864 make gdb.dvi
36865 @end smallexample
36866
36867 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
36868
36869 @node Installing GDB
36870 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
36871 @cindex installation
36872
36873 @menu
36874 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
36875 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
36876 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
36877 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
36878 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
36879 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
36880 @end menu
36881
36882 @node Requirements
36883 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
36884 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
36885
36886 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
36887 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
36888
36889 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
36890 @table @asis
36891 @item ISO C90 compiler
36892 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
36893 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
36894
36895 @end table
36896
36897 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
36898 @table @asis
36899 @item Expat
36900 @anchor{Expat}
36901 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
36902 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
36903 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
36904 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
36905 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
36906 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
36907
36908 Expat is used for:
36909
36910 @itemize @bullet
36911 @item
36912 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
36913 @item
36914 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
36915 @item
36916 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
36917 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
36918 @item
36919 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
36920 @item
36921 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
36922 @item
36923 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format})
36924 @end itemize
36925
36926 @item zlib
36927 @cindex compressed debug sections
36928 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
36929 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
36930 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
36931 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
36932 information in such binaries.
36933
36934 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
36935 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
36936 @url{http://zlib.net}.
36937
36938 @item iconv
36939 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
36940 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
36941 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
36942 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
36943
36944 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
36945 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
36946 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
36947 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
36948
36949 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
36950 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
36951 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
36952
36953 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
36954 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
36955 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
36956 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
36957 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
36958 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
36959 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
36960 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
36961 @end table
36962
36963 @node Running Configure
36964 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
36965 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
36966 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
36967 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
36968 build the @code{gdb} program.
36969 @iftex
36970 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
36971 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
36972 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
36973 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
36974 @end iftex
36975
36976 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
36977 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
36978 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
36979
36980 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
36981 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
36982
36983 @table @code
36984 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
36985 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
36986
36987 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
36988 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
36989
36990 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
36991 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
36992
36993 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
36994 @sc{gnu} include files
36995
36996 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
36997 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
36998
36999 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
37000 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
37001
37002 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
37003 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
37004
37005 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
37006 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
37007
37008 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
37009 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
37010 @end table
37011
37012 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
37013 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
37014 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
37015
37016 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
37017 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
37018 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
37019 argument.
37020
37021 For example:
37022
37023 @smallexample
37024 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
37025 ./configure @var{host}
37026 make
37027 @end smallexample
37028
37029 @noindent
37030 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
37031 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
37032 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
37033 correct value by examining your system.)
37034
37035 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
37036 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
37037 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
37038 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
37039
37040 @need 750
37041 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
37042 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
37043 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
37044
37045 @smallexample
37046 sh configure @var{host}
37047 @end smallexample
37048
37049 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
37050 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
37051 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
37052 @file{configure}
37053 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
37054 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
37055
37056 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
37057 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
37058 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
37059 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
37060 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
37061 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
37062 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
37063 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
37064 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
37065
37066 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
37067 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
37068 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
37069 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
37070 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
37071
37072 @node Separate Objdir
37073 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
37074
37075 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
37076 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
37077 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
37078 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
37079 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
37080 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
37081 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
37082 program specified there.
37083
37084 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
37085 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
37086 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
37087 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
37088 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
37089 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
37090
37091 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
37092 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
37093
37094 @smallexample
37095 @group
37096 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
37097 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
37098 cd ../gdb-sun4
37099 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
37100 make
37101 @end group
37102 @end smallexample
37103
37104 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
37105 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
37106 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
37107 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
37108 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
37109 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
37110
37111 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
37112 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
37113 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
37114 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
37115 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
37116
37117 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
37118 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
37119 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
37120 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
37121 You specify a cross-debugging target by
37122 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
37123
37124 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
37125 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
37126 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
37127
37128 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
37129 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
37130 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
37131 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
37132 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
37133
37134 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
37135 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
37136 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
37137 with each other.
37138
37139 @node Config Names
37140 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
37141
37142 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
37143 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
37144 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
37145 of information in the following pattern:
37146
37147 @smallexample
37148 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
37149 @end smallexample
37150
37151 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
37152 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
37153 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
37154
37155 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
37156 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
37157 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
37158 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
37159 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
37160 abbreviations---for example:
37161
37162 @smallexample
37163 % sh config.sub i386-linux
37164 i386-pc-linux-gnu
37165 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
37166 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
37167 % sh config.sub hp9k700
37168 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
37169 % sh config.sub sun4
37170 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
37171 % sh config.sub sun3
37172 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
37173 % sh config.sub i986v
37174 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
37175 @end smallexample
37176
37177 @noindent
37178 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
37179 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
37180
37181 @node Configure Options
37182 @section @file{configure} Options
37183
37184 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
37185 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
37186 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
37187 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
37188
37189 @smallexample
37190 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
37191 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
37192 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
37193 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
37194 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
37195 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
37196 @var{host}
37197 @end smallexample
37198
37199 @noindent
37200 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
37201 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
37202 @samp{--}.
37203
37204 @table @code
37205 @item --help
37206 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
37207
37208 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
37209 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
37210 @file{@var{dir}}.
37211
37212 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
37213 Configure the source to install programs under directory
37214 @file{@var{dir}}.
37215
37216 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
37217 @need 2000
37218 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
37219 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
37220 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
37221 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
37222 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
37223 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
37224 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
37225 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
37226 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
37227 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
37228 @var{dirname}.
37229
37230 @item --norecursion
37231 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
37232 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
37233
37234 @item --target=@var{target}
37235 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
37236 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
37237 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
37238
37239 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
37240
37241 @item @var{host} @dots{}
37242 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
37243
37244 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
37245 @end table
37246
37247 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
37248 needed for special purposes only.
37249
37250 @node System-wide configuration
37251 @section System-wide configuration and settings
37252 @cindex system-wide init file
37253
37254 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
37255 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
37256 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
37257
37258 Here is the corresponding configure option:
37259
37260 @table @code
37261 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
37262 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
37263 @var{file}.
37264 @end table
37265
37266 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
37267 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
37268
37269 @itemize @bullet
37270 @item
37271 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
37272 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
37273 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
37274 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
37275 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
37276 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
37277
37278 @item
37279 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
37280 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
37281 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
37282 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
37283 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
37284 @end itemize
37285
37286 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
37287 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
37288 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
37289 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
37290 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
37291 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
37292 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
37293 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
37294 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
37295 reread.
37296
37297 @menu
37298 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
37299 @end menu
37300
37301 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
37302 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
37303 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
37304
37305 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
37306 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
37307 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
37308 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
37309 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
37310 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
37311
37312 The following scripts are currently available:
37313 @itemize @bullet
37314
37315 @item @file{elinos.py}
37316 @pindex elinos.py
37317 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
37318 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
37319 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
37320 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
37321 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
37322 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
37323
37324 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
37325 @pindex wrs-linux.py
37326 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
37327 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
37328 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
37329 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
37330
37331 @end itemize
37332
37333 @node Maintenance Commands
37334 @appendix Maintenance Commands
37335 @cindex maintenance commands
37336 @cindex internal commands
37337
37338 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
37339 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
37340 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
37341 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
37342 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
37343
37344 @table @code
37345 @kindex maint agent
37346 @kindex maint agent-eval
37347 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
37348 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
37349 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
37350 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
37351 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
37352 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
37353 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
37354 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
37355 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
37356 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
37357 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
37358 addition and return the sum.
37359 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
37360 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
37361
37362 @kindex maint agent-printf
37363 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
37364 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
37365 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
37366 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
37367 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
37368
37369 @kindex maint info breakpoints
37370 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
37371 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
37372 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
37373 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
37374 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
37375 is shown:
37376
37377 @table @code
37378 @item breakpoint
37379 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
37380
37381 @item watchpoint
37382 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
37383
37384 @item longjmp
37385 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
37386 @code{longjmp} calls.
37387
37388 @item longjmp resume
37389 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
37390
37391 @item until
37392 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
37393
37394 @item finish
37395 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
37396
37397 @item shlib events
37398 Shared library events.
37399
37400 @end table
37401
37402 @kindex maint info bfds
37403 @item maint info bfds
37404 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
37405 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
37406
37407 @kindex set displaced-stepping
37408 @kindex show displaced-stepping
37409 @cindex displaced stepping support
37410 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
37411 @item set displaced-stepping
37412 @itemx show displaced-stepping
37413 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
37414 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
37415 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
37416 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
37417 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
37418
37419 @table @code
37420 @item set displaced-stepping on
37421 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
37422 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
37423
37424 @item set displaced-stepping off
37425 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
37426 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
37427
37428 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
37429 @item set displaced-stepping auto
37430 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
37431 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
37432 architecture supports displaced stepping.
37433 @end table
37434
37435 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
37436 @item maint check-psymtabs
37437 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
37438 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
37439
37440 @kindex maint check-symtabs
37441 @item maint check-symtabs
37442 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
37443
37444 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
37445 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
37446 Expand symbol tables.
37447 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
37448 names matching @var{regexp}.
37449
37450 @kindex maint cplus first_component
37451 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
37452 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
37453
37454 @kindex maint cplus namespace
37455 @item maint cplus namespace
37456 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
37457
37458 @kindex maint demangle
37459 @item maint demangle @var{name}
37460 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
37461
37462 @kindex maint deprecate
37463 @kindex maint undeprecate
37464 @cindex deprecated commands
37465 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
37466 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
37467 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
37468 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
37469 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
37470 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
37471 the replacement as part of the warning.
37472
37473 @kindex maint dump-me
37474 @item maint dump-me
37475 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
37476 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
37477 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
37478 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
37479
37480 @kindex maint internal-error
37481 @kindex maint internal-warning
37482 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
37483 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
37484 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
37485 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
37486 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
37487 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
37488 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
37489 @value{GDBN} session.
37490
37491 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
37492 used as the text of the error or warning message.
37493
37494 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
37495
37496 @smallexample
37497 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
37498 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
37499 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
37500 debugging may prove unreliable.
37501 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
37502 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
37503 (@value{GDBP})
37504 @end smallexample
37505
37506 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
37507 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
37508
37509 @kindex maint set internal-error
37510 @kindex maint show internal-error
37511 @kindex maint set internal-warning
37512 @kindex maint show internal-warning
37513 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
37514 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
37515 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
37516 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
37517 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
37518 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
37519 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
37520 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
37521 described in the table below.
37522
37523 @table @samp
37524 @item quit
37525 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
37526 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
37527
37528 @item corefile
37529 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
37530 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
37531 @end table
37532
37533 @kindex maint packet
37534 @item maint packet @var{text}
37535 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
37536 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
37537 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
37538 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
37539 checksum.
37540
37541 @kindex maint print architecture
37542 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37543 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
37544 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
37545
37546 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
37547 @item maint print c-tdesc
37548 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
37549 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
37550 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
37551
37552 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
37553 @item maint print dummy-frames
37554 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
37555
37556 @smallexample
37557 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
37558 @dots{}
37559 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
37560 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
37561 58 return (a + b);
37562 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
37563 @dots{}
37564 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
37565 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
37566 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
37567 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
37568 (@value{GDBP})
37569 @end smallexample
37570
37571 Takes an optional file parameter.
37572
37573 @kindex maint print registers
37574 @kindex maint print raw-registers
37575 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
37576 @kindex maint print register-groups
37577 @kindex maint print remote-registers
37578 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37579 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37580 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37581 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37582 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37583 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
37584
37585 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
37586 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
37587 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
37588 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
37589 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
37590 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
37591 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
37592 and offsets in the `G' packets.
37593
37594 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
37595 write the information.
37596
37597 @kindex maint print reggroups
37598 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37599 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
37600 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
37601 information.
37602
37603 The register groups info looks like this:
37604
37605 @smallexample
37606 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
37607 Group Type
37608 general user
37609 float user
37610 all user
37611 vector user
37612 system user
37613 save internal
37614 restore internal
37615 @end smallexample
37616
37617 @kindex flushregs
37618 @item flushregs
37619 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
37620
37621 @kindex maint print objfiles
37622 @cindex info for known object files
37623 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
37624 Print a dump of all known object files.
37625 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
37626 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
37627 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
37628
37629 @kindex maint print section-scripts
37630 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
37631 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
37632 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
37633 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
37634 matching @var{regexp}.
37635 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
37636 and the full path if known.
37637 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
37638
37639 @kindex maint print statistics
37640 @cindex bcache statistics
37641 @item maint print statistics
37642 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
37643 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
37644 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
37645 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
37646 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
37647 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
37648 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
37649 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
37650 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
37651 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
37652 lengths.
37653
37654 @kindex maint print target-stack
37655 @cindex target stack description
37656 @item maint print target-stack
37657 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
37658 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
37659 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
37660 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
37661 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
37662 address.
37663
37664 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
37665 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
37666
37667 @kindex maint print type
37668 @cindex type chain of a data type
37669 @item maint print type @var{expr}
37670 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
37671 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
37672 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
37673 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
37674 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
37675
37676 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
37677 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
37678 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
37679 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
37680 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
37681 information.
37682
37683 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
37684 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
37685 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
37686 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
37687 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
37688 always see the disassembly form.
37689
37690 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
37691
37692 @smallexample
37693 (gdb) info addr argc
37694 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
37695 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
37696 @end smallexample
37697
37698 For more information on these expressions, see
37699 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
37700
37701 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
37702 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
37703 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
37704 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
37705 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
37706
37707 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
37708 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
37709 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
37710 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
37711 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
37712 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
37713 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
37714 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
37715 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
37716
37717 @kindex maint set profile
37718 @kindex maint show profile
37719 @cindex profiling GDB
37720 @item maint set profile
37721 @itemx maint show profile
37722 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
37723
37724 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
37725 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
37726 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
37727 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
37728 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
37729 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
37730 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
37731
37732 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
37733 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
37734
37735 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
37736 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
37737 @cindex hardware debug registers
37738 @item maint set show-debug-regs
37739 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
37740 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
37741 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
37742 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
37743 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
37744 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
37745
37746 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
37747 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
37748 @item maint set show-all-tib
37749 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
37750 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
37751 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
37752 command.
37753
37754 @kindex maint set per-command
37755 @kindex maint show per-command
37756 @item maint set per-command
37757 @itemx maint show per-command
37758 @cindex resources used by commands
37759
37760 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
37761 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
37762
37763 @table @code
37764 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
37765 @itemx maint show per-command space
37766 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
37767 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
37768 took, following the command's own output.
37769 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
37770 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
37771
37772 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
37773 @itemx maint show per-command time
37774 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
37775 for each command.
37776 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
37777 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
37778 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
37779 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
37780 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
37781 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
37782 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
37783 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
37784 spent by the program been debugged.
37785 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
37786 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
37787
37788 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
37789 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
37790 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
37791 for each command.
37792 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
37793
37794 @enumerate a
37795 @item
37796 number of symbol tables
37797 @item
37798 number of primary symbol tables
37799 @item
37800 number of blocks in the blockvector
37801 @end enumerate
37802 @end table
37803
37804 @kindex maint space
37805 @cindex memory used by commands
37806 @item maint space @var{value}
37807 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
37808 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
37809
37810 @kindex maint time
37811 @cindex time of command execution
37812 @item maint time @var{value}
37813 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
37814 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
37815
37816 @kindex maint translate-address
37817 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
37818 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
37819 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
37820 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
37821 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
37822 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
37823 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
37824
37825 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
37826 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
37827 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
37828
37829 @end table
37830
37831 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
37832 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
37833
37834 @table @code
37835 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
37836 @kindex set watchdog
37837 @cindex watchdog timer
37838 @cindex timeout for commands
37839 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
37840 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
37841 reports and error and the command is aborted.
37842
37843 @item show watchdog
37844 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
37845 @end table
37846
37847 @node Remote Protocol
37848 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
37849
37850 @menu
37851 * Overview::
37852 * Packets::
37853 * Stop Reply Packets::
37854 * General Query Packets::
37855 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
37856 * Tracepoint Packets::
37857 * Host I/O Packets::
37858 * Interrupts::
37859 * Notification Packets::
37860 * Remote Non-Stop::
37861 * Packet Acknowledgment::
37862 * Examples::
37863 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
37864 * Library List Format::
37865 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
37866 * Memory Map Format::
37867 * Thread List Format::
37868 * Traceframe Info Format::
37869 * Branch Trace Format::
37870 @end menu
37871
37872 @node Overview
37873 @section Overview
37874
37875 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
37876 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
37877 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
37878 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
37879
37880 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
37881 transmitted and received data, respectively.
37882
37883 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
37884 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
37885 @cindex remote serial protocol
37886 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
37887 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
37888 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
37889 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
37890 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
37891
37892 @smallexample
37893 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37894 @end smallexample
37895 @noindent
37896
37897 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
37898 @noindent
37899 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
37900 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
37901 eight bit unsigned checksum).
37902
37903 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
37904 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
37905
37906 @smallexample
37907 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37908 @end smallexample
37909
37910 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
37911 @noindent
37912 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
37913 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
37914 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
37915
37916 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
37917 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37918 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
37919 retransmission):
37920
37921 @smallexample
37922 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37923 <- @code{+}
37924 @end smallexample
37925 @noindent
37926
37927 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
37928 once a connection is established.
37929 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
37930
37931 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
37932 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
37933 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
37934 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
37935 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
37936 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
37937 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
37938
37939 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
37940 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
37941 exceptions).
37942
37943 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
37944 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
37945 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
37946 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
37947
37948 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
37949 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
37950 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
37951
37952 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
37953 @anchor{Binary Data}
37954 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
37955 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
37956 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
37957 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
37958 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
37959 binary data.
37960
37961 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
37962 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
37963 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
37964 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
37965 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
37966 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
37967 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
37968 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
37969 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
37970 (described next).
37971
37972 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
37973 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
37974 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
37975 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
37976 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
37977 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
37978 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
37979 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
37980 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
37981 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
37982 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
37983 3}} more times.
37984
37985 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
37986 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
37987 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
37988 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
37989 @samp{0*"00}.
37990
37991 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
37992 error number. That number is not well defined.
37993
37994 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
37995 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
37996 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
37997 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
37998 on that response.
37999
38000 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
38001 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
38002 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
38003 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
38004 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
38005 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
38006
38007 @node Packets
38008 @section Packets
38009
38010 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
38011 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
38012 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
38013 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
38014
38015 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
38016 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
38017 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
38018 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
38019 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
38020 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
38021 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
38022 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
38023 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
38024 @var{baz}.
38025
38026 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
38027 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
38028 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
38029 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
38030 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
38031 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
38032 pick any thread.
38033
38034 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
38035 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
38036 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
38037 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
38038 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
38039 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
38040 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
38041 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
38042 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
38043 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
38044 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
38045 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
38046 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
38047
38048 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
38049 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
38050 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
38051 more information.
38052
38053 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
38054 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
38055
38056 Here are the packet descriptions.
38057
38058 @table @samp
38059
38060 @item !
38061 @cindex @samp{!} packet
38062 @anchor{extended mode}
38063 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
38064 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
38065 debugged.
38066
38067 Reply:
38068 @table @samp
38069 @item OK
38070 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
38071 @end table
38072
38073 @item ?
38074 @cindex @samp{?} packet
38075 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
38076 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
38077 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
38078
38079 Reply:
38080 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38081
38082 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
38083 @cindex @samp{A} packet
38084 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
38085 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
38086 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
38087
38088 Reply:
38089 @table @samp
38090 @item OK
38091 The arguments were set.
38092 @item E @var{NN}
38093 An error occurred.
38094 @end table
38095
38096 @item b @var{baud}
38097 @cindex @samp{b} packet
38098 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
38099 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
38100
38101 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
38102 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
38103 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
38104
38105 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
38106 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
38107 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
38108 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
38109 of view, nothing actually happened.}
38110
38111 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
38112 @cindex @samp{B} packet
38113 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
38114 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
38115
38116 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
38117 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
38118
38119 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
38120 @anchor{bc}
38121 @item bc
38122 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
38123 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
38124
38125 Reply:
38126 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38127
38128 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
38129 @anchor{bs}
38130 @item bs
38131 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
38132 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
38133
38134 Reply:
38135 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38136
38137 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
38138 @cindex @samp{c} packet
38139 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
38140 resume at current address.
38141
38142 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38143 packet}.
38144
38145 Reply:
38146 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38147
38148 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
38149 @cindex @samp{C} packet
38150 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
38151 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
38152
38153 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38154 packet}.
38155
38156 Reply:
38157 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38158
38159 @item d
38160 @cindex @samp{d} packet
38161 Toggle debug flag.
38162
38163 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
38164 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
38165
38166 @item D
38167 @itemx D;@var{pid}
38168 @cindex @samp{D} packet
38169 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
38170 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
38171 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
38172
38173 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
38174 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
38175 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
38176 big-endian hex string.
38177
38178 Reply:
38179 @table @samp
38180 @item OK
38181 for success
38182 @item E @var{NN}
38183 for an error
38184 @end table
38185
38186 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
38187 @cindex @samp{F} packet
38188 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
38189 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
38190 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
38191
38192 @item g
38193 @anchor{read registers packet}
38194 @cindex @samp{g} packet
38195 Read general registers.
38196
38197 Reply:
38198 @table @samp
38199 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38200 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
38201 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
38202 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
38203 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
38204 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
38205 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
38206
38207 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
38208 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
38209 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
38210 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
38211 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
38212 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
38213 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
38214 have been collected, and both have zero value:
38215
38216 @smallexample
38217 -> @code{g}
38218 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
38219 @end smallexample
38220
38221 @item E @var{NN}
38222 for an error.
38223 @end table
38224
38225 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
38226 @cindex @samp{G} packet
38227 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
38228 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
38229
38230 Reply:
38231 @table @samp
38232 @item OK
38233 for success
38234 @item E @var{NN}
38235 for an error
38236 @end table
38237
38238 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
38239 @cindex @samp{H} packet
38240 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
38241 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{op} depends on the operation to be performed:
38242 it should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
38243 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
38244 option), @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
38245 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
38246 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38247
38248 Reply:
38249 @table @samp
38250 @item OK
38251 for success
38252 @item E @var{NN}
38253 for an error
38254 @end table
38255
38256 @c FIXME: JTC:
38257 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
38258 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
38259 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
38260 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
38261 @c described. For example:
38262 @c
38263 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
38264 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
38265 @c otherwise returns current registers.
38266 @c
38267 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
38268 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
38269 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
38270
38271 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
38272 @anchor{cycle step packet}
38273 @cindex @samp{i} packet
38274 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
38275 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
38276 step starting at that address.
38277
38278 @item I
38279 @cindex @samp{I} packet
38280 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
38281 step packet}.
38282
38283 @item k
38284 @cindex @samp{k} packet
38285 Kill request.
38286
38287 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
38288 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
38289 thread?)}.
38290
38291 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
38292 @cindex @samp{m} packet
38293 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
38294 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
38295
38296 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
38297 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
38298 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
38299 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
38300 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
38301 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
38302 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
38303 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
38304
38305 Reply:
38306 @table @samp
38307 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38308 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
38309 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
38310 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
38311 @item E @var{NN}
38312 @var{NN} is errno
38313 @end table
38314
38315 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38316 @cindex @samp{M} packet
38317 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
38318 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
38319 hexadecimal number.
38320
38321 Reply:
38322 @table @samp
38323 @item OK
38324 for success
38325 @item E @var{NN}
38326 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
38327 written).
38328 @end table
38329
38330 @item p @var{n}
38331 @cindex @samp{p} packet
38332 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
38333 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
38334 register value is encoded.
38335
38336 Reply:
38337 @table @samp
38338 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38339 the register's value
38340 @item E @var{NN}
38341 for an error
38342 @item @w{}
38343 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
38344 @end table
38345
38346 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
38347 @anchor{write register packet}
38348 @cindex @samp{P} packet
38349 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
38350 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
38351 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
38352
38353 Reply:
38354 @table @samp
38355 @item OK
38356 for success
38357 @item E @var{NN}
38358 for an error
38359 @end table
38360
38361 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
38362 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
38363 @cindex @samp{q} packet
38364 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
38365 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
38366 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
38367
38368 @item r
38369 @cindex @samp{r} packet
38370 Reset the entire system.
38371
38372 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
38373
38374 @item R @var{XX}
38375 @cindex @samp{R} packet
38376 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
38377 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38378
38379 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
38380
38381 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
38382 @cindex @samp{s} packet
38383 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
38384 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
38385
38386 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38387 packet}.
38388
38389 Reply:
38390 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38391
38392 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
38393 @anchor{step with signal packet}
38394 @cindex @samp{S} packet
38395 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
38396 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
38397
38398 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38399 packet}.
38400
38401 Reply:
38402 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38403
38404 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
38405 @cindex @samp{t} packet
38406 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
38407 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
38408 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
38409
38410 @item T @var{thread-id}
38411 @cindex @samp{T} packet
38412 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38413
38414 Reply:
38415 @table @samp
38416 @item OK
38417 thread is still alive
38418 @item E @var{NN}
38419 thread is dead
38420 @end table
38421
38422 @item v
38423 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
38424 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
38425
38426 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
38427 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
38428 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
38429 The process ID is a
38430 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
38431 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
38432 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
38433
38434 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
38435 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
38436 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
38437 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
38438 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
38439 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
38440 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
38441 @c stopping or restarting threads.
38442
38443 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38444
38445 Reply:
38446 @table @samp
38447 @item E @var{nn}
38448 for an error
38449 @item @r{Any stop packet}
38450 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
38451 @item OK
38452 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
38453 @end table
38454
38455 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
38456 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
38457 @anchor{vCont packet}
38458 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
38459 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
38460 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
38461 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
38462 in their current state in non-stop mode.
38463 Specifying multiple
38464 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
38465 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38466
38467 Currently supported actions are:
38468
38469 @table @samp
38470 @item c
38471 Continue.
38472 @item C @var{sig}
38473 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
38474 @item s
38475 Step.
38476 @item S @var{sig}
38477 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
38478 @item t
38479 Stop.
38480 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
38481 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
38482 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
38483 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
38484 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
38485 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
38486
38487 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
38488 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
38489 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
38490 jumps to @var{start}).
38491
38492 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
38493 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
38494 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
38495
38496 @end table
38497
38498 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
38499 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
38500 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
38501
38502 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
38503 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
38504 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
38505 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
38506 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
38507 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
38508 as an implementation detail.
38509
38510 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
38511 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
38512 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
38513 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
38514 @var{thread-id}.
38515
38516 Reply:
38517 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38518
38519 @item vCont?
38520 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
38521 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
38522
38523 Reply:
38524 @table @samp
38525 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
38526 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
38527 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
38528 @item @w{}
38529 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
38530 @end table
38531
38532 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
38533 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
38534 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
38535 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
38536
38537 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
38538 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
38539 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
38540 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
38541 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
38542 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
38543 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
38544 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
38545 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
38546 packet is received.
38547
38548 Reply:
38549 @table @samp
38550 @item OK
38551 for success
38552 @item E @var{NN}
38553 for an error
38554 @end table
38555
38556 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38557 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
38558 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
38559 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
38560 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
38561 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
38562 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
38563 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
38564 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
38565 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
38566 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
38567 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
38568
38569
38570 Reply:
38571 @table @samp
38572 @item OK
38573 for success
38574 @item E.memtype
38575 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
38576 @item E @var{NN}
38577 for an error
38578 @end table
38579
38580 @item vFlashDone
38581 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
38582 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
38583 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
38584 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
38585 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
38586 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
38587 request is completed.
38588
38589 @item vKill;@var{pid}
38590 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
38591 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
38592 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
38593 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
38594 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
38595
38596 Reply:
38597 @table @samp
38598 @item E @var{nn}
38599 for an error
38600 @item OK
38601 for success
38602 @end table
38603
38604 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
38605 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
38606 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
38607 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
38608 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
38609 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
38610 state.
38611
38612 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
38613
38614 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38615
38616 Reply:
38617 @table @samp
38618 @item E @var{nn}
38619 for an error
38620 @item @r{Any stop packet}
38621 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
38622 @end table
38623
38624 @item vStopped
38625 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
38626 @xref{Notification Packets}.
38627
38628 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38629 @anchor{X packet}
38630 @cindex @samp{X} packet
38631 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
38632 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
38633 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38634
38635 Reply:
38636 @table @samp
38637 @item OK
38638 for success
38639 @item E @var{NN}
38640 for an error
38641 @end table
38642
38643 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
38644 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
38645 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
38646 @cindex @samp{z} packet
38647 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
38648 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
38649 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
38650
38651 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
38652 separately.
38653
38654 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
38655 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
38656 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
38657 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
38658 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
38659 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
38660
38661 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38662 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
38663 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
38664 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
38665 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
38666 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
38667
38668 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
38669 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
38670 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
38671 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
38672 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
38673 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
38674 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
38675 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
38676 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
38677 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
38678
38679 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
38680 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
38681
38682 @table @samp
38683
38684 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38685 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
38686 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
38687
38688 @end table
38689
38690 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
38691 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
38692 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
38693 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
38694 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
38695 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
38696 separators. Each expression has the following form:
38697
38698 @table @samp
38699
38700 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38701 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
38702 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
38703
38704 @end table
38705
38706 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
38707
38708 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
38709 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
38710 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
38711 target, is not defined.}
38712
38713 Reply:
38714 @table @samp
38715 @item OK
38716 success
38717 @item @w{}
38718 not supported
38719 @item E @var{NN}
38720 for an error
38721 @end table
38722
38723 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38724 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
38725 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
38726 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
38727 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
38728 address @var{addr}.
38729
38730 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
38731 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
38732 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
38733
38734 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
38735 movement.}
38736
38737 Reply:
38738 @table @samp
38739 @item OK
38740 success
38741 @item @w{}
38742 not supported
38743 @item E @var{NN}
38744 for an error
38745 @end table
38746
38747 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38748 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38749 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
38750 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
38751 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38752 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
38753
38754 Reply:
38755 @table @samp
38756 @item OK
38757 success
38758 @item @w{}
38759 not supported
38760 @item E @var{NN}
38761 for an error
38762 @end table
38763
38764 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38765 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38766 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
38767 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
38768 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38769 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
38770
38771 Reply:
38772 @table @samp
38773 @item OK
38774 success
38775 @item @w{}
38776 not supported
38777 @item E @var{NN}
38778 for an error
38779 @end table
38780
38781 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38782 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38783 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
38784 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
38785 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38786 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
38787
38788 Reply:
38789 @table @samp
38790 @item OK
38791 success
38792 @item @w{}
38793 not supported
38794 @item E @var{NN}
38795 for an error
38796 @end table
38797
38798 @end table
38799
38800 @node Stop Reply Packets
38801 @section Stop Reply Packets
38802 @cindex stop reply packets
38803
38804 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
38805 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
38806 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
38807 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
38808 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
38809 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
38810 @value{GDBN} source code.
38811
38812 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
38813 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
38814 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
38815 components.
38816
38817 @table @samp
38818
38819 @item S @var{AA}
38820 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
38821 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
38822 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
38823
38824 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
38825 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
38826 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
38827 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
38828 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
38829 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
38830 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
38831 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
38832
38833 @itemize @bullet
38834 @item
38835 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
38836 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
38837 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
38838 two-digit hex number.
38839
38840 @item
38841 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
38842 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38843
38844 @item
38845 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
38846 the core on which the stop event was detected.
38847
38848 @item
38849 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
38850 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
38851 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
38852 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
38853
38854 @item
38855 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
38856 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
38857 future.
38858 @end itemize
38859
38860 The currently defined stop reasons are:
38861
38862 @table @samp
38863 @item watch
38864 @itemx rwatch
38865 @itemx awatch
38866 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
38867 hex.
38868
38869 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
38870 @item library
38871 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
38872 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
38873 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
38874
38875 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
38876 @item replaylog
38877 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
38878 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
38879 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
38880 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
38881 for more information.
38882 @end table
38883
38884 @item W @var{AA}
38885 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38886 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
38887 applicable to certain targets.
38888
38889 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
38890 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
38891 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
38892 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
38893
38894 @item X @var{AA}
38895 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38896 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
38897
38898 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
38899 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
38900 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
38901 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
38902
38903 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
38904 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
38905 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
38906 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
38907 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
38908
38909 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
38910 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
38911 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
38912 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
38913 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
38914 system calls.
38915
38916 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
38917 this very system call.
38918
38919 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
38920 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
38921 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
38922 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38923 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
38924 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
38925
38926 @end table
38927
38928 @node General Query Packets
38929 @section General Query Packets
38930 @cindex remote query requests
38931
38932 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
38933 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
38934 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
38935 sending information to and from the stub.
38936
38937 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
38938 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
38939 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
38940 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
38941 conventions:
38942
38943 @itemize @bullet
38944 @item
38945 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
38946 @item
38947 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
38948 letter.
38949 @item
38950 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
38951 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
38952 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
38953 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
38954 @end itemize
38955
38956 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
38957 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
38958 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
38959 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
38960 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
38961 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
38962 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
38963 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
38964 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
38965 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
38966 packet.}.
38967
38968 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
38969 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
38970 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
38971 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
38972 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
38973
38974 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
38975
38976 @table @samp
38977
38978 @item QAgent:1
38979 @itemx QAgent:0
38980 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
38981 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
38982
38983 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
38984 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
38985 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
38986 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
38987 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
38988 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
38989 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
38990 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
38991 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
38992 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
38993 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
38994
38995 @item qC
38996 @cindex current thread, remote request
38997 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
38998 Return the current thread ID.
38999
39000 Reply:
39001 @table @samp
39002 @item QC @var{thread-id}
39003 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
39004 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
39005 @item @r{(anything else)}
39006 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
39007 @end table
39008
39009 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
39010 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
39011 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
39012 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
39013 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
39014 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
39015 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
39016
39017 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
39018 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
39019 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
39020 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
39021 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
39022 detect trailing zeros.
39023
39024 Reply:
39025 @table @samp
39026 @item E @var{NN}
39027 An error (such as memory fault)
39028 @item C @var{crc32}
39029 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
39030 @end table
39031
39032 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
39033 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
39034 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
39035 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
39036 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
39037 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
39038 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
39039 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
39040 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
39041 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
39042 randomization.
39043
39044 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
39045
39046 Reply:
39047 @table @samp
39048 @item OK
39049 The request succeeded.
39050
39051 @item E @var{nn}
39052 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
39053
39054 @item @w{}
39055 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
39056 by the stub.
39057 @end table
39058
39059 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39060 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39061 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
39062 address space randomization.
39063
39064 @item qfThreadInfo
39065 @itemx qsThreadInfo
39066 @cindex list active threads, remote request
39067 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
39068 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
39069 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
39070 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
39071 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
39072 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
39073 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
39074 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
39075
39076 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
39077
39078 Reply:
39079 @table @samp
39080 @item m @var{thread-id}
39081 A single thread ID
39082 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
39083 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
39084 @item l
39085 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39086 @end table
39087
39088 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39089 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
39090 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
39091 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
39092 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
39093 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
39094 fields.
39095
39096 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
39097 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
39098 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
39099 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
39100 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
39101
39102 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
39103 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
39104
39105 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
39106 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
39107 information associated with the variable.)
39108
39109 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
39110 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
39111 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
39112 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
39113 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
39114 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
39115
39116 Reply:
39117 @table @samp
39118 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39119 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
39120 local storage requested.
39121
39122 @item E @var{nn}
39123 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
39124
39125 @item @w{}
39126 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
39127 @end table
39128
39129 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
39130 @cindex get thread information block address
39131 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
39132 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
39133
39134 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
39135
39136 Reply:
39137 @table @samp
39138 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39139 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
39140 thread information block.
39141
39142 @item E @var{nn}
39143 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
39144 address could not be retrieved.
39145
39146 @item @w{}
39147 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
39148 @end table
39149
39150 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
39151 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
39152 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
39153 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
39154 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
39155 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
39156 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
39157
39158 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
39159
39160 Reply:
39161 @table @samp
39162 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
39163 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
39164 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
39165 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
39166 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
39167 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
39168 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
39169 @end table
39170
39171 @item qOffsets
39172 @cindex section offsets, remote request
39173 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
39174 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
39175 image.
39176
39177 Reply:
39178 @table @samp
39179 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
39180 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
39181 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
39182 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
39183 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
39184 segments by the supplied offsets.
39185
39186 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
39187 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
39188 to the @code{Bss} section.}
39189
39190 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
39191 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
39192 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
39193 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
39194 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
39195 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
39196 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
39197 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
39198 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
39199 @end table
39200
39201 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
39202 @cindex thread information, remote request
39203 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
39204 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
39205 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
39206 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
39207
39208 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
39209 (see below).
39210
39211 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
39212
39213 @item QNonStop:1
39214 @itemx QNonStop:0
39215 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
39216 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
39217 @anchor{QNonStop}
39218 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
39219 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
39220
39221 Reply:
39222 @table @samp
39223 @item OK
39224 The request succeeded.
39225
39226 @item E @var{nn}
39227 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
39228
39229 @item @w{}
39230 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
39231 the stub.
39232 @end table
39233
39234 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39235 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39236 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
39237 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
39238
39239 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
39240 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
39241 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39242 @anchor{QPassSignals}
39243 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
39244 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
39245 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
39246 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
39247 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
39248 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
39249 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
39250 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
39251 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
39252
39253 Reply:
39254 @table @samp
39255 @item OK
39256 The request succeeded.
39257
39258 @item E @var{nn}
39259 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
39260
39261 @item @w{}
39262 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
39263 the stub.
39264 @end table
39265
39266 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
39267 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
39268 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39269 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39270
39271 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
39272 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
39273 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
39274 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
39275 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
39276 Others should be silently discarded.
39277
39278 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
39279 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
39280 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
39281 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
39282 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
39283 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
39284 signals.
39285
39286 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
39287 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
39288
39289 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
39290 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
39291 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
39292 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
39293 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
39294
39295 Reply:
39296 @table @samp
39297 @item OK
39298 The request succeeded.
39299
39300 @item E @var{nn}
39301 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
39302
39303 @item @w{}
39304 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
39305 by the stub.
39306 @end table
39307
39308 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
39309 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
39310 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39311 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39312
39313 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
39314 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
39315 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
39316 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
39317 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
39318 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
39319 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
39320 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
39321 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
39322
39323 Reply:
39324 @table @samp
39325 @item OK
39326 A command response with no output.
39327 @item @var{OUTPUT}
39328 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
39329 @item E @var{NN}
39330 Indicate a badly formed request.
39331 @item @w{}
39332 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
39333 @end table
39334
39335 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
39336 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39337 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39338 packets.)
39339
39340 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
39341 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
39342 @ifnotinfo
39343 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
39344 @end ifnotinfo
39345 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
39346 @anchor{qSearch memory}
39347 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
39348 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
39349 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
39350
39351 Reply:
39352 @table @samp
39353 @item 0
39354 The pattern was not found.
39355 @item 1,address
39356 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
39357 @item E @var{NN}
39358 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
39359 @item @w{}
39360 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
39361 @end table
39362
39363 @item QStartNoAckMode
39364 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
39365 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
39366 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
39367 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
39368
39369 Reply:
39370 @table @samp
39371 @item OK
39372 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
39373 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
39374 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
39375 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
39376 @item @w{}
39377 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
39378 @end table
39379
39380 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
39381 @cindex supported packets, remote query
39382 @cindex features of the remote protocol
39383 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
39384 @anchor{qSupported}
39385 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
39386 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
39387 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
39388 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
39389 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
39390 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
39391 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
39392 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
39393 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
39394 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
39395 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
39396 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
39397 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
39398 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
39399
39400 Reply:
39401 @table @samp
39402 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
39403 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
39404 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
39405 possible forms).
39406 @item @w{}
39407 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
39408 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
39409 @end table
39410
39411 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
39412 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
39413 are:
39414
39415 @table @samp
39416 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
39417 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
39418 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
39419 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
39420 @item @var{name}+
39421 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
39422 need an associated value.
39423 @item @var{name}-
39424 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
39425 @item @var{name}?
39426 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
39427 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
39428 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
39429 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
39430 @end table
39431
39432 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
39433 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
39434 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
39435 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
39436 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
39437
39438 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
39439 are defined:
39440
39441 @table @samp
39442 @item multiprocess
39443 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
39444 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39445 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39446 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39447 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
39448
39449 @item xmlRegisters
39450 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
39451 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
39452 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
39453 description.
39454
39455 @item qRelocInsn
39456 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
39457 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39458 instruction reply packet}).
39459 @end table
39460
39461 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
39462 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
39463 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
39464 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
39465 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
39466 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
39467 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
39468 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
39469 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
39470 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
39471 all the features it supports.
39472
39473 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
39474 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
39475
39476 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
39477 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
39478 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
39479 form response.
39480
39481 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
39482 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
39483 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
39484 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
39485
39486 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
39487 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
39488 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
39489 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
39490 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
39491
39492 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
39493
39494 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
39495 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
39496 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
39497 @item Feature Name
39498 @tab Value Required
39499 @tab Default
39500 @tab Probe Allowed
39501
39502 @item @samp{PacketSize}
39503 @tab Yes
39504 @tab @samp{-}
39505 @tab No
39506
39507 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
39508 @tab No
39509 @tab @samp{-}
39510 @tab Yes
39511
39512 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39513 @tab No
39514 @tab @samp{-}
39515 @tab Yes
39516
39517 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
39518 @tab No
39519 @tab @samp{-}
39520 @tab Yes
39521
39522 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39523 @tab No
39524 @tab @samp{-}
39525 @tab Yes
39526
39527 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
39528 @tab No
39529 @tab @samp{-}
39530 @tab Yes
39531
39532 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
39533 @tab No
39534 @tab @samp{-}
39535 @tab No
39536
39537 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39538 @tab No
39539 @tab @samp{-}
39540 @tab Yes
39541
39542 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
39543 @tab No
39544 @tab @samp{-}
39545 @tab Yes
39546
39547 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
39548 @tab No
39549 @tab @samp{-}
39550 @tab Yes
39551
39552 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
39553 @tab No
39554 @tab @samp{-}
39555 @tab Yes
39556
39557 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
39558 @tab No
39559 @tab @samp{-}
39560 @tab Yes
39561
39562 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
39563 @tab No
39564 @tab @samp{-}
39565 @tab Yes
39566
39567 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
39568 @tab No
39569 @tab @samp{-}
39570 @tab Yes
39571
39572 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39573 @tab No
39574 @tab @samp{-}
39575 @tab Yes
39576
39577 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39578 @tab No
39579 @tab @samp{-}
39580 @tab Yes
39581
39582 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39583 @tab No
39584 @tab @samp{-}
39585 @tab Yes
39586
39587 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
39588 @tab Yes
39589 @tab @samp{-}
39590 @tab Yes
39591
39592 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
39593 @tab Yes
39594 @tab @samp{-}
39595 @tab Yes
39596
39597 @item @samp{QNonStop}
39598 @tab No
39599 @tab @samp{-}
39600 @tab Yes
39601
39602 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
39603 @tab No
39604 @tab @samp{-}
39605 @tab Yes
39606
39607 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
39608 @tab No
39609 @tab @samp{-}
39610 @tab Yes
39611
39612 @item @samp{multiprocess}
39613 @tab No
39614 @tab @samp{-}
39615 @tab No
39616
39617 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
39618 @tab No
39619 @tab @samp{-}
39620 @tab No
39621
39622 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
39623 @tab No
39624 @tab @samp{-}
39625 @tab No
39626
39627 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
39628 @tab No
39629 @tab @samp{-}
39630 @tab No
39631
39632 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
39633 @tab No
39634 @tab @samp{-}
39635 @tab No
39636
39637 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
39638 @tab No
39639 @tab @samp{-}
39640 @tab No
39641
39642 @item @samp{QAgent}
39643 @tab No
39644 @tab @samp{-}
39645 @tab No
39646
39647 @item @samp{QAllow}
39648 @tab No
39649 @tab @samp{-}
39650 @tab No
39651
39652 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
39653 @tab No
39654 @tab @samp{-}
39655 @tab No
39656
39657 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
39658 @tab No
39659 @tab @samp{-}
39660 @tab No
39661
39662 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
39663 @tab No
39664 @tab @samp{-}
39665 @tab No
39666
39667 @item @samp{tracenz}
39668 @tab No
39669 @tab @samp{-}
39670 @tab No
39671
39672 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
39673 @tab No
39674 @tab @samp{-}
39675 @tab No
39676
39677 @end multitable
39678
39679 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
39680
39681 @table @samp
39682 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
39683 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
39684 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
39685 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
39686 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
39687 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
39688 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
39689 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
39690 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
39691 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
39692
39693 @item qXfer:auxv:read
39694 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
39695 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
39696
39697 @item qXfer:btrace:read
39698 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39699 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
39700
39701 @item qXfer:features:read
39702 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
39703 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
39704
39705 @item qXfer:libraries:read
39706 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
39707 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
39708
39709 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
39710 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39711 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39712
39713 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
39714 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
39715 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39716 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39717
39718 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
39719 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
39720 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
39721
39722 @item qXfer:sdata:read
39723 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
39724 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
39725
39726 @item qXfer:spu:read
39727 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
39728 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
39729
39730 @item qXfer:spu:write
39731 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
39732 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
39733
39734 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
39735 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
39736 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
39737
39738 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
39739 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
39740 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
39741
39742 @item qXfer:threads:read
39743 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39744 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
39745
39746 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
39747 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39748 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
39749
39750 @item qXfer:uib:read
39751 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39752 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
39753
39754 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
39755 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39756 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
39757
39758 @item QNonStop
39759 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
39760 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
39761
39762 @item QPassSignals
39763 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39764 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
39765
39766 @item QStartNoAckMode
39767 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
39768 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
39769
39770 @item multiprocess
39771 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
39772 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
39773 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
39774 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
39775 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
39776 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
39777 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
39778 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
39779 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
39780 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
39781 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
39782
39783 @item qXfer:osdata:read
39784 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
39785 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
39786
39787 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
39788 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
39789 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
39790 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
39791
39792 @item ConditionalTracepoints
39793 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
39794 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
39795
39796 @item ReverseContinue
39797 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
39798 (@pxref{bc}).
39799
39800 @item ReverseStep
39801 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
39802 (@pxref{bs}).
39803
39804 @item TracepointSource
39805 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
39806 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
39807
39808 @item QAgent
39809 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
39810
39811 @item QAllow
39812 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
39813
39814 @item QDisableRandomization
39815 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
39816
39817 @item StaticTracepoint
39818 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
39819 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
39820
39821 @item InstallInTrace
39822 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
39823 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
39824
39825 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
39826 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
39827 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
39828 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
39829
39830 @item QTBuffer:size
39831 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
39832 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
39833
39834 @item tracenz
39835 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
39836 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
39837 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
39838
39839 @item BreakpointCommands
39840 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
39841 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
39842 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
39843
39844 @item Qbtrace:off
39845 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
39846
39847 @item Qbtrace:bts
39848 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
39849
39850 @end table
39851
39852 @item qSymbol::
39853 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
39854 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
39855 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
39856 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
39857
39858 Reply:
39859 @table @samp
39860 @item OK
39861 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39862 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39863 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
39864 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
39865 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
39866 below.
39867 @end table
39868
39869 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
39870 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
39871
39872 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
39873 target has previously requested.
39874
39875 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
39876 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
39877 will be empty.
39878
39879 Reply:
39880 @table @samp
39881 @item OK
39882 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39883 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39884 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
39885 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
39886 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
39887 @end table
39888
39889 @item qTBuffer
39890 @itemx QTBuffer
39891 @itemx QTDisconnected
39892 @itemx QTDP
39893 @itemx QTDPsrc
39894 @itemx QTDV
39895 @itemx qTfP
39896 @itemx qTfV
39897 @itemx QTFrame
39898 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
39899
39900 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39901
39902 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
39903 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
39904 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
39905 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
39906 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
39907 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
39908 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
39909 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
39910 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
39911 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
39912 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
39913
39914 Reply:
39915 @table @samp
39916 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39917 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
39918 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
39919 the thread's attributes.
39920 @end table
39921
39922 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
39923 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39924 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39925 packets.)
39926
39927 @item QTNotes
39928 @itemx qTP
39929 @itemx QTSave
39930 @itemx qTsP
39931 @itemx qTsV
39932 @itemx QTStart
39933 @itemx QTStop
39934 @itemx QTEnable
39935 @itemx QTDisable
39936 @itemx QTinit
39937 @itemx QTro
39938 @itemx qTStatus
39939 @itemx qTV
39940 @itemx qTfSTM
39941 @itemx qTsSTM
39942 @itemx qTSTMat
39943 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39944
39945 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39946 @cindex read special object, remote request
39947 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
39948 @anchor{qXfer read}
39949 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39950 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39951 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39952 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39953 additional details about what data to access.
39954
39955 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
39956 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39957 formats, listed below.
39958
39959 @table @samp
39960 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39961 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39962 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39963 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39964
39965 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39966 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39967
39968 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39969 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39970
39971 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39972 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39973 packet may have one of the following values:
39974
39975 @table @code
39976 @item all
39977 Returns all available branch trace.
39978
39979 @item new
39980 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39981 the last read request.
39982 @end table
39983
39984 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39985 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39986
39987 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39988 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39989 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39990 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39991 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39992
39993 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39994 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39995
39996 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39997 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39998 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39999 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40000 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40001
40002 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
40003 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
40004 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
40005
40006 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40007 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40008
40009 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40010 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
40011 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
40012 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
40013 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
40014 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
40015 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40016 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
40017
40018 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
40019 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
40020
40021 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40022 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40023
40024 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
40025 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
40026 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
40027 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
40028
40029 @table @code
40030 @item start=@var{address}
40031 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
40032 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
40033 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
40034 chosen as the starting point.
40035
40036 @item prev=@var{address}
40037 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
40038 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
40039 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
40040 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
40041 exists prior to the starting point.
40042
40043 @end table
40044
40045 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
40046 ignored.
40047
40048 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40049 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
40050 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
40051 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40052 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40053
40054 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40055 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40056
40057 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40058 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
40059
40060 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
40061 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
40062 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
40063 Action Lists}.
40064
40065 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40066 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40067 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40068
40069 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40070 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
40071 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
40072 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
40073 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40074
40075 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40076 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40077 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40078
40079 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40080 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
40081 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
40082 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
40083 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
40084 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
40085 in that context to be accessed.
40086
40087 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40088 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40089 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40090
40091 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40092 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
40093 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
40094 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40095 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40096
40097 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40098 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40099
40100 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40101 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
40102
40103 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
40104 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
40105 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40106
40107 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40108 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40109
40110 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40111 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
40112
40113 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
40114 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
40115
40116 This packet is not probed by default.
40117
40118 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40119 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
40120 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
40121 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
40122 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
40123
40124 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40125 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40126
40127 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40128 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
40129 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
40130 @xref{Operating System Information}.
40131
40132 @end table
40133
40134 Reply:
40135 @table @samp
40136 @item m @var{data}
40137 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
40138 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
40139 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
40140 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
40141 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
40142 request.
40143
40144 @item l @var{data}
40145 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
40146 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
40147 than the @var{length} in the request.
40148
40149 @item l
40150 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
40151 There is no more data to be read.
40152
40153 @item E00
40154 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
40155
40156 @item E @var{nn}
40157 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
40158 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
40159
40160 @item @w{}
40161 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
40162 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
40163 @end table
40164
40165 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
40166 @cindex write data into object, remote request
40167 @anchor{qXfer write}
40168 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
40169 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
40170 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
40171 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
40172 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
40173 to access.
40174
40175 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
40176 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
40177 formats, listed below.
40178
40179 @table @samp
40180 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
40181 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
40182 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
40183 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
40184 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
40185
40186 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40187 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40188 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40189
40190 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
40191 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
40192 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
40193 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
40194 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
40195 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
40196 in that context to be accessed.
40197
40198 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40199 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40200 @end table
40201
40202 Reply:
40203 @table @samp
40204 @item @var{nn}
40205 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
40206 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
40207
40208 @item E00
40209 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
40210
40211 @item E @var{nn}
40212 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
40213 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
40214
40215 @item @w{}
40216 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
40217 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
40218 @end table
40219
40220 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
40221 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
40222 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
40223 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
40224 must respond with an empty packet.
40225
40226 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
40227 @cindex query attached, remote request
40228 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
40229 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
40230 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
40231 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
40232 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
40233 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
40234 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
40235
40236 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
40237 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
40238 the @code{quit} command.
40239
40240 Reply:
40241 @table @samp
40242 @item 1
40243 The remote server attached to an existing process.
40244 @item 0
40245 The remote server created a new process.
40246 @item E @var{NN}
40247 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40248 @end table
40249
40250 @item Qbtrace:bts
40251 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
40252
40253 Reply:
40254 @table @samp
40255 @item OK
40256 Branch tracing has been enabled.
40257 @item E.errtext
40258 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40259 @end table
40260
40261 @item Qbtrace:off
40262 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
40263
40264 Reply:
40265 @table @samp
40266 @item OK
40267 Branch tracing has been disabled.
40268 @item E.errtext
40269 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40270 @end table
40271
40272 @end table
40273
40274 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
40275 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
40276
40277 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
40278 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
40279 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
40280
40281 @menu
40282 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
40283 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
40284 @end menu
40285
40286 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
40287 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
40288
40289 @menu
40290 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
40291 @end menu
40292
40293 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
40294 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
40295 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
40296
40297 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40298
40299 @table @r
40300
40301 @item 2
40302 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
40303
40304 @item 3
40305 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
40306
40307 @item 4
40308 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
40309
40310 @end table
40311
40312 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
40313 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
40314
40315 @menu
40316 * MIPS Register packet Format::
40317 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
40318 @end menu
40319
40320 @node MIPS Register packet Format
40321 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
40322 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
40323
40324 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
40325 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
40326 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
40327 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
40328 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
40329 most-significant -- least-significant.
40330
40331 @table @r
40332
40333 @item MIPS32
40334 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
40335 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
40336 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
40337
40338 @item MIPS64
40339 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
40340 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
40341 as @code{MIPS32}.
40342
40343 @end table
40344
40345 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
40346 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
40347 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
40348
40349 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40350
40351 @table @r
40352
40353 @item 2
40354 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
40355
40356 @item 3
40357 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
40358
40359 @item 4
40360 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
40361
40362 @item 5
40363 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
40364
40365 @end table
40366
40367 @node Tracepoint Packets
40368 @section Tracepoint Packets
40369 @cindex tracepoint packets
40370 @cindex packets, tracepoint
40371
40372 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
40373 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
40374
40375 @table @samp
40376
40377 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
40378 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
40379 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
40380 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
40381 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
40382 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
40383 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
40384 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
40385 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
40386 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
40387 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
40388 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
40389 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
40390 actions.
40391
40392 Replies:
40393 @table @samp
40394 @item OK
40395 The packet was understood and carried out.
40396 @item qRelocInsn
40397 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
40398 @item @w{}
40399 The packet was not recognized.
40400 @end table
40401
40402 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
40403 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
40404 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
40405 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
40406 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
40407 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
40408 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
40409
40410 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
40411 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
40412 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
40413 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
40414 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
40415 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
40416 tracepoint actions.
40417
40418 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
40419 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
40420 following forms:
40421
40422 @table @samp
40423
40424 @item R @var{mask}
40425 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
40426 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
40427 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
40428 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
40429 not fit in a 32-bit word.
40430
40431 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
40432 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
40433 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
40434 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
40435 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
40436 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
40437 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
40438
40439 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
40440 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
40441 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
40442 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
40443 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
40444 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
40445 packet).
40446
40447 @end table
40448
40449 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
40450 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
40451 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
40452 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
40453 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
40454 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
40455 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
40456 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
40457
40458 Replies:
40459 @table @samp
40460 @item OK
40461 The packet was understood and carried out.
40462 @item qRelocInsn
40463 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
40464 @item @w{}
40465 The packet was not recognized.
40466 @end table
40467
40468 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
40469 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
40470 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
40471 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
40472 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
40473 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
40474 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
40475 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
40476
40477 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
40478 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
40479 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
40480 fit in a single packet.
40481 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
40482 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
40483
40484 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
40485 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
40486 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
40487 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
40488
40489 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
40490 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
40491 query packets.
40492
40493 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
40494 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
40495 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
40496 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
40497 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
40498 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
40499 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
40500 be found.
40501
40502 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
40503 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
40504 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
40505 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
40506 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
40507 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
40508 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
40509 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
40510 mentioned in expressions.
40511
40512 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
40513 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
40514 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
40515 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
40516 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
40517
40518 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
40519 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
40520 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
40521 one of the following forms:
40522
40523 @table @samp
40524 @item F @var{f}
40525 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
40526 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
40527 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
40528
40529 @item T @var{t}
40530 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
40531 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
40532
40533 @end table
40534
40535 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
40536 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40537 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
40538 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
40539
40540 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
40541 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40542 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
40543 is a hexadecimal number.
40544
40545 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
40546 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40547 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
40548 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
40549 numbers.
40550
40551 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
40552 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
40553 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
40554
40555 @item qTMinFTPILen
40556 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
40557 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
40558 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
40559 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
40560 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
40561 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
40562 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
40563 arrange for that.
40564
40565 Replies:
40566
40567 @table @samp
40568 @item 0
40569 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
40570 @item @var{length}
40571 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length} is greater
40572 or equal to 1. @var{length} is a hexadecimal number. A reply of 1 means
40573 that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction regardless of size.
40574 @item E
40575 An error has occurred.
40576 @item @w{}
40577 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
40578 @end table
40579
40580 @item QTStart
40581 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
40582 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
40583 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
40584 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
40585 instruction reply packet}).
40586
40587 @item QTStop
40588 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
40589 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
40590
40591 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40592 @anchor{QTEnable}
40593 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
40594 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40595 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
40596 of data from it will resume.
40597
40598 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40599 @anchor{QTDisable}
40600 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
40601 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40602 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
40603 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
40604
40605 @item QTinit
40606 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
40607 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
40608
40609 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
40610 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
40611 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
40612 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
40613 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
40614
40615 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
40616 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
40617 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
40618 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
40619
40620 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
40621 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
40622 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
40623 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
40624 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
40625 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
40626
40627 @item qTStatus
40628 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
40629 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
40630
40631 The reply has the form:
40632
40633 @table @samp
40634
40635 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
40636 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
40637 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
40638 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
40639
40640 @end table
40641
40642 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
40643 explanations as one of the optional fields:
40644
40645 @table @samp
40646
40647 @item tnotrun:0
40648 No trace has been run yet.
40649
40650 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
40651 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
40652 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
40653 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
40654 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
40655
40656 @item tfull:0
40657 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
40658
40659 @item tdisconnected:0
40660 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
40661
40662 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
40663 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
40664
40665 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
40666 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
40667 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
40668 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
40669 @var{text} is hex encoded.
40670
40671 @item tunknown:0
40672 The trace stopped for some other reason.
40673
40674 @end table
40675
40676 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
40677 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
40678 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
40679 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
40680 trace.
40681
40682 @table @samp
40683
40684 @item tframes:@var{n}
40685 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
40686
40687 @item tcreated:@var{n}
40688 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
40689 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
40690
40691 @item tsize:@var{n}
40692 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
40693
40694 @item tfree:@var{n}
40695 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
40696
40697 @item circular:@var{n}
40698 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
40699 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
40700 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
40701 and may fill up.
40702
40703 @item disconn:@var{n}
40704 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
40705 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
40706 that the trace run will stop.
40707
40708 @end table
40709
40710 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
40711 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
40712 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
40713 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
40714 address @var{addr}.
40715
40716 Replies:
40717 @table @samp
40718 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
40719 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
40720 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
40721 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
40722 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
40723
40724 @end table
40725
40726 @item qTV:@var{var}
40727 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
40728 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
40729 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
40730
40731 Replies:
40732 @table @samp
40733 @item V@var{value}
40734 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
40735 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
40736 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
40737 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
40738 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
40739 program is running.
40740
40741 @item U
40742 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
40743 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
40744 was not collected.
40745 @end table
40746
40747 @item qTfP
40748 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
40749 @itemx qTsP
40750 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
40751 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
40752 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
40753 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
40754 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
40755 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
40756
40757 @item qTfV
40758 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
40759 @itemx qTsV
40760 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
40761 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
40762 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
40763 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
40764 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
40765 trace state variables.
40766
40767 @item qTfSTM
40768 @itemx qTsSTM
40769 @anchor{qTfSTM}
40770 @anchor{qTsSTM}
40771 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
40772 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
40773 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
40774 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
40775 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
40776 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
40777
40778 Reply:
40779 @table @samp
40780 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
40781 A single marker
40782 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
40783 a comma-separated list of markers
40784 @item l
40785 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40786 @item E @var{nn}
40787 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
40788 @item @w{}
40789 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
40790 stub.
40791 @end table
40792
40793 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
40794 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
40795
40796 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40797 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
40798 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
40799 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
40800 @dfn{last}).
40801
40802 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
40803 @anchor{qTSTMat}
40804 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
40805 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
40806 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
40807 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
40808 tracepoint markers.
40809
40810 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
40811 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
40812 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
40813 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
40814 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
40815 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
40816
40817 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
40818 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
40819 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
40820 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
40821 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
40822 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
40823 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
40824 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
40825 available.
40826
40827 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
40828 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
40829 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
40830
40831 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
40832 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
40833 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
40834 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
40835 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
40836 use whatever size it prefers.
40837
40838 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
40839 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
40840 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
40841 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
40842 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
40843
40844 @end table
40845
40846 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
40847 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
40848 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
40849 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
40850 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
40851 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
40852 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
40853 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
40854 it had executed in the original location.
40855
40856 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
40857 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
40858 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
40859 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
40860 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
40861 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
40862 format of the request is:
40863
40864 @table @samp
40865 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
40866
40867 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
40868 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
40869 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
40870 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
40871 memory starting at @var{to}.
40872 @end table
40873
40874 Replies:
40875 @table @samp
40876 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
40877 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
40878 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
40879 @item E @var{NN}
40880 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
40881 relocating the instruction.
40882 @end table
40883
40884 @node Host I/O Packets
40885 @section Host I/O Packets
40886 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40887 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40888
40889 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40890 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40891 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40892 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40893 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40894 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40895 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40896 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40897 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40898 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40899
40900 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40901 its arguments. They have this format:
40902
40903 @table @samp
40904
40905 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40906 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40907 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40908 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40909 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40910 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40911 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40912 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40913 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40914
40915 @end table
40916
40917 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40918
40919 @table @samp
40920
40921 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40922 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40923 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40924 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
40925 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40926 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40927 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40928 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40929 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40930 @var{attachment}.
40931
40932 @item @w{}
40933 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40934
40935 @end table
40936
40937 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40938
40939 @table @samp
40940 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40941 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40942 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
40943 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40944 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40945 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40946 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40947
40948 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40949 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40950 -1 if an error occurs.
40951
40952 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40953 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40954 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40955 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40956 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40957 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40958 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40959 @var{count} was zero.
40960
40961 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40962 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40963 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40964 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40965 some characters were escaped.
40966
40967 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40968 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40969 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40970 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40971 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40972 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40973 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40974 error occurred.
40975
40976 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
40977 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
40978 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
40979
40980 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40981 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40982 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40983
40984 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40985 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40986 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40987 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40988 some characters were escaped.
40989
40990 @end table
40991
40992 @node Interrupts
40993 @section Interrupts
40994 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40995
40996 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
40997 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
40998 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
40999 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
41000
41001 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
41002 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
41003 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
41004 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
41005 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
41006
41007 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
41008 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
41009 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
41010 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
41011 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
41012 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
41013 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
41014 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
41015
41016 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
41017 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
41018 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
41019
41020 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
41021 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
41022 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
41023 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
41024 currently-executing threads and processes.
41025 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
41026 running program, it should send one of the stop
41027 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
41028 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
41029 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
41030 Interrupts received while the
41031 program is stopped are discarded.
41032
41033 @node Notification Packets
41034 @section Notification Packets
41035 @cindex notification packets
41036 @cindex packets, notification
41037
41038 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
41039 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
41040 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
41041 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
41042 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
41043 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
41044 is not a problem.
41045
41046 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
41047 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
41048 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
41049 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
41050 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
41051 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
41052 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
41053
41054 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
41055 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
41056
41057 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
41058 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
41059 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
41060 not they understand it.
41061
41062 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
41063 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
41064 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
41065 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
41066 recipients.
41067
41068 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
41069 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
41070 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
41071 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
41072 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
41073
41074 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
41075 @table @samp
41076 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
41077 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
41078 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
41079 carrying the specific information about the notification.
41080 @var{name} is the name of the notification.
41081 @item @var{ack}
41082 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
41083 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
41084 @end table
41085
41086 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
41087 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
41088
41089 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
41090 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
41091 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
41092 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
41093 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
41094 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
41095 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
41096 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
41097 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
41098 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
41099
41100 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
41101 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
41102 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
41103 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
41104 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
41105 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
41106
41107 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
41108 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
41109 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
41110 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
41111 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
41112
41113 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
41114 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
41115 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
41116 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
41117 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
41118 normally.
41119
41120 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
41121 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
41122 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
41123 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
41124 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
41125 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
41126 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
41127 the process shall be repeated.
41128
41129 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
41130 following example:
41131 @smallexample
41132 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
41133 @code{...}
41134 -> @code{vStopped}
41135 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
41136 -> @code{vStopped}
41137 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
41138 -> @code{vStopped}
41139 <- @code{OK}
41140 @end smallexample
41141
41142 The following notifications are defined:
41143 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
41144
41145 @item Notification
41146 @tab Ack
41147 @tab Event
41148 @tab Description
41149
41150 @item Stop
41151 @tab vStopped
41152 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
41153 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
41154 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
41155 @value{GDBN}.
41156 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
41157
41158 @end multitable
41159
41160 @node Remote Non-Stop
41161 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
41162
41163 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
41164 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
41165 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
41166 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
41167
41168 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
41169 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
41170 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
41171 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
41172 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
41173 probe the target state after a mode change.
41174
41175 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
41176 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
41177 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
41178 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
41179 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
41180 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
41181 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
41182 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
41183 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
41184 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
41185 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
41186
41187 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
41188 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
41189 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
41190 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
41191 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
41192 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
41193 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
41194 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
41195 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
41196 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
41197 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
41198 @samp{OK}.
41199
41200 @node Packet Acknowledgment
41201 @section Packet Acknowledgment
41202
41203 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
41204 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
41205 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
41206 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
41207 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
41208 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
41209 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
41210
41211 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
41212 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
41213 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
41214 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
41215 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
41216
41217 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
41218 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
41219 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
41220 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
41221
41222 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
41223 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
41224 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
41225 @pxref{qSupported}.
41226 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
41227 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
41228 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
41229 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
41230 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
41231 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
41232 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
41233
41234 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
41235 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
41236 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
41237 connection.
41238 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
41239 new connection is established,
41240 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
41241 for the current connection, once disabled.
41242
41243 @node Examples
41244 @section Examples
41245
41246 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
41247 does not get any direct output:
41248
41249 @smallexample
41250 -> @code{R00}
41251 <- @code{+}
41252 @emph{target restarts}
41253 -> @code{?}
41254 <- @code{+}
41255 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41256 -> @code{+}
41257 @end smallexample
41258
41259 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
41260
41261 @smallexample
41262 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
41263 <- @code{+}
41264 -> @code{s}
41265 <- @code{+}
41266 @emph{time passes}
41267 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41268 -> @code{+}
41269 -> @code{g}
41270 <- @code{+}
41271 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
41272 -> @code{+}
41273 @end smallexample
41274
41275 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41276 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41277 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
41278
41279 @menu
41280 * File-I/O Overview::
41281 * Protocol Basics::
41282 * The F Request Packet::
41283 * The F Reply Packet::
41284 * The Ctrl-C Message::
41285 * Console I/O::
41286 * List of Supported Calls::
41287 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
41288 * Constants::
41289 * File-I/O Examples::
41290 @end menu
41291
41292 @node File-I/O Overview
41293 @subsection File-I/O Overview
41294 @cindex file-i/o overview
41295
41296 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
41297 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
41298 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
41299 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
41300 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
41301 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
41302
41303 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
41304 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
41305 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
41306 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
41307 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
41308
41309 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
41310 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
41311 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
41312 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
41313 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
41314 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
41315 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
41316
41317 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
41318 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
41319 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
41320 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
41321 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
41322
41323 @smallexample
41324 (@value{GDBP}) continue
41325 <- target requests 'system call X'
41326 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
41327 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
41328 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
41329 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
41330 @end smallexample
41331
41332 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
41333 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
41334 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
41335 system are not supported by this protocol.
41336
41337 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
41338
41339 @node Protocol Basics
41340 @subsection Protocol Basics
41341 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
41342
41343 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
41344 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
41345 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
41346 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
41347 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
41348 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
41349 to call the appropriate host system call:
41350
41351 @itemize @bullet
41352 @item
41353 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
41354
41355 @item
41356 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
41357 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
41358 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
41359 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
41360
41361 @end itemize
41362
41363 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
41364
41365 @itemize @bullet
41366 @item
41367 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
41368 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
41369 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
41370 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
41371 packet.
41372
41373 @item
41374 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
41375 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
41376
41377 @item
41378 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
41379
41380 @item
41381 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
41382
41383 @item
41384 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
41385 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
41386 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
41387 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
41388 packet.
41389
41390 @end itemize
41391
41392 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
41393 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
41394
41395 @itemize @bullet
41396 @item
41397 Return value.
41398
41399 @item
41400 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
41401
41402 @item
41403 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
41404
41405 @end itemize
41406
41407 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
41408 the latest continue or step action.
41409
41410 @node The F Request Packet
41411 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
41412 @cindex file-i/o request packet
41413 @cindex @code{F} request packet
41414
41415 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
41416
41417 @table @samp
41418 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
41419
41420 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
41421 This is just the name of the function.
41422
41423 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
41424 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
41425 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
41426 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
41427 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
41428 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
41429 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
41430
41431 @end table
41432
41433
41434
41435 @node The F Reply Packet
41436 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
41437 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
41438 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
41439
41440 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
41441
41442 @table @samp
41443
41444 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
41445
41446 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
41447
41448 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
41449 representation.
41450 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
41451
41452 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
41453 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
41454 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
41455
41456 @smallexample
41457 F0,0,C
41458 @end smallexample
41459
41460 @noindent
41461 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
41462
41463 @smallexample
41464 F-1,4,C
41465 @end smallexample
41466
41467 @noindent
41468 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
41469
41470 @end table
41471
41472
41473 @node The Ctrl-C Message
41474 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
41475 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
41476
41477 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
41478 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
41479 the target should behave as if it had
41480 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
41481 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
41482 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
41483 packet.
41484
41485 It's important for the target to know in which
41486 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
41487
41488 @itemize @bullet
41489 @item
41490 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
41491
41492 @item
41493 The system call on the host has been finished.
41494
41495 @end itemize
41496
41497 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
41498 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
41499 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
41500 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
41501 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
41502 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
41503
41504 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
41505 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
41506 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
41507 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
41508 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
41509 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
41510 or the full action has been completed.
41511
41512 @node Console I/O
41513 @subsection Console I/O
41514 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
41515
41516 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
41517 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
41518 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
41519 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
41520 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
41521 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
41522 conditions is met:
41523
41524 @itemize @bullet
41525 @item
41526 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
41527 @code{read}
41528 system call is treated as finished.
41529
41530 @item
41531 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
41532 newline.
41533
41534 @item
41535 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
41536 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
41537
41538 @end itemize
41539
41540 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
41541 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
41542 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
41543 is stopped at the user's request.
41544
41545
41546 @node List of Supported Calls
41547 @subsection List of Supported Calls
41548 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
41549
41550 @menu
41551 * open::
41552 * close::
41553 * read::
41554 * write::
41555 * lseek::
41556 * rename::
41557 * unlink::
41558 * stat/fstat::
41559 * gettimeofday::
41560 * isatty::
41561 * system::
41562 @end menu
41563
41564 @node open
41565 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
41566 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
41567
41568 @table @asis
41569 @item Synopsis:
41570 @smallexample
41571 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
41572 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
41573 @end smallexample
41574
41575 @item Request:
41576 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
41577
41578 @noindent
41579 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41580
41581 @table @code
41582 @item O_CREAT
41583 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
41584 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
41585 are concerned.
41586
41587 @item O_EXCL
41588 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
41589 an error and open() fails.
41590
41591 @item O_TRUNC
41592 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
41593 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
41594 truncated to zero length.
41595
41596 @item O_APPEND
41597 The file is opened in append mode.
41598
41599 @item O_RDONLY
41600 The file is opened for reading only.
41601
41602 @item O_WRONLY
41603 The file is opened for writing only.
41604
41605 @item O_RDWR
41606 The file is opened for reading and writing.
41607 @end table
41608
41609 @noindent
41610 Other bits are silently ignored.
41611
41612
41613 @noindent
41614 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41615
41616 @table @code
41617 @item S_IRUSR
41618 User has read permission.
41619
41620 @item S_IWUSR
41621 User has write permission.
41622
41623 @item S_IRGRP
41624 Group has read permission.
41625
41626 @item S_IWGRP
41627 Group has write permission.
41628
41629 @item S_IROTH
41630 Others have read permission.
41631
41632 @item S_IWOTH
41633 Others have write permission.
41634 @end table
41635
41636 @noindent
41637 Other bits are silently ignored.
41638
41639
41640 @item Return value:
41641 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
41642 occurred.
41643
41644 @item Errors:
41645
41646 @table @code
41647 @item EEXIST
41648 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
41649
41650 @item EISDIR
41651 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
41652
41653 @item EACCES
41654 The requested access is not allowed.
41655
41656 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41657 @var{pathname} was too long.
41658
41659 @item ENOENT
41660 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41661
41662 @item ENODEV
41663 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
41664
41665 @item EROFS
41666 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
41667 write access was requested.
41668
41669 @item EFAULT
41670 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
41671
41672 @item ENOSPC
41673 No space on device to create the file.
41674
41675 @item EMFILE
41676 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
41677
41678 @item ENFILE
41679 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
41680 has been reached.
41681
41682 @item EINTR
41683 The call was interrupted by the user.
41684 @end table
41685
41686 @end table
41687
41688 @node close
41689 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
41690 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
41691
41692 @table @asis
41693 @item Synopsis:
41694 @smallexample
41695 int close(int fd);
41696 @end smallexample
41697
41698 @item Request:
41699 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
41700
41701 @item Return value:
41702 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
41703
41704 @item Errors:
41705
41706 @table @code
41707 @item EBADF
41708 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
41709
41710 @item EINTR
41711 The call was interrupted by the user.
41712 @end table
41713
41714 @end table
41715
41716 @node read
41717 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
41718 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
41719
41720 @table @asis
41721 @item Synopsis:
41722 @smallexample
41723 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
41724 @end smallexample
41725
41726 @item Request:
41727 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41728
41729 @item Return value:
41730 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
41731 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
41732 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
41733
41734 @item Errors:
41735
41736 @table @code
41737 @item EBADF
41738 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41739 reading.
41740
41741 @item EFAULT
41742 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41743
41744 @item EINTR
41745 The call was interrupted by the user.
41746 @end table
41747
41748 @end table
41749
41750 @node write
41751 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
41752 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
41753
41754 @table @asis
41755 @item Synopsis:
41756 @smallexample
41757 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
41758 @end smallexample
41759
41760 @item Request:
41761 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41762
41763 @item Return value:
41764 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
41765 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
41766 is returned.
41767
41768 @item Errors:
41769
41770 @table @code
41771 @item EBADF
41772 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41773 writing.
41774
41775 @item EFAULT
41776 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41777
41778 @item EFBIG
41779 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
41780 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
41781
41782 @item ENOSPC
41783 No space on device to write the data.
41784
41785 @item EINTR
41786 The call was interrupted by the user.
41787 @end table
41788
41789 @end table
41790
41791 @node lseek
41792 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
41793 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
41794
41795 @table @asis
41796 @item Synopsis:
41797 @smallexample
41798 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
41799 @end smallexample
41800
41801 @item Request:
41802 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
41803
41804 @var{flag} is one of:
41805
41806 @table @code
41807 @item SEEK_SET
41808 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
41809
41810 @item SEEK_CUR
41811 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
41812 bytes.
41813
41814 @item SEEK_END
41815 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
41816 bytes.
41817 @end table
41818
41819 @item Return value:
41820 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
41821 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
41822 value of -1 is returned.
41823
41824 @item Errors:
41825
41826 @table @code
41827 @item EBADF
41828 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
41829
41830 @item ESPIPE
41831 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
41832
41833 @item EINVAL
41834 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
41835
41836 @item EINTR
41837 The call was interrupted by the user.
41838 @end table
41839
41840 @end table
41841
41842 @node rename
41843 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41844 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41845
41846 @table @asis
41847 @item Synopsis:
41848 @smallexample
41849 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41850 @end smallexample
41851
41852 @item Request:
41853 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41854
41855 @item Return value:
41856 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41857
41858 @item Errors:
41859
41860 @table @code
41861 @item EISDIR
41862 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41863 directory.
41864
41865 @item EEXIST
41866 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41867
41868 @item EBUSY
41869 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41870 process.
41871
41872 @item EINVAL
41873 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41874 of itself.
41875
41876 @item ENOTDIR
41877 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41878 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41879 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41880
41881 @item EFAULT
41882 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41883
41884 @item EACCES
41885 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41886
41887 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41888
41889 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41890
41891 @item ENOENT
41892 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41893
41894 @item EROFS
41895 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41896
41897 @item ENOSPC
41898 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41899 directory entry.
41900
41901 @item EINTR
41902 The call was interrupted by the user.
41903 @end table
41904
41905 @end table
41906
41907 @node unlink
41908 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41909 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41910
41911 @table @asis
41912 @item Synopsis:
41913 @smallexample
41914 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41915 @end smallexample
41916
41917 @item Request:
41918 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41919
41920 @item Return value:
41921 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41922
41923 @item Errors:
41924
41925 @table @code
41926 @item EACCES
41927 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41928
41929 @item EPERM
41930 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41931
41932 @item EBUSY
41933 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41934 being used by another process.
41935
41936 @item EFAULT
41937 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41938
41939 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41940 @var{pathname} was too long.
41941
41942 @item ENOENT
41943 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41944
41945 @item ENOTDIR
41946 A component of the path is not a directory.
41947
41948 @item EROFS
41949 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41950
41951 @item EINTR
41952 The call was interrupted by the user.
41953 @end table
41954
41955 @end table
41956
41957 @node stat/fstat
41958 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41959 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41960 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41961
41962 @table @asis
41963 @item Synopsis:
41964 @smallexample
41965 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41966 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41967 @end smallexample
41968
41969 @item Request:
41970 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41971 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41972
41973 @item Return value:
41974 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41975
41976 @item Errors:
41977
41978 @table @code
41979 @item EBADF
41980 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41981
41982 @item ENOENT
41983 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41984 path is an empty string.
41985
41986 @item ENOTDIR
41987 A component of the path is not a directory.
41988
41989 @item EFAULT
41990 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41991
41992 @item EACCES
41993 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41994
41995 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41996 @var{pathname} was too long.
41997
41998 @item EINTR
41999 The call was interrupted by the user.
42000 @end table
42001
42002 @end table
42003
42004 @node gettimeofday
42005 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
42006 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
42007
42008 @table @asis
42009 @item Synopsis:
42010 @smallexample
42011 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
42012 @end smallexample
42013
42014 @item Request:
42015 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
42016
42017 @item Return value:
42018 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
42019
42020 @item Errors:
42021
42022 @table @code
42023 @item EINVAL
42024 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
42025
42026 @item EFAULT
42027 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42028 @end table
42029
42030 @end table
42031
42032 @node isatty
42033 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
42034 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
42035
42036 @table @asis
42037 @item Synopsis:
42038 @smallexample
42039 int isatty(int fd);
42040 @end smallexample
42041
42042 @item Request:
42043 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
42044
42045 @item Return value:
42046 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
42047
42048 @item Errors:
42049
42050 @table @code
42051 @item EINTR
42052 The call was interrupted by the user.
42053 @end table
42054
42055 @end table
42056
42057 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
42058 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
42059 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
42060 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
42061 needed.
42062
42063
42064 @node system
42065 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
42066 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
42067
42068 @table @asis
42069 @item Synopsis:
42070 @smallexample
42071 int system(const char *command);
42072 @end smallexample
42073
42074 @item Request:
42075 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
42076
42077 @item Return value:
42078 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
42079 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
42080 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
42081 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
42082 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
42083 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
42084 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
42085
42086 @item Errors:
42087
42088 @table @code
42089 @item EINTR
42090 The call was interrupted by the user.
42091 @end table
42092
42093 @end table
42094
42095 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
42096 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
42097 the host is simplified before it's returned
42098 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
42099 is discarded, and the return value consists
42100 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
42101
42102 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
42103 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
42104 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
42105
42106 @table @code
42107 @item set remote system-call-allowed
42108 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
42109 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
42110 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
42111
42112 @item show remote system-call-allowed
42113 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
42114 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
42115 protocol.
42116 @end table
42117
42118 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
42119 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
42120 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
42121
42122 @menu
42123 * Integral Datatypes::
42124 * Pointer Values::
42125 * Memory Transfer::
42126 * struct stat::
42127 * struct timeval::
42128 @end menu
42129
42130 @node Integral Datatypes
42131 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
42132 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
42133
42134 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
42135 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
42136 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
42137
42138 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
42139 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
42140
42141 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
42142
42143 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
42144 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
42145
42146 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
42147
42148 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
42149 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
42150 byte order.
42151
42152 @node Pointer Values
42153 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
42154 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
42155
42156 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
42157 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
42158 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
42159 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
42160
42161 @smallexample
42162 @code{1aaf/12}
42163 @end smallexample
42164
42165 @noindent
42166 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
42167 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
42168 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
42169 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
42170
42171 @smallexample
42172 @code{123456/d}
42173 @end smallexample
42174
42175 @node Memory Transfer
42176 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
42177 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
42178
42179 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
42180 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
42181 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
42182 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
42183 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
42184 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
42185 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
42186
42187
42188 @node struct stat
42189 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
42190 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
42191
42192 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
42193 is defined as follows:
42194
42195 @smallexample
42196 struct stat @{
42197 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
42198 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
42199 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
42200 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
42201 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
42202 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
42203 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
42204 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
42205 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
42206 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
42207 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
42208 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
42209 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
42210 @};
42211 @end smallexample
42212
42213 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42214 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42215 structure is of size 64 bytes.
42216
42217 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
42218 range of values.
42219
42220 @table @code
42221
42222 @item st_dev
42223 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
42224
42225 @item st_ino
42226 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
42227
42228 @item st_mode
42229 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
42230 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
42231
42232 @item st_uid
42233 @itemx st_gid
42234 @itemx st_rdev
42235 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
42236
42237 @item st_atime
42238 @itemx st_mtime
42239 @itemx st_ctime
42240 These values have a host and file system dependent
42241 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
42242 support exact timing values.
42243 @end table
42244
42245 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
42246 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
42247 continuing.
42248
42249 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
42250 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
42251 get truncated on the target.
42252
42253 @node struct timeval
42254 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
42255 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
42256
42257 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
42258 is defined as follows:
42259
42260 @smallexample
42261 struct timeval @{
42262 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
42263 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
42264 @};
42265 @end smallexample
42266
42267 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42268 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42269 structure is of size 8 bytes.
42270
42271 @node Constants
42272 @subsection Constants
42273 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
42274
42275 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
42276 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
42277 values before and after the call as needed.
42278
42279 @menu
42280 * Open Flags::
42281 * mode_t Values::
42282 * Errno Values::
42283 * Lseek Flags::
42284 * Limits::
42285 @end menu
42286
42287 @node Open Flags
42288 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
42289 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
42290
42291 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
42292
42293 @smallexample
42294 O_RDONLY 0x0
42295 O_WRONLY 0x1
42296 O_RDWR 0x2
42297 O_APPEND 0x8
42298 O_CREAT 0x200
42299 O_TRUNC 0x400
42300 O_EXCL 0x800
42301 @end smallexample
42302
42303 @node mode_t Values
42304 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
42305 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
42306
42307 All values are given in octal representation.
42308
42309 @smallexample
42310 S_IFREG 0100000
42311 S_IFDIR 040000
42312 S_IRUSR 0400
42313 S_IWUSR 0200
42314 S_IXUSR 0100
42315 S_IRGRP 040
42316 S_IWGRP 020
42317 S_IXGRP 010
42318 S_IROTH 04
42319 S_IWOTH 02
42320 S_IXOTH 01
42321 @end smallexample
42322
42323 @node Errno Values
42324 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
42325 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
42326
42327 All values are given in decimal representation.
42328
42329 @smallexample
42330 EPERM 1
42331 ENOENT 2
42332 EINTR 4
42333 EBADF 9
42334 EACCES 13
42335 EFAULT 14
42336 EBUSY 16
42337 EEXIST 17
42338 ENODEV 19
42339 ENOTDIR 20
42340 EISDIR 21
42341 EINVAL 22
42342 ENFILE 23
42343 EMFILE 24
42344 EFBIG 27
42345 ENOSPC 28
42346 ESPIPE 29
42347 EROFS 30
42348 ENAMETOOLONG 91
42349 EUNKNOWN 9999
42350 @end smallexample
42351
42352 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
42353 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
42354
42355 @node Lseek Flags
42356 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
42357 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
42358
42359 @smallexample
42360 SEEK_SET 0
42361 SEEK_CUR 1
42362 SEEK_END 2
42363 @end smallexample
42364
42365 @node Limits
42366 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
42367 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
42368
42369 All values are given in decimal representation.
42370
42371 @smallexample
42372 INT_MIN -2147483648
42373 INT_MAX 2147483647
42374 UINT_MAX 4294967295
42375 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
42376 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
42377 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
42378 @end smallexample
42379
42380 @node File-I/O Examples
42381 @subsection File-I/O Examples
42382 @cindex file-i/o examples
42383
42384 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42385 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
42386
42387 @smallexample
42388 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
42389 @emph{request memory read from target}
42390 -> @code{m1234,6}
42391 <- XXXXXX
42392 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
42393 -> @code{F6}
42394 @end smallexample
42395
42396 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42397 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
42398
42399 @smallexample
42400 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42401 @emph{request memory write to target}
42402 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42403 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
42404 -> @code{F6}
42405 @end smallexample
42406
42407 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
42408 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
42409
42410 @smallexample
42411 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42412 -> @code{F-1,9}
42413 @end smallexample
42414
42415 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
42416 host is called:
42417
42418 @smallexample
42419 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42420 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
42421 <- @code{T02}
42422 @end smallexample
42423
42424 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
42425 host is called:
42426
42427 @smallexample
42428 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42429 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42430 <- @code{T02}
42431 @end smallexample
42432
42433 @node Library List Format
42434 @section Library List Format
42435 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42436
42437 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
42438 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
42439 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
42440 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
42441 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
42442 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
42443 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
42444 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
42445 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
42446 are loaded.
42447
42448 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
42449 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
42450 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
42451 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
42452
42453 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
42454 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
42455 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
42456 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
42457 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
42458 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
42459
42460 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42461 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42462
42463 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
42464 offset, looks like this:
42465
42466 @smallexample
42467 <library-list>
42468 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
42469 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
42470 </library>
42471 </library-list>
42472 @end smallexample
42473
42474 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
42475 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
42476
42477 @smallexample
42478 <library-list>
42479 <library name="sharedlib.o">
42480 <section address="0x10000000"/>
42481 <section address="0x20000000"/>
42482 <section address="0x30000000"/>
42483 </library>
42484 </library-list>
42485 @end smallexample
42486
42487 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
42488
42489 @smallexample
42490 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
42491 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
42492 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42493 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
42494 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42495 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
42496 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42497 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
42498 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42499 @end smallexample
42500
42501 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
42502 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
42503 section for each library.
42504
42505 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42506 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42507 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42508
42509 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
42510 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
42511 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
42512 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
42513
42514 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
42515 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
42516 target, the following parameters are reported:
42517
42518 @itemize @minus
42519 @item
42520 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
42521 @code{struct link_map}.
42522 @item
42523 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
42524 (Thread Local Storage) access.
42525 @item
42526 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
42527 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
42528 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
42529 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
42530 @item
42531 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
42532 @end itemize
42533
42534 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
42535 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
42536 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
42537
42538 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42539 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42540
42541 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
42542 looks like this:
42543
42544 @smallexample
42545 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
42546 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
42547 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
42548 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
42549 l_ld="0x152350"/>
42550 </library-list-svr>
42551 @end smallexample
42552
42553 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
42554
42555 @smallexample
42556 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
42557 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
42558 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42559 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
42560 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
42561 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42562 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
42563 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
42564 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
42565 @end smallexample
42566
42567 @node Memory Map Format
42568 @section Memory Map Format
42569 @cindex memory map format
42570
42571 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
42572 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
42573 memory map.
42574
42575 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
42576 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
42577 lists memory regions.
42578
42579 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42580 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
42581
42582 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42583
42584 @smallexample
42585 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42586 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
42587 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42588 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
42589 <memory-map>
42590 region...
42591 </memory-map>
42592 @end smallexample
42593
42594 Each region can be either:
42595
42596 @itemize
42597
42598 @item
42599 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
42600 bytes from there:
42601
42602 @smallexample
42603 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42604 @end smallexample
42605
42606
42607 @item
42608 A region of read-only memory:
42609
42610 @smallexample
42611 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42612 @end smallexample
42613
42614
42615 @item
42616 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
42617 bytes in length:
42618
42619 @smallexample
42620 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
42621 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
42622 </memory>
42623 @end smallexample
42624
42625 @end itemize
42626
42627 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
42628 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
42629 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
42630
42631 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
42632
42633 @smallexample
42634 <!-- ................................................... -->
42635 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
42636 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
42637 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
42638 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
42639 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
42640 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
42641 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
42642 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
42643 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
42644 and its type, or device. -->
42645 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
42646 start CDATA #REQUIRED
42647 length CDATA #REQUIRED
42648 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
42649 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
42650 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
42651 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42652 @end smallexample
42653
42654 @node Thread List Format
42655 @section Thread List Format
42656 @cindex thread list format
42657
42658 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
42659 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
42660 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
42661 the following structure:
42662
42663 @smallexample
42664 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42665 <threads>
42666 <thread id="id" core="0">
42667 ... description ...
42668 </thread>
42669 </threads>
42670 @end smallexample
42671
42672 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
42673 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
42674 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
42675 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
42676 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
42677
42678 @node Traceframe Info Format
42679 @section Traceframe Info Format
42680 @cindex traceframe info format
42681
42682 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
42683 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
42684 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
42685 collected in a traceframe.
42686
42687 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
42688 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
42689
42690 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42691 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42692
42693 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42694
42695 @smallexample
42696 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42697 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
42698 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42699 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
42700 <traceframe-info>
42701 block...
42702 </traceframe-info>
42703 @end smallexample
42704
42705 Each traceframe block can be either:
42706
42707 @itemize
42708
42709 @item
42710 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
42711 @var{length} bytes from there:
42712
42713 @smallexample
42714 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42715 @end smallexample
42716
42717 @item
42718 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
42719 collected:
42720
42721 @smallexample
42722 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
42723 @end smallexample
42724
42725 @end itemize
42726
42727 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
42728
42729 @smallexample
42730 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
42731 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42732
42733 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
42734 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
42735 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42736 <!ELEMENT tvar>
42737 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
42738 @end smallexample
42739
42740 @node Branch Trace Format
42741 @section Branch Trace Format
42742 @cindex branch trace format
42743
42744 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
42745 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
42746 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
42747 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
42748
42749 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
42750 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
42751
42752 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42753 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42754
42755 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42756
42757 @smallexample
42758 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42759 <!DOCTYPE btrace
42760 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
42761 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
42762 <btrace>
42763 block...
42764 </btrace>
42765 @end smallexample
42766
42767 @itemize
42768
42769 @item
42770 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
42771 and ending at @var{end}:
42772
42773 @smallexample
42774 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
42775 @end smallexample
42776
42777 @end itemize
42778
42779 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
42780
42781 @smallexample
42782 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
42783 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42784
42785 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
42786 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
42787 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
42788 @end smallexample
42789
42790 @include agentexpr.texi
42791
42792 @node Target Descriptions
42793 @appendix Target Descriptions
42794 @cindex target descriptions
42795
42796 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42797 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42798 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42799 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42800 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42801 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42802 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42803
42804 @itemize @bullet
42805 @item
42806 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42807 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42808 @item
42809 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42810 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42811 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42812 @item
42813 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42814 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42815 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42816 @end itemize
42817
42818 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42819 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42820 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42821 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42822 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42823
42824 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42825 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42826
42827 @menu
42828 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42829 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42830 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42831 descriptions.
42832 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42833 @end menu
42834
42835 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42836 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42837
42838 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42839 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42840 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42841 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42842 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42843 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42844 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42845 Format}.
42846
42847 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42848 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42849 specify a file are:
42850
42851 @table @code
42852 @cindex set tdesc filename
42853 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42854 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42855
42856 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42857 @item unset tdesc filename
42858 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42859 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42860
42861 @cindex show tdesc filename
42862 @item show tdesc filename
42863 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42864 @end table
42865
42866
42867 @node Target Description Format
42868 @section Target Description Format
42869 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42870
42871 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42872 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42873 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42874 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42875 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42876 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42877 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42878
42879 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42880 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42881 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42882 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42883 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42884
42885 Here is a simple target description:
42886
42887 @smallexample
42888 <target version="1.0">
42889 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42890 </target>
42891 @end smallexample
42892
42893 @noindent
42894 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42895 the x86-64 architecture.
42896
42897 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42898 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42899 are explained further below.
42900
42901 @smallexample
42902 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42903 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42904 <target version="1.0">
42905 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42906 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42907 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42908 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42909 </target>
42910 @end smallexample
42911
42912 @noindent
42913 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42914 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42915 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42916 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42917 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42918 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42919 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42920 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42921 the version mismatch.
42922
42923 @subsection Inclusion
42924 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42925 @cindex XInclude
42926 @ifnotinfo
42927 @cindex <xi:include>
42928 @end ifnotinfo
42929
42930 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42931 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42932 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42933 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42934 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42935
42936 @smallexample
42937 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42938 @end smallexample
42939
42940 @noindent
42941 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42942 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42943 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42944 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42945 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42946 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42947 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42948 original description.
42949
42950 @subsection Architecture
42951 @cindex <architecture>
42952
42953 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42954
42955 @smallexample
42956 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42957 @end smallexample
42958
42959 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42960 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42961
42962 @subsection OS ABI
42963 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42964
42965 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42966 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42967
42968 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42969
42970 @smallexample
42971 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42972 @end smallexample
42973
42974 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42975 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42976
42977 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42978 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42979
42980 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42981 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42982
42983 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42984
42985 @smallexample
42986 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42987 @end smallexample
42988
42989 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42990 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42991
42992 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42993 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42994 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42995 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42996 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42997 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42998 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42999
43000 @smallexample
43001 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
43002 <compatible>spu</compatible>
43003 @end smallexample
43004
43005 @subsection Features
43006 @cindex <feature>
43007
43008 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
43009 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
43010 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
43011 has this form:
43012
43013 @smallexample
43014 <feature name="@var{name}">
43015 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
43016 @var{reg}@dots{}
43017 </feature>
43018 @end smallexample
43019
43020 @noindent
43021 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
43022 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
43023 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
43024 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
43025
43026 @subsection Types
43027
43028 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
43029 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
43030 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
43031 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
43032 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
43033
43034 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
43035 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
43036 Types must be defined before they are used.
43037
43038 @cindex <vector>
43039 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
43040 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
43041 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
43042 @var{count}:
43043
43044 @smallexample
43045 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
43046 @end smallexample
43047
43048 @cindex <union>
43049 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
43050 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
43051 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
43052 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
43053
43054 @smallexample
43055 <union id="@var{id}">
43056 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
43057 @dots{}
43058 </union>
43059 @end smallexample
43060
43061 @cindex <struct>
43062 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
43063 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
43064 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
43065 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
43066 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
43067 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
43068 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
43069 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
43070
43071 @smallexample
43072 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43073 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
43074 @dots{}
43075 </struct>
43076 @end smallexample
43077
43078 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
43079 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
43080
43081 @smallexample
43082 <struct id="@var{id}">
43083 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
43084 @dots{}
43085 </struct>
43086 @end smallexample
43087
43088 @cindex <flags>
43089 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
43090 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
43091 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
43092 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
43093 are supported.
43094
43095 @smallexample
43096 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43097 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
43098 @dots{}
43099 </flags>
43100 @end smallexample
43101
43102 @subsection Registers
43103 @cindex <reg>
43104
43105 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
43106
43107 @smallexample
43108 <reg name="@var{name}"
43109 bitsize="@var{size}"
43110 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
43111 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
43112 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
43113 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
43114 @end smallexample
43115
43116 @noindent
43117 The components are as follows:
43118
43119 @table @var
43120
43121 @item name
43122 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
43123
43124 @item bitsize
43125 The register's size, in bits.
43126
43127 @item regnum
43128 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
43129 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
43130 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
43131 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
43132 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
43133 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
43134 in order of increasing register number.
43135
43136 @item save-restore
43137 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
43138 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
43139 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
43140 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
43141 ABI.
43142
43143 @item type
43144 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
43145 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
43146 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
43147 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
43148 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
43149 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
43150
43151 @item group
43152 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
43153 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
43154 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
43155 in @code{info registers}.
43156
43157 @end table
43158
43159 @node Predefined Target Types
43160 @section Predefined Target Types
43161 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
43162
43163 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
43164 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
43165 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
43166 types. The currently supported types are:
43167
43168 @table @code
43169
43170 @item int8
43171 @itemx int16
43172 @itemx int32
43173 @itemx int64
43174 @itemx int128
43175 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43176
43177 @item uint8
43178 @itemx uint16
43179 @itemx uint32
43180 @itemx uint64
43181 @itemx uint128
43182 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43183
43184 @item code_ptr
43185 @itemx data_ptr
43186 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
43187 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
43188 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
43189 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
43190 may be marked as data pointers.
43191
43192 @item ieee_single
43193 Single precision IEEE floating point.
43194
43195 @item ieee_double
43196 Double precision IEEE floating point.
43197
43198 @item arm_fpa_ext
43199 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
43200
43201 @item i387_ext
43202 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
43203
43204 @item i386_eflags
43205 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
43206
43207 @item i386_mxcsr
43208 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
43209
43210 @end table
43211
43212 @node Standard Target Features
43213 @section Standard Target Features
43214 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
43215
43216 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
43217 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
43218 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
43219 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
43220 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
43221 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
43222 can recognize them.
43223
43224 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
43225 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
43226 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
43227 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
43228 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
43229 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
43230 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
43231 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
43232
43233 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
43234 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
43235 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
43236
43237 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
43238 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
43239 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
43240 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
43241
43242 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
43243 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
43244 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
43245
43246 @menu
43247 * AArch64 Features::
43248 * ARM Features::
43249 * i386 Features::
43250 * MIPS Features::
43251 * M68K Features::
43252 * Nios II Features::
43253 * PowerPC Features::
43254 * S/390 and System z Features::
43255 * TIC6x Features::
43256 @end menu
43257
43258
43259 @node AArch64 Features
43260 @subsection AArch64 Features
43261 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
43262
43263 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
43264 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
43265 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43266
43267 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43268 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
43269 and @samp{fpcr}.
43270
43271 @node ARM Features
43272 @subsection ARM Features
43273 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
43274
43275 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
43276 ARM targets.
43277 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
43278 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43279
43280 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
43281 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
43282 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
43283 and @samp{xpsr}.
43284
43285 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
43286 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
43287
43288 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
43289 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
43290 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
43291 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
43292
43293 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
43294 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
43295 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
43296 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
43297 halves of the double-precision registers.
43298
43299 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
43300 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
43301 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
43302 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
43303 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
43304 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
43305
43306 @node i386 Features
43307 @subsection i386 Features
43308 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
43309
43310 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
43311 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43312
43313 @itemize @minus
43314 @item
43315 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
43316 @item
43317 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
43318 @item
43319 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
43320 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
43321 @item
43322 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
43323 @item
43324 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
43325 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
43326 @end itemize
43327
43328 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
43329
43330 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
43331 describe registers:
43332
43333 @itemize @minus
43334 @item
43335 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
43336 @item
43337 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
43338 @item
43339 @samp{mxcsr}
43340 @end itemize
43341
43342 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
43343 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
43344 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
43345
43346 @itemize @minus
43347 @item
43348 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
43349 @item
43350 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
43351 @end itemize
43352
43353 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
43354 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
43355
43356 @itemize @minus
43357 @item
43358 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
43359 @item
43360 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
43361 @end itemize
43362
43363 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
43364 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
43365
43366 @node MIPS Features
43367 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
43368 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
43369
43370 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
43371 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
43372 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
43373 on the target.
43374
43375 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
43376 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
43377 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43378
43379 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
43380 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
43381 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
43382 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43383
43384 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
43385 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
43386 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
43387 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43388
43389 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
43390 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
43391 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
43392
43393 @node M68K Features
43394 @subsection M68K Features
43395 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
43396
43397 @table @code
43398 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
43399 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
43400 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
43401 One of those features must be always present.
43402 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
43403 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
43404 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
43405 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
43406
43407 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
43408 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
43409 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
43410 @samp{fpiaddr}.
43411 @end table
43412
43413 @node Nios II Features
43414 @subsection Nios II Features
43415 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
43416
43417 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
43418 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
43419 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
43420 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
43421 @samp{mpuacc}).
43422
43423 @node PowerPC Features
43424 @subsection PowerPC Features
43425 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
43426
43427 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
43428 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43429 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
43430 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43431
43432 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43433 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
43434
43435 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
43436 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
43437 and @samp{vrsave}.
43438
43439 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43440 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43441 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
43442 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
43443 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
43444 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
43445
43446 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
43447 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
43448 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
43449 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
43450 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
43451 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
43452 user.
43453
43454 @node S/390 and System z Features
43455 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
43456 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
43457 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
43458
43459 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
43460 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
43461 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
43462 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
43463 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
43464 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
43465 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
43466 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
43467 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
43468
43469 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
43470 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
43471 @samp{fpc}.
43472
43473 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
43474 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
43475
43476 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
43477 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
43478 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
43479 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
43480 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
43481 32-bit wide.
43482
43483 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
43484 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
43485 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
43486
43487 @node TIC6x Features
43488 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
43489 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
43490 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
43491 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
43492 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
43493 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
43494
43495 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
43496 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
43497 through @samp{B31}.
43498
43499 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
43500 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
43501
43502 @node Operating System Information
43503 @appendix Operating System Information
43504 @cindex operating system information
43505
43506 @menu
43507 * Process list::
43508 @end menu
43509
43510 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43511 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43512 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43513 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43514 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43515 on a different aspect of target.
43516
43517 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43518 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43519 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43520 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43521
43522 @node Process list
43523 @appendixsection Process list
43524 @cindex operating system information, process list
43525
43526 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43527 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43528 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43529 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43530
43531 An example document is:
43532
43533 @smallexample
43534 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43535 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43536 <osdata type="processes">
43537 <item>
43538 <column name="pid">1</column>
43539 <column name="user">root</column>
43540 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43541 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43542 </item>
43543 </osdata>
43544 @end smallexample
43545
43546 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43547 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43548 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43549 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43550 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43551 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43552 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43553
43554 @node Trace File Format
43555 @appendix Trace File Format
43556 @cindex trace file format
43557
43558 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43559 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43560
43561 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43562 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43563 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43564 in the future.
43565
43566 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43567 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43568 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43569 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43570 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43571 of this section.
43572
43573 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
43574
43575 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43576 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43577 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43578 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43579 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43580 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43581 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43582 endianness.
43583
43584 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43585
43586 @table @code
43587 @item R @var{bytes}
43588 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43589 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43590 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
43591 hexadecimal encoding.
43592
43593 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43594 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43595 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43596 @var{length} bytes.
43597
43598 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43599 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43600 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43601
43602 @end table
43603
43604 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43605 of blocks.
43606
43607 @node Index Section Format
43608 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43609 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43610 @cindex index section format
43611
43612 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43613 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43614 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43615 description.
43616
43617 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43618 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43619 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43620 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43621 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43622 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43623
43624 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43625
43626 @enumerate
43627 @item
43628 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43629 unless otherwise noted:
43630
43631 @enumerate
43632 @item
43633 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43634 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43635 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43636 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43637 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43638 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43639 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43640
43641 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43642 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43643 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43644 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43645
43646 @item
43647 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43648
43649 @item
43650 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43651 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43652 to the next offset.
43653
43654 @item
43655 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43656
43657 @item
43658 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43659
43660 @item
43661 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43662 @end enumerate
43663
43664 @item
43665 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43666 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43667 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43668 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43669 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43670 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43671 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43672 CU indices.
43673
43674 @item
43675 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43676 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43677 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43678 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43679
43680 @item
43681 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43682 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43683
43684 @enumerate
43685 @item
43686 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43687
43688 @item
43689 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43690 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43691
43692 @item
43693 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43694 @end enumerate
43695
43696 @item
43697 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43698 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43699
43700 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43701 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43702 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43703 constant pool.
43704
43705 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43706 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43707 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43708
43709 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43710 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43711 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43712 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43713 index version:
43714
43715 @table @asis
43716 @item Version 4
43717 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43718
43719 @item Versions 5 to 7
43720 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43721 @end table
43722
43723 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43724
43725 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43726 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43727 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43728 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43729 collision.
43730
43731 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43732 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43733 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43734 the code.
43735
43736 @item
43737 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43738 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43739 strings.
43740
43741 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43742 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43743 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43744 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43745 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43746 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43747
43748 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43749 @end enumerate
43750
43751 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43752 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43753 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43754
43755 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43756 (bit 0 = LSB):
43757
43758 @table @asis
43759
43760 @item Bits 0-23
43761 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43762 @item Bits 24-27
43763 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43764 @item Bits 28-30
43765 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43766
43767 @table @asis
43768 @item 0
43769 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43770 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43771 with previous versions of the index.
43772 @item 1
43773 The symbol is a type.
43774 @item 2
43775 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43776 @item 3
43777 The symbol is a function.
43778 @item 4
43779 Any other kind of symbol.
43780 @item 5,6,7
43781 These values are reserved.
43782 @end table
43783
43784 @item Bit 31
43785 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43786
43787 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43788 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43789 @value{GDBN} sources.
43790
43791 @end table
43792
43793 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43794 global/static attributes in the index.
43795
43796 @smallexample
43797 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43798 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43799 switch (die->tag)
43800 @{
43801 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43802 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43803 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43804 kind = TYPE;
43805 is_static = 1;
43806 break;
43807 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
43808 kind = VARIABLE;
43809 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
43810 break;
43811 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
43812 kind = FUNCTION;
43813 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
43814 break;
43815 case DW_TAG_constant:
43816 kind = VARIABLE;
43817 is_static = ! is_external;
43818 break;
43819 case DW_TAG_variable:
43820 kind = VARIABLE;
43821 is_static = ! is_external;
43822 break;
43823 case DW_TAG_namespace:
43824 kind = TYPE;
43825 is_static = 0;
43826 break;
43827 case DW_TAG_class_type:
43828 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
43829 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
43830 case DW_TAG_union_type:
43831 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
43832 kind = TYPE;
43833 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
43834 break;
43835 default:
43836 assert (0);
43837 @}
43838 @end smallexample
43839
43840 @node Man Pages
43841 @appendix Manual pages
43842 @cindex Man pages
43843
43844 @menu
43845 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
43846 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
43847 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
43848 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
43849 @end menu
43850
43851 @node gdb man
43852 @heading gdb man
43853
43854 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
43855
43856 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
43857 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
43858 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
43859 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
43860 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
43861 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
43862 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
43863 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
43864 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
43865 @c man end
43866
43867 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
43868 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
43869 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
43870 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
43871
43872 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
43873 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
43874
43875 @itemize @bullet
43876 @item
43877 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
43878
43879 @item
43880 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
43881
43882 @item
43883 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43884
43885 @item
43886 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43887 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43888 @end itemize
43889
43890 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43891 Modula-2.
43892
43893 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43894 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43895 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43896 by using the command @code{help}.
43897
43898 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43899 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43900 executable program as the argument:
43901
43902 @smallexample
43903 gdb program
43904 @end smallexample
43905
43906 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
43907
43908 @smallexample
43909 gdb program core
43910 @end smallexample
43911
43912 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
43913 to debug a running process:
43914
43915 @smallexample
43916 gdb program 1234
43917 gdb -p 1234
43918 @end smallexample
43919
43920 @noindent
43921 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
43922 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
43923 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
43924
43925 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
43926
43927 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
43928 @table @env
43929 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
43930 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
43931
43932 @item run [@var{arglist}]
43933 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
43934
43935 @item bt
43936 Backtrace: display the program stack.
43937
43938 @item print @var{expr}
43939 Display the value of an expression.
43940
43941 @item c
43942 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
43943
43944 @item next
43945 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
43946 function calls in the line.
43947
43948 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43949 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
43950
43951 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43952 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
43953
43954 @item step
43955 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
43956 function calls in the line.
43957
43958 @item help [@var{name}]
43959 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
43960 about using @value{GDBN}.
43961
43962 @item quit
43963 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
43964 @end table
43965
43966 @ifset man
43967 For full details on @value{GDBN},
43968 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43969 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
43970 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
43971 @end ifset
43972 @c man end
43973
43974 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
43975 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
43976 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
43977 encountered with no
43978 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
43979 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
43980 Many options have
43981 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
43982 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
43983 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
43984 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
43985 more usual convention.)
43986
43987 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
43988 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
43989 option is used.
43990
43991 @table @env
43992 @item -help
43993 @itemx -h
43994 List all options, with brief explanations.
43995
43996 @item -symbols=@var{file}
43997 @itemx -s @var{file}
43998 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
43999
44000 @item -write
44001 Enable writing into executable and core files.
44002
44003 @item -exec=@var{file}
44004 @itemx -e @var{file}
44005 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
44006 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
44007 dump.
44008
44009 @item -se=@var{file}
44010 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
44011 file.
44012
44013 @item -core=@var{file}
44014 @itemx -c @var{file}
44015 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
44016
44017 @item -command=@var{file}
44018 @itemx -x @var{file}
44019 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
44020
44021 @item -ex @var{command}
44022 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
44023
44024 @item -directory=@var{directory}
44025 @itemx -d @var{directory}
44026 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
44027
44028 @item -nh
44029 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
44030
44031 @item -nx
44032 @itemx -n
44033 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
44034
44035 @item -quiet
44036 @itemx -q
44037 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
44038 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
44039
44040 @item -batch
44041 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
44042 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
44043 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
44044 commands in the command files.
44045
44046 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
44047 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
44048 more useful, the message
44049
44050 @smallexample
44051 Program exited normally.
44052 @end smallexample
44053
44054 @noindent
44055 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
44056 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
44057
44058 @item -cd=@var{directory}
44059 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
44060 instead of the current directory.
44061
44062 @item -fullname
44063 @itemx -f
44064 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
44065 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
44066 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
44067 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
44068 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
44069 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
44070 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
44071 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
44072
44073 @item -b @var{bps}
44074 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
44075 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
44076
44077 @item -tty=@var{device}
44078 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
44079 @end table
44080 @c man end
44081
44082 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
44083 @ifset man
44084 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44085 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44086 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44087
44088 @smallexample
44089 info gdb
44090 @end smallexample
44091
44092 @noindent
44093 should give you access to the complete manual.
44094
44095 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44096 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44097 @end ifset
44098 @c man end
44099
44100 @node gdbserver man
44101 @heading gdbserver man
44102
44103 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
44104 @format
44105 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
44106 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44107
44108 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44109
44110 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44111 @c man end
44112 @end format
44113
44114 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
44115 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
44116 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
44117
44118 @ifclear man
44119 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
44120 @end ifclear
44121 @ifset man
44122 Usage (server (target) side):
44123 @end ifset
44124
44125 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
44126 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
44127 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
44128 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
44129
44130 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
44131 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
44132 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
44133
44134 @smallexample
44135 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
44136 @end smallexample
44137
44138 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
44139
44140 @smallexample
44141 @ifset man
44142 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
44143 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
44144 @end ifset
44145 @ifclear man
44146 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
44147 @end ifclear
44148 @end smallexample
44149
44150 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
44151 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
44152 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
44153
44154 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
44155
44156 @smallexample
44157 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
44158 @end smallexample
44159
44160 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
44161 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
44162 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
44163 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
44164 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
44165 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
44166 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
44167 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
44168 print an error message and exit.
44169
44170 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
44171 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
44172
44173 @smallexample
44174 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44175 @end smallexample
44176
44177 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44178 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44179
44180 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44181 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
44182 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
44183 the program you want to debug.
44184
44185 @smallexample
44186 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44187 @end smallexample
44188
44189 @ifclear man
44190 @subheading Usage (host side)
44191 @end ifclear
44192 @ifset man
44193 Usage (host side):
44194 @end ifset
44195
44196 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
44197 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
44198 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
44199 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
44200 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
44201 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
44202 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
44203 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
44204 descriptor. For example:
44205
44206 @smallexample
44207 @ifset man
44208 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
44209 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
44210 @end ifset
44211 @ifclear man
44212 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
44213 @end ifclear
44214 @end smallexample
44215
44216 @noindent
44217 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
44218
44219 @smallexample
44220 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
44221 @end smallexample
44222
44223 @noindent
44224 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
44225 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
44226 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
44227 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
44228 `Connection refused'.
44229
44230 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
44231 described in
44232 @ifset man
44233 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
44234 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
44235 @end ifset
44236 @ifclear man
44237 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
44238 @end ifclear
44239 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
44240
44241 @smallexample
44242 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
44243 @end smallexample
44244
44245 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
44246 case.
44247 @c man end
44248
44249 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
44250 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
44251
44252 @itemize @bullet
44253
44254 @item
44255 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
44256
44257 @smallexample
44258 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44259 @end smallexample
44260
44261 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
44262 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
44263 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
44264 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
44265 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
44266 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
44267 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44268
44269 @item
44270 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
44271 program:
44272
44273 @smallexample
44274 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44275 @end smallexample
44276
44277 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
44278 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
44279 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
44280 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44281
44282 @item
44283 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
44284
44285 @smallexample
44286 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44287 @end smallexample
44288
44289 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
44290 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
44291 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
44292 debug several processes in the same session.
44293 @end itemize
44294
44295 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
44296
44297 @table @env
44298
44299 @item --help
44300 List all options, with brief explanations.
44301
44302 @item --version
44303 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
44304
44305 @item --attach
44306 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
44307
44308 @smallexample
44309 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44310 @end smallexample
44311
44312 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44313 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44314
44315 @item --multi
44316 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44317 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
44318 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
44319 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
44320
44321 @smallexample
44322 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44323 @end smallexample
44324
44325 @item --debug
44326 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
44327 process.
44328 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44329 the developers.
44330
44331 @item --remote-debug
44332 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
44333 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44334 the developers.
44335
44336 @item --wrapper
44337 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
44338 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
44339 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
44340 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
44341
44342 @item --once
44343 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
44344 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
44345 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
44346 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
44347
44348 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
44349
44350 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
44351 @c QDisableRandomization.
44352
44353 @end table
44354 @c man end
44355
44356 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
44357 @ifset man
44358 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44359 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44360 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44361
44362 @smallexample
44363 info gdb
44364 @end smallexample
44365
44366 should give you access to the complete manual.
44367
44368 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44369 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44370 @end ifset
44371 @c man end
44372
44373 @node gcore man
44374 @heading gcore
44375
44376 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
44377
44378 @format
44379 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
44380 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
44381 @c man end
44382 @end format
44383
44384 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
44385 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
44386 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
44387 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
44388 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
44389 running without any change.
44390 @c man end
44391
44392 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
44393 @table @env
44394 @item -o @var{filename}
44395 The optional argument
44396 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
44397 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
44398 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
44399 @end table
44400 @c man end
44401
44402 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
44403 @ifset man
44404 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44405 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44406 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44407
44408 @smallexample
44409 info gdb
44410 @end smallexample
44411
44412 @noindent
44413 should give you access to the complete manual.
44414
44415 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44416 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44417 @end ifset
44418 @c man end
44419
44420 @node gdbinit man
44421 @heading gdbinit
44422
44423 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
44424
44425 @format
44426 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
44427 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44428 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44429 @end ifset
44430
44431 ~/.gdbinit
44432
44433 ./.gdbinit
44434 @c man end
44435 @end format
44436
44437 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
44438 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
44439 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
44440 described in
44441 @ifset man
44442 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
44443 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
44444 @end ifset
44445 @ifclear man
44446 @ref{Sequences}.
44447 @end ifclear
44448
44449 Please read more in
44450 @ifset man
44451 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
44452 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
44453 @end ifset
44454 @ifclear man
44455 @ref{Startup}.
44456 @end ifclear
44457
44458 @table @env
44459 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44460 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44461 @end ifset
44462 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44463 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44464 @end ifclear
44465 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44466 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44467 See more in
44468 @ifset man
44469 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44470 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44471 @end ifset
44472 @ifclear man
44473 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44474 @end ifclear
44475
44476 @item ~/.gdbinit
44477 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44478 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44479
44480 @item ./.gdbinit
44481 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44482 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44483 See more in
44484 @ifset man
44485 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44486 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44487 @end ifset
44488 @ifclear man
44489 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44490 @end ifclear
44491 @end table
44492 @c man end
44493
44494 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44495 @ifset man
44496 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44497
44498 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44499 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44500 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44501
44502 @smallexample
44503 info gdb
44504 @end smallexample
44505
44506 should give you access to the complete manual.
44507
44508 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44509 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44510 @end ifset
44511 @c man end
44512
44513 @include gpl.texi
44514
44515 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44516 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44517 @include fdl.texi
44518
44519 @node Concept Index
44520 @unnumbered Concept Index
44521
44522 @printindex cp
44523
44524 @node Command and Variable Index
44525 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44526
44527 @printindex fn
44528
44529 @tex
44530 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44531 % meantime:
44532 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44533 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44534 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44535 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44536 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44537 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44538 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44539 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44540 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44541 \page\colophon
44542 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44543 @end tex
44544
44545 @bye
This page took 1.631916 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.